Marketing Case Analysis

profilesheuebdh15
AnatomyofaBusinessPlan.PDF

Anatomy of a

BUSINESS PLAN

The Step-by-Step Guide to Building a Business and Securing Your Company’s Future

7th Edition

eBook

Used by over 1 million business owners

Discount coupon included for our business plan software

Linda Pinson Author of the SBA Publication, “How to Write a Business Plan”

4 top-notch real business plans including all financial documents

Used successfully for 20 years by business owners, corporations, banks, and venture capitalists

Up-to-date research resource guide for accessing online and offline marketing and financial information

Add our award-winning software to save 100+ hours and make it easier to write a winning business plan

Business planning guide for nonprofits

Ready-to-use forms and worksheets

Seventh Edition

Anatomy of a

Business Plan The Step-by-Step Guide to Building Your Business and Securing Your Company’s Future

Linda Pinson

published by

Out of Your Mind… and Into the MarketplaceTM

ii

© 2008 Linda Pinson. All rights reserved. ISBN 0-944205-35-6 Anatomy of a Business Plan, 7th edition, eBook (for Windows® and Macintosh®)

If this book is distributed with AUTOMATE YOUR BUSINESS PLAN software that includes an end-user agreement, this book, as well as the software distributed with it, is furnished under license and may be used or copied only in accordance with the terms of such license. Except as permitted by any such license, no part of this book may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, recording, or otherwise, without the prior written permission of Linda Pinson. Please note that the content in this book is also protected under copyright law even if it is not distributed with software that includes an end-user license agreement.

Note: Further be advised that the publishing rights for the printed version of Anatomy of a Business Plan are also owned by Linda Pinson, Out of Your Mind…and Into the Marketplace™ publishing company in Tustin, CA. Print this file for your own use only. The content of this book is furnished for informational use only, is subject to change without notice, and should not be construed as a commitment by Linda Pinson. Linda Pinson assumes no responsibility or liability for any errors or inaccuracies that may appear in the informational content contained in this guide. Please remember that existing artwork or images that you may want to include in your business plan may be protected under copyright law. The unauthorized incorporation of such material into your new work could be a violation of the rights of the copyright owner. Please be sure to obtain any permission required from the copyright owner. Any references to company names in sample templates are for demonstration purposes only and are not intended to refer to any actual organization unless otherwise noted. Automate Your Business Plan™ and OUT OF YOUR MIND…AND INTO THE MARKETPLACE™ are trademarks of Linda Pinson. The cover photo is used by permission and copyrighted by the photographer, Andres Rodriguez. (© Andres Rodriguez. Image from BigStockPhotos.com) All other trademarks and copyrights are the property of their respective owners. Linda Pinson

OUT OF YOUR MIND… AND INTO THE MARKETPLACE™

13381 White Sand Drive Tustin, California 92780-4565, USA

Tel: 714-544-0248 Fax: 714-730-1414 Email: [email protected] Web site: www.business-plan.com

eBook Version 2005 6th Edition

iii

Praise for Previous Editions Anatomy of a Business Plan & Automate Your Business Plan “Anatomy of a Business Plan and Automate Your Business Plan have served as excellent business planning and financial analysis tools for Dale Carnegie© Training Centers Worldwide.”

Marc K. Johnston Senior Vice President, Franchise Development

Dale Carnegie© Training Centers Worldwide

“Anatomy of a Business Plan is one of the best books on the basics of putting together a thoughtful, thorough, and professional business plan.”

Jeffrey L. Seglin Inc. Magazine

“Simply put, Anatomy of a Business Plan with its companion software, Automate Your business Plan, is the best step-by-step guide to starting, building, and raising capital for your business. We have raised over $20 million for our clients by using it, and we have an additional $15 million pending. Use it; it works!”

Thomas Jay Wacker Centaur Holdings Corporation

“I recently reviewed two loan applications that included business plans. The most noteworthy item in both of these applications was the business plan. After reading each one, my confidence was greatly boosted. Each applicant stated that Linda Pinson’s software and book were easy to use. By the way, both loans were approved.”

Nancy Russell Comerica Bank

“Most business plan books need updating to account for new tax laws and other changes. This 6th edition (of Anatomy of a Business Plan) is one of the newest – and best – on the topic.”

Mark Henricks Crain’s Chicago Business

iv

About the Author Linda Pinson is an award-winning author, business planning expert, speaker, consultant, and nationally recognized business educator with a specialty in financial management and small business curriculum development. The author of nine popular entrepreneurial books, she has also developed and published the best selling business plan software program, Automate Your Business Plan™. Linda's books are widely used as curriculum in colleges and universities. They have been translated into several foreign languages including Spanish, Chinese, and Italian. Anatomy of a Business Plan has also been localized for Australia and the UK. Automate Your Business Plan™ has been customized for corporations and associations including Dale Carnegie® Training Centers Worldwide and The American Bar Association. Linda’s has been widely recognized and utilized as a business planning and financial expert, contracting with U.S. Government Accountability Office, Visa, MSN, and others. Linda is an officer on the Board of Directors of the Small Business Financial Development Corporation (CA state lending program). She also serves on the Tri County SBDC Advisory Board and is a member of the Entrepreneurial Advisory Committee at California State University at Fullerton. Her dedication to the small business community has been recognized through awards from the U.S. Small Business Administration, the National Association of Women Business Owners, and the State of California. Linda served as a delegate and tax issue chair at the White House Conference on Small Business. Linda resides in Tustin, California with her husband Ray. She is an avid golfer (one hole- in-one) and bowler, paints watercolors, and loves to fish. Linda and Ray have two sons, two daughter-in-laws, two grandsons, and one granddaughter (all great, of course).

v

Dedication It is with a great deal of pleasure that I dedicate this book to Tom Drewes, former President and founder of Quality Books, Inc., my mentor and friend. His kindness and encouragement was my inspiration in 1986. Because of his belief in me, my books are now being used in libraries across the nation. Thank you, Tom for your many years of tireless dedication to independent publishers and for your willingness to share yourself with so many—and ask for nothing in return.

Acknowledgments During the writing and revising of seven editions of Anatomy of a Business Plan, it has been my good fortune (and the readers’) to have input from many business associates whose expertise in certain areas admittedly exceeds my own. I would like to acknowledge four of those individuals here.

• Bernadette Tiernan, owner of Tiernan & Associates, in Ridgewood, NJ, was instrumental in helping me with the development “Chapter 5, The Marketing Plan”. Bernadette was the Assistant Dean of the School of Business at Rutgers University and the author of E-Tailing and the great marketing book, The Hybrid Company.

• Dr. Donald R. McCrea, President of Bus-Ed Partners, Inc., Irvine California

(www.bus-edpartners.com) wrote the “Product-Market Analysis” section on pages 64-67. This is a very valuable tool for narrowing your target market to realistic customers. Don was also the developer of my interactive marketing research web page for AUTOMATE YOUR BUSINESS PLAN. He has 30 years of experience and was formerly Director of Executive Education in the Graduate School of Management at University of California, Irvine. Prior to that he directed the Executive Degree Program at the Peter Drucker Graduate School of Management at Claremont Graduate University.

• John Neal, CPA, of Paulin Neal Associates (www.paulinneal.com) helped me with

“Developing an Exit Strategy” on pages 7-11. His company provides interim management and special projects. Their services include strategic planning and business plan development, business modeling, capital formation, financial management, and others. John serves on several for profit and not-for-profit boards and is chairman of the Small Business Committee of the California Chamber of Commerce.

• Ndaba Mdhlongwa, owner of Business Plan Solutions in Dallas, Texas

(www.businessplanprofessionals.com) was the writer of the Wholesale Mobile Homes.com business plan in Appendix III and worked with the owner to write the Karma Jazz Café business plan in Appendix IV. Ndaba has worked with me for eight years on various other book and software tasks, including the development of a great Instructor's Manual for Anatomy of a Business Plan.

Thank you, Bernadette, Don, John, and Ndaba. Anatomy of a Business Plan is a better book because of you. I thank you—and I know that my readers would also thank you personally if they had the chance.

vi

Table of Contents

Author Bio (Linda Pinson) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv Dedication and Acknowledgments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . v Automate Your Business Plan companion software . . ix Preface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xi

Chapter 1 Business Plan Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1

Why Do You Need a Business Plan? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 What Do Lenders and Investors Look For? . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Developing an Exit Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Developing Financial Assumptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Introduction to Planning for a Nonprofit Organization . . . 14 Steps to E-Tailing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16

Chapter 2 Cover Sheet & Table of Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 What to Include on a Cover Sheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Sample Cover Sheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 The Table of Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20

Chapter 3 Executive Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Executive Summary Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Sample Executive Summary (not seeking funding) . . . . . 27 Sample Executive Summary (seeking funding) . . . . . . . . 28

Chapter 4 Part I: The Organizational Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Summary of the Business . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Products or Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Administrative Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Legal Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Management and Personnel . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Accounting and Legal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Insurance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Intellectual Property . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42

Chapter 5 Part II: The Marketing Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Section I: Overview & Goals of a Marketing Strategy . . . 44 Section II: Market Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Section III: Contents of Your Marketing Strategy . . . . . . . 50 Section IV: Customer Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Section V: Implementation of Marketing Strategy . . . . . . 62 Section VI: Assessment of Marketing Effectiveness . . . . 63 Bonus: The Product-Market Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Marketing Worksheets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Marketing Plan Outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75

vii

Chapter 6 Part III: Financial Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Purpose of Financial Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Types of Financial Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 How to Proceed: New or Existing Businesses . . . . . . . . . 79 Section I: Statements of Financial Needs and Uses of Funds from a Lender or Investor . . . . . . . 80 Summary of Financial Needs (Sources) . . . . . . 81 Loan Fund Dispersal Statement (Uses) . . . . . . 81 Section II: Pro Forma (Projected) Statements . . . . . . 83 Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Quarterly Budget Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Three-Year Income Projection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Break-Even Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Projected Balance Sheet . . . . . . . . . . see page 83 Section III: Historical Financial Statements . . . . . . . . . . 100 Balance Sheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Profit & Loss (Income) Statement . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Business Financial History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Business Financial History Form . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Section IV: Financial Statement Analysis . . . . . . . . . . 112 Analyzing P&L (Income) Statements and Balance Sheets (Ratio Analysis) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114-118

Chapter 7 Part IV: Supporting Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Personal Résumés . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Owner's Financial Statement (Personal) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Credit Reports, Leases, Letters of Reference . . . . . . . . . 121 Contracts, Legal Documents, Misc. Documents . . . . . . . 122 Résumé Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Personal Financial History Form . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Trading Offer Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126

Chapter 8 U.S. Tax Information: Aid to Business Planning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127

Comparing U.S. Tax System and Business Accounting 128 Federal Taxes for Which You May be Liable . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Tax Calendar – Sole Proprietor . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Tax Calendar – Partnership . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Tax Calendar – S Corporation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 Tax Calendar – Corporation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Free Tax Publications Available From the IRS . . . . . . . . 134 Order Form for IRS Forms and Publications . . . . . . . . . . 136

Chapter 9 Business Planning for a Nonprofit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 Understanding Nonprofits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 Business Planning for Your Nonprofit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Executive Summary & Organizational Plan . . . . 140 Marketing Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Financial Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Supporting Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150

viii

Chapter 10 Packaging and Updating Your Business Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Part I: Business Plan Software Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Part II: Packaging for Success . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Part III: Keeping Your Business Plan Up-to-Date . . . . . . 154

Chapter 11 Financing Your Business . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Will You Need to Borrow Money . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 How Much Do You Need and When Do You Need It? . . . . 158 What are the Sources Available to You? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Debt Financing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Equity Financing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Which Type of Financing Costs the Most? . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Calculating the Cost . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165

Chapter 12 Resource Lists & Links for Business Plan Research . . . . . . . 167-76

Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177

Introduction and How This Plan Can Help You . . . . . . . . 177 Marine Art of California—Complete Business Plan . . . . . 179-216

Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217

Introduction and How This Plan Can Help You . . . . . . . . 217 Dayne Landscaping, Inc.—Complete Business Plan . . . 219-254

Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.Com Business Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255

Introduction and How This Plan Can Help You . . . . . . . . 255 Wholesale Mobile Homes.com—Complete Business Plan 257-294

Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295

Introduction and How This Plan Can Help You . . . . . . . . 295 Jazz Cafe—Complete Business Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297-330

Blank Forms and Worksheets (To Copy and Use) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331

Glossary of Business and Financial Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345

Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351

ix

x

xi

Preface

Thank you for choosing Anatomy of a Business Plan as the tool to help you write your business plan. I think you will be pleased with this new edition. It has often been said that, “You can run your business by the seat of your pants—but you will probably end up with torn pants.” One of the principal reasons for business failure is the lack of an adequate business plan. In today’s world, both small and large businesses have come to understand that they need to take the time to evaluate their business potential and map a plan for the future. It is also understood that lenders and investors no longer risk their money on a business unless they have good reason to think that it will be successful (i.e., profitable). It is the goal of this book to give you a clear, concise, and easy-to-understand process to follow as you develop your business plan. I have been working with business owners for many years and most of them have the same problem—they are experts in their industries, but are novices when it comes to business planning. In fact, many times, the prospect of writing a business plan is so formidable that business owners avoid it until it becomes a requirement for one reason or another. I, on the other hand, am not an expert in your industry. My job is to guide you step-by- step through the business planning process. If I am successful, you can follow that process, apply your industry expertise, and write a winning business plan for your company. Who is this book for? I frequently get asked if Anatomy of a Business Plan is appropriate for a big business or a tiny business—a start-up business or an existing business—high tech or low tech—a business seeking funding or a business looking for an internal planning tool—a product business or a service business—a restaurant or a technology business—a sole proprietorship or a corporation—or a division within a company. The answer is that it is the right book for all of the above. No matter who you are, the business planning process is the same. It is your focus that differs. If you are a smaller business and your business plan is intended only for internal use, your plan may be shorter and you may choose to address only certain issues. On the other hand, if your business is larger and more complex, you will probably need to put key people to work on the development of a more critical business plan that will be in keeping with your company vision. If you need funding, you will have to consider the goals of the lender or investor and address those issues. If you are a new business, you will only have projections. If you are an existing business, you will also have historical information. If you are a pure service business, you have no cost of goods. If you are a product business, you do. If you are high tech or low tech, the process is still the same. The variable is how you focus on your specific industry.

xii

The simplification of your business planning task has always been the primary goal of Anatomy of a Business Plan. In order to get the most out of the book and to make your job easier, I would suggest that the first thing you do is read the book to give you a general overview of the format and content. After reading, you will be ready to begin working your way through the actual business planning process. Example Business Plans In the back of the book (Appendix I, II, III, and IV) you will find four full-length business plan examples that are for four different kinds of business. All four were written by the business owners and/or consultants they worked with. The common tools that they used were Anatomy of a Business Plan and its companion software, Automate Your Business Plan.

• Marine Art of California is a start-up product business. The plan is for a sole proprietorship dealing in fine art pieces. The owner is seeking short-time limited partners and plans to recapture 100% ownership within about four years. We have added a possible one-year history for this business to show what might have happened during its first year.

• Dayne Landscaping, Inc. is a one-year-old landscaping and snow removal (service)

business. It is a small corporation, seeking to expand into new territories. Dayne Landscaping, Inc. is planning to seek funding from a traditional lending institution (bank).

• Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. is a dot.com bricks and clicks start-up

corporation planning to go after $10 million in venture capital. Because the business is more complex and is seeking venture capital, the executive summary, and the organizational and marketing plans are researched more heavily and written in more detail.

• Karma Jazz Café is an upscale restaurant that is scheduled to open in early 2008 in

Fort Worth, Texas. This is the owner’s second location of the same restaurant. The first Karma Jazz Café is in Atlanta, GA and is successfully up and running. The newest restaurant is considered to be a start-up business, but is patterned on and utilizes projected and historical financial information and other knowledge gained from the Atlanta location.

The interesting thing about the four plans is that they were researched and written by different people. As you read them, you will find that each of the writers brings something new and different into the planning process that will prove valuable to you in your own efforts.

Thank you again for choosing Anatomy of a Business Plan to help you accomplish your goal. I appreciate your confidence in Anatomy of a Business Plan and wish you success in the writing of your business plan!

Linda Pinson

1

CHAPTER

1

Business Plan Considerations

A well-written business plan will provide a pathway to profit for any new or existing business. Your business plan will also provide the documentation that a lender or investor requires if you find it necessary to seek outside funding sources for your business. This chapter is designed to give you some background information and guidelines to consider prior to writing your business plan. Why do you need a business plan? If you need access to additional capital, what does the lender or investor want to know? What are the key words that make your plan more effective? How do you develop an Exit Strategy? Where do the numbers come from in your financial plan? What is different about a business plan for a nonprofit organization? These questions will be addressed on the following pages.

Why Do You Need a Business Plan?

What Do Lenders and/or Investors Look For?

The "Key" to Effective Writing

Developing an Exit Strategy

Developing Financial Assumptions

Guide to Using this Book for a Nonprofit Plan

Bonus: Steps to E-tailing

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations

2

Why Do You Need a Business Plan? Every business will benefit from the preparation of a carefully written business plan. There are two main benefits and an additional one if you do business internationally.

1. To serve as a guide for your business The most important reason for writing a business plan is to develop a guide that you will follow throughout the lifetime of your business. The business plan is a blueprint of your business and will provide you with the tools to analyze your business and implement changes that will make your business more profitable. It will provide detailed information on all aspects of your company’s past and current operations, as well as its projections for the next few years. Of course, new business owners have no history and will base the information in their plans on projections developed through current research of the industry. To be of value, your plan must be kept up-to-date. While plans presented to lenders must be bound, you may choose to keep your working copy of the plan in a loose-leaf binder. Then you may add current financial statements, updated rate sheets, recent marketing information, and other data as they become available.

2. As documentation for financing A business plan is a requirement if you are planning to seek financing. If you are seeking capital, the business plan details how the desired investment or loan will further the company's goals and increase its profits. Every lender wants to know how you will maintain your cash flow and repay the loan (with interest) on a timely basis. Every investor also wants to know also how his investment will improve the overall net worth of the company and help him to achieve his desired return on investment. You will have to detail how the money will be used and back up your figures with solid information such as estimates, industry norms, rate sheets, etc. Lenders and investors have access to statistics that are considered normal for various industries, so be sure that your projections are reasonable.

3. To work in foreign markets If you do business internationally, a business plan provides a standard means of evaluating your business potential in a foreign marketplace. More than ever before, world trade is essential to the health of the American economy and to the growth of most U.S. companies. No business today can afford to overlook the potential of international commerce brought about by changes in communications, technology, and transportation. The development of a business plan will demonstrate ways in which your business can compete in this global economy.

Take the time to write a clear, concise and winning business plan. The success of your business depends on it! One of the principal reasons for business failure is lack of planning. I firmly believe in the often repeated quotation:

"The business that fails to plan, plans to fail."

What Do Lenders and Investors Look For? If you are looking for lenders or investors to provide debt or equity capital for your company, it is to your advantage to understand the elements that each would most want to

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations 3

see in a well-written business plan. If you are seeking debt capital from a traditional lender (banker), you will have to prove that you can repay the loan with interest. You will present your business plan to the loan officer who will in turn prepare the loan package and present it to the bank's loan committee for approval. Investors (or venture capitalists) become equity (ownership) partners in your company and have different expectations. They want to know that the money they are investing in your company will result in a specified return on the investment. You can increase your chances of success with lenders and investors by considering the following:

1. What is your credit history?

Whether it's a credit card, a car loan, a personal loan or a mortgage – lenders will want to know your credit risk level and will look at your credit score. The most widely used credit scores are FICO scores developed by Fair, Isaac based solely on information in consumer credit reports maintained at the credit reporting agencies. A FICO score considers payment history (tradelines and derogatory references), amounts owed, length of credit history, new credit and types of credit in use. Your credit influences the credit that's available to you, and the terms (interest rate, etc.) that lenders offer you. FICO scores are utilized by lenders to make millions of credit decisions every year. More information on credit scoring can be found online at www.myfico.com

In short, you will need to provide a credit history that demonstrates that you are a good risk. A past bankruptcy or a history of late payments will serve as a "red flag" and send out a warning signal that you may be a bad risk. Existing businesses will submit business financial history statements, copies of profit & loss statements, balance sheets and tax returns for previous years. If you are a new business, your personal financial history will be examined. The owners of your company will probably be required to submit personal balance sheets listing their assets. Copies of personal tax returns may also be requested. Lenders and investors frequently determine character based on prior business and/or personal financial performance.

2. What collateral do you have?

What assets do you have—and what are you willing to risk for the success of your business? You may be asked to use your home and other liquid assets such as CDs or other investments that qualify as collateral. Evaluation of collateral is generally at liquidation rate and the lender will establish the order of his right to claim and sell the collateral and the personal assets of guarantors or borrowers. The amount and type of collateral you provide shows your commitment to your company and removes risk on the part of the investor (your new equity partner) or the lender (the bank, etc. that is granting your loan request).

3. Can you meet the lender’s or investor’s financial goals?

Lenders and investors want to know that you appreciate their needs and that you have given consideration to your company’s ability to fulfill their financial goals.

a. If you are seeking a lender Your lender (banker) wants to know that your company can repay the loan plus interest and, for the period of the loan, maintain a positive cash flow that will allow you to continue to operate your business.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations

4

If the loan is to increase assets, any asset that you want to finance must last at least as long as the loan period. For example, you cannot get a five-year, $25,000 loan on a piece of electronic equipment that is expected to become obsolete within two years of the date of purchase. The asset should generate the repayment of funds. Show in your financial projections that the object of the loan will increase sales, increase efficiency, or cut costs and will, in turn, generate added revenue for repayment of the loan plus interest. If the loan is for working capital, show how the loan plus interest can be repaid through cash (liquidity), generally during the next year’s full operating cycle.

b. If you are seeking an investor

Venture capitalists and other equity investors will frequently require that you provide them with an exit strategy. They will want to know where the business is ultimately heading. The venture capitalist firm is most concerned that the company has a high profit potential, that it is competitive, sustainable, and that it is something that they understand. They will want to see a financial plan that shows how the company will move toward its goals and produce the desired profit to be distributed to them under a predetermined agreement. As equity partners, investors have a say in how the company is operated. They will want to see a strong management team and will be the hardest to satisfy because they are putting their own funds at risk.

4. Is there a demand for your product or service? Be prepared to show evidence that your product or service is well-received by your target market (your customers) and that the demand will be sustainable. You can demonstrate demand through a favorable sales history, accounts receivable information, or purchase orders. If you are a new service company or a business with a new product, show customer acceptance through test market results, questionnaire and survey data, and testimonials. To be valid, the responses must come from your target market and not from friends and family. Test market your product and get some evaluations. Ask people who have tried your products or utilized your services to write testimonial letters.

5. Do you have an experienced management team? Business failure is, more often than not, due to management problems. It is a well- known fact that, in the 1990s, many technology companies went under – in spite of their state-of-the-art development skills – because they were sorely lacking when it came to management. Lenders and investors will undoubtedly take a close look at qualifications of the people who are running the business. Industry expertise is a definite plus, but management experience may be the defining factor for achieving profitability.

6. Have you established a proprietary position?

This means that you have secured your position in the market in some manner. It is important that there is something unique about your business and that you have protected this uniqueness in some way. This may be through copyright, trademark or patent. If you are located in a mall or shopping center, proprietary position might be established by working with the management to limit direct competition within a given radius of your store.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations 5

7. Are your projections realistic? Lenders and investors will measure your projections against current industry standards available to them through various sources. Base your figures on your current market share. Explain your opportunities for growth and demonstrate how you plan to make use of these opportunities. Each industry has its range of accepted financial results and market approaches. The most common error is overstating revenues and understating expenses. Projections that are outside of industry standards will quickly kill the perceived credibility of your business plan. Examine the annual reports of public companies in your field. Read trade journals, business publications, and government and industry reports to determine trends in your business area. Work out a realistic timetable for achieving your goals. Remember that lenders and investors judge your plan and goals in terms of your industry's practices and trends.

8. Do you have a strong marketing plan?

When a lender or an investor is reviewing your business plan, one of the primary areas of focus will be your marketing plan. As you write your marketing plan, you will learn that much of the emphasis is placed on the development of a highly targeted market that can be effectively served by your business—customers who need what you have to offer and who will choose you over your competitors and pay you to solve their problems and fill their needs. The lender will make an assessment regarding the logic of your marketing plan and will decide whether or not it is probable that, during the term of your loan, you will be able to sell to those customers in a volume that is sufficient to repay your loan plus interest. An investor (or venture capitalist) will not be looking at your marketing plan solely in terms of your current plans. As a potential equity partner, he or she will also focus on your long-term marketing goals, making a determination as to whether or not it is likely that the company can continue to increase its market share accordingly and generate the desired return on investment.

The Key to Effective Writing The text of the business plan must be concise and yet must contain as much information as possible. This sounds like a contradiction, but you can solve this dilemma by using the key word approach. Write the following key words on a card and keep it in front of you while you are writing:

Who? When? How Much? What? Why? Unique? Where? How? Benefit to the Customer?

Answer all of the questions asked by the key words in one paragraph at the beginning of each section of your business plan. Then expand on that thesis statement by telling more about each item in the text that follows. Stress any uniqueness and benefit to the customer that may pertain to the section in which you are writing. Examples will be given in the following chapters to give you guidance. Keep in mind, if you are seeking financing, that

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations

6

the lender’s or investor’s time is limited and that your plan is not the only one being reviewed. Often the first paragraph following a heading will be the only area read, so it is important to include as much pertinent and concise information as possible.

Effective Use of Your Time There is no set length to a business plan. The average length seems to be 30 to 40 pages, including the Supporting Documents section. Break the plan down into sections. Set up blocks of time for work with target dates for completion. You may find it effective to spend some time at the library where you will not be interrupted by telephones or other distractions. An added bonus is that the reference material you need is close at hand. It takes discipline, time, and privacy to write an effective business plan.

Supporting Documents You will find it time-saving to compile your list of Supporting Documents while writing the text. For example, while writing about the legal structure of your business, you will realize the need to include a copy of your partnership agreement. Write "partnership agreement" on your list of Supporting Documents. When it comes time to compile that section of your plan, you will already have a listing of necessary documents. As you go along, request any information you do not have, such as credit reports. If you gather the necessary documents in this manner, the materials you need for the Supporting Documents Section will be available when you are ready to assemble it. Remember that you do not need to include copies of all supporting documents in every copy of your business plan. If a potential lender or investor needs additional information, you can provide copies on demand.

Business Plan Outline With the previous considerations in mind, you will be ready to begin formulating your plan. The pieces of a business plan presented in this book are as follows:

Cover Sheet Organizational Plan Table of Contents Marketing Plan Executive Summary Financial Documents

Each of the areas of the business planning process is covered in a separate chapter of the book. Anatomy of a Business Plan is designed to help you write a complete, concise, and well-organized plan that will guide you and your company toward a profitable future.

The remainder of this chapter addresses four subjects that will help you to focus on your goals and write your business plan more effectively.

Developing Your Exit Strategy

Developing Financial Assumptions

Business Planning Instructions for Nonprofits

Steps for E-tailers

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations 7

Develop an Exit Strategy: START THE RACE WITH THE FINISH LINE IN SIGHT

Before you begin the business planning process, I would like to introduce you to the concept of planning your exit strategy. An exit strategy is not a plan for failure. It is a plan for success. Developing an exit strategy before you write your business plan will enable you to make the best decisions for your business. When you have read the following pages, you should understand what an exit strategy is and how you can apply it to the business planning process.

It is always good to utilize the talents of experts who specialize in areas that are beyond your specific expertise. With that in mind, I asked John P. Neal, CPA to work with me to develop a section on planning an Exit Strategy. John is a Managing Principal of Paulin Neal Associates (www.paulinneal.com), providing interim executive and consulting services to improve the profitability and enterprise value of client companies. He has founded several companies and serves on the Boards of a variety of companies and organizations, including the California Chamber of Commerce.

Where is the Finish Line? Have you ever seen runners line up for a race not knowing where the Finish Line is? This would never happen, right? Whether you are starting a new business or expanding a current business, the implication is the same. Before you begin the race you need to know where you expect to finish. Businesses are started for many reasons. Some of the more common reasons include:

• To build a business for yourself instead of for someone else • To pursue a passion (e.g. “I’ve always wanted to own a restaurant.”) • To be your own boss and the master of your own time • To earn money doing what you really like to do (woodworking, quilting,

photography, writing, etc.)

• To capitalize on an invention • To replace income from the loss of a job • To create net worth (long-term capital appreciation)

It is also inherent in the makeup of entrepreneurs to think early on about future expansion of their enterprises. What new products or services can be added? Can new markets be reached? Should additional locations be added? What kind of resources will be needed to reach my goal? The list of reasons for start up and expansion could go on and on. What’s really important, though, is to understand that, in all cases, it is critical to develop an exit (liquidity) strategy.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations

8

Developing an Exit Strategy Is the Secret It is a given that most investors (i.e., Angels, Private Equity, and Venture Capitalists), will require a well thought out exit strategy as part of the business plan for any venture in which they plan to invest. However, most entrepreneurs, intent on creating an immediate source of income or just caught up in the excitement of launching or expanding their businesses, have a habit of overlooking the “finish line”. Consequently, they are unprepared for this certain-as-death and taxes event. So, what should your strategy be? Understand that there are no right or wrong strategies, only different ones. Your strategy should fit your goals. The logical place to start is with your long-term goals. The most obvious and often cited goal is retirement. Some entrepreneurs like to develop one business and then sell it to start another venture. You may have other reasons that you foresee will eventually cause you to exit your own business. Whatever your goals may be there are three things that you need to know before you begin to build a better business plan:

1. Where you are headed

2. When you want to get there

3. What your business will look like when you arrive

What are Some of the Forms of Exit? Some of the potential forms of exit include:

• Selling all or a portion of the business. It may be possible to sell the business outright to an independent buyer. In that case, you will want to maximize the net income of the business and avoid having assets tied up in the business, which you would intend to later keep in your personal possession (e.g. real estate).

• Passing the business to a family member. This can be a good way to transfer value to your heirs in a way that minimizes estate taxes. Proper structuring is important, as well as determining who will run the business. Frequently, heirs are unprepared to do so.

• Selling to an Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP). This can be a valuable vehicle when the new owner group is comprised of key employees in the business. There are certain tax advantages to ESOPs. Existence of the ESOP can also add to the value of the enterprise by giving employees a sense of ownership in the business.

• Taking the company public. For those interested in gaining liquidity quickly while having the option to share in future stock appreciation, this might be a good option. The complexities of this form of exit are substantial, as is the demand on management’s time leading up to and continuing on after the “event”. This option is not for the faint of heart and requires a good deal of guidance from CPAs and attorneys!

• Liquidation. In some cases, the best option to gain liquidity may be to simply discontinue conducting business, sell off the business assets, pay off creditors, and keep the proceeds (after taxes, of course). While this is, in some respects, the

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations 9

simplest option, it often yields the least return to the owners because there is no value given for the “going concern” or goodwill of the business. This is often the method used when the business value is closely tied to real estate or other productive assets. It is also common for sole proprietor service businesses where income production is dependent solely on the owner practicing his or her skills.

Each of the above involves a variety of considerations. For instance, if you plan to sell the business, what kind of market can you expect for your type of business? How big might it need to be to achieve optimal value? Will you be expected to stay on for a period of time? If you plan to pass it on to a family member, who will that be? How will you train them to run the business? Will whomever you have in mind to succeed you be interested in taking over when you are ready to get out? When will you need to begin the transition? Many of these questions are difficult to answer, but ultimately your successful exit will depend on it.

Make Decisions Based on Your Exit Strategy If you will take the time to think about and answer some of these questions, a clear picture of your business will begin to take form. Three of the major decisions you will be better prepared to make will be: 1. selecting the source, type, and amount of capital you will need for your business, 2. deciding on the current form of organization, or legal structure, (sole proprietorship, partnership, or corporation) that will best serve your needs, and 3. considering tax issues that will impact your business. Financing Your Business Your choice of financing (source of capital) is important and will directly influence your choice of exit. Keep in mind, when considering financing options, not only the ease with which you can raise the funds you require to reach your goals, but the costs of each type of financing in terms of both money and relationships. In the simplest sense, capital is available from four sources: 1. yourself, 2. friends and family, 3. financial institutions, and 4. the public at large (including Venture Capital and Private Equity). The monetary cost of each of these options is generally inversely proportional to its personal or “relationship” cost.

• Yourself (owner financing). The first question you should ask yourself is, “Do I really need additional financing to meet my goals, or do I just need to manage my cash flow effectively?” The second is, “Am I willing to risk what I already have to pursue the new venture?”

• Friends and Family. Friends and family can be the easiest, quickest, and least expensive form of financing. However, the emotional or relationship cost can be very high. What if your business fails and you are unable to repay your friends and family? Receiving funds from a traditional lender or a venture capital firm will take far longer, but failure to repay them isn’t likely to affect your family gatherings.

• Financial Institutions (debt capital). In the middle is the traditional bank or finance company. Like the venture capitalist (below), they want to see a completed business plan before loaning any money to you. However, they don’t tend to focus on your exit. Instead they focus on their exit, which is repayment of the

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations

10

loan when it is due along with interest and other applicable fees. These lenders want to see that management will be able to generate sufficient income and manage cash flow in such a way as to ensure timely repayment. They typically require personal guarantees of the owners and often will require additional collateral, such as a lien on your house or other property, to further ensure repayment.

• Venture Capital and Private Equity (equity capital). Venture capitalists and private equity firms typically invest in opportunities in which they expect to earn a high compound rate of return and that will provide an exit (return of their capital along with a return, or profit, on that capital) within five to seven years. They require a complete business plan with a strong exit strategy. Exit in this case, is usually via an Initial Public Offering (IPO) or acquisition by a larger, often public, company. In either case, such an exit typically results in a change of management and loss of control of the entity by the founders. While the venture capital option can be attractive, obviously it is not appropriate under many circumstances.

Dealing with Legal and Tax Issues It is always a good idea to seek the advice of an experienced corporate attorney and a business accounting professional. Since laws vary from state to state, it is best to choose advisors familiar with the state in which you will operate and live. The determination of financing needs has a direct bearing on the form of legal structure you will need for your business. Thinking about your exit strategy will provide the basis for determining the form or organization that will best serve your needs as you pursue your goals. If you are a new business and the choice is not clear-cut, your attorney and tax advisor can help you make the best decision. Alternatively, if you are a current business that is planning to expand through the use of debt or equity capital, you may be advised that you need to change to a legal structure that will enable you to protect your personal assets and to ensure your ability to deal with your lender or investor.

1. Among legal issues that you and your advisors need to consider:

• Liability of owners, directors, and officers: Owners, directors, and officers may become liable for the actions and debts of the company in certain events. Reasonable protection from such liability can be achieved by a combination of effective use of elections and structuring alternatives and supplemented with Directors and Officers (D&O) insurance.

• Applicability of state and federal securities laws: Rules regarding solicitation of investors are complex and require close compliance to avoid civil and criminal penalties.

• Rights of minority owners: Access to books and records and minimum disclosure requirements create obligations requiring strict compliance.

• Ease and cost of transfer of ownership: Depending on your time frame for exit, some legal structures are easier to deal with than others.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations 11

• Buy-sell agreements among partners or shareholders: Terms and conditions for buying out a partner/shareholder or their heirs should be spelled out clearly up front to avoid later disputes.

2. Some of the tax issues to be considered:

• Treatment of capital gains upon the sale/transfer of the business: Tax events need to be planned far in advance. This includes available tax elections to minimize taxes incurred when all or a portion of your interest in a business is sold.

• Corporate and personal taxes: Proper structuring can strike an optimal balance between corporate and personal taxes and avoids double taxation.

• Title to any real property owned: Certain property may be best owned by partners/shareholders individually and leased to the business in order to achieve the lowest overall tax bill.

• Reasonable compensation limits: The IRS and state taxing authorities can set limits on the level of salaries to owner employees. Payments in excess of these limits become dividends that are taxable to the owner and not allowed to be deducted by the corporation.

• Retirement plans: A strong retirement plan can be a key tool for attracting high quality employees as well as providing for the owners’ retirement. A wide variety of plans exist ranging from simple IRA’s to complicated 401K plans. Each has advantages and limitations.

• Unrelated Business Income: If you are planning to start a “not-for-profit” corporation, which is not subject to normal income taxes, you will need to follow specific guidelines restricting the types of revenue you can generate. Sales of products unrelated to your not-for-profit business purpose may subject the organization to taxation.

Exit Planning Just Makes Good Sense! By now you can see that thinking in terms of your future exit strategy will help you with your financing decisions and with your legal and tax considerations as you write your business plan. Obviously, the less complex your business is, the fewer decisions you will have to make. It does not matter whether you are writing a business plan for a new business or for an existing business that is moving in a new direction. Business planning is an ongoing process. As you continue to operate, your goals may change radically. The current and future goals and their impact on your exit strategy need to be continually reflected in your business plan. With your vision established and sound financial, legal, and tax strategies decided upon, you can confidently build your business plan and ….

Start the race with the finish line in sight!

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations

12

Developing

Financial Assumptions

What are Financial Assumptions? Financial assumptions are the rationale upon which you base the numbers that you enter in your financial statements. A simplified example would be explaining that a marketing expense projection of $28,000 is based on sending out four mailings during the year (January, April, August, and October) at a cost of $10,000 for the initial mailing and $6,000 for each subsequent mailing.

Adding Financial Assumption Explanations to Your Business Plan When you are writing the text portion of your business plan, each part of the plan should be developed not only as a conceptual idea, but in terms of how it will generate revenues and/or incur expenses. For example, when you decide which legal structure suits your purpose, go one step further and find out what costs you will incur during the process. When you make decisions as to who you management team will be and what their jobs will entail, plan also what their compensation and your costs will be in terms of salary, taxes, and benefits. When you consider a marketing campaign, determine its costs, probable response, and projected revenues. In essence, every financial statement could have a sheet appended to it that explains how you arrived at your numbers. There are several scenarios you can choose to follow.

• You can develop a full sheet of assumptions for your pro forma cash flow statement and append it to the back of the cash flow statement. On the other statements you can clarify only items that need explanation.

• On all financial statements you can add explanations at the bottom to clarify any items that would be confusing to the reader. In this instance, you would make no reference at the bottom to numbers that you feel need no clarification.

• You can include a page labeled “Financial Assumptions” either before or after your financial documents (or at some other location that is documented in your table of contents). On this page(s), you can list your financial assumptions. It is best in this instance to divide them into categories: revenues, inventory expenses, fixed and variable expenses, loans received, loan repayments, fixed asset purchases, etc. Also have a start-up cost category if you are a new business.

My choice is number 1. After a certain amount of time, even the most astute business planner tends to get confused about where some of the numbers came from. This method puts the clarification in close proximity to the number it describes.

Having the pro forma cash flow statement fully explained has an additional advantage if you are approaching a lender or investor. The pro forma cash flow statement is of the highest priority in determining the validity of your request for funding. If you take the time to develop a full assumptions sheet for your cash flow statement, it saves the lender or investor valuable time in trying to determine the premises upon which your numbers are based.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations 13

What Is the Process for Developing Your Assumptions? There is a logical process for creating financial assumptions. The steps are as follows:

1. As you develop each piece of your business plan, remember to develop it in terms of revenues you expect to generate and expenses you expect to incur (as in the examples above).

2. Keep a piece of paper at your side. As you determine the revenue and expense dollars related to the task you are working on, jot down the assumptions that you have developed. Be sure to include explanations of when revenues will be realized and when expenses will be incurred.

3. When you are ready to develop your financial plan, gather your assumptions together in one place and use them as the basis for the dollar amounts you input. Finally, append your assumptions to your financial statements where they are needed for clarification.

Oh, No! Another Job to Do! Every time I revise this book or its companion software and think of something more to add to the business planning process, I also think the reader will cringe because there is one more job to do. Let me assure you that the benefit of going through the Financial Assumption process will be extremely valuable to you.

One of the most frequent errors made by people writing a business plan is that what they say in the text portion of the plan does not correlate with the numbers they use in their financial documents. In fact, some people try to develop their financial plans first and then develop their organizational and marketing plans. This is a fatal error. You must develop the qualitative information and then quantify it in your financial plan. If the numbers do not work out, then you go back to the drawing board and make new decisions that will give you better financial results.

By utilizing the financial assumption process, you will be developing your plan the right way—write the text, thinking in terms of revenues and expenses; list the assumptions on a sheet of paper; transfer the numbers into your financial documents; append any assumptions that are needed for clarification of numbers to your financial documents.

The financial assumption process will do two things for you. It will save you time because you will have all of your numbers at your finger tips when you are ready to develop your financial plan. The most important benefit, however, will be that your business plan will have absolute continuity between what you say in words in the text portion of your plan and what you say in numbers in the financial plan. In other words, the qualitative part of your plan will say the same thing as the quantitative part of your plan and the plan will be both credible and defensible.

Qualitative = Quantitative = Credibility + Defensibility

__________________________________________________ On page 30 of the Dayne Landscaping, Inc. sample business plan (Appendix II), you will find an example of one way of documenting a list of financial assumptions. The writer in this example chose to include it as one of the Supporting Documents. You can also see an example of a clarification of a single line item in the pro forma cash flow statement at the bottom of page 20 of the Marine Art of California plan.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations

14

New for nonprofits in this 7th edition of Anatomy of a Business Plan In the past twenty plus years, I have been asked many times by start-up and existing social entrepreneurs if Anatomy of a Business Plan could be used to write a business plan for their nonprofit organizations. My answer has always been,

“Yes, it can. The process for business planning is the same for a nonprofit organization as for a for-profit business. However, there are some topics in the text part of the plan that should be approached in a slightly different manner to reflect the mission and goals of a nonprofit. One example would be how you deal with target marketing. A for-profit company targets its customers. A nonprofit’s target market is referred to as it’s target audience and is divided into two categories – program recipients and funding sources. Also, there are some differences in the financials. For example, the chart of accounts is built around the nonprofit’s program services. In place of the product and/or service income categories used by for-profits, a nonprofit will have income categories based on its revenue sources, such as corporate and foundation support, grants and public funds, individual contributions, etc. Its expense categories differ in that variable expenses will be program- related. Terminology also differs. For a nonprofit, a profit and loss (income statement) is known as a statement of activities and a balance sheet is called a statement of financial position.”

Chapter 9

Business Planning for Your Nonprofit Although, we have always answered your questions, we have never had anything in written form to address the specific differences that need to be incorporated in the business planning process for a nonprofit. In this new edition of the book, you will find a chapter devoted to guiding you through those parts of your plan that require special attention.

How to Use the Nonprofit Chapter Business planning for the most part is the same process for a nonprofit organization as it is for a for-profit company. For that reason, you need to follow the book through each of the sections of your business plan, but you also need to know two things:

• When you are addressing a topic that is different for nonprofits

• What it is that you need to do that will be appropriate to a nonprofit

Nonprofit Organizations

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations 15

Follow The Process Below

• Spend some time reading the book. My first suggestion would be for you to spend a couple of hours going through Anatomy of a Business Plan to acquaint yourself with the business planning process and to look at the example business plans in the appendices.

• Read Chapter 9. Next, I would strongly urge you to read the nonprofit

chapter to gain a general understanding about business planning for nonprofits and to see an overview of the differences that will need to be addressed during the planning process.

• Follow the book. Now you are ready to start working on your business plan.

Follow the book just the same as you would if your organization were not a nonprofit. Most tasks will be the same for a nonprofit organization and a for-proit company.

• Use our icon. As you go through the next several chapters and develop

your business plan, you will see an icon next to the headings of those sections that will need special attention if you are planning for a nonprofit organization. The icon will look like the one below.

Page 143

NPO is short for nonprofit organization. The text below the letters tells you the page to go to in Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit, that will address the differences.

• Refer to the referenced page. Go to the page shown in the icon. Read the

instructions under the same heading. They will guide you as you develop that section of your business plan so that it will now be appropriate for your nonprofit.

• Return to the main part of the book to address the next topic. If there is no

NPO icon by the topic, you will follow the same instructions as a for-profit company.

By following the above process, you should find it fairly easy to develop a credible business plan for your nonprofit organization. It should have all of the needed elements that are appropriate to all businesses, but still have that special focus that is so necessary for developing and expanding a successful nonprofit. I hope you are pleased with the nonprofit chapter and with the process for utilizing it. Hopefully, the question I have been asked for many years is at last answered in this edition of Anatomy of a Business Plan. Best wishes to you as you develop a business plan for your nonprofit organization.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 1, Business Plan Considerations

16

Summary of Steps to E-tailing

Are You Planning to Be an E-tailer? If you are planning to sell via the Internet, the following are steps to follow as you plan, design, and set up your web site. As you write your business plan, incorporate the steps into the appropriate sections of your plan—organization, marketing, and financial. Step 1: Set Your Goals.

Be consistent with your Business Plan. Address potential problems from the start. Reinforce your marketing strategy.

Step 2: Access the Internet.

Determine which connection components should be upgraded. Implement changes (ISP, transmission speed, etc.) as needed. Will your current methods work to support your e-commerce goals?

Step 3: Promote Your Web Site.

Establish your presence on the Internet (domain name registration, keywords). Link to and from other sites that serve your target market.

Step 4: Design Your Web Site.

Project a professional image. Consider EDI compliance. Consider intranets and extranets.

Step 5: Create an Electronic Catalog.

Determine if Cyber Malls are for you. Achieve the best balance of graphics and text.

Step 6: Identify Your Distribution Channel.

Determine your supply chain. Create appropriate links.

Step 7: Develop a Method of Order Processing.

Have electronic funds transfer capability. Offer real-time payment solutions (credit cards, e-cash, smart cards).

Step 8: Select Security Systems.

Safeguard your customers’ privacy. Protect your confidential company records/data.

Step 9: Develop Inventory Tracking Procedures.

Cut your costs by tracking and controlling. Link to suppliers and/or customers as needed.

Step 10: Refine Your Customer Interface.

Encourage feedback from your customers. Track customer purchase patterns. Communicate with your customers.

Reprinted by permission: © 2008, Bernadette Tiernan (from her book, "E-Tailing”)

17

CHAPTER

2

The Cover Sheet and Table of Contents

The Cover Sheet of your business plan is like the cover of a book. It provides the first impression to the reader of your business plan. It should be neat and attractive and should contain information that will grab the reader’s attention. The Table of Contents is also an important element of every good business plan. It enables the reader of your plan to quickly find information on the various aspects of your business. The next three pages cover the following:

What to Include on a Cover Sheet

Sample Cover Sheet

Table of Contents Help

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 2, The Cover Sheet & Table of Contents 18

The Cover Sheet

What to Include on a Cover Sheet The first page of your business plan will be the cover sheet. It serves as the title page and should contain the following information:

• Company name

• Company address

• Company phone number (including area code)

• Web address, if you have a web site

• Logo, if you have one

• Names, titles, addresses, and phone numbers of the owners or corporate officers

• Month and year in which plan is issued

• Name of the preparer

• Number of the copy

• Confidentiality statement (optional)

The company name, address, phone number, and web site address should appear in the top one-third of the page. If you have a logo it will be an added enhancement to the page, especially if it is printed in color. Information regarding the owners or corporate officers of the business will appear in the center of the page. The bottom third of the page will contain the remaining information. The month and year in which the plan was written lets the lender know if it is up-to-date. For instance, if your plan is five months old, a lender or investor might request an update on certain financial information. Many lenders and investors prefer that the plan be written by one or more of the business owners or officers. This signifies a hands-on approach to the running of the company. Numbering your copies helps you keep track of them. Lastly, you may choose to add a confidentiality statement. See the example cover sheet in Appendix III, Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. cover sheet. Keep a log with the following information: number of copy, name of person reviewing the copy, reviewer's phone number and date submitted. This way you can keep up with the reviewing process and can make follow-up calls to the lender if necessary.

A sample cover sheet follows. As you can see, this one page contains a lot of information. It provides the name, location, and phone number of your business. By listing the sole proprietor, partners, or corporate officers, a lender or investor will know the legal structure of the business and how to contact key people directly for additional information. Keep in mind that lenders and investors must review many business plans in a limited amount of time. It is to your advantage to help them by making your plan thorough and concise.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 2, The Cover Sheet & Table of Contents 19

Sample Cover Sheet

AeroTech, Inc. 372 East Main Street

Burke, NY 10071 (207) 526-4319

www.aerotech.com

John Guzman, President 742 South Street

Jamestown, NY 10081 (207) 814-0221

Roberta Thompson, Vice-President

86 West Avenue Burke, NY 10071 (207) 764-1213

Thomas Choi, Secretary

423 Parker Place Jessup, NY 10602 (207) 842-1648

Althea Johnson, Treasurer

321 Nason Street Adams, NY 10604

(207) 816-0201

Plan prepared August, 2008 by the Corporate Officers

Copy 2 of 6

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 2, The Cover Sheet & Table of Contents 20

The Table of Contents

The Table of Contents is an important part of your finished business plan. It needs to be well-organized so that the reader can quickly find information on any aspect of your business. For example, if your executive summary gives an overview of the managers of your company, the reader should be able to look in the table of contents and find the page number in your organizational plan where you address the management. By the same token, the page in which the resumes can be found in the supporting documents section should also be listed. In the same way, marketing results can be traced through the marketing plan and backed up with copies of demographic studies, etc. in the supporting documents. Obviously, the Table of Contents cannot be finished until your plan is complete. You can use the headings in your business plan to develop the table of contents. Once you have finished your plan you can insert the page numbers. If, at some time, you alternately choose to print and bind only portions of your plan, the table of contents can be scaled down to match that version. The length of the Table of Contents will be dependent on the complexity of your plan. Most small start-up businesses will need only one page. Existing companies will have historical information and financial statements as well as projections. Larger, more complex companies will most likely have more detailed headings, especially if the company is going after venture capital. In all cases, your business plan will have the following major divisions in the table of contents. The subheadings will depend on your decision as to what you include in your plan.

• Executive Summary

• Part I: Organizational Plan

• Part II: Marketing Plan

• Part III: Financial Documents

• Supporting Documents The Tables of Contents in the example business plans at the back of the book should help you to see how your own can be organized.

Chapters 3 through 7 of this book will cover the above subjects in order and will guide you through the content and development of each one. As you think through each section, you can make your own decisions as to what you will address in your own plan and as to how the headings for those topics will fit within the table of contents.

21

CHAPTER

3

Executive Summary

The Executive Summary is the thesis statement of your business plan. It summarizes who you are, what your company does, where your company is going, why it is going where it is going, and how it will get there. If you are seeking funding, it specifies the purpose of the funding you seek and justifies the financial feasibility of your plan for the lender or investor. Although the executive summary appears near the front of the plan, it is most effectively written after the rest of your business plan is complete. At that time, your concepts will be well-developed and all of the important information and financial data will be available. Use the Key Word approach mentioned earlier in the book. In a concise, but powerful statement you will sum up the essence of your business plan by including answers to the following questions:

Who?

What?

Where?

When?

Why?

How?

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 3, The Executive Summary 22

What is an Executive Summary? As stated in the introduction, the Executive Summary is the thesis statement of your business plan. It summarizes the content and purpose of your finished business plan, covering all of the key points. It specifies who you are, what your company does, where your company is going, why it is going where it is going, and how it will get there. The Executive Summary can be approached from either of the two following perspectives.

If your plan is for internal use only and you are not seeking funds This statement would summarize your business. It would be a brief overview of the company’s goals and statement of how it will focus to meet its projections.

If you are seeking funding The Executive Summary specifies the purpose of the funding you seek and justifies the financial feasibility of your plan for the lender or investor. A lender or investor reading only the executive summary should quickly see the name, age, legal structure, location, nature, and uniqueness of your business including strengths and risks. The Executive Summary should provide a quick overview of your business’ past performance and of its future goals and how you plan to reach them. Information on the management team is imperative if you are seeking venture capital. Finally, the executive summary would include the amount and purpose of the loan or investment request, timing needs, justification for financing, and a repayment statement (lender) or statement of potential return on investment (venture capitalist).

For a lender. Address the question of loan repayment. The lender needs to see your company's ability to meet interest expense as well as principal repayments. The lender will want to know when the loan is needed and what you will use as collateral. For angels. The angel investor, jokingly referred to as the “Bank of Mom and Dad,” is generally a wealthy individual who becomes personally involved with a start-up company—loaning expertise, experience, and money. It is best to have a solid business plan to justify the funding. However, depending on the level of familiarity, you may be able to get by with a less than perfect plan. For a venture capitalist. The days of the easy flow of venture capital are long gone. Since the April 2000 public market correction, companies can’t depend on prospective future funding. They need to show evidence of progress and strong relationships. Remember that an investor will be an equity partner in your company and you will have to address how you will meet his/her goals for growth and profitability. After funding, the venture capitalist will very likely sit on your board of directors and serve as an advisor to your management. Increasingly, investors have been looking for an annual return of 45% to 60% over three to five years.

Your executive summary should generate excitement and give the reader an awareness of the uniqueness of your business and the qualifications of your management team. Do not exaggerate your potential. Rather, stick to projections that you can back up with facts. One of the greatest errors of business plan writers is the overstatement of projected market share and potential revenues.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 3, The Executive Summary 23

Finish Your Business Plan Before You Write the Executive Summary As you write your business plan and refine your ideas, you will probably discover new ideas and information that you will want to incorporate into your business plan to make your business more effective and profitable. For this reason, the Executive Summary is most effectively written after your plan has been completed. At that time, all the information and financial data will be available and you can draw it from the written text and financial spreadsheets. In addition, periodic updates of your business plan may require that you revise your Executive Summary to reflect the changes that will constantly be taking place in your business.

Use the Keyword Approach Use the keyword approach. The Executive Summary is generally contained on one page if it is for internal use. If you are trying to approach a lender or investor, it should not exceed two or three pages. In a concise and clear one- or two-page statement you will sum up the essence of your business plan by including answers to the following questions: Who? What? Where? When? Why? How?

The following pages will guide you

as you write your Executive Summary

Introductory Overview Begin your Executive Summary with a brief but concise overview of your business: who you are, where you are located, what you do, when the company was (or will be) established, and what makes your company unique.

Example. The following paragraph is a simplified overview for AeroTech, Inc. To see a fully developed example, take some time to study that executive summary in the Wmhinc.com example business plan in Anatomy of a Business Plan, Appendix III.

"AeroTech, Inc. was established in 1999 to meet the demand for specialized parts in the aerospace industry. This industry experienced moderate growth with an increase in contracts beginning in 2001. Industry projections indicate a growing demand for the type of products the company manufactures. AeroTech, Inc. maintains a competitive edge

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 3, The Executive Summary 24

with prompt order fulfillment, excellent customer relationships, and custom design capabilities .The company is adequately housed in a 10,000 square-foot facility and desires to meet the growing demand for its products through the purchase of new and more modern equipment, which will provide the opportunity for broader scope bidding, increased custom design capabilities, lower per unit costs, and faster turnaround time. In the next three to five years, AeroTech, Inc. plans to increase its current 20% market share to 35%.”

Market Opportunity Clearly define the opportunities in the marketplace that you are positioned to take advantage of. This information will come from your market research and SWOT analysis. Capital Requirements If your company is seeking funding, state how much capital you need. If your company is not seeking funding, delete this section from your own executive summary. Breakdown of Use of Funds Provide a breakdown of how and when your company is planning to utilize loan or investment funds. (See example table below). If your company is not seeking a loan or investment, delete this section from your own executive summary.

Breakdown of Use of Funds

Construction of New Facility Amount

1. Payment upon signing contract (4-01-08) $ 200,000 (from owners)

2. Completion of framing (6-01-08) $ 250,000 (from loan)

3. Completion of project (8-15-08) $ 250,000 (from loan)

Total from Owners Total from Loan Funds

$ 200,000 $ 500,000

Loan Repayment State your plans to repay the loan. What type of loan are you seeking? How many years/months will you have to repay the loan? What will be the amount and frequency of your loan payments? When do your payments begin and end? If you have figured out how much you will need, you can use an amortization application (such as the one in our Automate Your Business Plan software) to auto-calculate your principal and interest payment for any number of years. If your company is not seeking a loan, delete this section from your own executive summary.

Page 140

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 3, The Executive Summary 25

Mission State the mission of your company. The mission statement is a concise description of how you want your company to be viewed by its customers. It also states your company's vision as to future directions toward which it intends to move.

Example. The following is a mission statement for Wmhinc.com.

"At Wmhinc.com, our mission is to provide the most innovative and practical web based housing solutions. Wmhinc.com plans are to become a dominant player in the online marketplace, providing new, factory over-run, and bank-owned homes direct to the consumer."

Management Provide a brief profile on each owner. If you have key staff members who participate or will participate in the management of your company, also include a brief profile on each one. List their experience in industry specific areas. Include a brief experience statement as well as honors, awards, and recognition received.

Competitors Provide a brief profile on each of your direct competitors. Limit this section to major competitors. Also include brief profiles of your indirect competitors. List each competitor and give an overview of what services they offer. List the strengths and weaknesses of each.

Competitor’s Strengths and Weaknesses Outline the strengths and weaknesses of your competitors.

Your Company's Competitive Advantages Describe the factors within your company that give you a competitive advantage. This information can come from the Strengths section of the SWOT analysis you developed in the Organizational Plan.

Financial Projections Provide a summary of your income statement projections for the next three years. Include expected revenue, expense, and net profit projections for the three-year period.

Example. The following is a simplified example for AeroTech, Inc.

"Forecasts for identified revenue growth resulting from a devoted and loyal client-base and aggressive marketing initiatives indicate that AeroTech, Inc will exceed $11 million by the end of year 3. Net profit for the three years is forecast to be in excess of $4 million."

Page 140

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 3, The Executive Summary 26

In Summary The Executive Summary is just that—a summary of your business plan. If you are writing your plan to serve as a guide for your firm, and not planning to seek a lender or investor, writing an executive summary will help you to formulate a good overall picture of where you are planning to go in your business. If you are seeking a lender or investor, the Executive Summary will be the first introduction to your business and should answer key questions regarding your company and its potential for growth and profitability. Remember that the rest of the plan must back up what you say in the Executive Summary. For example, if you are sponsoring an event at a trade show in order to increase revenue, you must not only show figures on its cost, but must also demonstrate a ready market for the event in the marketing and financial sections. In supporting documents, you can back up the amount requested with information, such as event attendance, historic benefits of sponsorship, and the company’s personal experience. When you have finished with the formulation of your business plan and answered the key word questions, you will be ready to write your Executive Summary.

Note. To help you there are examples on the next four pages—one for a company whose business plan is for internal purposes only and one for a company that is seeking loan funds.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 3, The Executive Summary 27

Two Example Executive Summaries 1. If you are not planning to seek a lender or investor

The following is an example Executive Summary for a company whose goal does not involve seeking financing from a lender or investor. It is different from the second example in that it does not involve justification of financing or a schedule for receipt of funds, repayment of a loan, or plans for return on investment to a venture capitalist (equity partner).

BestCARE Company

Executive Summary

BestCARE Company is a partnership established in 2001, whose purpose is to provide quality full-time care to the elderly through licensed residential board and care homes. The company is administratively located at 1234 Hillside Drive in the city of Laguna Hills, California, the home of Jennifer Lopez, R.N., one of two partners. In addition to attending to the administration and accounting duties, Ms. Lopez also oversees medical services for the elderly residents. Her partner, Henry Johnson, oversees maintenance of the homes and does all of the shopping for food, furniture, patient supplies, etc. BestCARE Company owns and operates three five-bedroom homes within Orange County, California. Each home provides 24-hour per day, full-care services for up to six residents. Two fully-trained caregivers have been hired for each home and live on the premises. Contract-service caregivers work on the live-ins’ days off. The three current homes have now been running profitably for the last three years. Current research shows that there are twice as many families seeking board and care homes as the preferred lifestyle for their elderly parents than was the case in 2001. This has created a high demand where the supply is short. BestCARE Company is now planning to expand by purchasing two more homes over the next five years. The two new homes will be mortgage-free. They will be purchased with cash from previous profits from the company that have been retained and invested by the partners. This business plan will serve as a five-year plan that will guide the company through the administrative, marketing, and financial issues that are inherent in reaching a growth goal that will double the size of the company.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 3, The Executive Summary 28

2. If you are planning to seek a lender or investor

The following is an example Executive Summary for a company whose goal is to seek financing from a lender or investor. Unlike the second example (following this one), this executive summary will have to address the financing needs of the company in terms of how much money is needed, when it is needed, how the company plans to use the funds, how the use of those funds will achieve a desired outcome, and how and when repayment will take place to the lender. In the case of venture capital, you will project the investor’s return on investment. The lender or investor will also look for information regarding the management of the company.

See: Anatomy of a Business Plan, Appendix III, Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. business plan for the most comprehensive example of an Executive Summary (page 259).

AeroTech, Inc.

Executive Summary

Formed in 1999, AeroTech, Inc. was established with the objective of custom designing and manufacturing specialized parts for the aerospace industry. AeroTech, Inc. is an S corporation operating from a 10,000 square-foot manufacturing and warehousing space in Aerospace Tech Park, a light industrial park, located at 372 E Main Street, Burke, New York. In the past two years, the Economic Development Corporation (EDC) of Burke has been successful in encouraging large aerospace and technology corporations to relocate to the Tech Park. AeroTech, Inc. has developed excellent working relationships with the relocated companies. The company currently serves 20% of the total market with gross revenues of $3,650,000. Market Opportunity Burke EDC projections through the year 2011 indicate a 30% increase in tenancy in the Tech Park by aerospace companies. Federal government statistics project a 25% increase in the United States in aerospace development through the year 2020. Information from engineering and aerospace trade associations indicates that automation is needed to allow the company to remain competitive. By building on past working relationships with current companies and by actively marketing to new residents of the Tech Park, AeroTech, Inc. will be able to capture an additional 15% of the market; the Corporation’s share will be 35% of the total market.

cont. next page

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 3, The Executive Summary 29

Capital Requirements The company is seeking growth capital in the amount of $250,000 for the purpose of purchasing automated equipment and for training existing personnel in the use of that equipment. Modernization of equipment will result in a 35% increase in production and will decrease the unit costs by 25%. Funding is needed in time for the equipment to be delivered and in place by May 23, 2008. There is a two-month period between order placement and delivery date. Training of employees on the new equipment is projected to cover a two- week period following equipment placement. Breakdown of Use of Funds Provided below is a breakdown of the use of funds.

Activity Amount Automated Equipment $ 230,000 Personnel Training 20,000

Total $250,000

Loan Repayment Repayment of the loan and interest can begin promptly within 30 days of receipt of funds. The loan can be secured by company-owned real estate that has a 2007 assessed valuation of $800,000. Mission The mission of AeroTech, Inc. is to serve the aerospace industry, providing premium quality parts, value added services, and quality workmanship. The company’s experience and proven service to the aircraft industry have demonstrated its capability to meet current and future aerospace requirements. Management AeroTech, Inc. has a very strong management team as well as a board of directors comprised of several industry and community leaders. Brief profiles of the management team are provided below (See resumes in Supporting Documents).

John Guzman, President and Chief Executive Officer John Guzman was previously CEO for Omni Aerospace and was the force behind its well-documented growth between 1991 and 1998.

cont. next page

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 3, The Executive Summary 30

Management, cont.

Roberta Thompson, VP Marketing Director Roberta Thompson previously served as marketing head of the products division of ABC Corporation. Thomas Choi, Corporation Secretary Thomas Choi heads up Administration, capitalizing on his twelve years as an administrative executive with USAmerica Air. Althea Johnson, CFO Althea Johnson was a senior partner with JFG Accounting and successfully achieved turnarounds for several multi-million dollar corporations Donald Smith, Production Donald Smith came to AeroTech, Inc. following 20 years as an R&D and production engineer with Bordman Electronics.

Competitors Competitive threats come from Aerospace Manufacturing and Technology, AeroDesigns, Inc., Aero Parts & More, and Space Technology, Inc. While Aerospace Manufacturing and Technology and AeroDesigns, Inc. have longer operating histories, their technology is obsolete and subject to several inherent disadvantages. These disadvantages include longer installation time, more complex components and assembly, and excessive weight issues. Aero Parts & More and Space Technology, Inc. have technology that meets the unique demands of the marketplace. However, both companies have a short operating history and lack the credibility demanded by customers. AeroTech, Inc.'s Competitive Advantages AeroTech, Inc. boasts a world-class management team with extensive experience in the aerospace industry and a successful record of running multi-million dollar corporations. AeroTech, Inc. benefits from first-mover initiatives as the company introduces groundbreaking parts designed specifically for the latest technology in the aerospace industry. Additional competitive advantages include: patented technology, state-of-the-art equipment, and long-term contracts with key clients including the United States military. Financial Projections The company is expected to break even 24 months after completion of the employee training period. Forecasts for identified revenue growth resulting from a devoted and loyal customer-base and aggressive marketing initiatives indicate that AeroTech, Inc. will exceed $13 million by the end of year 3. Net profit for the three years is forecast to be in excess of $1.3 million.

31

CHAPTER

4

Part I The Organizational Plan

The first major section of your business plan addresses the organizational details of your business. It begins with a description of your business and its products and/or services. The remainder of the organizational plan is devoted to administrative setup—or how your business is put together in order to function in an efficient and cost- effective manner. Using short, but descriptive statements, address the following areas. Feel free to include other organizational topics that you think are key to your particular industry.

Summary of the Business (Mission, Business Model, Strategy, Strategic Relationships, SWOT Analysis)

Products and/or Services

Administrative Plan (Location, Legal Structure, Management and Personnel, Accounting and Legal, Insurance, Security, Intellectual Property)

32 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 4, Part I: The Organizational Plan

Summary of the Business (Organizational Plan: Section I) Establish the Foundation Upon Which You Will Build Your Business. Describing your business in this section will help you to think about it in conceptual terms. You need to understand your own vision of the business – what you want to accomplish and how you want your business to be viewed by others. Based on that vision, you will determine the strategy you will use and the strategic relationships that you will develop to help you reach your goals and objectives. Begin with a broad overview of the nature of your business. Using the key word approach, begin by telling when and why the company was formed. Describe the nature and uniqueness of the products and/or services provided and briefly review the general history and future goals of the company. After the company has been introduced in a paragraph or two, the summary of the business can be completed by addressing each of the following topics:

Mission State your company’s mission, projecting a sense of what your goals are regarding its future place within your industry and within the community. A mission statement is a brief (one or two sentences) description of the company’s fundamental purpose including, nature, values, and its work. It should clearly explain why the company exists and what it plans to achieve in the future.

Business Model Describe your company’s business model and why it is unique to your industry. A business model is the method of doing business by which a company can generate revenue and sustain itself.

Strategy Give an overview of the company’s strategy—its short-term and long-term objectives and how you plan to realize those objectives. A strategy is a plan of action designed to achieve a particular goal that has been established.

Strategic Relationships If you have strategic relationships, tell who they are with and how they will benefit your company. A strategic relationship is a mutually beneficial formal contractual alliance established between two or more organizations.

SWOT Analysis Finally, conduct an analysis on your business, examining key factors that are internal and external to your business.

Note. See: "What is a SWOT Analysis?" and "How to Conduct a SWOT Analysis" – next two pages)

Page 140

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 4, Part I: The Organizational Plan 33

What is a SWOT Analysis? SWOT stands for Strengths, Weaknesses, Opportunities, and Threats. A SWOT analysis is an in-depth examination of key factors that are internal (strengths and weaknesses) and external (opportunities and threats) to a business.

• Internal Factors. The examination of internal factors takes a close look at the organization, laying out core competencies and areas in which a business has a competitive advantage. It also looks at areas in which a business has a lack of certain strengths.

• External Factors. An examination of external factors takes a look at the marketplace in which a business operates and helps to identify new areas in which the business can grow and niche markets that can be pursued, all which will ultimately lead to greater profits for the business. It also looks at changes and trends in the marketplace that may affect a company’s business operations.

Benefits of a SWOT analysis Conducting a SWOT analysis will enable a business to channel its focus into those areas that present the greatest opportunities and those competencies in which it is strongest. Concurrently, the business will look into ways to mitigate its weaknesses and develop plans and strategies to overcome any threats that present themselves. When conducting a SWOT analysis, you should be realistic about the strengths and weaknesses of your business.

How to Conduct a SWOT Analysis To conduct a SWOT analysis, answer the following questions in each section:

Strengths

• Do you have a proprietary product/technology? • Do you have a superior location? • Do you have a unique business model? • Do you have any value added services? • What advantage(s) do you have over your competitors? • What specialized areas do you have expertise in? • What recognition have you received?

Weaknesses

• What aspects of the operations of the business can be improved upon? • What aspects of the product(s) and/or service(s) can be improved upon? • Is there a lack of expertise in any area? • Is the location of your business a problem? • Have you received any negative press?

34 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 4, Part I: The Organizational Plan

Opportunities

• Are there any markets that are not being served with your product(s) and/or service(s)?

• Are there any emerging niche segments within your industry? • Are there any target market and/or industry trends that are of interest to

you? • Are there any changes in technology that could be beneficial to you? • Is there an emerging/developing market within your industry? • Have some of your competitors left the marketplace? • Are there any companies that can be taken over? • Are there any companies with whom strategic alliances can be formed? • Are there any opportunities in international markets?

Threats

• Are there any new competitors emerging? • Are existing competitors gaining strength? • Are the prices of your competitors going up or down? • Are competitors introducing new products and/or services to the

marketplace? • Are there any challenges that are emerging within the industry? • Are there any new government regulations being enforced?

Example Summary of the Business. To see a fully developed example addressing all of the elements discussed in the Summary of the Business, take some time to study that section in the Wmhinc.com example business plan in Appendix III.

Products or Services (Organizational Plan: Section II) In this section of your plan you will describe your products and services. What are you selling? In the Marketing Plan (Chapter 5) you will analyze whether or not there is a real need for all your products and services or if your repertoire should be limited to those items that are truly in demand.

If you are the manufacturer and/or distributor of a product

• Manufacturers. Describe your products and give a general description of their development from raw materials to finished item. The development of a flow chart or time line can help you to identify the various stages of research and development (R&D) and production.

Page 141

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 4, Part I: The Organizational Plan 35

A time line can also be used to demonstrate when raw materials must be ordered, how much time is needed in the production process, and how much time is involved in inventory storage and in shipping and handling. Discuss the raw materials that are used and how much they will cost. Who are your suppliers, where are they located, and why did you choose them? Although you may order from one main supplier, include information on alternate suppliers.

Address how you could handle a sudden increase in orders or a loss of a major supplier. How will the work get done and at what cost? Project peak production times and determine when money will be needed for key purchases. Include cost breakdowns in the Supporting Documents section to back up your statements.

Describe your production equipment and other product assets in terms of what you already own, what you plan to purchase, and how much it will cost. Again think in terms of dollars. When you are projecting cash flow, this information will provide the source for your financial assumptions regarding production equipment.

• Distributors. Describe the products that your company will be distributing and the manufacturers that will be your source for those products. Do you have alternate manufacturers that you can use or are you dependent on certain manufacturers. As a distributor, will you purchase your products prior to selling them – or – will you purchase at a discount as the sales are made? What are your terms? You might find it helpful to use a table with columns listing the products, manufacturers, terms, and alternate sources.

• Manufacturers and Distributors. If you are anticipating importing raw materials or finished products for distribution in this country and/or abroad, expand your business plan to include global information.

Be sure that you can identify the steps involved in bringing goods into this country or in shipping them overseas along with the time and costs involved. You may be working with foreign manufacturers and agents. You will deal with freight forwarders and custom brokers. The cost of their services and the time and method of payment will also affect your cash flow.

If you are a retailer Describe the main types (or categories) of products that you sell. Describe your product selection process and why specific suppliers or vendors were chosen. If you are the retailer of a small number of products, you can list them individually followed by information on the source, purchase price (discount), and selling price (markup). If timing is of significance, you can use a flow chart to demonstrate the distribution process. How do the products you sell in your shop get from the manufacturer through your industry’s normal distribution channels, into your store, onto your shelves, and into your customers’ hands?

36 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 4, Part I: The Organizational Plan

What is your system for managing and tracking inventory? How do you determine the volume of goods you need to stock in inventory and see that it is maintained?

“Bricks” and/or “Clicks” Retailers

Who are you? Do you have a straight brick and mortar business or are you strictly an online retailer (e-tailer) — or are you a combination of both? In many ways the retailing process is much the same whether you do your selling online or from a physical location. You still need to deal with wholesalers, product mix, promotion, etc. However, the way you deal with inventory may be significantly different. Although brick and mortar businesses often sell their goods via the Internet, they traditionally stock their full line of products and offer immediate fulfillment of orders. Retailers who sell solely via the Internet, however, frequently stock only high volume items and consignment goods. It is not uncommon for e-tailers to stock no inventory and to depend on the wholesaler for fulfillment of their orders.

E-Tailers. If you are planning your web site, you will find it very useful to check out the Summary Steps for E-Tailers on page 16.

If you provide a service Tell what your service is, why you are able to provide it, how it is provided, who will be doing the work, and where the service will be performed. Tell why your business is unique and what you have that is special to offer to your customers. If you have both a product and a service that work together to benefit your customer (such as warranty service for the products you sell), be sure to mention this in your plan. Consider equipment and supplies needed to perform your service together with associated costs. Think about other related overhead. Will you be providing service at the customer’s location or will you work from an office or shop? Of primary concern to a service provider is the relationship between the amount of time spent in providing the service and the amount of time that can actually be billed to the customer. Even if the service is billed by the job, rather than by the hour, it will be necessary to plan carefully to see that compensation is adequate to cover the time spent providing the service. Remember that time involved and billable hours are a key to success for a service provider. In all cases You will need to know if you will be selling the same products and/or services online as you do offline or if you will limit your web site sales to specific items? You will also need to consider future services or products that you plan to add to your business. Try to think about potential problem areas and work out a plan of action.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 4, Part I: The Organizational Plan 37

Administrative Plan (Organizational Plan: Section III) This section of the Organizational Plan will show how your business is put together administratively. It will help you to setup your business so that it will function in an efficient and cost-effective manner. Keep in mind, as you write about each of the following areas, that you will need to approach them in terms of revenues and expenses that will be related to each of your decisions. That way, when you are working on the Financial Plan, you will have the dollar figures to carry over into your financial statements.

Examples

• If you plan to have employees, project how many hours they will work and at what rate. Also project increased revenue you might expect because you have those employees.

• If you have decided to incorporate, address associated costs (attorney, incorporation fee, etc.).

• If you are leasing a building, find out about associated costs, such as utilities, insurance, improvements, etc. If the building is larger than a previous facility, what effect will the added space have on revenues you generate or costs you incur?

• If you develop a web site, how much will you spend on the initial development? How often and at what cost will it be updated? Will you have an in-house web specialist? What are your web hosting costs?

Location If location is not a marketing decision, you will include it in this section. Two examples of businesses of this type might be a web seller or a manufacturer that ships by common carrier such as United Parcel Service. Their locations would not be directly tied to their target markets. However, if location is a marketing consideration, you may prefer to address it in your marketing plan. For example, if you are opening a retail shop and need to be directly accessible to your customers, your choice of location will be determined by your target market and might, therefore, be more aptly addressed in your Marketing Plan. You might begin writing about your location as follows:

AeroTech, Inc. is housed in 10,000 square feet of warehouse space located at 372 E. Main Street, Burke, NY. This space was chosen because of accessibility to shipping facilities, good security provisions, low square footage costs, and proximity to sources of supply.

Now expand on each reason and back up your statements with a physical description of the site and a copy of the lease agreement.

38 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 4, Part I: The Organizational Plan

Your lease or rental agreement will contain the financial information needed for monthly cost projections for the Cash Flow statement. The value of property owned will be transferred to a balance sheet in the Financial Documents section. If you are a new business, you should plan for associated costs such as utilities, improvements, office furniture, and equipment. Give background information on your site choice. List other possible locations and tell why you chose your location. You may want to include copies of pictures, layouts, or drawings of the location in the Supporting Documents section.

A Location Analysis Worksheet is included at on page 343 of this book. This worksheet is intended as a guideline for writing a location (site) analysis.

Legal Structure Describe the legal structure you have chosen and explain why it is the most advantageous for your business. Name the owners or corporate officers, highlight their strengths and weaknesses, and include resumes of each one in the Supporting Documents section of your business plan.

If you anticipate changing your legal structure in the future, make projections regarding why you would change, when the change would take place, who would be involved, and how the change will benefit the company (for example, if your exit strategy is to form an IPO).

If you are a sole proprietor. Give a brief overview of your experience and abilities. As a sole proprietor, you assume 100% of the risk. Evaluate your strengths and weaknesses and state your plans for getting help in needed areas. Do you have current relationships with associates who will serve as advisors in various capacities?

If you have formed a partnership. Explain why the partners were chosen, what they bring to the company, and how their abilities complement each other. Show their experience and qualifications by including copies of their resumes. Include a copy of your partnership agreement in the Supporting Documents section. Your agreement should include provisions for partners to exit and for the dissolution of the company. Spell out distribution of the profits and financial responsibility for any losses. Explain the reasoning behind the terms of your agreement.

If you have formed an LLC or a corporation. Outline the company’s legal structure (limited liability company, S corporation, nonprofit corporation, professional corporation, etc.) and give highlighted information on the owners or corporate officers. Who are they, what are their skills, why were they chosen, and what will they bring to the organization? Include a copy of the charter and articles in the Supporting Documents. If you have a Board of Directors or Advisory Board, tell who they are and what they bring to the table that will further your company’s goals.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 4, Part I: The Organizational Plan 39

Management and Personnel Your management and personnel needs will be determined by the capabilities of the business owners, by the amount of time they will be able to commit to the business, and by the demands of the marketplace. Small businesses usually start up with the owners doing most of the work. As the business becomes larger and sales increase, your management and personnel needs will also change. Project your company’s goals for growth and plan for the changes that will be necessitated in management and personnel.

Management The most critical issue to be addressed in your business may well be that of management. Many potentially profitable operations have failed due to inability to effectively manage the company’s overall operation. One of the first questions that a potential lender or investor will ask is, “Why should your management team be entrusted with our money?” A few years ago investment capital was flowing heavily into high tech start-ups based on great ideas, but little experience. Most of them failed. There is still available capital, but the rules have changed. The new investment business model is the company with the proper mix of entrepreneurial vision and an experienced management team.

As the decision maker in your business, two of the questions you will need to ask yourself are, “What are the key areas of management in my business?” and “What outside help will I require?”

Managerial hiring policies, job descriptions, and employee contracts are all part of making the right choices. Decide how your managers will be compensated: salaries, benefits, bonuses, vacation time, stock purchase plans.

An organizational chart (see example below) can visually show areas of responsibility and the personnel in charge of each section along with the number of employees they will manage. For example, you may need key people in charge of administration, operations, marketing, and finance. Each of these individuals may have middle managers that they will supervise. In turn, the vice president of marketing might be directly responsible for middle managers whose responsibilities are divided into web site marketing, media advertising, and public relations. If you are involved in global trade, you may need a manager for international marketing.

Partial Organizational Chart

AeroTech, Inc.

R&D Dept. Manufacturing Quality Control

Donald Smith Production

Roberta Thompson Marketing

Thomas Choi Administration

Althea Johnson Finance

John Guzman CEO

Page 142

40 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 4, Part I: The Organizational Plan

Personnel How many employees will be needed for the company to operate efficiently? What jobs will you need them for? At what stage in the business will they be hired? What qualifications/experience will they need to have? What hours will they work? What salaries and benefits will they be paid?

Some businesses fail because they hire too many people too soon, anticipating more than their market share of business. Other businesses fail because they become too successful too soon and they are not organizationally ready. Your business plan is the key to responding promptly to the unexpected in order to keep your business progressing smoothly.

If you are seeking a lender or an investor, you will frequently hear them refer to what is known as the “Best- and Worst-Case Scenarios.” They want to know that you will be able to identify potential problems and to work out solutions before these difficulties occur. It is to your advantage to prepare for the unexpected so your business can continue to run smoothly. In the “best-case,” do you have enough people to handle an unexpected influx in sales? In the “worst-case,” if sales projections are not achieved, are there other ways in which you can generate revenue? Will you be required to reduce staff or will they be able to fill other positions? For example, if sales drop off at your sporting goods store, could personnel increase revenues by teaching in-store classes or by holding sports clinics?

I like to use this section to list the current employees on the company payroll and follow with a hiring plan for the future. For each, list the type of employee, desired qualifications, salary and benefits, and when you expect the hiring to take place. This will provide the financial assumptions to plan your cash flow.

Note. To see a good example, see Appendix I, Marine Art of California. Mr. Garcia did an excellent job of addressing this topic.

Accounting and Legal

Accounting Describe your accounting department. Tell what accounting system will be used and why it was chosen. What portion of your accounting/recordkeeping will be done internally? Who will be responsible for the reliability and efficiency and those records? Will you be using an outside accountant to maximize your profits? If so, who within your company will be skilled at working with the accountant—and who will be responsible for reading and analyzing the financial statements provided by the accountant? It is important to show not only that your accounting will be taken care of, but that you will have some means of using your financial statements to implement changes to make your company more profitable. After reading this section, a lender or investor should have confidence in your company's ability to keep and interpret a complete set of financial records. Information regarding your accounting and the auditing of your books is often requested on the Business Financial Statement provided by potential lenders and investors. If you plan to hire someone to do internal accounting, the salaries should be covered under management or personnel. If you will be utilizing outside accounting professionals, be sure to incorporate their fees into your financial projections.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 4, Part I: The Organizational Plan 41

Legal Murphy’s Law will prevail in this area for sure. Just when you think you don’t need legal help, you do. Before your company suddenly finds itself in a position that requires the immediate services of a good attorney (contracts, proprietary issues, disputes, etc.), you should practice due diligence and align yourself with a legal firm that specializes in working with your type of business. Larger firms often have an in-house legal department. Again—budget for in-house staff in your personnel plan. If you plan to keep an attorney on retainer, be sure to include the amount in your financial assumptions.

Insurance Insurance is an important consideration for every business. The goal is to protect your company against common claims and against serious risks for your particular industry. Talk with a reputable insurance agent. Consider the types of coverage appropriate to your business. Plan to adopt aggressive policies to reduce the likelihood of insurance claims. Product liability is a major consideration, especially in certain industries. Service businesses are concerned with personal liability, insuring customers' goods while on the premises or during the transporting of those goods. If a vehicle is used for business purposes, your insurance must reflect that use. If you own your business location, you will need property insurance. If you lease, you may need insurance relating to content or inventory. Some types of businesses require bonding. Partners may want life insurance naming each other as the beneficiary. Decisions will need to be made about major medical insurance that you intend to provide for management and/or employees. Exporters may reduce risks by purchasing export credit insurance from the Export-Import Bank of the U.S. agent, the Foreign Credit Insurance Association. Policies for exporters include insurance for financing or operating leases, medium term insurance, the new-to- export policy insurance for the service industry, and the umbrella policy.

Keep your insurance information current. An Insurance Update Form is provided for you in the Blank Forms section of the book on page 342. Use it to maintain information on alternate insurance companies. If your premiums are suddenly raised or your coverage is canceled, you will be able to refer to the form in order to quickly find another carrier.

Security As many as a third of small business failures are the result of dishonesty. Security involves not only theft of office supplies, equipment, and inventories by employees and/or customers, but also the theft of information. Address the issue of security as it relates to your business. Again there will be some important decisions to be made. Product businesses will probably have inventory controls to establish. Service businesses may need to protect client information as well as their own business information.

42 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 4, Part I: The Organizational Plan

In this age of advanced technology, major concerns have surfaced regarding Internet, Intranet, and Extranet security. Among the important questions to be answered are those relating to the transfer of information via the Internet. Businesses that accept credit cards online need to protect their customer’s vital information through the establishment of a secure web site. They also need to protect their own proprietary information from intruders into their systems. Anticipate problem areas in your business, identify security measures you will put into practice. Tell why you chose them and what you project they will accomplish. Discuss this area with your insurance agent. You may be able to lower certain insurance costs while protecting your business.

Intellectual Property If you own intellectual property or proprietary rights, you can address it at this point. Your designs, products, inventions, and ideas can be protected under United States and international intellectual property laws, which cover trademarks, patents, and copyrights. Intellectual property is a highly specialized area of the law and it is best to speak with an expert who can go over the unique details of your own design. You will need to back up your statements by including copies of registrations, photos, diagrams of products in development, or any other pertinent information in Supporting Documents.

• Patents secure an inventor’s exclusive right to make, use or sell an invention for a term of years. Your design for a new product may not be an invention in a technical sense, but the idea is certainly your intellectual property.

• Trademarks by definition point distinctly to the origin or ownership of merchandise to which it is applied. A trademark is legally reserved to the exclusive use of the owner as maker or seller. A distinctive logo, insignia, or domain name can also be protected by a trademark. The symbol ™ is used when a trademark application is in progress; the symbol ® is used when the trademark is officially registered.

• Copyright protection exists for original works of authorship fixed in any tangible medium of expression, such as literary, musical and dramatic works, pictorial, graphic and sculptural works, sound recordings and architectural works. Copyrights are indicated by the symbol © before the name and year of the copyright holder. Copyright protection does not apply to things such as ideas, procedures, processes or concepts. Website material is usually copyrighted; so are lengthy corporate writings.

Summary In this chapter, you have covered all of the areas that should be addressed in the Organizational Plan. If you have been thorough, it will help you to anticipate problem areas and to be prepared with solutions. You are now ready to go to the next chapter to formulate your Marketing Plan.

43

CHAPTER

5

Part II The Marketing Plan

The marketing section of your business plan defines all of the components of your marketing strategy. When you write your Marketing Plan, you will address the details of your market analysis, sales, advertising, and public relations campaigns. The Plan should also integrate traditional (offline) programs with new media (online) strategies. This chapter describes a very comprehensive list of marketing plan components. These components represent a full spectrum of marketing possibilities.

If your business is larger and more complex—and you are financially able, you will address most of these components in order to develop an aggressive marketing plan.

Note: You can use the headings and subheadings in the Marketing Plan Outline at the end of the chapter as a guide to follow in laying out your own Marketing Plan, omitting those that do not apply to your business.

If your business is very small, you will not need to include all of the components. You will have to decide which ones fit within the scope of your business. However, your marketing plan should still contain the following major sections:

Market Analysis (Target Market, Competition, Industry Trends)

Sales Strategy (On-line and Off-line)

Advertising (Traditional and Web)

Public Relations

Customer Service

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

44

Overview and Goals of a Marketing Strategy (Marketing Plan: Section I)

Your marketing strategy is the comprehensive approach your business will take to achieve your business objectives. Definition of a Marketing Strategy Your marketing strategy integrates the activities involved in marketing, sales, advertising, public relations, and networking. Each of these components of your overall marketing strategy serves a unique purpose, offers specific benefits, and complements every other component. All components must work together to enhance your company image, reinforce your brand strength, and ensure that your company is distinct from your competitors. A list of the major components of a successful multi-media (online and offline) marketing strategy is shown in Figure 5.1, pages 68-70

The traditional (offline) and new media (online) components of your marketing strategy should all fit together precisely. These components include promotion of your range of services and products; determination of your prices or rate structure; creation of an advertising plan, public relations endeavors, promotional campaigns; and a long list of multi-media considerations. It is important to think through your strategy and gather information about your market and your competition before you set your fee structure or book ad space. Trial-and-error marketing plans are too expensive.

Marketing is one area in which assistance is offered through a wide variety of local and national sources. At its best, marketing is a specialized field where you can learn a lot quickly by listening to experts. Your local Small Business Development Center (SBDC) offers workshops on marketing, publications and reference materials at little or no cost to you. They will have consultants on staff or readily available to help you out. Self-help business books are also available in abundance on every aspect of your marketing plan.

The purpose of this chapter is to outline marketing fundamentals as they relate to formation of the marketing section of your business plan.

Goals of Your Marketing Strategy What do you hope to accomplish through your marketing strategy? Your market research, advertising campaigns, sales incentives, public relations efforts, and networking plans should all move your business in the direction of achieving your marketing goals. Many companies hope to expand their customer base, increase sales, achieve profitability, promote new products and services, and other similar idealistic objectives. Not every business owner, however, can articulate precisely what these goals mean for his/her own company.

The best marketing plans are results-oriented; they define specific, realistic, measurable goals within time parameters. All sales, advertising, and public relations efforts are then designed to work together to achieve these goals. If the goals are not accomplished within

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

45

a planned schedule, individual components of the marketing plan should be reassessed and redesigned. Goals of your marketing strategy, for example, could include creating a strong brand, building a strong customer base, and increasing product/service sales. Each goal should be explained in specific terms, that is, what do these goals mean to your company? As an illustration, let’s examine three examples of goals:

• Create a strong brand. What is the current level of brand awareness for your company/product/service? Are you starting from scratch or building on a familiar name? What are the characteristics of this brand that you want to reinforce in the minds of consumers? What level of brand awareness do you hope to achieve?

• Build a strong customer base. Who are your best customers? What customers are most likely to spend money, and return? What is the profile (demographics, psychographics) of your ideal customer? How can you reach this market, online and offline? What particular characteristics of your company/product/service are most likely to inspire loyalty in your ideal customers?

• Increase product/service sales. If this is an existing business, what is your current level of sales? If this is a start-up, or new division of an existing business, how can you predict the future demand for your product/service? What new level of sales growth can your business handle? What quantities of your product can you produce/distribute? What level of service can you support through existing or additional staff?

Your marketing activities will comprise a significant portion of your overall business expenses, so investors and bankers will need to understand the importance of the results you are seeking. Make it clear in the statement of your marketing goals that the expenditures you are about to delineate are crucial to the development and growth of your company. By clearly identifying the goals of your marketing plan, you will make a convincing case to support your financial projections.

Basic Marketing Questions Four fundamental questions should be answered in order to identify your marketing goals—who, what, where, when, and how? Specifically:

• Who are your customers? Who are your competitors?

• What are you selling? What quantities and prices of your products will you sell?

• Where is your target market located? Where can you reach your target market?

• When are your customers most likely to buy? When are your busy seasons?

• How will you reach your customers (stores, offices, web site, catalogs)?

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

46

Marketing Musts Four activities will help you organize your marketing efforts in the most effective direction to achieve your goals. Worksheets are available at the end of this section for each of the following “marketing musts.”

1. Sell selectively. This will help you define your market niche. What will you

offer that is distinctly different (better, less expensive, faster, higher quality, etc.) from your competitors? Why should anyone buy from you? What market share can you seek?

2. Know your niche. What type of individuals and/or businesses do you plan to serve? Start by answering in general terms (professionals, service companies, manufacturing, retail, etc.), then try to be very specific. Spell out the demographics first—age, sex, income, etc.

Then you can move on to psychographics, or lifestyle considerations. When you clearly define the population you hope to sell to, you’ll have a better view of what services they require. Where do they spend their free time? What activities are they involved in? How do they spend their disposable income? This information leads you to details about what they read (therefore, where you’ll want publicity and advertising coverage), where they hang out (for promotions and appearances), what they watch and listen to (if television and radio spots are on your mind). Then go out and ask them what they want. Don’t try to guess. Find out what they really need. If your market is local (and where is local, anyway?), your small local newspapers probably offer affordable ad packages; chambers of commerce and professional organizations have newsletters that offer insert opportunities. But if you don’t know exactly where your market is, you can’t determine what your market reads.

3. Create your pitch. Define precisely what “your product/service attributes” mean so that your product or service comes alive for your prospective clients. Make it so important that they will no longer want to live or work without it. Appeal to their individual needs.

4. Price for profits. The goal of your business is to make a profit. Many start-up businesses fail to make a profit as early as projected because they didn’t price properly. Know what your competition charges, and determine if you should be less than, equal to or higher priced. Be sure for product pricing that you have covered your materials, labor and overhead costs. Don’t forget shipping, handling or storage in the total price. Service, like consulting, can be difficult to pinpoint. Some products and services will fall into an hourly rate structure; others are better-suited to a service fee. If you provide a service, you may even be on-call for a monthly service fee. Remember that small businesses often do not have big budgets, so if this is your market, your pricing decisions will have to take into account what your market will bear. Learn what your competition charges.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

47

Market Analysis (Marketing Plan: Section II) The Market Analysis section of your Marketing Plan contains information about your target market, competitors, and marketing trends. Market research methods and results are also delineated in this section. Details about each of these components follow.

Identify Target Markets Who are you selling to? Who are your ideal customers? Your target market should be defined in terms of demographics, psychographics, and special characteristics of niche markets, if applicable. For research information about your target market, we have developed a special web page at www.marketingplan.com/aybp.html. You will be guided through a full listing of marketing research sites with hot links to each of the resources.

Demographics refers to the statistical data of a population, including average age, income, and education. Government census data is a common source of demographic information.

Psychographics uses demographics to determine the attitudes and tastes of a particular segment of a population. Psychographics examines lifestyles: where people spend their vacations, where they shop, how they spend their disposable income, what sports they participate in or watch, which clubs/organizations they join, and more.

Niche markets are a small segment of the population that shares common characteristics, interests, spending habits, etc. Successful niche marketing focuses on a small segment of a total market. It is the best strategy for a small business to achieve a market leadership position. It is expensive, and bland, to try to be all things to all people.

Examples of niche markets include SOHOs (small office/home office), Generation X or Y, cultural niches, hip hop, to name a few. (The website www.nichemarkets.com offers a longer list.) Niche markets are better informed than the mass market experts in a particular area of special interest. They will demand communication that is content-rich and substantial to match their level of intelligence and depth of understanding.

BONUS. On pages 64-67, you will find a discussion on “The Product-Market Analysis.” If you take the time to read and study it, you will learn the “Four Rules of Target Marketing”—or how to narrow your target market by making two important decisions: which customer needs you will satisfy and who the specific customers are to whom you wish to sell your product or services.

Page 143

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

48

Research Your Competition Who is competing with you? After you have identified your target market, it is important to discern what other companies are after the same market. What are their strengths and weaknesses relative to your business? If you are not certain who your competitors are, use several search engines to see what company names are presented when you seek your own products and services online. Remember that because it is so easy to check out any company online and obtain far more detail than you could have acquired by a telephone call or brochure, many individuals and businesses will follow this procedure. If you don’t do it, you’ll be working in the dark.

Check trade associations, and manufacturing company listings, and other directories available in your library Reference section if you want to do an offline search. An easier place to start, however, is to hunt for information about your competitors at www.marketingplan.com/aybp.html (our special web site). Click on the link to “Using the Internet for Competitive Intelligence” and you can go directly to an article archived on the CIO.com website.

In researching your competitors, check out the general health of the business, their approach to marketing, and their financial information. In addition, specifically investigate the following in depth:

Check out their websites. Examine their design, format, and content. Is the site professional and complete? What features and benefits do they promote? How do they position their product/services to their target market? What websites do they link to? What is the nature of the content they provide? Do they offer any community-building, message boards, or chat rooms? Do they feature special events?

Investigate the prices of their products and services. How do they compare to yours? Do they offer the same products/services? Do they offer discounts? Any other special offers?

Determine who their advertisers are. Who advertises on their website now? What rates do they charge for advertising? What are the terms of their affiliate programs, if any?

Assess Market Trends Your marketing plan should reflect your observations and insight about trends in your industry and in your target market. Information about the general direction of the marketplace can help you target what people want. Futurist Faith Popcorn identified sixteen market trends in her book, Clicking (HarperCollins, 1996) that are still accurate today. She coined the phrase “cocooning” to describe the phenomenon of staying-at- home to relax and unwind. Dramatic increases in the sales of home theatre equipment, rentals of VHS/DVD movies, and take-out food are a testimonial to the longevity of this trend. Another of her trends, called “small indulgences,” which describes our desire to reward ourselves for our hard work with affordable luxuries, is evident as Starbucks coffee and Godiva chocolate shops become neighborhood staples and shopping mall anchors. What market trends will have an impact on your business, influencing the demand for your products and services? Are you on-trend?

Page 143

Page 143

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

49

Industry trends influence almost every business within its segment. These are major trends such as the increase in service businesses in the U.S., the decline of manufacturing, the precarious position of Internet pure-plays, to name a few.

Target market trends, like the events categorized by Faith Popcorn and other marketing gurus, have an impact on the direction of a smaller segment of the population or business community. Trends can be influenced by demographics, such as the aging of our population and huge number of baby-boomers reaching age 50 every minute, or by cultural and social influences outside the realm of demographics. Examples of market trends that evolve from demographic shifts include the increase in the number of assisted-living facilities, and the growth of innovative products and services designed for a more “youthful” retired population.

The shifting demographics of online shoppers will have an important influence on companies that plan to reach their target market via Internet sales. The fastest-growing online demographic group today is 45 to 64 year-old Internet users. This means baby boomers are reaching critical mass online as well as offline. The number of online female shoppers is increasing more rapidly than male shoppers in every age bracket. Your marketing plan should demonstrate that you have analyzed market trends and have considered these trends in the creation of your marketing strategy.

Conduct Market Research Market research can prevent your company from making erroneous decisions that result in expensive design mistakes in new products, marketing campaigns, and more. Market research has traditionally been conducted through techniques such as questionnaires, polls, surveys, and focus groups. Today your business can take advantage of both online and offline market research techniques.

Methods of Research

Questionnaires can be administered by paper or by online surveys. In either case, questionnaires are more likely to be answered if there is an incentive for the consumer to respond (a reward, that is). Questionnaires should be administered to a representative sample of the target market. Online questionnaires that are non-intrusive, optional, and offer a “thanks for your time” incentive can provide the most timely and valuable information. The incentive could be a discount on the respondents next purchase, for example, or a coupon for a popular business product or service.

Focus Groups offer more insight regarding customer preferences and thought processes than questionnaires. In focus groups, small groups of consumers are brought together under the direction of a moderator while researchers record their observations (usually behind one-way mirrors or on videotape), responses, reactions, and comments. Consumer feedback about new product developments, pricing structures, and branding issues can be analyzed relatively quickly using the focus group technique. Participants are usually paid for their time.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

50

Focus groups can also be conducted online using an Internet chat room. The greatest advantage of online focus groups is the speed with which they can be arranged and the reduced travel costs. Observers can watch from their computers, interject questions to probe an issue in more depth, and no one is inconvenienced.

Surveys—telephone surveys are the terror of many quiet dinners and have become increasingly unpopular (and unreliable). Online surveys, on the other hand, meet with surprising success if presented positively. Websites can include several questions (un-intrusive, simple, quick to answer) in their format to elicit comments and suggestions from website visitors, particularly shoppers.

Because surveys are shorter than questionnaires, a reward isn’t necessary. With guarantees of privacy and a promise not to re-sell or relay the respondents’ information to other sources, it is often possible to acquire constructive information quickly.

Database analysis

What kinds of information will you want to collect and store to help you make better executive decisions about your business? If you store information in a data warehouse for later analysis, your data warehouse systems can help you identify trends within your company in sales, marketing, production, and finance. The sales and marketing data will be particularly useful for managing your marketing plan.

Contents of Your Marketing Strategy (Marketing Plan: Section III)

In this section of your marketing plan, the contents shift from descriptive to extremely detailed. For example, when you describe your sales strategy, you will also elaborate on the materials you will produce and the campaigns you will organize.

When you define your advertising strategy, you will need to identify how you will spend your money on each medium and in what markets. Web advertising campaigns will be described in terms of specific portals, size of banner ads, frequency of e-mail marketing, and more.

General Description This section of your marketing plan introduces the sections which follow and provides a brief synopsis. This section should include: (1) the allocation of your efforts (i.e., the percentage of your total budget dedicated to online marketing vs. offline marketing), and (2) the components that are expected to generate the greatest percentage of new business.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

51

Method of Sales and Distribution How will your company reach your customers? Are your sales primarily handled by bricks (physical stores), clicks (website), catalogs (direct mail), or hybrid (multiple channels)? Do you have plans to expand your methods of sales/distribution as sales increase?

Stores or physical offices should be described by size, location, and physical characteristics in reasonable detail. Kiosks and other additional methods of sales should also be included.

Catalogs should be described in terms of size, frequency of mailings, and approximate number of items offered.

Website information should include design information, description of contents and major features, hosting arrangements, technological considerations, credit card processing, security arrangements, and other details about the creation and maintenance of this website. If your business will operate primarily as an online store or distributor, some of this information will already be covered in other sections of your business plan. If your company will be listed in online malls (zShops at Amazon.com, iMall, shopping@Yahoo!, to name a few) include details about your arrangement and fees in this section of your marketing plan.

Packaging If you provide a product, your packaging will be a crucial early consideration. If you are not a trained or talented designer, seek assistance for this. Packaging has a huge impact on the consumer’s decision to buy.

If you provide a service, the “package” is you. Your company image should be defined before you begin any other marketing efforts. The image of a professional such as a lawyer or accountant, for example, involves building a private practice that will be distinctly different from an advertising agency seeking clients in the fashion industry. Your message should come across loud and clear. Are you conservative? Trendy? Cost- conscious? Flashy? Keep your message consistent and simple for your market. All your online and offline marketing efforts, your sales pitch, public relations activities, advertising, and promotional campaigns should be supportive of one another and of your image.

Pricing Policy How much flexibility is there in your pricing strategy? What is your price floor (the lowest price you can charge and still cover your costs) and what is your price ceiling (the highest price the market will bear)? Your marketing plan must address your pricing policy and how prices can be adjusted if necessary to increase demand or cover unanticipated revenue shortfalls.

Price strategy. You may find the range between your price floor and price ceiling offers considerable leeway. Somewhere in this range is the right price point for your product or service. How do you find out what that point is? Your pricing

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

52

strategy can be tested through focus groups and surveys. What price is the average customer willing to pay? Another way to determine pricing that has become a new trend with entrepreneurs is to test-market through online sales on the auction website eBay (www.ebay.com). This website can provide insight to what the market will bear and how hot the product really is perceived to be. EBay has become such a popular resource for small business owners that the website now offers special services for small companies to sell their products directly through eBay.

Competitive position. Should your prices be greater than, less than, or equal to your competitors? Do you need to adjust your prices when your competitors make a change? If you are claiming to offer the highest quality and most personalized service, you may be able to justify charging more than your competitors. If you are appealing to a more “elite” clientele than your competitors, you will also be able to establish your pricing independently. If you hope to beat your competitors on price by going lower, you’ll have to be sensitive to your price floor—what you can truly afford to discount and still be a profitable business.

If you want to remain equal to your competitors you’ll have to be extremely sensitive to any “value-added” offerings and special promotions they are offering that can work as sales incentives, drawing customers away from your business and toward theirs. Your quick and well-formulated response to your competitors’ special offers will be critical.

Branding What do current and prospective customers think of your brand? Branding defines and focuses a company’s image. Strong brands today are reinforced through a mix of advertising online and offline, sales and customer service efforts, sales incentives that combine online and offline offerings, and public relations strategies that incorporate all sales channels. Consumer reaction defines the brand in the long run. Branding emphasizes the need to build an emotional connection between your products and your purchasers.

Database Marketing Database analysis enables a company to personalize their marketing campaign. With personalization, information is presented to customers based on the study of their previous buying patterns. Personalized, or one-to-one, marketing attempts to anticipate what customers are seeking, predicting future behavior from past choices.

If your business integrates customer information from databases that track their shopping behavior from their catalog purchases to their shopping mall trips to their e-commerce buys, you can maximize personalization. Personalization can be used most effectively in Web sales. For example, you can send personalized e-mail notices about upcoming sales, special promotions, or new product releases that may be of special interest based on the individual’s past purchases.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

53

Sales Strategies This section outlines your use of online and offline sales materials to reach your target market. Traditional sales involve the creation of printed materials to accompany your sales efforts. Online sales involve refinement of your Web strategy in order to present your products and services in the best possible manner.

Direct Sales If you are a start-up company, you may find yourself working as both CEO and chief salesperson (not to mention, head of office maintenance…). Your marketing plan should identify how you plan to contact prospects, what materials you will send out or deliver, and what follow-up will occur. Your direct sales approach should combine both offline (personal) contact with prospective customers, and online sales through your Web site.

Offline sales require materials that can be sent to prospective customers and brought with a salesperson (or you) to presentations. Do you have to design new sales materials? What is required? Will you have to create a new logo and graphics for your material? Consider the traditional list of printed materials: brochures, pamphlets, flyers, stationery, business cards, catalog, promotional flyers, etc. Identify the specific materials that you will need to design and print for use in your sales campaign. Online sales require a website that doubles as a marketing tool. In addition to the technological considerations of website design, special attention must be directed to engaging the site visitor and providing incentives to buy. Websites that contain creative features that attract new visitors and encourage them to return to the site are called “sticky,” which refers to the ability of a site to bring visitors back for additional shopping. For details about successful online selling techniques, check E-Tailing (Dearborn, 1999), which prescribes specific website marketing strategies. Your online “pitch” must be just as engaging and irresistible as your in-person sales appeal. In addition to creating a website design that makes your company and your products/services stand out, another important early step of your online sales strategy is to register with the search engines. Search engines direct traffic to your website, and you are unlikely to be discovered by your target market without their help, unless you are already a major brand name. When you register with the major search engines, you have a greater opportunity for your website to keep on working for you 24/365.

Direct Mail The cost of direct mail campaigns has been estimated to be about $1 to $2 per item. As postage and paper costs escalate, direct mail becomes a less attractive sales option. If your business decides to conduct a direct mail campaign, you may find it preferable to create your own mailing list rather than purchase a list, unless you deal with a reputable list supplier that guarantees their list is current and highly accurate. But even with the best mailing list, be prepared for a low rate of return. Direct mail coupled with incentive offerings can be slightly more effective.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

54

E-Mail Marketing Compared to direct mail, e-mail marketing is a bargain at $.01 to $.25 per item. E-mail marketing has now outpaced direct mail, according to experts. E-mail correspondence is more likely to be read than direct mail. It offers opportunities to send personalized offers, based on your understanding of your customers’ preferences. However, your company must avoid spamming, or sending unwanted e-mail (like junk mail) to large lists of recipients. To avoid any perception of spamming, your e-mail marketing strategy should allow for “opt-in” and “opt-out”—the method by which your customers and website visitors elect to receive future e-mail correspondence from you or decline if they are not interested.

Affiliate Marketing Affiliate marketing engages the services of a virtually limitless sales force through some type of commission structure for sales, leads, or website visits. Affiliates are only paid for the actual sales, and their commission is a small percentage of the total sale. One of the most popular affiliate programs is run by Amazon.com (www.amazon.com). Affiliates of Amazon, who link their website visitors to Amazon’s website, earn a five percent commission on completed sales. If they elect to sell Amazon products on their own website they can earn a larger commission of fifteen percent. Affiliate programs can offer a creative strategy for service-based businesses to sell related products on their website without having to develop the products themselves.

Reciprocal Marketing Arrangements in which one company offers customers a discount for another company’s goods, either in their store or on their website, are examples of reciprocal marketing. Creative opportunities within local communities or online communities can make this a beneficial and inexpensive alternative to promote your company. Chambers of Commerce often extend these offers within their own circle of member businesses. Online opportunities can cross these geographic boundaries to offer virtually limitless possibilities among complementary companies.

Viral Marketing Viral marketing occurs when a company offers something that people find so intriguing that they spread the word on their own. In order to be effective, your company offering must be simple, entertaining, or engaging in some way. It also must include your company’s insignia or the whole point is missed. Viral marketing by word-of-mouth has been highly effective, but viral marketing by the Web has even greater impact. Word can spread more quickly, and to greater numbers of people, by e-mail and forwarded web links than by telephone calls. And when people see an e-mail from someone they know, they are most likely to read it.

Sales Incentives/Promotions Sales incentives can be offered at physical stores and offices, through direct mail, and by your website. A combination of promotional offers that reach customers through multiple channels are most likely to give you the best return on your investment.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

55

The most important consideration is that your sales incentives should have a direct tie-in to your company so that customers remember your business as well as your promotional offer. Promotions like free samples, give-aways, and incentive items (pens, pads, gadgets, etc.) are important components of any trade show exhibit—they’re expected. Sweepstakes have the potential to attract attention both online and offline. Cash-back coupons and discount coupons also work well in both channels. The combination of discount coupons and an e-mail marketing campaign can be particularly effective.

Advertising Strategies Advertising is the most potentially expensive investment of your marketing strategy. Because of the high costs involved, the efforts should be researched thoroughly before you begin. This is not an area for amateurs. If you hire no other consultants, and you know you need to advertise your business, hire someone with advertising expertise. The standards today are very high, even in the smallest local papers. Online advertising is a relatively new field and uses different guidelines than print. Graphics, photos, layouts, text, and design have to be completely professional for a positive impact in both the online and offline advertising options. If you can pinpoint your target market in the finest detail, you can specify precisely where your ad campaign should be located. Size, timing, duration, frequency all come into play. Don’t try this by trial and error. Get guidance from an expert.

Traditional Advertising How will you invest your advertising dollars in traditional media? Traditional media includes television, radio, print, and extreme advertising. Your investment in market research truly pays off when you begin to determine how to allocate your advertising budget. Only the venues that have an impact on your target market are worth your investment. What television shows do they watch? What radio programs do they listen to? What do they read for business and for entertainment? Where are they traveling and by what method of transportation? With accurate market research to guide you, you can avoid costly advertising mistakes.

Television (network and cable). Network television advertising remains the most costly advertising investment. Within this top tier, the highest price for commercial time is still the Super Bowl. Network prime time follows in rank- order, followed by non-prime time network buys. In spite of the recent growth of national cable television, network television advertising still has the power to create brands in a way that few other advertising alternatives can. Major corporations seek prime advertising spots, and are willing to pay exorbitant rates to reach huge audiences and create a major impact. Cable advertising, which is predicted to assume an increasing share of the total television advertising dollars, works at several levels. National cable advertising can be as costly as network television programming, but local cable television offers rates that may be affordable for even very small businesses.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

56

The additional expenses incurred with advertising—such as creating your commercials and identifying your media plan—must be factored into the total cost of your television advertising. A poorly crafted commercial placed in the wrong time slot may be worse than no commercial, and certainly will be worse for your budget. Radio. Radio advertising offers small businesses an opportunity to reach a national or local audience with a rate schedule far below television advertising. Radio advertisements can reach your target market during business hours as well as personal time, during commute time, and mid-day programming. Since many businesspeople spend inordinate amounts of time driving from meeting to meeting, and others keep a radio on in the background while they work, radio advertising has become increasingly desirable. Print. Your marketing research should provide you with information about the newspapers, magazines, periodicals, and professional or trade journals that are of interest to your target market. Print ads are most effective when they have a single focal point, a distinctive picture, and an explicit headline message of nine words or less. Extreme advertising. Extreme advertising includes billboards, bus wraps, blimp, and any other form of oversize outdoor ads. Extreme advertising is most effective when the message is straightforward and simple, without complex graphics and extended narratives.

Web Advertising/New Media Your online advertising dollars should be invested with the same care and precision as your investment in traditional media. Web advertising options include banner ads, PDA advertising, advertising on portals and vortals, and interactive television. Market research again serves as the foundation from which to build your campaign, directing your strategy to include the online options that are most visible to your target market. What websites do they visit? Where do they shop online? What portals do they use?

Banner ads. Banner ads have been widely criticized, but they are still a popular form of online advertising. New standards for online ads, which include a more advertiser-friendly format that closely resembles a traditional print ad and a new form of sidebar, have breathed new life into banner ads. Even critics agree that banner ads offer a method of headlining a brand name over and over again, building brand awareness, even if the “click through” rate is lower than five percent.

Rich media (or multimedia) banner ads are believed to be three to five times more effective than standard ads, because they can be designed to be more creative and interactive. However, many experts fear that the consumer target market may not have the equipment or modem speed to take advantage of a multimedia presentation. You need to understand your target market and their capabilities before you invest in this option.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

57

PDA advertising. Personal Digital Assistant (PDA) advertising meets the unique space and size requirements of specific wireless devices. PDA advertising is most effective when it is specifically designed for these devices rather than personal computers. Web marketing campaigns need to be restructured to meet restrictions of smaller screen space, lack of color and font choices, graphic restrictions, and slow content delivery due to narrow bandwidth—restrictions that will eventually be eliminated. The best use of this form of advertising is to reach consumers on- the-go for things like travel arrangements, comparison pricing, auction bidding, hotel and entertainment plans, and stock activities. Portals/vortals. Portals guarantee a tremendous number of viewers at an extremely high cost. Advertising on a portal is beyond the scope of most small businesses, but placement in a marketplace on a portal may be a way to build online traffic. Amazon.com’s zShops, [email protected], iMall, and other similar locations offer the opportunity for broader exposure without the high price tag of a portal ad. Advertising on portals requires an understanding of consumer behavior in your target market to achieve the best results. Vortals, or vertical portals like iVillage.com, Oxygen.com, and Women.com, offer access to niche markets on a larger scale. Vortal advertisements are about twice as expensive as portal advertising, but can reach a more responsive audience if properly identified. Interactive television. Interactive advertising, or advertising on “smart television,” has evolved from the need to engage consumers in new and different ways to make an impact. Interactive television units are expected to increase worldwide in the next five years to over 81 million units, accompanied by an increase in interactive advertising. Interactive advertising is most effective when they are completely innovative, entertaining, and provide interesting content in a creative way.

Long-term Sponsorships Sponsorships can be designed to meet the marketing goals of any company. Long-term sponsorships offer the benefit of helping to strengthen brand awareness in niche markets. In both the online and offline areas, long-term sponsorships help to build strong relationships with a business or organization and it’s direct market, offering opportunities to co-brand multiple events, functions, advertisements, and more, providing high visibility for the advertiser. Co-branding can be set up as an exclusive arrangement or as a joint sponsorship among several complementary companies.

Public Relations The primary difference between advertising and public relations is that you always pay for advertising space, while press coverage from your public relations efforts is “free” (aside from the fact that you may have paid to orchestrate the event that subsequently became newsworthy). Activities that demonstrate your strengths and the terrific qualities of your business in a newsworthy way can be of more value in the long run than the most expensive advertising campaign. Public relations campaigns strive to build credibility in the marketplace through routes that are more discreet than direct advertising.

Page 143

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

58

Building an Online Presence Your website offers a vehicle for public relations that companies without an online presence can’t imitate. Community groups or clubs, chat groups, and message boards offer incentives for people to return to your website more frequently. Community groups can be established on your website to allow individuals with common interests access to shared information. What community group and club activities can be included on your website? Chat groups facilitate dynamic interaction among visitors to your website. Chat groups can be set up by topic according to a regular schedule for maximum effectiveness. Message boards encourage a running dialogue of questions and answers, and allow visitors to your website to exchange information or to request information from a subject expert on your site.

Events (Online and Offline) Can you create an event that will attract people to your website or to your physical store or office location? Grand openings, anniversary celebrations, celebrity visits, and other creative events serve a dual purpose. If they are done well, they will reinforce your relationship with existing customers and attract new business. If they are significant and newsworthy events, you may be fortunate enough to receive press coverage.

Publicizing Your Efforts Seek opportunities for press coverage of your work and your accomplishments whenever you can. The impact of public relations is cumulative. You won’t see immediate results in most cases, so consistency is critical. Press Releases A simple press release, preferably one-page, accompanied by a photo, can gain more visibility for you than an advertisement if the newspapers pick it up. Press releases should be interesting, newsworthy, concise, and sent to the right person. Watch the newspapers carefully to determine who the correct contact for your press release is. The Business Editor generally receives huge numbers of releases. If a specific reporter tends to cover stories about your industry or interests, try addressing the release to that individual instead. The media brings you into the broader public view than your advertising can. It is your way to reach larger numbers in less time. Use it wisely. Send your press releases to:

1. Weekly newspapers – reporters are always looking for great new stories.

2. Daily newspapers – usually want only a local twist, so stay close to home, unless it’s a national story.

3. Wire Services – seek up-to-the-second news items, so move quickly if you have a hot item to report.

4. Magazines – offer a chance to look like an expert, but you will need longer lead time. Plan ahead.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

59

5. Radio – attracts the attention of the mobile and the sedentary. A guest

spot can boost you into a whole new spectrum.

6. Television – the most important medium to be prepared for. Take the time to learn how to present yourself on television to make effective use of the incredible power of this medium. With television, you need to be concise and controlled, speaking in sound bites to be sure your point gets across the way you want it to and isn’t edited out.

Press kits can also be helpful. You can prepare your own press kit or hire a marketing consultant to help you out. Your press kit should build your credibility as an expert in your field or profession. It should include:

• a biography (short and directed to events that are significant today) • a photo (headshot, 8x10 or 5x7 black and white) • your brochure • copies of articles that have quoted or featured you

The press kit doesn’t accompany every press release. It is used to introduce you as a resource, as an “expert” available when members of the media need a resource for quotes, opinions, inside information, validation, and more.

Networking Networking can mean the difference between isolation and involvement for any business owner. For home-based businesses networking takes on a particularly significant role. It replaces the water-cooler and coffee-pot contact that occurs daily in every corporate office. Networking is by definition a supportive system of sharing information and services among individuals and groups having a common interest. Networking will keep you in contact with the outside world, help you avoid isolation and stagnation, and build your business contacts for current and future plans.

Networking is a two-way street, an exchange of information. Real networking requires that you do more than reach out to give and receive business cards. Give a little information, and get a sincere grasp of what one another’s skills are. Then you’ve really reached out.

You will need to become involved in several levels of networks to provide contacts for you within:

• the business community at large • your peer group of professionals • your local community • the community at-large.

Involvement in some organization at each of these levels of networks will provide public relations opportunities that will not develop from within your own home. The following are a few ideas to get you started in each of these four areas:

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

60

The Business Community Small business organizations offer the potential for small business owners to pull together for a bigger impact. The impact can be political, as it is in organizations whose mission is to lobby, or economic, as in those organizations that emphasize member benefits and discounts. In larger numbers there is certainly more influence. As a member of these groups, you may qualify for corporate rates on products and services, special discounts, and/or group rate health insurance. Examples include: National Association for the Self- Employed (NASE), National Small Business United (NSBU), and a host of local home- based business support groups. It is a comfort to know that other business owners share your concerns and interests. The organizations mentioned above are very large national groups. Subsets of the business community may find what they need in other organizations, and often will join more than one as time and finances permit. The National Association of Women Business Owners (NAWBO), for example, is designed for women business owners of any size firm. NAWBO has statewide chapters that independently run monthly meetings and events, as well as a strong nationwide offering of conferences and workshops. New corporate discount packages are made available fairly often as this group draws the attention of major corporate sponsors. Industry organizations often combine large corporations and small businesses, offering business owners an opportunity to meet with a diverse group of individuals. Statewide chambers of commerce and regional industry associations may be worth exploring.

Your Peer Group of Professionals Professional associations are your link with other business leaders or owners, prospective customers/clients, sales leads, and sources for general business information. Membership fees vary, and benefits of membership include a wide range of products/services, such as membership directories, newsletters and other publications, discounts, group rates for programs, educational opportunities and more. Membership in these groups serves a different purpose for you. These groups are your resource for new information in your profession, mentors, support resources when your business grows and you need to hire help, virtually or actually. You may find it difficult to sell here, especially if you’re among a group all selling the same thing. But you will absolutely need these contacts. And if you achieve a leadership position, you can also achieve public recognition. Not bad for public relations purposes. Trade associations are available for almost every profession. You’ll learn the secret handshake for your peer group, just as in professional associations. Membership rates and offerings vary. Monthly and annual meetings can help to keep you current in your own field, and help you find the best suppliers, vendors, etc. for your work. But the same word of caution applies here as above – you may not be closing sales deals within a group of your peers, but you need these contacts to thrive. As a leader, your opportunity for public recognition in your field will help you grow your business.

The Community Civic organizations provide an opportunity for you to become active in local community service groups. Your local chamber of commerce is a good start. Local chambers will promote their own members’ products and services over anyone else in the community. They will often publish their own directory and run their own schedule of business

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

61

functions. If the mission of the group doesn’t track with your objectives, keep the time you spend to a minimum but don’t be a stranger. Let your specialty be well known, and define your area of expertise so that referrals will be passed your way. Lead a workshop. Be a speaker at a meeting. Volunteer activities at local hospitals, schools, libraries, and colleges are almost endless. Fundraising activities are usually a top priority. Volunteer to help with a task that offers you an opportunity to demonstrate your skill and talent. In this way, you’ll not only help the organization, but also promote your talent through demonstration of your abilities.

The World At-Large Don’t lose your national and international focus, no matter how regional your business is today. Watch for events and opportunities that can bring you in contact with a wide range of people around the country, even if your business is geared to your own community. You can do a better job of serving any market you select if you are in touch with the outside world. As soon as you realize your business has potential beyond the borders of the United States, start making connections in the global community. Use the contacts of corporations that have already opened doors to gain introductions and entry into this rapidly growing area for opportunity. Seek the international organizations that will give you both support and recognition.

Commitment Your degree of involvement in any organization should reflect the importance of this organization or association to your business success—unless, of course, you are joining for purely social reasons. The best use of your time, however, will be to find and focus on a few organizations that offer both business and personal satisfaction. Why waste your time? In a position of leadership in any type of organization you will give the most time but will also gain the best contacts. You will get to know the most people. You will have the most opportunity for media exposure. If you know that one particular organization is a great source of direct leads for your business, work your way into an active role in the leadership of the group. Start by participating on a committee to get a sense of the group and the internal dynamics. Determine how you can volunteer your time in a way that also provides you with an opportunity to showcase your skills. Your talents will be most visible to the group if you share them and help the association accomplish its goals. If you are only a name on a mailing list, you are less likely to be approached personally.

Customer Service (Marketing Plan: Section IV) Consumer expectations of high quality service must be met if you want to keep your customers. Consumers expect to be able to contact a customer representative with

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

62

questions, concerns, problems, complaints, and returns. Business customers expect the same. Your business will need to identify your plans to meet these needs.

Description of Customer Service Activities Will you offer 24/7 access to customer service representatives? Can your customers reach you by phone, fax, or e-mail at any time? As your business grows, you will probably need to consider the addition of the services of a call center, which offers uninterrupted service for your customers. How will you deal with customer contact in the meantime?

Expected Outcomes of Achieving Excellence It’s an old marketing maxim that it is far less expensive to retain existing customers than to add new ones, so your business gains an immediate benefit from building a loyal customer base. For an excellent resource with insight and techniques about building a solid customer base, check Loyalty Marketing in the Internet Age (Dearborn, 2000). Implementation of Marketing Strategy (Marketing Plan: Section V) As the scope of your marketing plan expands to include complex multimedia campaigns, the resources and skills of professionals may be needed to design the best approach.

In-House Responsibilities Whether or not you outsource any or all of your marketing work, you and your team remain responsible for keeping your marketing plan on track. Your marketing plan should support your overall business objectives and work within the framework of your total business plan. You are ultimately responsible for ensuring that occurs. Out-sourced Functions

Advertising, public relations, and marketing firms specialize in each component of your marketing plan identified in the previous pages. You may decide to hire an outside firm for only a portion of your marketing activities, such as advertising, for example. Advertising companies can generally offer as much or little support as you choose, from media planning to creating commercials. As a small business, you may be able to find a small advertising business that will offer a fee schedule that fits your budget. It’s worth checking out.

Advertising Networks operate in a manner similar to traditional advertising companies, but they specialize in online advertising. Advertising networks like DoubleClick and 24/7 Media serve as brokers of Internet time and space. These companies collect online advertising inventory and sell spots to advertisers, saving clients the effort of examining advertising sites and negotiating deals. Ad networks can also focus on a specific target market segment and identify pertinent websites. Their fee is paid as a percentage of ad sales or cost-per-thousand rate.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

63

Assessment of Marketing Effectiveness (Marketing Plan: Section VI) Once your marketing plan is implemented, you will need to assess your results. You will need to continuously monitor the effectiveness of each online and offline campaign.

• Are your website promotions reaching your target market?

• What online advertising methods are the most effective in driving traffic to your website?

• What is the cross-over from online promotions to offline sales, and from offline promotions to online sales?

• Should certain radio, print, or television advertisements be strengthened?

• Should any be abbreviated or eliminated?

Assessment of the effectiveness of your marketing plan provides the management information you need to direct your future efforts and to make the wisest investment of your marketing dollars.

This completes the presentation of the components of a winning marketing plan.

To Help You The remaining pages in this chapter are as follows:

• “Product-Market Analysis” bonus discussion referred to under

the Target Market section. (pages 64-67) • Marketing Worksheets that will make it easier to develop your

own marketing plan. (pages 68-74, figures 5.1 thru 5.5) • The Marketing Plan Outline to provide you with an overview of

the components and to help you with the formatting of your own marketing plan. (pages 75-76)

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

64

The Product-Market Analysis developed and contributed by

Donald R. McCrea Ph.D. and president of Bus-Ed Partners, Inc.

www.bus-edpartners.com

Before you write your Marketing Plan. The most important thing you need to do is to analyze your market and make a product-market decision. There are two parts to this decision:

1. The choice of which customer needs you will satisfy as reflected in the specific product or service you will sell to your customers.

2. The choice of the specific customers to whom you wish to sell your product or service (your target market segment).

Once you have made these decisions, you will be ready to write your marketing plan, as described previously in this chapter. If you take the time to do this analysis and carefully choose which customers you will market your product or service to, you will find that almost every prospect you talk to will have a need for what you're selling.

Choosing a group of customers to sell to (i.e., selecting a target market segment) means selecting potential customers according to some criteria you have determined are related to the likelihood these customers will want to buy your product or service. These criteria might include demographic factors such as age, income, or where they live; or lifestyle factors such as interest in sports, antique collecting, reading mystery novels, or seeing foreign movies. Your job as a businessperson is to determine what factors relate to your customers likelihood of buying your product or service.

Follow the Four Rules for Marketing and Sales Success The following four rules for marketing and sales success are designed to help you analyze your market and choose the customers who are more likely to want to buy your product or service. Focusing your marketing and selling efforts on these customers will make finding and keeping new customers easier for you than if you are less selective about which customers you target.

Note. These rules apply equally whether you are selling to consumers or you are selling to other businesses. The rules also apply to you whether you are a start-up or an existing business.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

65

Rule #1: Find Potential Customers Who Want Your Product or Service If your potential customers are consumers, will they recognize that they have a need or want? If your customers are businesses, will they recognize that they have a business problem to solve or an opportunity to exploit?

If the group of customers you have chosen to sell to clearly recognize their need, want, problem, or opportunity, then they are more likely to want to buy your product or service. Note, though, that it’s not enough that you recognize that your prospects have a need or problem: you will have to determine if they will recognize this, as well. If your prospects do not recognize their need or problem, then the first action plan of your marketing and selling activities will be to create or heighten your prospects awareness of their need or problem. This will require specific effort on your part, and is typically done through an integrated marketing communications program.

It’s far simpler and less costly, however, if (during your analysis) you can identify that there is a selected group of potential customers who already recognize their need or problem. This group then validates your plan by becoming your target market segment, and your marketing and selling tasks become easier with this group. The question you must answer: What are the characteristics of your potential customers that are related to their need or desire for your product or service? For example, if you are selling an electric toothbrush, people who visit a dentist regularly are more likely to be interested in your toothbrush than those who don't visit the dentist very often. Customer characteristics that relate to the likelihood of visiting a dentist might include income and education. You might therefore choose to sell your electric toothbrush only to individuals making more than $50,000 a year and with at least a college degree.

Rule #2: Identify Customers Who Are Ready to Buy Will the want/need/problem/opportunity cause your prospects enough pain or the prospect of enough pleasure that they will be willing to take action?

If your prospects are ready to act to fill their need or solve their business problem, then they will be more likely to buy your product or service. On the other hand, if your potential customers need or problem is not strong enough to motivate them to take action, then you will be required to expend more sales and marketing effort to convince them that they will benefit from filling the need or solving the problem. Keep in mind that your prospects probably have several needs or problems, so you must show them that the one you can fill or solve is of high enough priority that they should fill it before the others.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

66

This again would require specific effort on your part, and will become another requirement for your integrated marketing communications program. You will be able to save yourself much of this effort, however, if you plan to refine your target market segment to include only those prospects who already recognize their need or problem and who are willing to act on that need or problem.

To continue your analysis, then, the next question you must ask yourself is: Are there additional customer characteristics that will tell me that these customers will be ready to buy? To expand on the example above: Of those who visit the dentist regularly, those with a higher likelihood of gum disease may be more ready to buy your electric toothbrush than those with healthy teeth and gums. One customer characteristic that is related to a higher incidence of gum disease is age. You might therefore choose to sell your electric toothbrush to those individuals who are over 45 years of age.

When you combine this characteristic with the income and education characteristics we selected previously, your analysis has determined that your target market segment would now become those individuals earning $50,000 or more per year, with four or more years of college education, and who are over 45 years of age.

To complete your analysis, there are two more rules to apply once you have identified your target market segment. Both rules will help your business achieve success.

Rule #3:

Let the Customers Know That You Can Fill Their Needs Will your prospects recognize that you can fulfill their need or want, or solve their business problem? If you are an existing business, do your prospects already recognize your ability to fill their need or want, or solve their business problem?

If you are an existing business, and they do, then your marketing communications program has already done its job or you have already built good relations with these prospects. You can move on to Rule #4.

If your prospects do not yet recognize your ability to meet their need or solve their problem, then you must figure out how to demonstrate to them your ability to do so. This activity will become a part of your marketing communications program, and will form the core of your initial selling activities. Your prospects must recognize that you have a solution to their need or problem before they will commit to spending time or resources with you.

If you have chosen a target market segment satisfying Rules #1 and #2, then the bulk of your marketing and sales activities and expenditures will be dedicated to satisfying Rule #3 and Rule #4, below. Rule #3 will be satisfied by your advertising and promotional activities.

Once you have figured out how to educate your prospects on your ability to satisfy their need or solve their problem, you can move on to Rule #4.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

67

Rule #4: Find Customers Who Will Pay Will your prospects pay you to meet their need or solve their business problem?

There are two parts to Rule #4:

1. Will your prospect pay? - and - 2. Will your prospect pay you?

Even though your prospects recognize their need or problem, are motivated to take action, and recognize that you have a solution, they may not be ready or able to pay, or to pay you. You must ensure your prospect will have funds budgeted or available to fill this need or solve this problem. You also must ensure you are dealing with the decision-makers. In the case of a family, the husband and wife may make joint decisions, especially on large purchases. In the case of a business, several individuals may comprise the “buying center,” including a purchasing agent, an executive, a financial officer, and possibly others. Once you have determined your prospects' ability and willingness to pay, you must ensure that they are willing to pay you (i.e., they recognize you can fill their need or solve their problem in a way that no other competitor or substitute product can do). They must clearly see greater value in what you have to offer them, and trust you to stand behind your product or services ability to meet their need or solve their problem. If your prospects can't distinguish you from your competitors, don't trust you, or can't distinguish your product or service from other products or services offered to them, then a portion of your marketing and sales activities will have to be spent on educating them about your uniqueness and trustworthiness. Of course, uniqueness and trustworthiness must have value to your prospects before they will be willing to pay for them.

Conclusion If you are a new business, analyzing your market, remember that every firm must satisfy these four rules for marketing and sales success. If you are an existing business and you are having difficulty finding customers to purchase your product or service or you are spending a lot of time ”convincing“ your prospects to buy, consider targeting your market segment to satisfy Rules #1 and #2. Then, you'll find that almost every prospect you talk to has a need for what you're selling. You'll then be able to concentrate your marketing and sales efforts on satisfying Rules #3 and #4, to ensure they easily see how you can fulfill their needs better than any of your competitors. If the results of your product-market analysis show that there are valid customers for your product or service, you are now ready to write your marketing plan. The benefit of following the four rules will be shorter sales cycles, a higher percentage of prospects converted to customers, and more productive use of your marketing and sales dollars.

______________________________________ © 2008 Linda Pinson & Donald R. McCrea

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

68

Components of a Successful

Multi-Media Marketing Strategy

Marketing - Traditional (Offline) + New Media (Online)

Identify target market(s). - Demographics - Psychographics - Niche market specifics Research/assess competition. Assess industry trends. Conduct market research. - questionnaires - focus groups - surveys Create packaging/image. Determine pricing strategy. Create branding/image strategy. - logo - slogan - pitch Develop customer database assessment. Identify co-marketing opportunities. Design reciprocal marketing strategies. Evaluate effectiveness of all components of the marketing plan.

Identify online target market(s). - Online demographics - Online psychographics - Online niche market specifics Research /assess competitors’ websites. Assess online industry trends. Conduct market research. - e-mail questionnaires - online focus groups (structured chats) - online (website) surveys Mirror branding/image online. Design online customer database assessment. Merge online/offline database analysis. Identify online co-marketing opportunities. Identify links to/from other websites. Evaluate effectiveness of online marketing.

Sales – Traditional (Offline) + New Media (Online)

Refine the sales pitch. Design and print all sales materials. - Brochures - Pamphlets, folders - Stationery, business cards, etc. - Catalog - Promotional flyers, other Create direct mail campaign. Instigate viral marketing.

Determine the online sales pitch. Design/implement the website. - Introduce the company - Define products/services - Identify additional content needs Register with search engines. Create an e-mail marketing campaign. Create affiliate programs. Create viral marketing opportunities online.

Figure 5.1 – page 1

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

69

Sales Incentive/Promotions (Offline) + New Media (Online) Create in-store campaigns and mailers:

- cash back coupons - discounts/coupons - special introductory offers - free samples

Design sweepstakes and contests. Identify give-aways. Identify trade show opportunities. - determine level of involvement (exhibitor vs. attendee)

Create campaigns on the website and via e-mail for:

- cash back coupons - discounts/coupons - special offers (ex: free shipping)

Design online sweepstakes or points programs - example: points for frequent web

shoppers) Identify give-aways (e.g., as a thank you for completing a website survey).

Advertising – Traditional (Offline) + New Media (Online)

Determine if an advertising agency should be hired. Determine placement, frequency, and prices for each of the following options.

- Television (network, cable) - Radio (national, local) - Print (newspapers, magazines, trade

journals, bulletins, yellow pages, newsletters, etc.)

- Extreme advertising (billboards, buses, blimps, etc.)

- Other (event signage, t-shirts, point-of- purchase signs, etc.)

Identify opportunities for sponsorship (of events, programs, materials, etc.).

Determine if an advertising network should be hired. Determine placement, frequency, and prices for each of the following options.

- Banner ads (vertical, rectangle, click thru)

- Portal advertising - Vortal (vertical portal) advertising - Online newsletters, newspapers - Interactive television - Direct TV - Links to/from - Advertorials on other websites

Identify opportunities for online sponsorships (of Web events, of portions of a website, of online newsletters).

Figure 5.1 – page 2

Components of a Successful Multi-Media Marketing Strategy

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

70

Public Relations – Traditional (Offline) + New Media (Online)

Determine if a public relations agency should be hired. Conduct scheduled events for public/niche:

- workshops - open house - seminars - celebrations

Arrange for:

- participation in other events (special lectures, speeches, workshops)

- guest appearances (radio, television, guest columnist)

- interviews (print) Identify community and charitable events for personal and financial contributions.

Determine if the public relations function should be outsourced. Arrange for online events:

- special guest expert chats - regularly scheduled chat

groups - community-building activities - message boards - website simulcast of offline

events Arrange for guest appearances on other websites: - chat groups - message board (ask the expert) - interviews (in online

newsletters, magazines)

Networking – Traditional (Offline) + New Media (Online)

Identify groups, associations, organizations and conferences:

- your local community - trade associations - business organizations - professional groups

Determine level of involvement in each:

- join - seek a leadership position - attend meetings/events only

Identify online networking opportunities to participate in:

- chat rooms - message boards - professional association websites - other

Establish regular e-mail contact with:

- current clients - prospective clients - business and professional

associates

Figure 5.1 – page 3

Components of a Successful Multi-Media Marketing Strategy

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

71

Marketing Musts

1. Sell Selectively Describe your products and/or services. What trends today have an impact on your products and services? How can you apply information about these trends to your own marketing strategy?

Figure 5.2

“Sell Selectively” Worksheet

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

72

Marketing Musts

2. Know Your Niche

Describe your customers in detail. In addition to demographic data, consider psychographic issues:

• hobbies • disposable income • leisure activities • memberships • vacations • family status • other lifestyle information

What additional information should you obtain about your customers? How does this information have an impact on your marketing strategy?

• Marketing

• Sales

• Advertising

• Public Relations

• Networking

Figure 5.3 “Know Your Niche” Worksheet

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

73

Marketing Musts

3. Create Your Pitch Define precisely the attributes of your products and services.

- Product/Service A: - Product/Service B: - Product/Service C:

How can you make your products and services come alive for your prospective customers/clients? For one of your products or services, write a brief pitch that grabs attention. Focus on the needs of your customers and the product/service benefits.

Figure 5.4 “Create Your Pitch” Worksheet

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

74

Marketing Musts

4. Set Prices for Profits

How does your present pricing structure compare to your competitors? (Equal to, More than, or Less than) Have you covered all of your expenses to produce this product or provide this service, considering:

• Materials

• Labor

• Overhead expenses

• Shipping costs

• Handling costs

• Storage

For services you provide, what are the advantages and disadvantages of the following pricing structures:

• Hourly billing rates

• Project by project estimates

• Monthly retainer structure

What is your price floor? Ceiling?

Figure 5.5 “Price for Profits” Worksheet

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

75

Marketing Plan Outline

I. Overview and Goals of Marketing Strategy

A. Overview of Marketing Strategy

B. Goals of Marketing Strategy 1. Creating a Strong Brand 2. Building a Strong Customer Base 3. Increasing Product/Service Sales

II. Market Analysis A. Target Market(s)

1. Demographics 2. Psychographics 3. Niche market specifics

B. Competition 1. Description of Major Competitors 2. Assessment of Their Strengths/Weaknesses

C. Market Trends 1. Industry Trends 2. Target Market Trends

D. Market Research 1. Methods of Research 2. Database Analysis 3. Summary of Results

III. Marketing Strategy A. General Description

1. Allocation of marketing efforts (% of budget dedicated to online v. offline) 2. Expected return on investment from most significant components

B. Method of Sales and Distribution 1. Stores, offices, kiosks 2. Catalogs, direct mail 3. Website

C. Packaging 1. Quality Considerations 2. Packaging

D. Pricing 1. Price strategy 2. Competitive position

E. Branding

F. Database Marketing (Personalization)

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 5, Part II: The Marketing Plan

76

G. Sales Strategies 1. Direct Sales 2. Direct Mail 3. Email Marketing 4. Affiliate Marketing 5. Reciprocal Marketing 6. Viral Marketing

H. Sales Incentives/Promotions 1. Free Samples 2. Cash Back Coupons 3. Sweepstakes 4. Online Promotions 5. Add-ons 6. Rebates 7. Other

I. Advertising Strategies 1. Traditional Advertising (TV, Radio, Print, Extreme)

2. Web Advertising/New Media (Banner Ads, PDA Advertising, Portals/Vortals, Interactive Television

3. Long-term Sponsorships

J. Public Relations 1. Building an Online Presence (Communities, Chats, Message Boards) 2. Events (online and offline) 3. Press releases (print, radio, television, online) 4. Interviews (online newsletters and websites, print, radio, television, chat

rooms, online events)

K. Networking (memberships and leadership positions)

IV. Customer Service A. Description of Customer Service Activities

B. Expected Outcomes of Achieving Excellence

V. Implementation of Marketing Strategy A. In-House Responsibilities

B. Out-Sourced Functions 1. Advertising, Public Relations, Marketing Firms 2. Advertising Networks 3. Other

VI. Assessment of Marketing Effectiveness * *Note. The assessment is for existing businesses and is added after periodic

evaluations.

77

CHAPTER

6 Part III Financial Documents

You learned earlier that the body of a Business Plan is divided into three main sections. Having completed the Organizational and Marketing Plans, you are now ready to develop the third area of your plan. Financial Documents are those records used to show past, current, and projected finances. In this section I will cover the following major documents that you will want to consider and include in your Business Plan. They will consist of both pro forma (projected) and actual financial statements. Your work will be easier if these are done in the order presented.

Summary of Financial Needs Dispersal of Loan Funds Statement

Cash Flow Statement (Budget)

Three-Year Income Projection

Break-Even Analysis

Balance Sheet

Profit & Loss Statement

Loan Application/Financial History

Financial Statement Analysis

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

78

Before You Begin You are now beginning the Financial Documents section of your business plan. I would strongly suggest that you prepare these documents in the order that I have presented them because it will simplify the process. In the same way that a house builder must lay the foundation, build the walls and finally put on the roof, you will find that your financial statements will build on each other. Each one will use information from the ones previously done. If you try to jump ahead, you will make your task more difficult. Before you begin work on your financial statements go back to Chapter 1 and reread the section on “Developing Financial Assumptions”. Remember that the numbers in your financial plan are derived through the development of organizational and marketing concepts in terms of revenues that will be generated and expenses that will be incurred.

Purpose of Financial Documents In the first two sections, you have written about the physical setup of your operation and your plans for finding and reaching your customers. The Financial Documents section is the quantitative interpretation of everything you have stated in the text portion of your plan. Well-executed financial statements will provide you with the means to look realistically at your business in terms of profitability. Financial Documents is often the first section examined by a potential lender or investor. The financial documents included in your plan are not just for the purpose of satisfying a potential lender or investor. The primary reason for writing a business plan is so that it will serve as a guide during the lifetime of your business. It is extremely important that you keep it updated frequently. This means examining your financial statements on a periodic basis, measuring your actual performance against your projections and revising your new projections accordingly.

Types of Financial Documents There are four types of financial documents covered in this chapter under Sections I, II, III, and IV. Before you start to develop your financial plan, it is best to gain a basic understanding of what these documents are and why they are important to your business.

• Statements of Sources and Uses of Funds from a Lender or Investor The first two documents covered are the "Summary of Financial Needs" and the "Loan Fund Dispersal Statement". These two documents, explained in Section I of the chapter, are the only ones that are written in paragraph form rather than as spreadsheets in rows and columns. They are included only if your business is seeking funds from a lender or investor (or other source).

• Pro Forma Statements

The word "pro forma" in accounting means "projected". These are the statements (cash flow, income projections, etc.) that are used for you to predict the future profitability of your business and will be covered in Section II of this chapter. You will not be performing magic and will never be 100% right. However, your projections should be based on realistic research and reasonable assumptions. It is dangerous to overstate your revenues and understate your expenses.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

79

• Actual Performance Statements

These are the historical financial statements reflecting the past performance of your business. If you are planning a new business, you have no history. Therefore, you will not have these statements to include. However, once you have been in business for even one accounting period, you will have a Profit & Loss Statement and a Balance Sheet for those periods. The actual performance statements will be explained and illustrated in Section III of this chapter.

• Financial Statement Analysis

Once you have completed the financial documents described above, it is also important to use them as tools to look at your business and enable you to make future decisions that will make your business more profitable. Financial Statement Analysis utilizes the income statement and the balance sheet and is the study of relationships and comparisons of single components in a single or in comparative financial statements. In Section IV of this chapter, you will learn how to use your income statement and balance sheet to prepare a financial statement analysis of your business.

How to Proceed The financial documents will be presented in the order discussed in the paragraphs above. It will be necessary for you to determine your individual situation and decide which documents to include in your own business plan. Below are five descriptions. Decide which one fits your business and proceed accordingly:

1. If yours is a new business — and — you are going to seek a lender or investor. Include the "Application of Loan Funds" and the "Loan Fund Dispersal Statement". You will also include all of the pro forma statements. You have no financial history and cannot include actual performance statements. Financial statement analysis will be based on projections only and will utilize your three-year profit & loss (income) projection.

2. If yours is a new business — and — you are not going to seek a lender or investor.

You will not include the "Application of Loan Funds" and the "Loan Fund Dispersal Statement". You will include all pro forma statements. Again, financial statement analysis will be based only on projections and will utilize your three-year profit & loss (income) projection.

3. If yours is an existing business — and — you are going to seek a lender or investor.

You will need to include all financial documents discussed in this chapter. 4. If yours is an existing business — and — you are not seeking a lender or investor.

You will include all financial documents discussed in this chapter with the exception of the "Application of Loan Funds" and the "Loan Fund Dispersal Statement".

5. If this business plan is being written for a division within a larger business.

Consider your division as being a business within a business and include financial documents as indicated in whichever of the above scenarios fits your situation.

.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

80

Now You Are Ready To Prepare Your Financial Documents

The four types of financial documents will be presented in the following order:

Section I: Statements of financial needs and uses of lender/investor funds Section II: Pro forma statements Section III: Actual financial statements Section IV: Financial statement analysis

Helpful hints:

1. Work in order. You should work on financial documents in the order that they are presented in the book. It will make your job easier. Most of your financial documents will use information from the ones you will have already completed.

2. Add explanations when needed. When you prepare your financial statements, it is a good idea to append a written explanation of any items that are unusual or that would not be immediately clear to your lender or investor.

Examples:

• If you are a manufacturing business and have shut down operations for a period to put in new equipment, appending an explanation would clear up any queries about the reason for decreased revenues or inventory levels during that time.

• If you have a heavy increase in advertising expenses, but the increased revenues will not materialize until a future financial statement period, you can attach a note of explanation about your projected benefits for future periods.

Example Financial Spreadsheets

in this chapter have no correlation with each other

Do not try to follow the numbers from one spreadsheet to the next. The Appendices contain four business plans with 100% correlation between spreadsheets. You will be able to see from them how the numbers build on each other throughout the financial plan.

*************************

Section I: Statements of Financial Needs and

Uses of Funds from a Lender or Investor The financial text document and example on the next two pages describes your needs for capital to be infused into your company through borrowed or invested funds. It also outlines your intended use of those funds. Include these statements only if you are seeking funds from a lender or investor.

Summary of Financial Needs Loan Fund Dispersal Statement

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

81

Summary of Financial Needs If you are applying for a loan, your lenders and investors will analyze the requirements of your business. They will distinguish among the three types of capital as follows:

Working capital. Fluctuating needs to be repaid through cash (liquidity) during the business's next full operating cycle, generally one year.

Growth capital. Needs to be repaid with profits over a period of a few years. If you are seeking growth capital, you will be expected to show how the capital will be used to increase your business profits enough to be able to repay the loan (+ interest) within several years (usually not more than seven).

Equity capital. Permanent needs. If you seek equity capital, it must be raised from investors who will take the risk for dividend returns or capital gains, or a specific share of the business.

Keeping the above in mind, you must now prepare a Summary of Financial Needs. This document is an outline giving the following information:

• Why you are applying for a loan or investment funds

• How much you need to accomplish your goals

Loan Fund Dispersal Statement Uses of financing. The potential lender will require a statement of how the money you intend to borrow will be used. It will be necessary for you to tell:

• How you intend to utilize the loan funds.

• Back up your statement with supporting data. The backup statement will show the lender that you have done your homework properly.

The following are two examples that will help to clarify your understanding of the above.

Example 1: How Money Will Be Used. Funds for advertising Back-up Statement. Refer to the advertising section of your plan. That section must contain a breakdown of how you intend to do your advertising. Include rate sheets in the Supporting Documents.

Example 2: How Money Will Be Used. Funds for expansion. Include a concise

statement explaining how you intend to expand.

Back-up Statement. Include the following information: • Projected costs of carrying out plans. • Projections as to how that expansion will ultimately result in

increased profits for your business and thereby enable you to repay your loan.

• References to other sections of your business plan that relate to projected expansion.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

82

Sample Page Summary of Financial Needs & Loan Fund Dispersal Statement

Summary of Financial Needs

1. Genesis Multimedia is seeking a loan to increase growth capital in the following areas of production:

a. Equipment ( new and more modern) b. Training of personnel in operation of above

2. Funds needed to accomplish the above goal will be $250,000.

Loan Fund Dispersal Statement

1. Dispersal of Loan Funds Genesis Multimedia will utilize anticipated loan funds in the amount of $250,000 to modernize its production equipment. This will necessitate the purchase of two new pieces of equipment and the training of present personnel in the operation of that equipment.

2. Back-Up Statement a. The equipment needed is as follows:

(1) High-speed F-34 Atlas Press (purchase price: $123,000) (2) S71 Jaworski Ebber (purchase price: $110,000)

b. The training is available from the manufacturer as a three-week intensive program. (cost: 10 employees @ $1,200 = $12,000)

c. The remaining $5,000 of loan funds will be used to make the first monthly installment on loan repayment (a period of low production due to training off the premises).

d. The equipment will result in a 35% increase in production and will decrease unit cost by 25%. The end result will be a net profit increase sufficient to repay the loan and interest within three years with a profit margin of 15%.*

* Note. Refer to page 17 for production plan of ABC Corporation. See pages 27

and 28 of the marketing section for market research and projected trends in the industry. (See footnote at bottom of page.)

Page numbers at the bottom of the example above are hypothetical and do not refer to page numbers in “Anatomy of a Business Plan”. The production plan referred to in the example would include a description of the equipment, how the work will be done, by whom, and at what cost. Market research would show projected demand for your product, and thus would show how increased production would result in increased sales and ultimately in your company's capability to repay the loan in a timely fashion.

Be sure that your supporting data can be easily found by the loan officer who is examining your application. If your information is not well-organized and easily retrievable, you risk having your loan turned down simply because information cannot be located. The necessity of having a well-written Table of Contents will be discussed in Chapter 10, "Packaging and Updating Your Plan".

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

83

Section II: Pro Forma Statements

The financial statements that follow are pro forma statements. They show your projections for the future profitability of your business.

All business plans must contain the following pro forma statements:

Cash Flow Statement Three-Year Income Projection Break-Even Analysis

Blank forms of all three pro forma statements are included in the blank worksheet section in the back of the book (Appendix V of “Anatomy of a Business Plan”). They are ready for you to customize and input your numbers. Projected Balance Sheet A potential lender or investor may also require that you include a pro forma (or projected) balance sheet for a specific target date in the life of your business (e.g., “end of year one”). You will find instructions for the development of a balance sheet under “Actual Financial Statements” in the next part of this chapter. There are also examples in our sample business plans in Appendices I, II, III, and IV. Also included in this section are:

• Cash to be Paid Out and Sources of Cash Worksheets These worksheets will help you to develop your cash flow statement and may be included in your business plan.

• Quarterly Budget Analysis Spreadsheet This is your tool for comparing your company’s projections with its actual performance. Your cash flow statement will be effective only if it is revised quarterly reflecting the results of a budget analysis.

If you are a new business You have no actual performance to measure against projections. Therefore, you will not have a quarterly budget analysis until you have been in business for three months.

If you have been in business for one or more quarters Do a quarterly budget analysis, revise your cash flow statement accordingly and insert the revised cash flow statement in your business plan.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

84

Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement (Budget) It is a fact that a third or more of today's businesses fail due to a lack of cash flow. The cash flow statement is usually the first thing a lender or investor examines in your business plan. What is cash flow?

What is a Cash Flow Statement? The Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement is the financial document that projects what your Business Plan means in terms of dollars. A cash flow statement is the same as a budget. It is a pro forma (or projected) statement used for internal planning and estimates how much money will flow into and out of a business during a designated period of time, usually the coming tax year. Your profit at the end of the year will depend on the proper balance between cash inflow and outflow. The Cash Flow Statement identifies when cash is expected to be received and when it must be spent to pay bills and debts. It also allows the manager to identify where the necessary cash will come from. This statement deals only with actual cash transactions and not with depreciation and amortization of goodwill or other non-cash expense items. Expenses are paid from cash on hand, sale of assets, revenues from sales and services, interest earned on investments, money borrowed from a lender and influx of capital in exchange for equity in the company. If your business will require $100,000 to pay its expenses and $50,000 to support the owners, you will need at least an equal amount of money flowing into the business just to maintain the status quo. Anything less will eventually lead to an inability to pay your creditors or yourself. The availability or non-availability of cash when it is needed for expenditures gets to the very heart of the matter. By careful planning, you must try to project not only how much cash will have to flow into and out of your business, but also when it will need to flow in and out. A business may be able to plan for gross receipts that will cover its needs. However, if those sales do not take place in time to pay the expenses, your venture will soon be history unless you plan ahead for other sources of cash to tide the business over until the revenues are realized. Time Period. The Cash Flow Statement should be prepared on a monthly basis for the next tax year (or more) of your business. To be effective, it must be analyzed and revised quarterly to reflect actual performance in the preceding three months of operations.

Steps for Planning Your Cash Flow Statement

1. Prepare individual budgets Begin by compiling individual projections and budgets. They might be as follows:

• Revenue projections (product and service) • Inventory purchases • Variable (selling) expense budget (with marketing budget) • Fixed (administrative) expense budget

Page 147

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

85

2. Prepare planning worksheets

Because the cash flow statement deals with cash inflow and cash outflow, the first step in planning can be best accomplished by preparing two worksheets.

a. Cash to be Paid Out

This worksheet documents the cash flowing out of your business. It identifies categories of expenses and obligations and the projected amount of cash needed in each category. Use the information from your individual budgets (inventory purchases, direct expenses, administrative expenses, owner draws, etc.).

These expenditures are not always easy to estimate. If yours is a new business, it will be necessary for you to do lots of market research. If you are an existing business, you will combine information from past financial statements with trends in your particular industry.

b. Sources of Cash Use this worksheet to document the cash flowing into your business. It will help you to estimate how much cash will be available from what sources. To complete this worksheet, you will have to look at cash on hand, projected revenues, assets that can be liquidated, possible lenders or investors, and owner equity to be contributed. This worksheet will force you to take a look at any existing possibilities for increasing available cash.

3. Check out the examples On the next four pages, you will see examples of the two worksheets along with accompanying information explaining each of the categories used. The worksheets are filled in for our fictitious company, Genesis Multimedia, to help you understand the process. Please note that the Cash to be Paid Out Worksheet shows a need for $131,000. It was necessary in projecting Sources of Cash to account for $131,000 without the projected sales because payment is not expected to be received until November and December (too late for cash needs January through October). Next year, those revenues will be reflected in cash on hand or other salable assets. When you do your own worksheets:

• Try to be as realistic as possible. Do not overstate revenues and/or understate expenses, a deadly error frequently made during the planning process.

• Be sure to figure all of your estimates on both worksheets for the same time period (i.e. annually, quarterly, monthly).

Note. Blank forms of the two worksheets are provided in Appendix V.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

86

Explanation of Categories

Cash to Be Paid Out Worksheet 1. Start-Up Costs

These are the costs incurred by you to get your business underway. They are generally one-time expenses and are capitalized for tax purposes.

2. Inventory Purchases Cash to be spent during the period on items intended for resale. If you purchase manufactured products, this includes the cash outlay for those purchases. If you are the manufacturer, include labor and materials on units to be produced.

3. Variable Expenses (Selling or Direct Expenses)

These are the costs of all expenses that will relate directly to your product or service (other than manufacturing costs or purchase price of inventory).

4. Fixed Expenses (Administrative or Indirect Expenses) Include all expected costs of office overhead. If certain bills must be paid ahead, include total cash outlay even if covered period extends into the next year.

5. Assets (Long-Term Purchases) These are the capital assets that will be depreciated over a period of years (land, buildings, vehicles, equipment). Determine how you intend to pay for them and include all cash to be paid out in the current period. Note: Land is the only asset that does not depreciate and will be listed at cost.

6. Liabilities What are the payments you expect to have to make to retire any debts or loans? Do you have any Accounts Payable as you begin the new year? You will need to determine the amount of cash outlay that needs to be paid in the current year. If you have a car loan for $20,000 and you pay $500 per month for 12 months, you will have a cash outlay of $6,000 for the coming year.

7. Owner Equity This item is frequently overlooked in planning cash flow. If you, as the business owner, will need a draw of $2,000 per month to live on, you must plan for $24,000 cash flowing out of your business. Failure to plan for it will result in a cash flow shortage and may cause your business to fail.

Note. Be sure to use the same time period throughout your worksheet.

Variable & Fixed Expense Categories Must Be Determined By You Every business has expenses that are specific to its industry. You will have to customize your variable and fixed expense categories to match your business. The ones used in the examples will give you some ideas. Type your own headings in the working spreadsheets. As you begin to operate your business, you will be better able to determine what your true expenditures are. However, for your business plan, you will need to set your expense headings beginning with this worksheet and use the same ones throughout your spreadsheets. You can change later if you find that your current categories do not meet your needs.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

87

Cash to Be Paid Out Worksheet

Business Name: Genesis Multimedia Time Period Covered: Jan 1 – Dec 31, 2008

1. Start-Up Costs: $ 1,450 Business License 30 Corporation Filing 500 Legal Fees 920 Other Start-up Costs: 0

2. Inventory Purchases 32,000

Cash out for goods intended for resale

2. Variable Expenses (Selling) Advertising/Marketing 8,000 Freight 2,500 Fulfillment of Orders 800 Packaging Costs 0 Sales Salaries/Commissions 14,000 Travel 1,550 Miscellaneous Variable Expense 300

Total Selling Expenses 27,150

4. Fixed Expenses (Administrative) Financial Administration 1,800

Insurance 900 Licenses/Permits 100 Office Salaries 16,300 Rent Expenses 8,600 Utilities 2,400 Miscellaneous Fixed Expense 400

Total Administrative Expenses 30,500

5. Assets (Long-Term Purchases) 6,000 Cash to be paid out in current period

6. Liabilities 9,900 Cash outlay for retiring debts, loans, and/or accounts payable

7. Owner Equity 24,000 Cash to be withdrawn by owner

Total Cash to Be Paid Out $ 131,000

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

88

Explanation of Categories

Sources of Cash Worksheet 1. Cash On Hand

Money that you have on hand in your bank accounts and other resources. Be sure to include petty cash and income that you have not yet deposited.

2. Sales (Revenues)

This includes projected revenues from the sale of your product and/or service. If payment is not expected during the time period covered by this worksheet, do not include that portion of your sales. Think about the projected timing of sales. If receipts will be delayed beyond the time when a large amount of cash is needed, make a notation to that effect and take it into consideration when determining the need for temporary financing. Include deposits you require on expected sales or services. To figure collections on Accounts Receivable, you will have to project the percentage of invoices that will be lost to bad debts and subtract it from your Accounts Receivable total.

3. Miscellaneous Income

Do you, or will you have, any money out on loan or deposited in accounts that will yield interest income during the period in question?

4. Sale of Long-Term Assets

If you are expecting to sell any of your fixed assets such as land, buildings, vehicles, machinery, equipment, etc., be sure to include only the cash you will receive during the current period.

Important. At this point in your worksheet, add up all sources of cash. If you don’t have an amount equal to your projected needs, you will have to plan sources of cash covered under numbers 5 and 6.

5. Liabilities

This figure represents the amount you will be able to borrow from lending institutions such as banks, finance companies, the SBA, etc. Be reasonable about what you think you can borrow. If you have no collateral, don’t have a business plan, or if you have a poor financial history, you will find it difficult, if not impossible, to find a lender. This source of cash requires preplanning.

6. Equity

Sources of equity come from owner investments, contributed capital, sale of stock, or venture capital. Do you anticipate the availability of personal funds? Does your business have the potential for growth that might interest a venture capitalist? Be sure to be realistic in this area. You cannot sell stock (or equity) to a nonexistent investor.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

89

Sources of Cash Worksheet

Genesis Multimedia

Time Period Covered: From January 1, 2008 to December 31, 2008

1. Cash On Hand $ 20,000

2. Sales (Revenues)

Sales 90,000

Service Income 22,000

Deposits on Sales or Services 0

Collections on Accounts Receivable 3,000

3. Miscellaneous Income

Interest Income 1,000

Payments to be Received on Loans 0

4. Sale of Long-Term Assets 0

5. Liabilities

Loan Funds (Banks, Lending Inst., SBA, etc.) 40,000

6. Equity

Owner Investments (Sole Prop. or Partnership) 10,000

Contributed Capital (Corporation) N/A

Sale of Stock (Corporation) N/A

Venture Capital 35,000

A. Without product sales = $ 131,000 Total Cash Available

B. With product sales = $ 221,000

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

90

Using the Worksheets. Now that you have completed the two worksheets, you are ready to use that information. You have estimated how much cash will be needed for the year and you now know what sources are available. In the next phase of cash flow planning you will break the time period of one year into monthly segments and predict when the cash will be needed to make the financial year flow smoothly. Project sales on a monthly basis based on payment of invoices, demand for your particular product or service and ability to fill that demand. Figure the cost of goods, fixed and variable expenses in monthly increments. Most will vary. When do you plan to purchase the most inventory? What months will require the most advertising? Are you expecting a rent or insurance increase? When will commissions be due on expected sales? Determine your depreciable assets needs. How much will the payments be and when will they begin? Fill in as much of the cash flow statement as you can, using those projections and any others that you can comfortably determine. To clarify the process of filling in a cash flow statement, I will walk you through January and February again using Genesis Multimedia the example.

January Projections

1. Genesis Multimedia projects a beginning cash balance of $20,000. 2. Cash Receipts: Product manufacturing will not be completed until February, so there will

be no sales. However, service income of $4,000 is projected. 3. Interest on the $20,000 will amount to about $100 at current rate. 4. There are no long-term assets to sell. Enter a zero. 5. Adding 1, 2, 3, and 4 the Total Cash Available will be $24,100. 6. Cash Payments: Product will be available from the manufacturer in February and

payment will not be due until pickup. However, there will be prototype costs of $5,000. 7. Variable (Selling) Expenses: Estimated at $1,140 8. Fixed (Administrative): Estimated at $1215 9. Interest Expense: No outstanding debts or loans. Enter zero.

10. Taxes: No profit for previous quarter. No estimated taxes would be due. 11. Payments on Long-Term Assets: Genesis plans to purchase office equipment to be paid

in full at the time of purchase. Enter $1139 12. Loan Repayments: No loans have been received. Enter zero. 13. Owner Draws: Owner will need $2,000 for living expenses. 14. Total Cash Paid Out: Add 6 through 13. Total $10,494 15. Cash Balance: Subtract Cash Paid Out from Total Cash Available ($13,606) 16. Loans to be Received: Being aware of the $30,000 to be paid to the manufacturer in

February, a loan of $40,000 is anticipated to increase Cash Available. (This requires advance planning.)

17. Equity Deposit: Owner plans to add $5,000 from personal CD. 18. Ending Cash Balance: Adding 15, 16, and 17 the sum is $58,606.

February Projections

1. February Beginning Cash Balance: January Ending Cash Balance ($58,606) 2. Cash Receipts: Still no sales, but service income is $2,000. 3. Interest Income: Projected at about $120. 4. Sale of Long-Term Assets: None. Enter zero. 5. Total Cash Available: Add 1, 2, 3, and 4. The result is $60,726. 6. Cash Payments: $30,000 due to manufacturer, $400 due on packaging design. 7. Continue as in January. Don't forget to include payments on your loan.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

91

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

92

Instructions for Completing Your Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement

This page contains instructions for completing the cash flow statement on the next page. A blank form for your own projections can be found in Appendix V.

• Vertical Columns are for the 12 months plus 6-month and 12-month period columns. • Horizontal Positions on the statement contain all sources of cash and cash to be paid out

(chart of accounts). Figures are retrieved from worksheets and individual budgets.

Assumptions are projected for each month, reflecting the flow of cash in and out of your business for a one-year period. Begin with the first month of your business cycle and proceed as follows: 1. Project the Beginning Cash Balance. Enter under "January."

2. Project the Cash Receipts for January. Apportion your total year’s revenues throughout the 12 months. Try to weight revenues as closely as you can to a realistic selling cycle for your industry.

3. Add Beginning Cash Balance and Cash Receipts to determine Total Cash Available.

4. Project cash payments to be made for cost of goods to be sold (inventory that you will purchase or manufacture). Apportion your total inventory budget throughout the year, being sure you are providing for levels of inventory that will fulfill your needs for sales projected.

5. Customize your Variable and Fixed Expense categories to match your business.

6. Project Variable, Fixed and Interest Expenses for January. Fill out any that you can for all 12 months.

7. Project cash to be paid out on Taxes, Long-Term Assets, Loan Repayments and Owner Draws.

8. Calculate Total Cash Paid Out (Total of Cost of Goods to Be Sold, Variable, Fixed, Interest, Taxes, Long-Term Asset Payments, Loan Repayments and Owner Draws).

9. Subtract Total Cash Paid Out from Total Cash Available. The result is entered under "Cash Balance/Deficiency." Be sure to bracket this figure if the result is a negative to avoid errors.

10. Look at Ending Cash Balance in each of the months and project Loans to be Received and Equity Deposits to be made. Add to Cash Balance/Deficiency to arrive at Ending Cash Balance for each month.

11. Ending Cash Balance for January is carried forward and becomes February's Beginning Cash Balance. (Each month’s ending balance is the next month’s beginning balance.)

12. Go to February and input any numbers that are still needed to complete that month. The process is repeated until December is completed.

To Complete the 6-Month and 12-Month Period Columns 1. The Beginning Cash Balance for January is entered in the first space of the "Total" column. 2. The monthly figures for each category (except Beginning Cash Balance, Total Cash Available,

Cash Balance/Deficiency, and Ending Cash Balance) are added horizontally and the result entered in the corresponding Total category.

3. The Total column is then computed in the same manner as each of the individual months. If you have been accurate with your computations, the December Ending Cash Balance will be exactly the same as the Total Ending Cash Balance.

Note. If your business is new, you will have to base your projections solely on market research and industry trends. If you have an established business, you will also use your financial statements from previous years.

A natom

y of a B usiness P

lan, C hapter 6, P

art III: F inancial D

ocum ents 93

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

94

Quarterly Budget Analysis Your Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement (yearly budget) is of no value to you as a business owner unless there is some means to evaluate the actual performance of your company and measure it against your projections. What is a Quarterly Budget Analysis? A quarterly budget analysis is the financial analysis tool that is used to compare your projected cash flow statement with your business's actual performance. Its purpose is to let you know whether or not you are operating within your projections and to help you maintain control of all phases of your business operations. When your analysis shows that you are over or under budget in any area, it will be necessary to determine the reason for the deviation and to implement changes for the future that will enable you to get back on track.

Example. If you have budgeted $1,000 in advertising funds for the first quarter and you find that you have actually spent $1,600, the first thing you should do is look at the sales that have occurred as a result of increased advertising. If they are over projections by an amount equal to or more than the $600, your budget will still be in good shape. If not, you will have to find expenses in your budget that can be revised to make up the deficit. You might be able to take a smaller draw for yourself or spend less on travel. You might even be able to increase your profits by adding a new product or service.

It should be clear at this point that the correct process to keep you from running out of operating capital in the middle of the year is to make yearly projections, analyze at the end of each quarter and then to revise your budget based on that analysis and current industry trends. How to Develop a Quarterly Budget Analysis The Quarterly Budget Analysis needs the following seven columns:

1. Budget Item. The list of budget items is taken from headings on the Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement. All items in your budget should be listed.

2. Budget This Quarter. Fill in the amount budgeted for current quarter from your Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement.

3. Actual This Quarter. Fill in actual expenditures or receipts for quarter.

4. Variation This Quarter. Subtract the amount spent or received from the amount budgeted for the current quarter. This will be the amount spent or received over or under budget.

5. Year-to-Date Budget. Amount budgeted from beginning of year through and including current quarter (from cash flow statement).

6. Actual Year-to-Date. Actual amount spent or received from beginning of year through current quarter.

7. Variation Year-to-Date. Subtract the amount spent or received from the amount budgeted from the start of the year through the current quarter.

Note. You will not have any information to input into columns 3, 4, 5, 6, and 7 until you have been in business at least one quarter.

Page 149

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

95

By subtracting the amount actually spent, you will arrive at the variation for the quarter. The last three columns are for year- to-date-figures. If you analyze at the end of the 3rd quarter, figures will represent the first nine months of your tax year. Making Calculations: When you calculate variations, the amounts are preceded by either a plus (+) or a minus (- ), depending on whether the category is a revenue or an expense. If the actual amount is greater than the amount budgeted, (1) Revenue categories will represent the variation as a positive (+). (2) Expense categories will represent the variation as a negative (-).

Quarterly Budget Analysis

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

96

Three-Year Income Projection

What is a Three-Year Income Projection? A three-year income projection is a pro forma income (or profit & loss) statement. This statement differs from a cash flow statement in that it includes only projected income and deductible expenses. This difference is illustrated as follows: Your company will make payments of $9,000 on a vehicle in 2008. Of that amount, $3,000 is interest. The full amount ($9,000) will be recorded on a cash flow statement; only the interest ($3,000) will be recorded on a projected income statement. Principal paid on your loan ($6,000) is not a deductible expense.

Variation in Period Covered There is some difference of opinion as to the period of time that should be covered and whether or not it should be on an annual or month-by-month basis. If you are seeking funds, talk to the lender about his or her specific requirements. If not, I suggest a three-year projection with annual rather than monthly projections. In a rapidly-changing economy, it is difficult to make accurate detailed projections.

Account for Increases and Decreases Increases in income and expenses are only realistic and should be reflected in your projections. Industry trends can also cause decreases in both income and expenses. An example of this might be in the computer industry where heavy competition and standardization of components has caused a decrease in the cost and the sale price of both hardware and software. The state of the economy will also be a contributing factor in the outlook for your business.

Sources of Information Information for a three-year income projection can be developed from your pro forma cash flow statement and your business and marketing analysis. The first year's figures can be transferred from the totals of income and expense items. The second and third year's figures are derived by combining these totals with projected trends in your particular industry. Also remember that certain expenses from your first year may not be repeated in future years. You may also have new expenses to take into account. For instance, you may have a new product or service, you may begin importing or exporting internationally and have customs and freight, or you may begin offering merchant credit card services and have associated fees. Again, if you are an established business, you will also be able to use past financial statements to help you determine what you project for the future of your business. Be sure to take into account fluctuations anticipated in costs, efficiency of operation, changes in your market, etc.

At the end of each year, you can compare your company’s projections against its actual performance. You may be required by some lenders or investors to extend your projection to five years. The process will be the same.

Note. A filled-in example of a Three-Year Income Projection form is provided on the next page. A blank form for your use is located in Appendix V.

Page 146

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

97

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

98

Break-Even Analysis

What is a Break-Even Point? This is the point at which a company's costs exactly match the sales volume and at which the business has neither made a profit nor incurred a loss. The break-even point can be determined by mathematical calculation or by development of a graph. It can be expressed in:

1. Total Dollars of Revenue (exactly offset by total costs)

2. Total Units of Production (cost of which exactly equals the income derived by their sale).

To apply a Break-Even Analysis to an operation, you will need three projections:

1. Fixed Costs. Administrative Overhead + Interest. Many of these costs remain constant even during slow periods. Interest expense must be added to fixed costs for a break-even analysis.

2. Variable Costs. Cost of Goods + Selling Expenses. Usually varies with volume of business. The greater the sales volume, the higher the costs.

3. Total Sales Volume. Projected sales for same period. Source of Information All of your figures can be derived from your Three-Year Projection. Since break-even is not reached until your total revenues match your total expenses, the calculation of your break- even point will require that you add enough years’ revenues and expenses together until you see that the total revenues are greater than the total expenses. Retrieve the figures and plug them into the following mathematical formula. (By now you should be able to see that each financial document in your business plan builds on the ones done previously.) Mathematically A firm's sales at break-even point can be computed by using this formula: B-E Point (Sales) = Fixed Costs + [(Variable Costs/Est. Revenues) x Sales]

Terms Used: a. Sales = volume of sales at Break-Even Point b. Fixed Costs = administrative expense, depreciation, interest c. Variable Costs = cost of goods and selling expenses d. Estimated Revenues = income (from sales of goods/services)

Example: a. S (Sales at B-E Point) = the unknown b. FC (Fixed Costs) = $25,000 c. VC (Variable Costs) = $45,000 d. R (Estimated Revenues) = $90,000

Using the formula, the computation would appear as follows: S (at B-E Point) = $25,000 + [($45,000/$90,000) x S] S = $25,000 + (1/2 x S) S - 1/2 S = $25,000 S = $50,000 (B-E Point in terms of $ of revenue exactly offset by total costs)

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

99

Graphically Break-even point in graph form for the same business would be plotted as illustrated below. There is a blank form for your use in Appendix V.

To Complete the Graph. Determine the following projections.

1. Fixed Costs for Period. Those costs that usually remain constant and must be met regardless of sales volume (administrative, rent, insurance, depreciation, salaries, etc.). Also add interest expense. (Ex: $25,000)

2. Variable Costs. Cost associated with the production and selling of your products or services. If you have a product, you will include cost of goods (inventory purchases, labor, materials) with your variable costs (freight, packaging, sales commissions, advertising, etc.) If you wish, these costs may be expressed by multiplying the unit cost by the units to be sold for a product. (Example: $1.50 per unit x 30,000 units = $45,000). For a service having no cost of goods, use total of projected selling expenses (variable).

3. Total Sales Volume. This figure represents your total projected revenues. You may also calculate revenues by multiplying projected units of product to be sold by sale price per unit. (Example: 30,000 units @ $3.00 = $90,000); For a service, you can multiply projected billable hours by your hourly rate. (Example: 900 hours x $100 = $90,000)

To Draw Graph Lines

1. Draw Horizontal Line at point representing Fixed Costs (25). 2. Draw Variable Cost Line from left end of Fixed Cost Line sloping upward to point where Total Costs (Fixed +

Variable) on vertical scale (7) meet Total Revenues on the horizontal scale (9). 3. Draw Total Revenues Line from zero thru point describing total Revenues on both scales (where 9 meets 9).

Break-Even Point - That point on the graph where the Variable Cost Line intersects the Total Revenue Line. This business estimates that it will break even at the time sales volume reaches $50,000. The triangular area below and to the left of that point represents company losses. The triangular area above and to the right of the point represents expected company profits.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

100

Section III

Actual Performance (Historical) Financial Statements

The financial statements covered on the following pages are actual performance (or historical) statements. They reflect the past activity of your business.

• If you are a new business owner, you have no business history. Your financial section will end with the projected statements and a Personal Financial History.

• If you are an established business, you will include the following actual performance financial documents:

Balance Sheet

Profit & Loss (Income) Statement

Business Financial History or

Loan Application

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

101

Balance Sheet What is a Balance Sheet? The Balance Sheet is a financial statement that shows the financial position of the business as of a fixed date. It is usually done at the close of an accounting period. The Balance Sheet can be compared to a photograph. It is a picture of what your business owns and owes at a particular given moment and will show you whether your financial position is strong or weak. By regularly preparing this statement, you will be able to identify and analyze trends in the financial strength of your business and thus implement timely modifications.

Assets, Liabilities, and Net Worth All balance sheets are divided into three categories. The three are related in that, at any given time, a business's assets equal the total contributions by its creditors and owners. They are defined as follows:

Assets = Anything your business owns that has monetary value

Liabilities = Debts owed by the business to any of its creditors

Net Worth (Capital) = Amount equal to the owner's equity

The relationship between these terms is simply illustrated in the following accounting formula.

Assets - Liabilities = Net Worth Examined as such, it becomes apparent that if a business possesses more assets than it owes to creditors, its net worth will be a positive. Conversely, if the business owes more money to creditors than it possesses in assets, the net worth will be a negative.

Projected Balance Sheets If you are seeking financing, your lenders or investors may require that you provide them with projected balance sheets for “day-one” after capital infusion, or “end-of-year one”. The financial information for a projected balance sheet as of a fixed date is compiled by using figures from the same-date column of your pro forma cash flow statement and same-date status on inventory, capital assets, long-term loans, and current liabilities. An example of an “end-of-year one” projected balance sheet can be seen in the sample business plans for Marine Art of California and Wholesale Mobile Homes, Inc.com in the Appendix. The format is the same for projected or actual balance sheets.

Categories and Format The Balance Sheet must follow an accepted accounting format and contain the previously mentioned categories. By following this format, anyone reading the Balance Sheet can readily interpret it.

Note. A sample filled-in Balance Sheet and Explanation of Balance Sheet Categories are provided for you on the next two pages. There is also a blank form for your own use in Appendix V.

Page 144

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

102

Explanation of Categories Balance Sheet

Assets. Everything owned by or owed to your business that has cash value.

1. Current Assets. Assets that can be converted into cash within one year of the date on the Balance Sheet.

• Cash. Money you have on hand. Include moneys not yet deposited. • Petty Cash. Money deposited to Petty Cash & not yet expended. • Accounts Receivable. Money owed to you for sale of goods and/or services • Inventory. Raw materials, work in process and goods manufactured or purchased

for resale • Short-Term Investments. Expected to be converted to cash within one year--

stocks, bonds, CDs. List at lesser of cost or market value. • Prepaid Expenses. Goods or services purchased or rented prior to use (ex: rent,

insurance, prepaid inventory purchases, etc.)

2. Long-Term Investments. Stocks, bonds, and special savings accounts to be kept for at least one year.

3. Fixed Assets. Resources a business owns and does not intend for resale. • Land. List at original purchase price. • Buildings. List at cost less depreciation. • Equipment, Furniture, Autos/Vehicles. List at cost less depreciation. "Kelley Blue

Book" can be used to determine current value of vehicles. Liabilities. What your business owes; claims by creditors on your assets.

1. Current Liabilities. Those obligations payable within one operating cycle. • Accounts Payable. Obligations payable within one operating cycle. • Notes Payable. Short-term notes; list the balance of principal due. Separately list

the current portion of long-term debts. • Interest Payable. Interest accrued on loans and credit. • Taxes Payable. Amounts estimated to have been incurred during the accounting

period.

• Payroll Accrual. Current Liabilities on salaries and wages.

2. Long-Term Liabilities. Outstanding balance less the current portion due (business loans, mortgages, vehicle, etc.)

Net Worth. Also called Owner Equity. The claims of the owner or owners on the assets of the business (Document according to the legal structure of your business.)

1. Proprietorship or Partnership. Each owner's original investment plus earnings after withdrawals.

2. Corporation. The sum of contributions by owners or stockholders plus earnings retained after paying dividends.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

103

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

104

Profit & Loss (Income) Statement What is a Profit & Loss (Income) Statement? This statement shows your business financial activity over a period of time, usually your tax year. In contrast to the Balance Sheet, which shows a picture of your business at a given moment, the Profit & Loss Statement (P & L) can be likened to a moving picture--showing what has happened in your business over a period of time. It is an excellent tool for assessing your business. You will be able to pick out weaknesses in your operation and plan ways to run your business more effectively, thereby increasing your profits. For example, you may find that some heavy advertising in March did not effectively increase your sales. In following years, you may decide to utilize your advertising funds more effectively by using them at a time when there is increased customer spending taking place. In the same way, you might examine your Profit & Loss Statement to see what months have the heaviest sales volume and plan your inventory accordingly. Comparison of your P & Ls from several years will give you an even better picture of the trends in your business. Don’t underestimate the value of this particular tool when planning your tactics.

How to Develop a Profit & Loss Statement The Profit & Loss Statement (Income Statement) is compiled from actual business transactions, in contrast to pro forma statements, which are projections for future business periods. The P & L shows where your money has come from and where it was spent over a specific period of time. It should be prepared not only at the end of the fiscal year, but at the close of each business month. It is one of the two principal financial statements prepared from the ledgers and the records of a business. Income and expense account balances are used in The Profit & Loss Statement. The remaining asset, liability and capital information provides the figures for the Balance Sheet covered on the last three pages. At the end of each month, the accounts in the General Ledger are balanced and closed. Balances from the revenue accounts (numbered 400-499) and the expense accounts (numbered 500-599) must be transferred to your Profit & Loss Statement. If you use an accounting professional or have a good in-house software program, either should generate a profit & loss statement and balance sheet for you at the end of every month as well as at the end of your tax year. Many owners of smaller businesses set up their own set of manual books. If your general records are set up properly, the transfer of information should still be fairly simple as long as you understand what information is needed and which general records are to be used as sources.

Format and Sources of Information The Profit & Loss (or Income) Statement must also follow an accepted accounting format and contain certain categories.

On the next page, you will see the correct format and a brief explanation of the items to be included or computations to be made in each category in order to arrive at "The Bottom Line" or owner's share of the profit for the period.

Page 145

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

105

Profit & Loss Statement

Correct Format and Explanation of Categories

Income 1. Net Sales (Gross sales less Returns and Allowances). What were your cash receipts for the

period? If accounting is on an accrual basis, what amount did you invoice out during the period? You may wish to have subcategories for different types of sales.

2. Cost of Goods Sold. The cost of manufacturing or purchase of products sold for the period. The Cost of Goods is calculated using a, b, and c below. (a + b - c = C.O.G.)

a. Beginning Inventory. Product on hand at beginning of accounting period. b. Purchases. Material, labor, or cost of inventory purchased during accounting

period.

c. Ending Inventory. Product on hand at the end of the accounting period. 3. Gross Profit. Computed by subtracting Cost of Goods Sold from Net Sales. (1 minus 2)

If you are in a service business and do not sell any products, you will not have any cost of goods to compute. Net sales and gross profit will be the same.

Expenses 1. Variable Expenses (Selling). What expenses did you have that were directly related to your

product or service? (i.e. - advertising/marketing, freight, fulfillment of orders, sales salaries/commissions, trade shows, travel, vehicles, depreciation (production equip), etc.? These expenses vary and are usually directly proportional to your volume of business. Divide into sub-categories customized to your business.

2. Fixed Expenses (Administrative). What expenses did you have during the period on office overhead (accounting/legal, insurance, office supplies, office salaries, rent, utilities, depreciation of office equipment, etc.)? These expenses are often fixed and remain the same regardless of your volume of business. They should also be divided into subcategories customized to your business.

Net Income From Operations. Gross Profit (3.) minus Total Fixed (Selling) Expenses and Variable (Administrative) Expenses (Expenses numbers 1 and 2)

Other Income. Interest received during the period Other Expense. Interest paid out during the period

Net Profit (Loss) Before Income Taxes. The Net Income from Operations plus Interest Income minus Interest Expense. The amount of profit prior to income taxes.

Income Taxes. List taxes paid out during the period (Federal, State, local, self-employment )

Net Profit (Loss) After Income Taxes. Subtract all income taxes paid out from the net profit (or loss) before income taxes. This is what is known as "the bottom line."

Sample Forms. The next two pages contain two Profit & Loss Statement forms. As you will see in the Example 12-Month Profit & Loss Statement, the spreadsheet is divided into columns representing each of the 12 months + 6-month and annual total columns. At the end of your tax year, you will have filled in all monthly columns. After calculating your annual totals, your P&L will be complete. At the end of the year, this form will provide an accurate moving picture of the year's financial activity. The second is a single form to be used for either a monthly, quarterly, or annual profit & loss statement. Blank forms for your own use are provided in Appendix V.

Page 146

106 A

natom y of a B

usiness P lan, C

hapter 6, P art III: F

inancial D ocum

ents

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

107

108 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

Business Financial History The business financial history is the last of the financial statements required in your business plan. It is a summary of financial information about your company from its start to the present.

If Yours is a New Business You will have only projections for your business. If you are applying for a loan, the lender will require a Personal Financial History. This will be of benefit in that it will show the manner in which you have conducted your personal business, an indicator of the probability of your succeeding in your business.

If Yours is an Established Business The loan application and your Business Financial History are the same. When you indicate that you are interested in obtaining a business loan, the institution considering the loan will supply you with an application. The format may vary slightly. When you receive your loan application, be sure to review it and think about how you are going to answer each item. Answer all questions and by all means be certain your information is accurate and that it can be easily verified.

Information Needed and Sources When you fill out your Business Financial History (loan application), it should become immediately apparent why this is the last financial document to be completed. All of the information needed will have been compiled previously in earlier parts of your plan and in the financial statements you have already completed. To help you with your financial history, the following is a list of information most frequently required. Also listed are the some of the sources you can refer to for that information:

• Assets, Liabilities, Net Worth. You should recognize these three as balance sheet terms. You have already completed the Balance Sheet for your company and need only to go back to that record and bring the dollar amounts forward.

• Contingent Liabilities. These are debts you may come to owe in the future (for example: default on a cosigned note or settlement of a pending lawsuit).

• Inventory Details. Information is derived from your Inventory Record. Also, in the Organizational Plan you should already have a summary of your current policies and methods of evaluation.

• Profit & Loss Statement. This is revenue and expense information. You will transfer the information from your Annual Profit & Loss (last statement completed) or from compilation of several if required by the lender.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

109

• Real Estate Holdings, Stocks and Bonds. Refer back to your Organizational Plan. You may also have to go through your investment records for more comprehensive information

• Legal Structure Information (Sole Proprietorship, Partnership or Corporation). There are generally three separate schedules on the financial history, one for each form of legal structure. You will be required to fill out the one that is appropriate to your business. In the Organizational section, you will have covered two areas that will serve as the source of this information—Legal Structure and Management. Supporting Documents may also contain some of the information that you will need.

• Audit Information. Refer back to the Organizational Plan under Accounting & Legal. You may also be asked questions about other prospective lenders, whether you are seeking credit, who audits your books, and when they were last audited.

• Insurance Coverage. You will be asked to provide detailed information on the types of insurance your company has (i.e., liability, earthquake, workers compensation, inventory, machinery and fixtures, buildings, extended coverage, etc.). Your Organizational Plan and Insurance Update worksheet should have all of the information you will need to fill in this section of the financial history.

Business Financial History Form You will find an example of a Business Financial History that might be required by a potential lender or investor on the next two pages (110-111).

Personal Financial Statement Form If you are a new business and need your Personal Financial Statement for this section, you will find a sample form in “Anatomy of a Business Plan”, Chapter 7, "Supporting Documents".

Please Note. Part IV: Financial Statement Analysis will follow after the Business Financial History example. (See pages 112-118)

Analysis of your financial statements will help you to make decisions and implement changes that will make your business more profitable.

110 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

111

112 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

Section IV

Financial Statement Analysis: The Final Tool

The Financial Documents I have presented will probably be sufficient for both your own use and that of a potential lender or investor. Some of the documents may not be required. You should also note that we may have omitted forms required by some lenders or investors. The important thing for you to be aware of when compiling financial statements is that the information must be correct, it must reflect the assumptions developed in the Organizational and Marketing Plans, and you must have supportive records that back up your numbers. By now you will have completed all of the pro forma and historical financial statements required for your business. There is an additional financial tool, however, that will help you as well as your lenders and/or investors to look at your business, analyze it according to industry standards, and to make decisions that will increase profitability. That tool is financial statement analysis. It is accomplished by applying a set of formulas to the information on your profit and loss (income) statements and balance sheets. How to Analyze Financial Statements In the last pages of this section, I will explain financial statement analysis and give you examples of how you can use it to look at your business. Doing a financial statement analysis of your business is like all of the other tasks you have already completed. There is a definite process and if you follow it step-by-step, you will have added a valuable component to your business plan. Read the following pages. When you are finished reading, go to the sample business plans in Appendices I, II, III, and IV and see how the analyses were done for Marine Art of California, Dayne Landscaping, Inc., Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc., and Karma Jazz Café. You will note in all cases that there is a ratio table and spreadsheets preceded by a one-page summary. Apply the formulas to your income statements and balance sheets to figure the ratios for your business. You can also complete a vertical analysis using the income statements and balance sheets. A horizontal analysis can only be completed if you have been in business for two or more years. Analysis Summary Once you have figured the ratios and completed your vertical (and horizontal, if you have been in business for two or more years) analyses, be sure to develop a summary sheet for your business plan. The summary sheet allows you and/or your lenders or investors to get a quick overview of your business and how it compares to industry standards. The summary should contain: (1) a list of your projected ratios, (2) a list of historical ratios if you are a current business, and (3) a list of standard ratios for your industry. After you list the ratios, you should finish your summary with your comments regarding what your ratios indicate for the future of the company.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

113

Financial Statement Analysis Putting Your Financial Statements to Work

To better utilize the financial section of your business plan as a working tool, you will use the financial statements that you have prepared to analyze your business. The following pages are devoted to giving you the basics about financial statement analysis. After you have read the material and understand how to apply the formulas to develop ratios, you can do an analysis of your own business and append it to the end of your financial section.

Note. If you are a new business, your analysis will be based on projections only. If you are a current business, you will use your historical profit and loss (income) statements and your balance sheets.

Your financial statements contain the information you need to help make decisions regarding your business. Many small business owners think of their financial statements as requirements for creditors, bankers, or tax preparers only, but they are much more than that. When analyzed, your financial statements can give you key information needed on the financial condition and the operations of your business. Relationships are expressed as ratios or percentages Financial statement analysis requires measures to be expressed as ratios or percentages. For example, consider the situation where total assets on your balance sheet are $10,000. Cash is $2,000; Accounts Receivable is $3,000; and Fixed Assets is $5,000. The relationships of each of the three to total assets would be expressed as follows:

Ratio Relationship Percentages Cash .2 .2:1 20% Accounts Receivable .3 .3:1 30% Fixed Assets .5 .5:1 50% Financial statement analysis involves the studying of relationships and comparisons of:

• Items in a single year's financial statement • Comparative financial statements for a period of time • Your statements with those of other businesses

Note. A Financial Statement Analysis Ratio Table form has been provided in Appendix V for your use. The form has all of the formulas for figuring your ratios. Input the appropriate numbers from your income statements and balance sheets and calculate according to the formulas. This will give you the information for your analysis summary page.

114 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

Analyzing Your P&L (Income) Statements & Balance Sheets

Many analytic tools are available, but the focus here will be on the following measures, using your profit & loss (income) statements and balance sheets, that are of most importance to a small business owner in the business planning process:

Liquidity Analysis Measures of Investment Profitability Vertical Financial Statement Analysis Measures of Debt Horizontal Financial Statement Analysis

Liquidity Analysis The liquidity of a business is the ability it has to meet financial obligations. The analysis focuses on the balance sheet relationships for the current assets and current liabilities. The three main measures of liquidity and their formulas are as follows:

1. Net Working Capital. The excess of current assets over current liabilities is net working capital. The more net working capital a business has, the less risky it is, as it has the ability to cover current liabilities as they come due.

Current Assets Formula: - Current Liabilities Net Working Capital

2. Current Ratio. The current ratio is a more dependable indication of liquidity than

the net working capital. Current ratio is computed using the following formula:

Current Ratio = Current Assets Current Liabilities

There are no set criteria for the normal current ratio, as that is dependent on the business you are in. If you have predictable cash flows, you can operate with a lower current ratio. A higher ratio means a more liquid position. A ratio of 2.0 is considered acceptable for most businesses. This would allow a company to lose 50% of its current assets and still be able to cover current liabilities. For most businesses, this is an adequate margin of safety.

3. Quick Ratio. Since inventory is the most difficult current asset to dispose of quickly, it is subtracted from the current assets in the quick ratio to give a tougher list of liquidity. A quick ratio of 1.00 or greater is usually recommended, but that is dependent upon the business you are in. The quick ratio is computed as follows:

Quick Ratio = Current Assets Inventory Current Liabilities

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

115

What are Liquidity Ratios Good For? Liquidity ratios can be used to see if your business is in any risk of insolvency. You will also be able to assess your ability to increase or decrease current assets for your business strategy. How would these moves affect your liquidity? Your creditors will use these ratios to determine whether or not to extend credit to you. They will compare the ratios with those of previous periods and with industry standard ratios.

Profitability Analysis A Profitability Analysis will measure the ability of a business to make a profit. This type of analysis will utilize your profit and loss (income) statements. Three of these measures and their formulas are as follows:

1. Gross Profit Margin. The gross profit margin indicates the percentage of each sales dollar remaining after a business has paid for its goods.

Gross Profit Margin = Gross Profit Sales

The higher the gross profit margin, the better. The normal rate is dependent on the business you are in. The Gross Profit Margin is the actual markup you have on the goods sold.

2. Operating Profit Margin. This ratio represents the pure operations profits, ignoring interest and taxes. In other words, this is the percentage of each sales dollar remaining after a business has paid for its goods and paid for its variable and fixed expenses. Naturally, a high operating profit margin is preferred.

Operating Profit Margin = Income from Operations Sales

3. Net Profit Margin. The net profit margin is clearly the measure of a business success

with respect to earnings on sales.

Net Profit Margin = Net Profit Sales

A higher margin means the firm is more profitable. The net profit margin will differ according to your specific type of business. A 1% margin for a grocery store is not unusual due to the large quantity of items handled; while a 10% margin for a jewelry store would be considered low.

Your creditors will look at these ratios to see just how profitable your business is. Without profits, a business cannot attract outside financing. As a business owner, you can see just how profitable your business is. If the ratios are too low, you will want to analyze why.

• Did you mark up your goods sold enough? Check your gross profit margin. • Are your operating expenses too high? Check your operating profit margin. • Are your interest expenses too high? Check your net profit margin.

116 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

Debt Measures The debt position of a business indicates the amount of other people’s money being used to generate profits. Many new businesses assume too much debt too soon in an attempt to grow too quickly. The measures of debt use the balance sheet to tell your business how indebted it is and how able it is to service the debts. The more indebtedness you have, the greater will be your risk of failure.

1. Debt to Assets Ratio. This is a key financial ratio used by creditors. It shows what you owe in relationship to what you own. The higher this ratio, the more risk of failure.

Debt to Assets Ratio = Total Liabilities Total Assets

The acceptable ratio is dependent upon the policies of your creditors and bankers. If, for instance, you had rates of 79% and 74% for two consecutive years, these would be excessively high and show a very high risk of failure. Clearly 3/4 of the company is being financed by other people's money, and it does not put the business in a good position for acquiring new debt.

2. Debt to Equity Ratio. This is a key financial ratio used by creditors. It shows what is owed in relationship to the owner's equity in the company. Again, the higher this ratio, the more risk of failure.

Debt to Equity Ratio = Total Liabilities Total Equity (Net Worth)

If your business plan includes the addition of long-term debt at a future point, you will want to monitor your debt ratio. If you are seeking a lender, is it within the limits acceptable to your banker?

Investment Measures As a small business owner, you have invested money to acquire assets, and you should be getting a return on these assets. Even if the owner is taking a salary from the business, he/she also should be earning an additional amount for the investment in the company.

1. Return on Investment (ROI). The Return on Investment uses your balance sheet and measures the effectiveness of you, as the business owner, to generate profits from the available assets.

ROI = Net Profits Total Assets

The higher the ROI, the better. The business owner should get a target for the ROI. What do you want your investment to earn? Many small business owners have successfully created jobs for themselves, but still don't earn a fair return on their investment. Set your target for ROI, and work towards it.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

117

Vertical Financial Statement Analysis Percentage analysis is used to show relationship of components in a single financial statement.

• For a balance sheet. Each asset on the balance sheet is stated as a percent of the total assets, and each liability and equity item is stated as a percent of the total liabilities and owner equity (or net worth).

• For an Income Statement. In vertical analysis of the income statement, each item is stated as a percent of the total net sales.

An evaluation of components on single financial statements from one or more years can show changes that may alert you to investigate current expenditures. For example a high percentage increase in cost of goods sold should be cause for investigation. A decrease in gross profit from one year to the next might trigger the owner to look at the mark-up. You can also evaluate your percentages against those of competitors or against industry standards for your trade to help you make judgments that can help your business be more profitable in the future. If your competitor is making a gross profit of 47% and yours is only 32%, you will want to know the reason why. Does he have a better source for purchasing product? Is his manufacturing process more efficient?

Horizontal Financial Statement Analysis Horizontal analysis is a percentage analysis of the increases and decreases in the items on comparative financial statements. The increase or decrease of the item is listed, and the earlier statement is used as the base. The percentage of increase or decrease is listed in the last column.

• For a balance sheet. Assets, Liabilities, and Owner's Equity of one year are measured against a second year. The increase or decrease of the item is listed followed by the percentage of increase or decrease.

• For an Income Statement. In horizontal analysis of the income statement, Income and Expense items of one year are measured against a second year. The increase or decrease of the item is listed followed by the percentage of increase or decrease.

The horizontal financial statement analysis can also alert you to potential or current problems that can decrease your profitability. As an example, if you have an increase in sales, but a decrease in gross profit, you might look at your mark up. If you have a large increase in advertising expense, you will need to see if the expense was justified by increased sales. Summary Now, you can see how financial statement analysis can be a tool to help you manage your business.

• If the analysis produces results that don't meet your expectation—or if the business is in danger of failure, analyze your expenses and use of assets. Your first stop should be to cut expenses and increase productivity of assets.

118 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 6, Part III: Financial Documents

• If return on investment is too low, examine how you could make your assets (equipment, machinery, fixtures, inventory, etc.) better work to your benefit.

• If your profit is low, be sure that your mark up is adequate, analyze operating expenses to see that they are not too high, and review your interest expenses.

• If your liquidity is low, you could have a risk of becoming insolvent. Examine the level and composition of current assets and current liabilities.

• Vertical and horizontal financial statement analysis will reveal trends and compositions that signify trouble. Using management skills, you can take corrective action.

What is Your Situation? Your Financial Statement Analysis will need to be set up according to your individual situation. For example, a new business will have projections only and will have no historical statements to analyze. A one-year-old business would have historical statements for the first year and projections for the second year. A business that is several years old may wish to analyze more than one year of their past financial statements and show their projections for future years. Most plans will follow one of the two following two formats:

1. New Businesses – Projected Analysis for year one You will prepare a ratio table, filling in column three only with projected ratios for your first year of business. You will not input any information in column four. You will also prepare Projected Vertical Income Statement and Balance Sheets for your first year. After you have completed these three spreadsheets, you will do a Financial Statement Analysis Summary, filling in the Projected and Industry Standard columns. This will complete your analysis.

When you update your plan at the end of year one, you can come back and fill in the Historical column for year one and the Projected column for year two. You can also prepare a Historical Vertical Income Statement and Balance Sheet for year one and a Projected Vertical Income Statement and Balance Sheet for year two.

2. Current Businesses – Historical Analysis of previous year and Projected Analysis

for the coming year You will prepare a Ratio Table, filling in column three with historical ratios for your previous business year. In column four you will input your projections for the coming year. You will prepare a Historical Vertical Income Statement and Balance Sheet for the past year and a Projected Vertical Income Statement and Balance Sheet for the coming year. When you have completed these spreadsheets, you will do a Financial Statement Analysis Summary, filling in Historical, Projected, and Industry Standard columns.

Note. For a more detailed discussion of Financial Statement Analysis see my basic recordkeeping and accounting small business book, Keeping the Books (7th edition, 2007, Kaplan Publishing, New York, NY).

119

CHAPTER

7

Part IV Supporting Documents

Now that you have completed the main body of your Business Plan, it is time to consider any additional records that pertain to your business and that should be included in your business plan. Supporting Documents are the records that back up the statements and decisions made in the three main parts of your Business Plan. This chapter covers most of the documents which you will want to include. They will be discussed in the following order:

Personal Résumés

Owner's Financial Statement

Credit Reports

Copies of Leases

Letters of Reference

Contracts

Legal Documents

Location Studies, Demographics, etc.

120 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 7, Supporting Documents

About Supporting Documents After completing the main body of your Business Plan, you are now ready to consider the Supporting Documents that should be included. These are the records that back up the statements and decisions made in the three main parts of your Business Plan. As you are compiling the first three sections, it is a good idea to keep a separate list of the Supporting Documents that you mention or that come to mind. Many of these documents will actually be needed as you write your plan so that you will have solid financial information to use in your projections. For instance, discussion of your business location might indicate a need for demographic studies, location maps, area studies, leases, etc. The information in the lease agreement will state the financial terms. Once you have the location, you will also know the square footage of your facility and you will be able to project other associated costs, such as utilities, improvements, etc. If you are considering applying for a loan to purchase equipment, your supporting documents might be existing equipment purchase agreements or lease contracts. If you are planning a major advertising campaign, include advertising rate sheets from your targeted advertiser. If you are doing business internationally, you may wish to include customs documents, trade agreements, or shipping agreements. If you are exporting a product or providing a service in a foreign country, it might be beneficial to include demographics on your target market, competition evaluations, and anything else that is pertinent to your business. By listing these items as you think of them and gathering them as you are working on your business plan, you will have a fairly complete set of all of your supporting documents by the time you finish writing your organizational, marketing and financial sections. You can sort them into a logical sequence, add them to your working copy, and be ready to add any new ones that become pertinent during the lifetime of your business. Note. All supporting documents would not be included in every copy of your business plan. Include only that information you think will be needed by the potential lender or investor. The rest should be kept with your copy of the plan and be easily accessible. The following pages will cover most of the documents you will normally need to include. The end of the chapter includes examples of some of the types of supporting documents.

Personal Résumés If you are a sole proprietor, include your own résumé. If your business is a partnership, there should be a résumé for each partner. If you are a corporation, include résumés for all officers of the corporation.

It is also a good idea to include résumés for your management and any other key personnel that will be involved in making decisions and affecting the profitability of the company, showing why they were chosen, what their skills are, and how the company will benefit from their management.

A résumé need not, and should not, be a lengthy document. Preferably, it should be contained on one page for easy reading. Include the following categories and information:

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 7, Supporting Documents

121

• Work History. Name of business with dates of employment. Begin with most recent. Include duties, responsibilities, and related accomplishments.

• Educational Background. Schools and dates attended, degrees earned, and fields of concentration.

• Professional Affiliations and Honors. List active affiliation with organizations that will add to credibility. Tell about any distinguishing individual or business award received.

• Special Skills. (For example: relates well to others, able to organize, not afraid to take risks, etc.)

If you find it difficult to write your own résumé, there are professionals who will do it for you for a nominal fee. A well-written résumé will be a useful tool and should always be kept up-to-date. Once written, it is a simple task to update your information, adding new items and eliminating those that will not benefit you in your current endeavors.

An example of a résumé is located on p. 123.

Owner’s Financial Statement This is a statement of the owner/owners’ personal assets and liabilities. Information can be compiled in the same manner as a Balance Sheet (See Chapter 6, Balance Sheet). It is also a statement of annual income and expenditures. If you are a new business owner, your personal financial statement will be included as a part of the Financial Documents section and may be a standard form supplied by the potential lender.

See the personal financial statement form on pp. 124-125.

Credit Reports Credit ratings are of two types, business and personal. If you are already in business, you may have a Dun & Bradstreet rating. You can also ask your suppliers or wholesalers to supply you with letters of credit. Personal credit ratings can be obtained upon request through credit bureaus, banks and companies with whom you have dealt on a basis other than cash.

Copies of Leases Include all lease agreements currently in force between your company and a leasing agency. Some examples are the lease agreement for your business premises, equipment, automobiles, etc. These agreements will provide solid backup for the financial information that you have projected regarding the lease of property and assets. It is important to note here that all lease agreements should be carefully entered into. In many instances they will contain clauses (especially in the case of site locations) that can eat heavily into a company’s profits.

Letters of Reference These are letters recommending you as being a reputable and reliable business person worthy of being considered a good risk. There are two types of letters of reference:

• Business references. Written by business associates, suppliers, and customers. • Personal references. Written by non-business associates who can assess your

business skills; not by friends or relatives.

122 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 7, Supporting Documents

Contracts Include all business contracts, both completed and currently in force. Some examples are:

• Current loan contracts • Papers on prior business loans • Purchase agreements on large equipment • Vehicle purchase contracts • Service contracts • Maintenance agreements • Miscellaneous contracts

Legal Documents Include all legal documents pertaining to your business. Examples are:

• Articles of Incorporation • Partnership Agreements • Limited Partnership Agreements • DBAs • Business Licenses • Copyrights, trademarks and patents • Trade agreements (See example page 126) • Licensing agreements • Insurance policies, agreements, etc. • Property and vehicle titles

Miscellaneous Documents These are all the documents (other than the above) that are referred to, but not included, in the Organizational and Marketing sections of your Business Plan. A good example of what we mean should be those records related to selecting your location in the Organizational or Marketing Plan. Your location might be finalized as the result of the development of a Location Plan. You can refer to this section in your Table of Contents. The potential lender or investor can then turn to this portion of your plan and examine that Location Plan which might include:

• Demographic Studies • Map of Selected Location • Area Studies (Crime Rate, Income, etc.)

To Help You. The next four pages contain samples of a résumé, a personal financial statement, and a trade offering. You will also find examples of several other types of supporting documents in Appendix I: Marine Art of California, Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc., Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc., and Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Cafe.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 7, Supporting Documents

123

Sample Résumé

John Smith 742 South Street

Jamestown, NY 10081 (207) 814-0221

[email protected]

W O R K E X P E R I E N C E

2002 - Present ABC CORPORATION Burke, New York Corporate President. Overall management responsibility for tool and die manufacture providing specialized parts to the aerospace industry. Specific management of Research and Development Department.

1996 - 2002 ABC COMPONENTS Jamestown, New York

Sole Proprietor and General Manager. Sole responsibility for research and development of specialty aircraft parts. Long-term goal of expanding to incorporate and provide specialty parts to aerospace industry.

1986 - 1996 JACKSON AIRCRAFT CO. Burke, New York

Quality Control Supervisor. Responsibility for the development and implementation of a quality control program for automated aircraft assembly facility. Implemented quality control program resulting in $4.3 million in increased profits to the company.

E D U C A T I O N

University of California, Berkeley - Master of Business Administration, Emphasis on Marketing, 1996. Stanford University, Palo Alto, CA – B.S. in Civil Engineering, 1986.

PROFESSIONAL AFFILIATIONS

American Society of Professional Engineers New York City Industrial League Burke Chamber of Commerce

SPECIAL RECOGNITION New York Businessman of the Year, 2006 New York Council on Small Business, 2003 - present Director, Burke Chamber of Commerce

SPECIAL SKILLS

Resourceful and well-organized; Relates well to employees; Self-motivated and not afraid to take risks.

124 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 7, Supporting Documents

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 7, Supporting Documents

125

126 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 7, Supporting Documents

Capital, Inc. presents

Genesis Multimedia, Inc.

248,000 Shares of Common Stock

Resale of Securities Under

Regulations

Trading Offer Capital, Inc. Capital, Inc. hereby introduces Genesis Multimedia, Inc. This company has been in operation since 2001 and currently has $7,000,000 in annual sales. The company is currently trading on the OTC Bulletin Board. Listed below is the Bid and Ask price of Genesis Multimedia, Inc., trading symbol (GMMI), CUSIP no. 274106-12-5:

BID ASK Current 34.25 35.5 Discount 5% 6%

Restricted Capital, Inc. has purchased these shares under an agreement that shares cannot come back into the United States before one year. As a consequence, the transfer agent will issue instructions that no shares being resold under this purchase can be transferred to any person in the United States before one year. Although, Genesis Multimedia, Inc. is a fully reporting company for over one year, these shares can come back into United States pursuant to an exemption from registration or a filing of a registration before 41 days. After 41 days, any sales of these securities can be sold to any U.S. person or to an account of any U.S. person who is outside the United States.

Investor's Qualifications The shares may be freely traded outside the United States and can be sold or transferred to any non- U.S. person within 41 days and to any U.S. person after 41 days.

127

CHAPTER

8

U. S. Tax Information: An Important Aid to Writing Your Business Plan

A basic understanding of the U.S. tax system is an absolute necessity if you are going to write a Business Plan for a company that will operate within or do business with the U.S. It has long been a premise of the majority of taxpayers that the system is unwieldy, complicated, unfair, and a plague to most Americans. If you will try to put those feelings aside temporarily, I will show you how a basic understanding of the tax system can be an invaluable aid to you during business planning. In this chapter, I have also included the following visual aids and lists that should help you with your business planning in relation to taxes:

Calendars of Federal Taxes

List of Free IRS Publications

Information Resources

If you are doing business internationally

Business planning follows the same format throughout the world. With the spread of global trade, all countries are seeking common ground upon which to do business together and a business plan serves as an important link leading to successful international venturing. If you are in the United States and you participate in foreign trade, you will need to understand the legalities pertaining to the countries with which you are doing business. By the same token, those businesses outside the United States will need to familiarize themselves with the American legal and tax systems. This chapter will deal only with cursory tax information pertaining to the United States. The reader of this book should in no way construe it as legal or accounting advice.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 8, U.S. Tax Information

128

Comparing the U.S. Tax System and Business Accounting Comparison of the U.S. Tax System and business accounting is like studying the chicken and the egg. They cannot be separated. Many new business owners attempt to set up an accounting system without examining and understanding the IRS's tax forms to be completed at the end of the year. This is a gross error for two reasons. The first is failure to account for financial information required by the IRS at tax time. More important, however, is the failure to utilize information and services that will help you to develop an effective accounting system, which will, in turn, enable you to analyze your business and implement changes to keep it on the track to profitability. The relationship between business planning and the tax system can be more easily perceived by studying a Schedule C for a sole proprietorship. Below is a discussion of the form, listing the information it utilizes and the benefits to be gained by understanding it.

Schedule C (Form 1040) This form is entitled Profit or (Loss) From Business or Profession (required tax reporting form for all sole proprietors).

a. Information required. Gross receipts or sales, beginning and ending inventories, labor,

materials, goods purchased, returns and allowances, deductions, and net profit or loss. The net profit is the figure upon which your income tax liability is based.

b. Benefits of understanding. In order to provide the year-end information required on a

Schedule C and to figure income tax liability, it will be necessary for you to set up a chart of accounts in your accounting system. An examination of the entries on a Schedule C will be of some help in determining the breakdown of those accounts. The secret to developing a strong set of financial documents is the initial establishment of the chart of accounts that is customized to your industry and specifically to your particular business. That chart of accounts — asset, equity, revenue, cost of goods, and expense accounts — will be constant throughout your entire set of business plan financial statements. Running account balances enable you to utilize your accounting software at any given moment to generate profit & loss statements and balance sheets for your business. These two financial statements, in turn, supply you with every piece of information that you will need to analyze your business and make decisions that will increase your profitability.

Note. Form 1065, U.S. Partnership Return of Income and Form 1120-A, or Form 1120, U.S. Corporation Income Tax Returns are used for those legal structures.

Federal Taxes for Which You May be Liable During the tax year, all businesses must comply with reporting regulations and periodic payments of federal taxes. Familiarize yourself with the federal taxes liabilities. Your legal structure will determine required reporting dates. They are not the same for sole proprietorships and partnerships as they are for S corporations and C corporations. Your cash flow statement must reflect these payments. If you fail to account for tax liabilities, you will find yourself with an unbalanced budget and it is possible that a serious cash deficiency could result.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 8, U.S. Tax Information 129

Calendars of Federal Taxes The tax calendars developed and provided in this chapter will help you to meet those requirements. The four calendars have been set up to give you a quick read on the dates that reports must be filed and taxes paid. Print out a copy of the tax calendar for your legal structure and tack it on your wall as a visual reminder. Be sure to look ahead as the due dates are firm and a penalty may be imposed for not reporting on time. Free IRS Publications What most of us don't know is that the United States government has spent a great deal of time and money to make free publications available for the preparation of income taxes. It is important that you set up a tax information file and also that you keep it current. Make a conscious decision to send for (or download) these publications. At least once a year, you should update your file with new publications and you should make it a priority to study the revisions that take place in U.S. tax laws. Forms and publications are available either in hard copy directly from the IRS or by going on the Internet and accessing them from their web site. If you choose to download them, they can be accessed and/or printed out in Acrobat Reader, a free software application available from Adobe at www.adobe.com Remember that your Business Plan is an ongoing process requiring the implementation of many changes. You may rest assured that many of those changes will be a direct result of new tax laws. To Help You Understand Taxes and Set up a File of IRS Publications

In order to help you with your tax planning (and related business planning), the remainder of this chapter will provide you with the following:

• Calendars of federal taxes for which a sole proprietor, partnership, S

corporation or corporation may be liable. You will find four calendars. Choose the one that is appropriate to your legal structure.

• A list of free publications available from the IRS which will be helpful

to business owners. You will also find telephone numbers and Internet addresses for easy access of forms and publications. These publications are updated every November and can be ordered shortly thereafter.

• An order form page telling you where and how to send for free forms

and publications. You can request them by mail, call a toll free number and ask for them by number, or download them via the Internet.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 8, U.S. Tax Information

130

Sole Proprietor

Calendar of Federal Taxes for Which You May Be Liable

January 15 Estimated tax Form 1040ES

31 Social security (FICA) tax and the withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

31 Providing information on social security

(FICA) tax and the withholding of income tax W-2 (to employee)

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax 940-EZ or 940

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

31 Information returns to non-employees and

transactions with other persons Form 1099 (to recipients)

February 28 Information returns to non-employees and

transactions with other persons Form 1099 (to IRS)

28 Providing information on social security

(FICA) tax and the withholding income tax W-2 & W-3 (to Social Security Admin.)

April 15 Income tax Schedule C (Form 1040)

15 Self-employment tax Schedule SE (Form 1040)

15 Estimated tax Form 1040ES

30 Social security (FICA) tax and the

withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

30 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

June 15 Estimated tax Form 1040ES

July 31 Social security (FICA) tax and the

withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

September 15 Estimated tax Form 1040ES

October 31 Social security (FICA) tax and the

withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 941, and 943

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

If your tax year is not January 1st through December 31st:

• Schedule C (Form 1040) is due the 15th day of the 4th month after end of the tax year. Schedule SE is due same day as Form 1040.

• Estimated tax (1040ES) is due the 15th day of 4th, 6th, and 9th months of tax year, and the 15th day of 1st month after the end of tax year.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 8, U.S. Tax Information 131

Partnership Calendar of Federal Taxes for Which You May Be Liable

January 15 Estimated tax (individual who is a partner) Form 1040ES

31 Social security (FICA) tax and the withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

31 Providing information on soc. security (FICA) tax and

the withholding of income tax W-2 (to employee)

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax 940-EZ or 940

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

31 Information returns to non-employees and

transactions with other persons Form 1099 (to recipients)

February 28 Information returns to non-employees and

transactions with other persons Form 1099 (to IRS)

28 Providing information on social security

(FICA) tax and on withholding income tax W-2 & W-3 (to Social Security Admin.)

April 15 Income tax (individual who is a partner) Schedule C (Form 1040)

15 Annual return of income Form 1065

15 Self-employment tax (individual who is partner) Schedule SE (Form 1040)

15 Estimated tax (individual who is partner) Form 1040ES

30 Social security (FICA) tax and the

withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

30 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

June 15 Estimated tax (individual who is a partner) Form 1040ES

July 31 Social security (FICA) tax and the

withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

September 15 Estimated tax (individual who is a partner) Form 1040ES

October 31 Social security (FICA) tax and the

withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 941, and 943

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

If your tax year is not January 1st through December 31st:

• Income tax is due the 15th day of the 4th month after end of tax year. • Self-employment tax is due the same day as income tax (Form 1040). • Estimated tax (1040ES) is due the 15th day of the 4th, 6th, and 9th month

of the tax year and the 15th day of 1st month after end of the tax year.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 8, U.S. Tax Information

132

S Corporation Calendar of Federal Taxes for Which You May Be Liable

January 15 Estimated tax (individual S corp. shareholder) Form 1040ES

31 Social security (FICA) tax and the withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

31 Providing information on social security

(FICA) tax and the withholding of income tax W-2 (to employee)

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax 940-EZ or 940

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

31 Information returns to non-employees and

transactions with other persons Form 1099 (to recipients)

February 28 Information returns to non-employees and

transactions with other persons Form 1099 (to IRS)

28 Providing information on social security

(FICA) tax and the withholding of income tax W-2 & W-3 (to Social Security Admin.)

March 15 Income tax 1120S

April 15 Income tax (individual S corp. shareholder) Form 1040

15 Estimated tax (individual S corp. shareholder) Form 1040ES

30 Social security (FICA) tax and the

withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

30 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

June 15 Estimated tax (individual S corp. shareholder) Form 1040ES

July 31 Social security (FICA) tax and the

withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

September 15 Estimated tax (individual S corp. shareholder) Form 1040ES

October 31 Social security (FICA) tax and the

withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 941, and 943

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

If your tax year is not January 1st through December 31st:

• S corporation income tax (1120S) and individual S corporation shareholder income tax (Form 1040) are due the 15th day of the 4th month after end of tax year.

• Estimated tax of individual shareholder (1040ES) is due 15th day of 4th, 6th, and 9th months of tax year and 15th day of 1st month after end of tax year.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 8, U.S. Tax Information 133

Corporation

Calendar of Federal Taxes for Which You May Be Liable

January 31 Social security (FICA) tax and the withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

31 Providing information on social security

(FICA) tax and the withholding of income tax W-2 (to employee)

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax 940-EZ or 940

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

31 Information returns to non-employees and

transactions with other persons Form 1099 (to recipients)

February 28 Information returns to non-employees and

transactions with other persons Form 1099 (to IRS)

28 Providing information on social security

(FICA) tax and the withholding of income tax W-2 & W-3 (to Social Security Admin.)

March 15 Income tax 1120 or 1120-A

April 15 Estimated tax 1120-W

30 Social security (FICA) tax and the

withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

30 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

June 15 Estimated tax 1120-W

July 31

Social security (FICA) tax and the withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 942, and 943

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

September 15 Estimated tax 1120-W

October 31 Social security (FICA) tax and the

withholding of income tax Note: See IRS rulings for deposit - Pub. 334

941, 941E, 941, and 943

31 Federal unemployment (FUTA) tax

(only if liability for unpaid taxes exceeds $100) 8109 (to make deposits)

December 15 Estimated tax 1120-W

If your tax year is not January 1st through December 31st:

• Income tax (Form 1120 or 1120-A) is due on the 15th day of the 3rd month after the end of the tax year.

• Estimated tax (1120-W) is due the 5th day of the 4th, 6th, 9th, and 12th months of the tax year.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 8, U.S. Tax Information

134

Free Tax Publications Available from the IRS The following is a list of IRS Publications that may prove helpful to you in the course of your business. Make it a point to keep a file of tax information. Send for these publications and update your file with new publications at least once a year. The United States government has spent a great deal of time and money to make this information available to you for preparation of income tax returns.

By Phone or Mail. You may call IRS toll free at 1-800-TAX-FORM (1-800-829-3676) between 8 a.m. and 5 p.m. weekdays and 9 a.m. to 3 p.m. on Saturdays. If you wish to order publications or forms by mail, you will find an order form for the publications on page three of this file. By Computer and Modem. If you subscribe to an on-line service, ask if IRS information is available and, if so, how to access it. The IRS offers the ability to download electronic print files of current tax forms, instructions, and taxpayer information publications (TIPs) in three different file formats. Internal Revenue Information Services (IRIS) is housed within FedWorld, known also as the Electronic Marketplace of U.S. Government information, a broadly accessible electronic bulletin board system. FedWorld offers direct dial-up access, as well as Internet connectivity, and provides "gateway" access to more than 140 different government bulletin boards.

IRIS at FedWorld can be reached by: 1. Modem (dial-up) The Internal Revenue Information Services

bulletin board at 703-321-8020 (not toll free)

2. Telnet − iris.irs.ustreas.gov

3. File Transfer Protocol (FTP) − connect to ftp.irs.ustreas.gov

4. World Wide Web – www.ustreas.gov Tax Guide for Small Business (For Individuals Who Use Schedule S or S-EZ) Sole proprietors should begin by reading Publication 334, Tax Guide for Small Business. It is a general guide to all areas of small business and will give you comprehensive information. Listing of Publications for Small Business If you are a business owner, the following IRS publications will provide you with fairly detailed information on specific tax-related topics. 1 Your Rights as a Taxpayer 15 Circular E., Employer's Tax Guide

15A Employers Supplemental Tax Guide

17 Your Federal Income Tax

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 8, U.S. Tax Information 135

463 Travel, Entertainment, Gift and Car Expenses

505 Tax Withholding and Estimated Tax

509 Tax Calendars for 2008

533 Self-Employment Tax

535 Business Expenses

536 Net Operating Losses

538 Accounting Periods & Methods

541 Partnerships

542 Corporations

S Corporations get instructions for 1120S

544 Sales and Other Dispositions of Assets

551 Basis of Assets

553 Highlights of Tax Changes

556 Examination of Returns, Appeal Rights, and Claims for Refund

560 Retirement Plans for the Small Business

583 Starting a Business and Keeping Records

587 Business Use of Your Home (including Use by Day-Care Providers)

594 The IRS Collection Process

908 Bankruptcy Tax Guide

910 Guide to Free Tax Services

911 Direct Sellers

925 Passive Activity & At Risk Rules

946 How to Depreciate Your Property

947 Practice Before the IRS and Power of Attorney

1066 Small Business Tax Workshop Workbook

1544 Reporting Cash Payments of Over $10,000 (Received in a Trade or Business)

1546 The Taxpayer Advocate Service of the IRS

1853 Small Business Talk

136 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 8: U.S. Tax Information

137

9 CHAPTER

Business Planning for a Nonprofit

You may want to start a business based on a societal problem you would like to address. This is called social entrepreneurship. A social entrepreneur recognizes a community problem and uses entrepreneurial skills and traits to start a business that will address the social problem and make a significant change. Your vehicle as a social entrepreneur will most likely be a non-profit organization.

Starting and running a nonprofit organization is much the same as operating a for-profit business. However, there are a few key differences between the two and they must be taken into account when you write your business plan.

What is Different in a Nonprofit Business Plan? The focus of this chapter is to give you a basic understanding about nonprofits and to highlight the differences that will need to be addressed in each of the major areas of your business plan.

Executive Summary Organizational Plan Marketing Plan Financial Plan Supporting Documents

138 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit

Understanding Nonprofits As mentioned above, nonprofit organizations are established with the objective of addressing a social problem. A major difference between nonprofit and for-profit corporations is that the former does not have stockholders. Instead, nonprofits have members who are granted certain rights including the power to vote for the board of directors. Having members however, is not a requirement. Nonprofits must apply and be recognized by the IRS. They may also be required to submit an incorporation form to the state in which they will operate. The state incorporation process gives the organization the rights bestowed to nonprofits under that state’s governing laws (also see “Obtaining Legal Nonprofit Status” – next page). Types of Nonprofit Organizations There are several different types of nonprofit organizations. Below is a listing of some of the common ones. The number refers to the section of the Internal Revenue Code under which the nonprofit may be organized.

Types of Nonprofit Organizations

Number Description

501(c)(1) Corporations Organized Under Act of Congress (including Federal Credit Unions)

501(c)(2) Title Holding Corporation For Exempt Organization

501(c)(3) Charitable Organizations - Charitable, religious, educational, scientific, literary, etc. organizations

501(c)(4) Civic leagues, community organizations, and other social welfare organizations

501(c)(5) Labor unions, farm bureaus, and other labor and agricultural organizations

501(c)(6) Trade associations, chambers of commerce, real estate boards, and other business leagues

501(c)(7) Hobby clubs, country clubs, and other organizations formed for social and recreational purposes

501(c)(8) Lodges and similar orders and associations

Benefits of Nonprofit Organizations Forming and operating a nonprofit organization has its benefits. First and foremost, you have an opportunity to make a change in the world. Through your nonprofit, you can accomplish great things that change people’s lives. If you have something you are passionate about, you can turn that passion into a business by forming a nonprofit organization. Below are additional benefits of nonprofits:

• Tax exemption (free from paying income taxes on related income) • Ability to attract donations that are tax deductible to the donor

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit 139

• Ability to receive grants • Use of volunteer staff, board members, etc. • Use of donated facilities and equipment • Not prohibited on making a profit (just restricted on how they make and

spend money) Qualifications to Become a Nonprofit To qualify to become a nonprofit, your organization can be any of the following:

• Coalition • Community organization • Corporation • Unincorporated association • Trust

Nonprofit organizations must serve a scientific, literary, educational, artistic or charitable purpose that benefits the public. A nonprofit does not have to be incorporated. However, to avoid any personal liability for the organization’s operations, it is best to incorporate. It is also necessary to be a corporation in order to establish a board and solicit donations. Obtaining Legal Nonprofit Status In order to receive the benefits listed above, an organization must formally apply to the Internal Revenue Service to be recognized as a nonprofit organization. This process is accomplished by completing and filing Form 1023 with the IRS. This is a 28 page form that requests much of the information you will be assembling for your business plan. The application process can take several months. It is recommended that you start the process as soon possible. Many states also require that a similar form be submitted.

Business Planning For Your Nonprofit Organization

As with any company, the business plan will serve as a roadmap. As your organization grows or as changes take place within it, the plan should be updated to keep you on course. Your business plan will also be used to acquire funding from donors and foundations. In some cases, it is beneficial to establish strategic alliances with other nonprofit organizations. Your business plan will help to layout your vision and the benefits of the potential partnership. Critical to the success of your organization will be the establishment of a board of directors. If you are starting a new organization, potential board members will want to see a detailed business plan so they know what they will be getting involved in.

140 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit

On the following pages we will look at each of the major sections of a business plan. Note that they are the same for both a for-profit and a nonprofit company. However, there are some things in each of these sections that will need to be specifically addressed if you are a nonprofit. As you are writing your plan, follow the instructions throughout the book, but be sure to incorporate the changes that are explained below.

Executive Summary In your executive summary, you will concisely and clearly demonstrate the need for the service(s) you will provide and explain the specific problem(s) you will address. It is important to note that, just as in a for-profit business plan, the executive summary will not be written until you have developed the body of your business plan. Your executive summary will contain all the elements described in Chapter 3. Differences will exist in the management and market opportunity sections.

Market Opportunity Focus on the problems that you have identified within the community and specify what you will do to address them. Management As a nonprofit, your management section will include a profile of the Executive Director, key staff members, and executive board members. In this description, give brief information about their educational background as well as experience.

Part I: Organizational Plan To develop this section, you will follow the guide in Chapter 4. The only difference will be the tone.

Summary of the Business As with a for-profit business, begin with a summary of the business. In addition to the information covered in Chapter 4, you will want to give an overview of how the organization came about and the purpose it will serve.

Mission Remember that nonprofits are mission driven. As such, the mission must be defined clearly. The mission statement for a nonprofit is generally longer than one for a for- profit business. There is no right or wrong way to state your mission. Just be sure that it includes the following elements: services offered, benefits of services, target audience, and the values of the organization.

Business Model Traditionally, the business model for nonprofits is based on the organization receiving donations or grant funds. Nonprofits also may have income generating opportunities. Describe your organization’s business model and explain why it is unique.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit 141

Strategy In the case of a nonprofit, this section will be broader. After discussing your goals and objectives, as explained in chapter 4, you will talk about your organization’s planned activities and current resources.

• Activities. After laying out your goals and objectives, you will want to outline your organization’s planned activities and programs. These are the action items that will be put into play for you to meet each of your desired goals and objectives and help advance the mission of your organization. While this is important for internal purposes, it is equally important that the public know exactly what it is you will do. This will help to get the public involved and to attract contributions.

• Current Resources. This section is primarily for start up organizations and should

be added after your discussion on activities. Your current resources will be an inventory of what you have to get you going. This includes start up money, people who you have on board to help you get started, your skills and expertise in your service area, and other intangibles. These things should be explained in a brief paragraph.

Strategic Relationships Nonprofits typically establish strategic alliances in order to facilitate their efforts. Discuss the organizations you plan to partner with. Explain how you will work with them and what the benefits of the partnership will be. You will also want to include public and private community leaders that have expressed support for your organization. SWOT Analysis As part of your strategic planning, you will develop a SWOT (strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, threats) analysis. For a nonprofit, the SWOT analysis is commonly called a Situational Assessment or an Environmental Analysis.

Program Services and Products For the most part, nonprofits focus on program services that are meant to benefit a specific segment of the population. Some nonprofits also sell products that support their stated cause and (in some cases) provide an additional revenue stream.

Program Services Provide a description of your program services and why they are unique. In addition, you will want to explain the problems that they address. You can use a table to illustrate this point. A sample is provided on the next page. If you choose, you can also draw a flowchart that shows the steps in your service fulfillment process.

142 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit

Canine Program Services

Description Benefit

1. Training and Providing Service Dogs

1. Assist independent adults with physical disabilities by enhancing the ability to perform daily tasks

2. Training and Providing Facility Dogs

2. Engage patients in activities to stimulate healing and recovery

3. Training and Providing Hearing Dogs

3. Benefit adults who are deaf or hard of hearing by alerting them to important everyday sounds

Products for Sale Nonprofits often sell products to support their cause. Logo T-shirts and/or hats might be an example. By wearing them, the consumer publicizes the program. Revenue from the sales provides another means of raising funds for the organization. If your organization sells products, tell what they are and how they will contribute to the success of your mission.

Administrative Plan Most of the sections in the administrative plan for a nonprofit are the same as those found in a for-profit business plan. However, the Management and Personnel section should be expanded to include a segment on the Board of Directors.

Management A nonprofit business plan will include profiles of the Executive Director and key staff members. Include a write up of how their background and experience will contribute toward the accomplishment of your nonprofit organization’s goals and objectives. Be brief in your description and include resumes for each of these individuals in your supporting documents. Board of Directors For the board of directors, include a discussion on the composition of the board, the role it will play for your nonprofit, and whether or not its members will be compensated. Give a brief profile of key board members (such as the executive board). Be sure to include resumes of all current board members in your supporting documents.

Part II: The Marketing Plan Most of the sections in a nonprofit marketing plan will be similar to one of a for-profit business. However, some sections will have significant differences. They are as follows:

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit 143

Market Analysis (Marketing Plan: Section II)

Identify Target Markets (Audience) The target market for a nonprofit is generally referred to as a target audience and can be divided into two categories – program recipients and funding sources. Include details of your research for each target audience in Supporting Documents.

• Program Recipients. Begin by identifying and describing the community you plan to serve. Follow that up by segmenting specific groups by demographics and psychographics to clearly define your target audience based on your organization’s goals. Create a profile of that audience and show how many people are out there that you will serve.

• Funding Sources. Identify the various types of funding sources that you plan to target. Create a profile for each one, describing the benefits it would derive from funding your nonprofit. Estimate the size of each type of funding source.

Research Your Competition In this section, you will focus on both nonprofit organizations and for-profit entities that pose competitive threats. If there are any gaps that exist in services, describe them and explain why you think they exist. More importantly, show how your organization will close the gaps. Assess Market Trends To begin with, you will want to conduct market research to determine if there is a need for the services you plan to offer. In the case of a nonprofit, this is called a Needs Assessment. In addition to showing the current conditions, your research should also determine the trends in the needs you want to address. To help you answer some questions, you can conduct a survey or focus group using a sampling of individuals that make up the target audience. You can also interview community leaders who can layout the needs of the community to you directly.

Contents of Your Marketing Strategy (Marketing Plan: Section III)

Public Relations A nonprofit organization generally places heavy emphasis on public relations (PR) activities. Your PR plan will be designed to generate as much visibility for your organization as possible, enabling it to gain added support from the community and to attract grant and donor funds.

Part III: Financial Documents Nonprofits are the same as for-profit companies in that they plan for and analyze their organizations through the use of cash flow and income projections and monthly and annual balance sheets and P&L (income) statements. These pro forma and historical statements are then utilized to perform periodic budget analyses. Based on the results, management and the board of directors can then make decisions and implement changes that will enable the organization to run more effectively.

144 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit

Develop a Chart of Accounts The key for a nonprofit is to establish a chart of accounts (asset, liability, net assets, revenue, and expense categories) that will reflect the operations of the organization. These same accounts are used throughout all of your projected and historical financial statements. The examples below should help you develop your accounts and understand how the financial statements for a nonprofit differ from those of a for-profit company. Statement of Financial Position (Balance Sheet) The statement of financial position (aka balance sheet) for a nonprofit organization (NPO) looks much the same as the for-profit balance sheet presented on pages 101-103. However, a nonprofit divides its assets into current assets followed by non-current types of assets, reflecting its liquidity. Net worth is referred to fund balance (or net assets) and is divided according to asset restrictions. It might have accounts similar to the following:

Statement of Financial Position ABC Nonprofit Corporation

Assets Liabilities

Current Assets Current Liabilities Cash Accounts Payable Accounts (Fees) Receivable Grants Payable Pledges Receivable Notes Payable Inventory Mortgage Payable Prepaid Expenses Interest Payable Short-term Investments Deferred Revenue Payroll Accrual

Long-Term Investments Non-current (Long-Term) Liabilities Fixed Assets Notes Payable

Land Mortgage Payable Buildings Equipment Total Liabilities Furniture Vehicles Fund Balance (Net Assets)

Grants Receivable Unrestricted Sponsorships Receivable Temporarily Restricted Public Funding Receivable Permanently Restricted Revenues in Excess of Expenses

Other Assets Total Net Assets

Total Assets Total Liabilities and Net Assets

Warning! Nonprofits that sell products will need the Inventory and Cost of Goods categories that are included in our example chart of accounts. The products you sell must be related to the purpose for which the nonprofit was formed. Sales of non-related products are taxable.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit 145

Statement of Activities (P&L or Income Statement) A profit and loss (income) statement for a nonprofit is alternately referred to as a statement of activities. It follows the same format as a for-profit P&L (page 105), but has categories that reflect its various sources of income and related expenditures. The income and expense in your business plan statement of activities will be divided into general categories, backed up by all of the detail in your organization’s books.

The accounts in a statement of activities for your nonprofit might be similar to the example below.

Statement of Activities Annual for Year 2009

INCOME 1. Revenues/Support

Corporate and Foundation Support Grants and Public Funds Individual Contributions Fees for Services

Total Revenues/Support $ 2. Cost of Good Sold $ 3. Gross Profit on Sales (1-2) $

EXPENSES

1. Variable (Program Related) $ Contract Services Conferences and Exhibits Marketing Printing and Publications Professional Fundraising Programs (specify or group) Salaries & Benefits (non administrative) Special Events and Meetings Travel Vehicle

2. Fixed (Administrative) $

Accounting & Legal Insurance Office Supplies Rent Salaries (Officers) (w-benefits) Salaries (Other) (w-benefits) Salaries (payroll expense) Telephone Utilities

Total Operating Expenses $

Revenues in Excess of Expenses (Net Income) $

Beginning Fund Balance (Net Assets) $ Ending Fund Balance (Net Assets) $

146 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit

As you can see on the example on the previous page, there are no categories for taxes because nonprofits do not report or pay taxes except in the case of earning income that is unrelated to the mission of the organization.

The statement of activities/profit and loss statement for a nonprofit commonly ends by adding the net income increase/decrease to the beginning fund balance (net assets) for the period to arrive at its ending fund balance (net assets).

12-Month Profit & Loss Statement (Statement of Activities) This is a historical statement of activities documenting the income, expenses and net income by month for a completed one-year period. Follow the instructions and format on pages 104-106 in Chapter 6 (Financial Documents) for this financial statement. Utilize the categories (as in the example above) developed for your nonprofit. The categories will be on the left and there will be fourteen columns to the right – twelve columns for the months, one 6-month total column, and one 12-month total column.

Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun 6-Month Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec 12-Month

Totals Totals

Note. Use same categories (accounts) as developed for Statement of Activities.

Three-Year Income Projection (Projected Statement of Activities) This is a pro forma (projected) statement of activities by the year for the next three years. Follow the instructions and format on pages 105 and 106 in Chapter 6 (Financial Documents) for developing this financial statement, but utilize the examples above to develop the categories and headings. Again, they will be the same categories that you used for both the annual and 12-month P&L (Statement of Activities). The categories will be on the left and there will be four columns to the right, one for each of the three projected years and one for totals for the three years.

Year 1 Year 2 Year 3 Total 3 years

INCOME

EXPENSES

REVENUES IN EXCESS OF EXPENSES (Net Income)

ENDING FUND BALANCE (Net Assets)

Note. Use same categories (accounts) as developed for Statement of Activities.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit 147

Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement One of the major forecasting tools used by all businesses is a Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement or Budget. It deals only with actual cash transactions and not with depreciation, amortization, or other non-cash expense items. The cash flow projection is used for internal planning and estimates how much money will flow through your nonprofit during a designated period of time, usually the coming fiscal year. Net income at the end of the year will depend on the proper balance between cash inflow and outflow. There is no magic formula for projecting revenues and expenses, especially for a start-up nonprofit. Estimates will be close at best and will be based on your organization’s concept, your research, and standards for your industry. For this reason, it is important to be conservative with your forecasts, taking care not to overstate revenues or understate expenses. After your nonprofit has been in business for a period of time, your projections will become more accurate because they will be based on a combination of your organization’s history and current economic and industry trends.

Steps for Planning Your Cash Flow As you learned in Chapter 6, Financial Documents, the preparation of your cash flow statement (budget) is most effectively done in three steps:

• Prepare individual income and expense forecasts.

• Use the forecasts to prepare cash to be paid out and sources of cash worksheets covering a one-year period.

• Transfer the worksheet information to the pro forma cash flow statement, breaking the annual information into monthly segments.

Note. The accounts that were identified during the development of your statement of financial position (balance sheet) and statement of activities (profit and loss) will be used on your worksheets and subsequently in your cash flow projection. This is the only financial statement that utilizes income statement (profit and loss) items and non-income statement (balance sheet) items on the same form. This is because it takes into account all cash transactions that cause money to flow into or out of your organization – revenues received, expenses paid, asset purchases, loans infused, loan repayments, and interest paid.

Example Cash Flow for a Nonprofit Follow the instructions on pages 84-93, Chapter 6, Financial Documents to develop your cash flow statement. Use your chart of accounts for income and expenses and do not list any accounts relating to taxes or owner draws. On the next page, you will see an example of a cash flow statement for a nonprofit.

148 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit

2009 Cash Flow Projection Jan Feb Mar etc.

Beginning Cash Balance Cash Receipts

A. Revenues/Support 1. Corporate and Foundation Support 2. Grants and Public Funds 3. Individual Contributions 4. Fees for Services

B. Interest Income C. Sale of Long-Term Assets

Total Cash Available

Cash Payments A. Cost of Goods to be Sold B. Activity Related (Variable)

1. Contract Services 2. Conferences and Exhibits 3. Marketing 4. Printing and Publications 5. Professional Fundraising 6. Programs (specify or group) 7. Salaries & Benefits (non admin) 8. Special Events and Meetings 9. Travel

10. Vehicle

C. Administrative (Fixed) 1. Accounting & Legal 2. Insurance 3. Office Supplies 4. Rent 5. Salaries, Officers (w-benefits) 6. Salaries, Others (w-benefits) 7. Salaries (payroll expense) 8. Telephone 9. Utilities

D. Interest Expense E. Long-Term Asset Payments F. Loan Payments

G. Mortgage Payments

Total Cash Paid Out

Cash Balance/Deficiency

Loans to be Received Ending Cash Balance

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit 149

Budget Analysis (also known as Budget Deviation Analysis or BDA)

A budget deviation analysis is the financial tool that is used to compare your projected cash flow statement with your business's actual performance.

A nonprofit’s cash flow projection (or budget) is used to estimate the receipt and disbursement of funds and to help guide the organization in its day-to-day operations. In order to maximize the utilization of your budget, it will be necessary to make comparisons between projected cash flow and actual performance for the same period (monthly, quarterly, and/or annually) and take a close look at any deviations that exist.

As with all businesses, when you determine that you are over or under budget in any area, it will be necessary to determine the reason for the deviation and to implement changes for the future that will enable you to get back on track.

How often does a Nonprofit Need to Perform a BDA? A non-profit should perform a budget deviation analysis on a monthly basis. This will enable the executive director and staff to take immediate steps to correct significant deviations. It is also generally shared with its board of directors to aid in their understanding and decision making in regard to financial matters. For a monthly analysis, the headings listed on page 95 would change to the following and would not include the year-to-date headings. Also, you will note that we have added a column for percentage of deviation (optional):

Budget Analysis (BDA) For the Month Ending: May 31, 2008

BUDGET ITEM Budget Actual Variation % Deviation Budget - Actual Variation/Budget x 100 Example: Advertising 5,500 6,472 (972) (17.67%) For business planning purposes, a quarterly budget analysis may provide the best overview because it tends to eliminate those deviations that average out over a longer period. For example, if you are anticipating a large contribution in February, but it does not materialize until March, your February analysis would indicate the deviation whereas your quarterly analysis would not.

Format and Chart of Accounts for a Quarterly Budget Analysis The instructions and example in Chapter 6, on pages 94 and 95 should guide you through the development of a quarterly budget analysis form for your nonprofit. The headings will be the same. The categories will be developed from the same chart of accounts (income statement and non-income statement items) that you used in your statement of activities (income statement) and statement of financial position (balance sheet).

150 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 9, Business Planning for a Nonprofit

Part IV: Supporting Documents The Supporting Documents will include detailed information referenced in various sections of your business plan. Most of the things you include in your supporting documents will be similar to a for-profit business. The following is a list of additional documents that might be included for a nonprofit organization.

• Bylaws for the organization

• Resumes of the board of directors

• Demographic profiles of the population sector you service with your programs

• Psychographic studies reinforcing the need for your program services

• Agreements with other nonprofit organizations

• Contracts with professional fundraisers

• Grant and/or funding applications

• Support letters from community and industry leaders

151

CHAPTER

10

Packaging Your Plan And Keeping It Up-to-Date

Part I: Business Planning Software. Because I often get questions regarding business plan software, I will dedicate some space in the first part of this chapter to addressing what you should look for before making a purchase. Quick fixes may be good when it comes to saving time, but they can be the kiss of death when it comes to something as serious as business planning. On the other hand, the right software package (such as our own Automate Your Business Plan) can save you many hours of time and frustration.

Part II: Packaging Your Business Plan. This is an important part of the planning process. Putting your plan together the right way will increase its readability and effectiveness for the business itself and for potential lenders and investors. In the first half of this chapter, we will give you some ideas on how to organize and present your business plan for maximum effectiveness.

Business Planning Software Packaging for Success

Part III: Keeping Your Business Plan Up-to-Date. Your business plan will serve you well if you revise it often and let it serve as your guide during the lifetime of your business. In order to update it, you as the owner or key decision maker of your company will have the final responsibility to analyze what is happening and implement the changes that will make your business more profitable. The second half of this chapter will address changes to be considered in the following areas.

Changes within the Company Changes in Customer Needs Changes in Technology

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 10, Packaging and Updating Your Plan

152

Part I: Business Plan Software There are several software programs on the market today. What the prospective business plan writer hopes for is a quick solution to a difficult problem -- a program with questions that can be answered by filling in the blanks after which the software will automatically generate a finished business plan.

Do not Use a Canned Program There are, in fact, some "fill in the blanks" software packages. However, it is not advisable for you to use this type of program. There are at least two good reasons:

• Your business plan serves as the guide for your particular business. Even though you may have the same type of business as someone else, you will have different areas of focus. You will want to fill your own special niche and do things that are unique to your business. These differences should be reflected in your plan. A canned business plan cannot possibly serve you well.

• If you are going to potential lenders or investors, you will find that they will readily recognize and reject business plans that contain the canned statements and generic financial plans that come from certain software applications. These “cookie cutter” business plans are an immediate indicator to that person that you have not put much time and effort into the planning process and that you may not know your business well enough to succeed at it. Since the repayment of your loan depends on your business skills, this may indicate that you will be a poor risk.

Effective Software Programs The right software package should allow for you to do your own research and write your own executive summary, business description, and organizational and marketing statements. This is the only way that you can create a plan that will make your business unique. Well thought out, individualized business plans will favorably impress your lender or investor by showing them that you have thoroughly researched your business and have the expertise to run it effectively. Thorough planning will also give you the confidence to better run your business. Integrated (linked) financial statements (or spreadsheets) can be a great help to you in the financial section of your business plan. They should be pre-formatted and pre-formulated and linked together. If so, you will save a great deal of time. You plug in the amounts to the allocated cells and the program should do all of your calculations. Also, any numbers should automatically flow to other related spreadsheets. Your time will be cut considerably, allowing you to make changes or create "what if" situations and see the results immediately. Even here, a note of caution is called for. Some of the most well known programs claim to have wonderful spreadsheet capabilities but on closer examination, they are full of flaws. Invalid numbers are generated by wizards via guessing games. Quick fix formulation causes unrealistic numbers to flow through your spreadsheets. Meaningless charts and graphs are generated. The upshot is an invalid financial plan that can spell disaster for your business. A strong financial plan is your best friend. To preserve that strength, it is your responsibility to see that you know what you are getting when you choose your software.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 10, Packaging and Updating Your Plan

153

Yes! There is Business Planning Software That Delivers What It Promises!

In order to further implement the writing of your business plan, we have developed a software program that will guide you neatly through the entire business planning process. Automate Your Business Plan for Windows, now in its 14th version, is for IBM and compatibles. The software has its

own full-powered word processor and an easy-to-use spreadsheet application and does not require any additional software. We provide you with instructions and examples and formatted templates for every task. When it comes to your financial plan, we cannot be beat. We have spent years developing and refining a process that will result in a completely customized, integrated (linked), and highly credible set of spreadsheets for your business. Automate Your Business Plan is Anatomy of a Business Plan translated into software. It follows the book step-by-step and will print out a finished business plan. The four business plans in Appendices I, II, III, and IV were developed with the software.

Part II: Packaging for Success When you have finished writing your business plan, there are a few additional considerations that will help in making a favorable impression with a potential lender or investor. Good packaging will also make your plan easier for you to use.

• Binding and Cover. For your working business plan, it is best to use a three ring binder. That way information can be easily added, updated or replaced. Your working plan should have a copy of all of your supporting documents. The plan that you take to a potential lender or investor, should be bound in a business type cover. You can purchase one from an office supply store or take it to your printer and have it done. Use blue, brown, or black covers. Bankers are usually conservative.

• Length. Be concise! Generally, you should have no more than 30 - 40 pages in the plan you take to a lender, including Supporting Documents. As you write each section, think of it as being a summary. Include as much information as you can in a brief statement. Potential lenders prefer not to search through volumes of material to get to needed information. You can always have an expanded version of your plan in your own binder, including a complete set of your supporting documents.

• Presentation. Make your plan look presentable. However, do not go to the unnecessary expense of paying for professional word processing services unless you cannot do it yourself. The lender or investor is not interested in seeing an expensive looking business plan. What he is looking for is what your business plan says in terms of business concepts and financial numbers.

• Table of Contents. Be sure to include a Table of Contents in your Business Plan. It will follow the Cover Sheet. Make it detailed enough so you or a lender or investor can locate any of the areas addressed in the plan. It must also list any Supporting Documents and their corresponding page numbers. It might help you to use the Table of Contents in this book as a guide to compiling your own.

• Number of Copies. Make copies for yourself and each lender or investor that you wish to approach.. Keep track of each copy. Don’t try to work with too many potential funding sources at one time. If you are refused, be sure to retrieve your business plan.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 10, Packaging and Updating Your Plan

154

Part III: Keeping Your Plan Up-to-Date Revising Your Business Plan Revision is an on-going process. Changes are constantly taking place in your business. If your Business Plan is going to be effective either to the business or to a potential lender or investor, it will be necessary for you to update it on a regular basis. Changes necessitating such revisions can be attributed to three primary sources:

• Changes within the Company Any number of changes may occur in your organization. You may choose to expand from a brick and mortar company into a more modern “clicks and bricks” venture. Conversely, with the current failure rate in dot.coms, your company may find that it has to fall back and move its focus to more traditional types of offerings — or you might find your company expanding from B to C business into the B to B arena. Changes from within the company may also necessitate changes in legal structure, the addition of new partners, or changes in management.

• Changes Originating with the Customer Your product or service may show surges or declines due to your customers’ changes in need or taste. This is evident in all the companies who fold because they continue to offer what they like instead of what the customer will buy or use. In the clothing industry, for example, retailers have to pay close attention to current styles, popular materials, and seasonal colors.

Marketing to a new and expanding customer base will also require careful consideration of both demographic and psychographic factors that may differ from those of current customers. Remember that your customers’ buying patterns are also integrally related to the current economy. If money is scarce, you will have to be more innovative in your marketing efforts. You may need to make a strong shift toward increased online marketing and selling to reach more buyers. If you sell your products and services internationally, you need to understand the cultures in order to satisfy the customers.

• Technological Changes You will have to change your business to stay current with a changing world. As technology changes within your industry, bringing new products and services on the market, you will have to keep up or you will be left behind.

The computer industry is a perfect example of fast changes in technology. Developers are challenged daily with the problems of keeping their products or losing their niche in the marketplace. The toy industry is another. Little girls and boys are no longer satisfied with storybook dolls and tinkertoys. They want electronic miracles that are programmed to walk and talk and fly and think and feel.

Technological advances, especially those in the area of communication, have also revolutionized the ways in which we do business. The Internet has enabled small business owners to research information, communicate instantly with venders and customers, process credit cards and transfer funds electronically, and to market and sell products and services to their customers via the Internet. Yesterday’s typewriters, telephones, and airmail letters have been replaced with computers, cell phones, and e-mail.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 10, Packaging and Updating Your Plan

155

Implementing Changes in Your Business Plan You, as the owner or manager of the company, must be aware of the changes in your industry, your market, and your community. First you must determine what revisions are needed in order for you to accomplish the goals you have set for your company. To make this determination, you will have to look at your current plan and decide what you have to do to modify it in order to reflect the changes discussed above. If you find that writing the company business plan is an overwhelming task for one person, utilize key employees to keep track of the business trends applicable to their expertise. For example, your buyer can analyze the buying patterns of your customers and report to you. Your research and development person might look at changes in technology and materials for your products. Your webmaster can make suggestions regarding your web site. Your marketing department can develop a plan that will take advantage of new ways that will help you to reach your potential customers. Each department can be responsible for information that pertains to its particular area and report on a periodic basis. You may also find that it is effective to hire an outside consultant to perform a periodic analysis of your current plan in relation to your company’s goals. Be aware, however, that the final judgment as to the implementation of changes will rest with you, the owner or CEO. You will have to analyze the information and decide on any changes to be effected. If your decision turns out to be wrong, don't dwell on it. Correct your error and cut your losses as soon as possible. With experience, your percentage of correct decisions will increase and your reward will be higher profits.

Anticipating Your Problems Try to see ahead and determine what possible problems may arise to plague you. For example, you may have to deal with costs that exceed your projections. At the same time, you may experience a sharp decline in sales. These two factors occurring simultaneously can portend disaster if you are not ready for them. Also, I might add, a good year can give you a false sense of security. Be cautious when things are too good. The increased profits may be temporary. Also, what sells today may not sell tomorrow. As an example, recreational equipment often sells in cycles that are related to current fads. Today’s $100 item will most likely be selling for $29 next year—or it may even be no longer a viable product. You might think about developing an alternate budget based on possible problems that are likely to be encountered. This may be the time when you will decide that emphasis on a service rather than on a product would be more profitable due to changes in the economy and decreased spending. For instance, the repair of what is already owned may far outpace the buying of replacement items. Alternately, as the buying of luxury services wanes, the company might plan instead to provide those services that are considered a necessity.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 10, Packaging and Updating Your Plan

156

Don’t Fall into the Trap! More often than not, a business owner will spend a lot of time and effort writing a business plan when the pressure is on to borrow funds or to get a business started. The intention is there to always keep that plan up-to-date. Before long, things get hectic and the business plan is put in a drawer, never again to be seen. When you are tempted to put yours aside, just repeat to yourself, "the business that operates by the seat of its pants will probably end up with torn pants". Do Remember to Revise Your Plan Often Awareness of changes within your industry and revision of your business plan reflecting those changes will benefit you greatly. Your business plan can be your best friend. If you nurture your relationship with it, you will have a running start on the path to success! When you are finished, your Business Plan should be professional. At the same time, it should be obvious to the lender or investor that it was done by the people who own and run the business. Your business plan will be the best indication the lender will have to judge your potential for success.

Be sure that your business plan is

representative of your best efforts! It is my hope that you have been able to use this book to help you develop a concise, logical and appropriate plan for your business. When your work is done and your business plan is complete, don't forget to:

Operate within your business plan. Anticipate changes. Revise your plan and keep it up-to-date.

Do these things and I will guarantee you that you are well on your way to improving your chances of success and growth as you continue with your business venture. Thank you for utilizing Anatomy of a Business Plan to guide you through the planning process.

Linda Pinson

The Next Two Chapters • Chapter 11, Financing Your Business will help you to understand debt and equity

financing and provide you with financing resources.

• Chapter 12, U.S. and International Research Resources is a comprehensive list of offline and online resources that you can use to obtain marketing and financial information for your business plan.

157

11

CHAPTER

Financing Your Business

When you are planning to start a new business (or expand your current operation), four very important questions arise relating to finance:

Will you need to borrow money?

If you need outside financing, how much do you need and when will you need it?

What are the sources of funding available to meet your needs?

How much will it cost?

In order to make an intelligent decision on a timely basis, you will need to address all four of these questions. If you fail to do so, the lack of sufficient and ready capital can quickly lead to business failure.

Will You Need to Borrow Money? The first step is to ask yourself some questions that will help you to make the right decision – questions that will help you to realistically understand your financial needs and keep you from making costly errors that may ultimately bankrupt a potentially viable business. To determine whether or not you will need outside financing, some of the questions you might ask yourself are:

1. Have I written a business plan that will enable me to make financial decisions based on achieving the desired goals for my business?

158 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 11, Financing Your Business

2. Am I willing to risk my own money on my venture? What are the risks? What are my own sources of available capital? If you are not willing to take a risk, don't expect someone else to.

3. Do I really need additional financing or do I just need to manage my present cash

flow more effectively? 4. What do I need the money for? If I borrow, can I realistically project increased

revenues? If so, when will those increased revenues justify the debt?

How Much Do You Need — When Do You Need It? If you have decided that you will need additional financing, you will then need to carefully assess your needs and determine not only the amount you need, but when you will need it. Many business owners overestimate or underestimate their capital requirements and/or do not time their financing to the best advantage. Either can lead to serious problems. The first thing you need is a realistic business plan and one that you intend to follow as closely as possible. The only way to look at every aspect of your business is through the planning process. It will force you to develop an organizational plan and a marketing plan and to quantify your concepts through the development of projected financial statements whose numbers can then be analyzed and used in the decision making process. Those projections give you an educated estimate of your financial needs and tell you when they will most likely occur. Your business plan will answer such questions as:

• What are my most critical needs?

• If I need the money for immediate operating capital, how much will I need to operate my business until it becomes self-sustaining?

• If I need the money to buy fixed assets for my business, has my research shown that I can reach the target market that will justify the purchase of those assets? If not now, when would be the optimum time to add those assets?

• If I need the money for marketing, what are the most effective ways to reach my target market? How much will it cost to advertise? Will the increased marketing be reflected in even higher increases in revenues? According to my industry trends, what are the best selling periods and when will I need financing in order to have the lead time to advertise for the best results?

What are the Sources Available to You? I get calls almost every day asking for direction to sources of start-up capital. Sources of financing available to prospective and expanding businesses fall into two broad categories, which we will discuss in this chapter:

• Debt financing (dollars borrowed)

• Equity financing (ownership dollars injected into the business)

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 11, Financing Your Business 159

Debt Financing Debt financing is generally obtained from one of two sources. It can come either from a non-professional source such as a friend, relative, customer or colleague or from a traditional lending institution such as a bank, commercial finance company or, on special occasions, directly from the U.S. Small Business Administration (SBA).

1. Friends or Relatives Borrowing from a friend or relative is generally the most readily available source, especially when the capital requirements are smaller. This is frequently the least costly in terms of dollars, but may become the most costly in terms of personal relations if your repayment schedule is not timely or your venture does not work out. This avenue should be approached with great caution!

2. Angel Programs

For smaller business owners, women and minorities, there has been a growing trend toward the development of "Angel" programs through business organizations and companies specializing in small business. Individuals and small companies that want to invest smaller amounts in promising businesses are linked with those companies and the two decide whether or not the loan will be made. This avenue is still relatively new, but holds even more promise for the future.

3. Traditional Lending Institutions Banks, savings and loans and commercial finance companies have long been the major sources of business financing, principally as short-term lenders offering demand loans, seasonal lines of credit and single-purpose loans for fixed assets.

You should be aware of the fact that almost all lending institutions are strict about collateral requirements and may reasonably require established businesses to provide one-third of the equity injection and start-ups up to 50% or more. Again, as a borrower, you will be required to have a business plan with adequate documentation demonstrating a projected operating cash flow that will enable you to repay (on time) the loan with interest.

4. SBA Guaranteed Loans

The SBA guaranteed loan program is a secondary source of financing. This option comes into play after private lending options have been denied. The SBA offers a variety of loan programs to eligible small businesses that cannot borrow on reasonable terms from conventional lenders in the amount needed without

Research Angel Investors Online Several organizations exist that serve as an intermediary between Angel investors and business owners. Business owners can submit their business plans, which will then be matched and submitted to prospective investors with funding interests in specific plans. For a list of intermediary networks and lists of Angel investors, use the following key words in a search on the Internet: "Angel Investors"

160 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 11, Financing Your Business

governmental help. Most of the SBA's business loans are made by private lenders and then guaranteed by the Agency. Though it may not necessarily be easier to be approved for an SBA guaranteed loan, the guaranty will allow you to obtain a loan with a longer maturity at better repayment terms and interest rates, thereby reducing your monthly payments and the initial loan burden.

a. 7(a) Guaranteed Loan Program. This is the SBA’s primary loan program. You can use a 7(a) loan to: expand or renovate facilities; purchase machinery, equipment, fixtures and leasehold improvements; finance receivables and augment working capital; refinance existing debt (with compelling reason); finance seasonal lines of credit; construct commercial buildings; and/or purchase land or buildings.

Loan amounts of $100,000 or less receive an SBA guaranty as high as 80%. All other loans receive a 75% SBA guaranty. Currently, the maximum amount for a loan guaranty is $1,500,000 (75% of $2 million). The average size loan is $175,000 with an eight-year maturity. The 7(a) loan program is available to businesses that operate for profit and qualify as small under SBA size standard criteria.

You submit a loan application to a lender for initial review. If the lender approves the loan subject to an SBA guaranty, a copy of the application and a credit analysis are forwarded by the lender to the nearest SBA office.

The SBA looks for good character, management expertise, financial resources to operate the business, a feasible business plan, adequate equity or investment in the business, sufficient collateral, and the ability to repay the loan on time from the projected operating cash flow.

After SBA approval, the lending institution closes the loan and disburses the funds; you make monthly loan payments directly to the lender. As with any loan, you are responsible for repaying the full amount of the loan.

Generally, liens will be taken on assets financed by SBA proceeds, and the personal guarantee of the principal owners and/or the CEO are required. The borrower must pledge sufficient assets, to the extent that they are reasonably available, to adequately secure the loan. However, in most cases, a loan will not be declined by SBA where insufficient collateral is the only unfavorable factor. The lender sets the rate of interest: loans under 7 years, maximum prime +2.25%; 7 years or more, maximum 2.75% over prime; under $50,000, rates may be slightly higher. The length of time for repayment depends on the use of proceeds and the ability of the business to repay: usually five to ten years for working capital and up to 25 years for fixed assets.

b. CAPLines. Eligibility and interest rate rules are the same as for 7(a) guaranteed

loans. It is for the financing of assets. The primary collateral will be the short- term assets financed by the loan. SBA will guarantee up to 75% of loans above $150,000 (85% on loans of $150,000 or less). There are five short-term working-capital loan programs for small businesses under CAPLines: (1) Seasonal Line, (2) Contract Line, (3) Builders Line (4) Standard Asset-Based Line, and (5) Small Asset-Based Line. The asset-based lines must revolve.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 11, Financing Your Business 161

c. International Trade Loan Program. Applicants must establish either that the loan proceeds will significantly expand existing export markets or develop new ones, or that the applicant is adversely affected by import competition. SBA can guarantee 75% of an amount up to $2,000,000 in combined working-capital and fixed-asset loans. The lender must take a first-lien position on items financed. Only collateral located in the United States and its territories and possessions is acceptable as collateral under this program. Additional collateral may be required including personal guaranties, subordinate liens or items that are not financed by the loan proceeds. The proceeds of the loan may not be used for debt repayment. Fees and interest rates are the same as for 7(a) loans.

d. Export Working Capital Program (EWCP). This program is for exporters seeking short-term working capital. The SBA will guarantee 90 percent of the principal and interest, up to $1,500,000. When an EWCP loan is combined with an International Trade Loan, the SBA’s exposure can go up to $1.75 million. The EWCP uses a one-page application form and streamlined documentation, and turnaround is usually within 10 days. You may also apply for a letter of prequalification from the SBA. Businesses must have operated for the past 12 months, not necessarily in exporting, prior to filing an application. Interest rates are not regulated by the SBA and the lender is not limited to the rates specified for regular 7(a) loans.

e. Defense Loan and Technical Assistance (DELTA) Program. The DELTA Program is available to help defense-dependent small business concerns adversely affected by defense cuts to diversify into the commercial market. The program provides both financial and technical assistance. A joint effort of the SBA and the Department of Defense, DELTA offers about $1 billion in gross lending authority. At least 25% of the business’ revenues from the immediate preceding year must have come from defense related contracts and the borrower must show that he will create or retain one job per $50,000 of SBA assistance. Loan amounts are up to $2,000,000. The SBA processes, guarantees and services DELTA loans through the regulations, forms, and operating criteria of the 7(a) Program and the 504 Certified Development Company Program. Technical assistance is provided through SBDCs, SCORE, other federal agencies, and other technical and management assistance providers.

Streamlined Applications and Approvals (SBA Loan Guaranty) There are several options available to lenders that help streamline delivery of the SBA’s loan guaranty.

• LowDoc Loan Program. LowDoc is one of the SBA’s most popular programs.

Once you have met your lender’s requirements for credit, LowDoc offers a simple, one page SBA application form and rapid turnaround for loans of $150,000 or less. SBA will guarantee up to 85% of the loan amount. The loans should be adequately secured. Business assets are usually pledged and personal guarantees of the principals are required. The applicant completes the front of a one-page SBA application; the lender completes the back. The

162 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 11, Financing Your Business

lender requires additional information. The same interest rate rules apply as in the 7(a) program.

To be eligible, business must have average annual sales for the past three years not exceeding $5 million and must have fewer than 100 employees. Business start-ups are also eligible for the LowDoc Loan Program.

• SBA Express. This program makes capital available to businesses seeking loans of up to $350,000 without requiring the lender to use the SBA process. Lenders use their existing documentation and procedures to make and service loans. The SBA guarantees up to 50 percent of an SBA Express loan. Your local SBA office can provide you with a list of SBA Express lenders.

• Certified and Preferred Lenders Program. The most active and expert SBA lenders qualify for the SBA’s Certified and Preferred Lenders Program. Participants are delegated partial or full authority to approve loans, which results in faster service. Certified lenders are those that have been heavily involved in regular SBA loan-guaranty processing and have met certain other criteria. Preferred lenders are chosen from among the SBA’s best lenders and enjoy full delegation of lending authority. A list of participants in the Certified and Preferred Lenders Program may be obtained from your local SBA office.

• 7(M) Micro Loan Program. The MicroLoan Program provides small loans up to $35,000. Under this program, the SBA makes funds available to nonprofit intermediaries; these, in turn, make the loans. The average loan size is $10,500. Completed applications usually are processed by an intermediary in less than one week. This is a pilot program available at a limited number of locations.

Micro loans may be used to finance machinery, equipment, fixtures and leasehold improvements. They may also be used to finance receivables and for working capital. They may not be used to pay existing debt. Depending on the earnings of your business, you may take up to six years to repay a microloan. Rates are pegged at no more than 4 percent over the prime rate. There is no guaranty fee. Each nonprofit lending organization will have its own collateral requirements, but must take as collateral any assets purchased with the microloan. Generally the personal guaranties of the business owners are also required.

• 504 Certified Development Company. CDCs are nonprofit corporations set up to contribute to the economic development of their communities or regions. They work with the SBA and private-sector lenders to provide financing to small businesses. The program is designed to enable small businesses to create and retain jobs; the CDC’s portfolio must create or retain one job for every $50,000 of debenture proceeds provided by the SBA. They provide small businesses with 10 or 20-year financing for the acquisition of land and buildings, machinery and equipment or for constructing, modernizing, renovating or converting existing facilities. To be eligible, the business must

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 11, Financing Your Business 163

operate for profit. Tangible net worth must not exceed $7 million and average net income must not exceed $2.5 million for the past two years.

The maximum loan amount is generally $1,500,000. The amount may go up to $2 million if the project meets public policy goals (i.e., business district revitalization, expansion of export, expansion of minority business). Collateral may include a mortgage on the land and the building being financed. Personal guarantees of principals are required. SBA will take business assets as collateral. Interest is set at second TD rate based on the current market rate for 5- and 10-year U.S. Treasury Bonds and is generally below market rate.

Equity Financing If your company has a high percentage of debt to equity (what you owe compared to what you own), you will find it difficult to get debt financing and you will probably need to seek equity investment for additional funds. What this simply means is that you will trade a certain percentage of your company for a specific amount of money to be injected into the company. Where does equity financing come from? As with debt capital, this type of capital can come from friends and relatives, from SBA licensed investment companies, or from professional investors known as a "venture capitalists."

1. Friends and Relatives. Again, be reminded that mixing your friends or relatives and your business may not be a good idea.

Interest Rates Applicable to SBA Guaranteed Loans

Interest rates are negotiated between the borrower and the lender but are subject to SBA maximums, which are pegged to the Prime Rate. Interest rates may be fixed or variable. Fixed rate loans of $50,000 or more must not exceed Prime Plus 2.25 percent if the maturity is less than 7 years, and Prime Plus 2.75 percent if the maturity is 7 years or more. Loans between $25,000 and $50.000: Maximum rates must not exceed Prime Plus 3.25 percent if the maturity is less than 7 years, and Prime Plus 3.75 percent if the maturity is 7 years or more. Loans of $25,000 or less: Maximum interest rate must not exceed Prime Plus 4.25 percent if the maturity is less than 7 years, and Prime Plus 4.75 percent, if the maturity is 7 years or more.

• For current Prime rates, visit http://www.bankrate.com • For more information on SBA programs, visit

http://www.sba.gov/financing

164 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 11, Financing Your Business

2. SBA licensed investment companies. The SBA also licenses Small Business

Investment Companies (SBICs). They make venture/risk investments by supplying equity capital and extending unsecured loans to small enterprises that meet their criteria. The SBIC Program provides an alternative to bank financing, filling the gap between the availability of venture capital and the needs of small businesses that are either starting or growing. They use their own funds plus funds obtained at favorable rates with SBA guaranties and/or by selling their preferred stock to the SBA. SBICs are for-profit firms whose incentive is to share in the success of a small business. The Program provides funding to all types of manufacturing and service industries.

3. Professional Investors/Venture Capitalists. The venture capitalist is a risk taker,

usually specializing in related industries and preferring three to five year old companies that have shown high growth potential and will offer higher-than- average profits to their shareholders. These investments are often arranged through venture capital firms that act as "matchmakers."

As risk takers, venture capitalists focus on and have a right to participate in the management of the business. If the company does not perform, they may become active in the decision making process. The most frequent question we get asked is, "What is the standard amount of equity you have to trade for financing?" The trade of equity for capital is based on supply and demand. In other words, the deal is made according to who has the best bargaining power. Venture capitalists also require the inclusion of an exit strategy in the company’s business plan. The exit strategy lays out the future goals for the company and minimizes risk to the investor by providing a way out if there is a strong indicator that the business will fail to reach its profitability goals.

Which Type of Financing Costs the Most? The cost of financing is usually related to the degree of risk involved. If the risk is high, so is the cost.

1. The least expensive money to use is your own. The cost to you is whatever you would have made on your money by investing it in other sources (savings, money market accounts, bonds, retirement plans, real estate, etc.).

Note. At this point, I should mention credit cards. Many new business owners borrow heavily on their credit cards only to find themselves up to their ears in debt. Under the right terms, credit cards can provide short-term solutions. However, if they are not used wisely, they can be one of the most expensive sources of cash and may well pave the road to bankruptcy.

Internet Info on SBICs For more information on Small Business Investment Companies visit the following web site: http://www.sbaonline.sba.gov/INV/overview.html

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 11, Financing Your Business 165

2. Friends and relatives. The next lowest in cost generally comes from friends and relatives who may charge you a lower interest rate. But don't forget that it may cost you in other ways.

3. Banks & other traditional lenders. The third on the cost ladder is probably the

traditional lender (banks, SBA, etc.) This lender will want to know what the capital will be used for and will require that it be used for those specific needs. If the risk is too high, most conventional lenders cannot approve your loan because it would be a poor financial decision for the bank's investors. One default out of ten will undermine their whole program.

4. Outside lenders and venture capitalists. Traditionally, the most expensive is the

outside lender who charges a high interest rate because of the risk involved and the venture capitalist who requires a percentage of your business.

Calculating the Cost Before you get a loan, take time to understand the terms under which the loan will be made. What is the interest rate? How long do you have to repay the loan? When will payments begin and how much will they be? What are you putting up as collateral? If you have venture capital injected into the business, what will be the overall price to you of the equity and control that you will forfeit? Any source of financing can and should be calculated as to cost before the financing is finalized. Again back to your business plan. Determine when the financing is needed, plug cash injection, repayment figures, and resulting income projections into your cash flow statement and check out the result. Will the financing make you more profitable and enable you to repay the lender or distribute profits to the venture capitalist? In Summary Securing financing for your company must be planned well in advance. The more immediate your need, the less likely you are to get the best terms. Don't ask your banker to give you a loan yesterday…and don’t expect venture capitalists to jump on the bandwagon because you suddenly need their money. Planning ahead for cash flow is one of the best means for determining if and when you will need a lender or investor. It will also help you to determine how much you need. When you plan for financing, remember that you will not only have to show that your industry has good potential for profit. You will also have to present a strong case for the ability to manage your company through the period of debt. Getting financing is serious business for both you and for the lender/investor. Take time to plan carefully for your financial needs and your company will prosper and grow accordingly.

166 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 11, Financing Your Business

167

CHAPTER

12

U.S. and International Resources for Business Plan Research

How Can You Find the Information You Need?

One of the most frequent questions asked by business plan writers is, “How do I find the information I need to make marketing and financial projections?”

In this chapter, you will be provided with both online and offline resources that assist you with your marketing and financial research efforts.

Resources in this chapter have been organized in the following sections:

Internet Research Links

Library Resources

Publications and Periodicals

Indexes to Periodicals and Magazine Articles

Books

U.S. Government Departments

U.S. Small Business Administration

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 12, U.S. and International Business Research Resources 168

Internet Resources

Consumer Information U.S. Demographic Information http://www.census.gov

European Demographics Statistics http://europa.eu.int/comm/eurostat/Public/datashop/print- catalogue/EN?catalogue=Eurostat

Foreign Government Data Sources http://www.lib.umich.edu/

Industry Standard Ratios (Risk Management Association) http://www.rmaorg.com

International demography and population studies http://demography.anu.edu.au/VirtualLibrary/ http://vlib.org/

Lifestyle, Environment, and Other Statistics--Japan http://www.jinjapan.org/stat/index.html

Values and Lifestyles (VALS) http://www.sric-bi.com/VALS/

Company Information

European Business Directory http://www.europages.com/

Industrial Classifications http://www.census.gov/

International Company Listing http://www.trade.gov/ U.S. Industry & Trade Outlook® http://www.ntis.gov/products/bestsellers/industry-trade.asp?loc=4-2-0

U.S. Small Business Administration http://www.sbaonline.sba.gov/

Yahoo Industry List of Businesses http://dir.yahoo.com/Business_and_Economy/Directories/Companies/

Competitive Analysis Accounting and Finance Resource http://www.brint.com/Business.htm#Accounting

Business Sites http://www.techweb.com

Competitive Intelligence http://www.cio.com/CIO/arch_0695_cicolumn.html

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 12, U.S. and International Business Research Resources 169

Fortune Magazine http://www.fortune.com

Hoover’s Online http://www.hoovers.com

International Competitive Analysis http://www.trade.gov/ http://www.brint.com/International.htm

U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission http://www.sec.gov

Wall Street Journal http://online.wsj.com/public/us

Country Information Asia http://www.asia-inc.com

CIA World Factbook http://www.cia.gov/cia/publications/factbook/index.html

City Sites http://officialcitysites.org/country.php3

Culture http://ecai.org

Demography and Population Studies http://demography.anu.edu.au/VirtualLibrary

Europe http://europa.eu.int/eurodicautom/Controller

Foreign Government Information http://dir.yahoo.com/Government/countries

Import and Export http://www.census.gov/foreign-trade/www/

Middle East http://arabia.com

STAT-USA http://www.stat-usa.gov

World Trade Search http://world-trade-search.com

Economic Environment Documents Center http://www.lib.umich.edu/

Economic indicators from the U.S. Census Bureau http://www.census.gov/econ/www/

Economic Growth Research http://econ.worldbank.org/programs/macroeconomics/

170 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 12, U.S. and International Business Research Resources

Entrepreneur Resources Center for Family Business http://web.cba.neu.edu/fambiz/

EntreWorld http://www.entreworld.org/

The Entrepreneurial Edge http://peerspectives.org

U.S. Small Business Administration http://www.sbaonline.sba.gov/

Yahoo Business Information http://dir.yahoo.com/Business_and_Economy/

Legal Environment Advertising Law http://www.arentfox.com/quickGuide/businessLines/advert/advertisingLaw/a dvertisinglaw.html

European Union Business Law http://europa.eu.int/eur-lex/en/index.html

International Law Dictionary & Directory http://august1.com/pubs/dict/index.shtml

International Legal Resources http://www.wcl.american.edu http://www.spfo.unibo.it/Welcome.html http://www.lawschool.cornell.edu http://www.law.indiana.edu http://willy.law.pace.edu

Intellectual Property Law http://www.patents.com

Law Library of Congress http://lcweb.loc.gov

Meta-Index for U.S. Legal Research http://gsulaw.gsu.edu/metaindex

North American Free Trade Agreement http://www.nafta-sec-alena.org/DefaultSite/index.html

Santa Barbara County Law Library http://www.countylawlibrary.org

United States Patent and Trademark Office http://www.uspto.gov

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 12, U.S. and International Business Research Resources 171

Legislative and Regulatory Environments Food and Drug Administration http://www.fda.gov

Federal Trade Commission http://www.ftc.gov

Federal Communications Commission http://www.fcc.gov

Thomas Legislative Information on the Internet http://thomas.loc.gov

Library Resources The resources listed below can be found in the business section of your local library. The librarian in the business section of your library can help you with locating the materials you need. For your convenience, the resources below have been arranged in alphabetical order.

American Business Disc (American Business Information). CD-ROM covering 10 million businesses. Can be searched by company name, SIC code, Yellow Page headings, address and geographically by ZIP code, city, and state.

American Manufacturers Directory (American Business Information). Lists American manufacturers with 25 or more employees.

Bacon's Newspaper/Magazine Directory (Bacon's Information). Lists media as source of publicity information.

City and County Data Book (U.S. Dept. of Commerce). This book (updated every three years) contains statistical information on population, education, employment, income, housing, and retail sales.

Directory of Directories (Gale Research Inc). Describes over 9,000 buyer's guides and directories.

Discovering Small Business (Gale Research Inc.). CD-ROM detailing 300 specific types of ventures with sample business plans, information on financial programs, licensing, and current journal articles.

Dun and Bradstreet Directories (Dun and Bradstreet). Lists companies alphabetically, geographically, and by product classification.

Encyclopedia of Associations (Gale Research Inc.). Lists trade and professional associations throughout the United States. Many publish newsletters and provide marketing information. These associations can help business owners keep up with the latest industry developments.

Encyclopedia of Associations: National Organizations of the U.S. (Gale Research Inc.). CD provides instant access to information on 23,000 national organizations in the U.S.

Encyclopedia of Business Information Sources (Gale Research Inc.). Lists handbooks, periodicals, directories, trade associations, and more for over 1200 specific industries and business subjects. Start here to search for information on your particular business.

172 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 12, U.S. and International Business Research Resources

Federal Yellow Book (Monitor Leadership Directories, Inc.). Lists the names, titles, office locations and telephone numbers of people in hundreds of offices in the Executive Office, Cabinet-level departments, and more than 70 Independent Federal Agencies, such as the EPA and FDA.

Incubators for Small Business (U.S. Small Business Administration). Lists over 170 state government offices and incubators that offer financial and technical aid to new small businesses.

Industry Norms & Key Business Ratios (Dun & Bradstreet). Provides balance sheet figures for companies in over 800 different lines of business as defined by SIC number.

Lifestyle Market Analyst (Standard Rate & Data Service). Breaks down population geographically and demographically. Includes extensive lifestyle information on the interests, hobbies, and activities popular in each geographic and demographic market.

National Trade and Professional Associations of the U.S. (Columbia Books, Inc.). Trade and Professional Associations are indexed by association, geographic region, subject, and budget.

Pratt's Guide to Venture Capital Sources (Stanley Pratt). New York, Securities Data Publishing, 1999.

Reference Book for World Traders (Alfred Croner). This three volume set lists banks, chambers of commerce, customs, marketing organizations, invoicing procedures, and more for 185 foreign markets. Also listed are sections on export planning, financing, shipping, laws, and tariffs are also included, with a directory of helpful government agencies.

RMA Annual Statement Studies (Risk Management Association). Industry norms and ratios are compiled from income statements and balance sheets. For each SIC code three sets of statistics are given with each set representing a specific size range of companies based upon sales.

Small Business Sourcebook (Gale Research Inc.). A good starting place for finding consultants, educational institutions, governmental agencies offering assistance, as well as specific information sources for over 140 types of businesses.

Sourcebook for Franchise Opportunities (Dow-Jones Irwin). Provides annual directory information for U.S. franchises, and data for investment requirements, royalty and advertising fees, services furnished by the franchiser, projected growth rates, and locations where franchises are licensed to operate.

Standard Industrial Classification Manual (U.S. Dept. of Commerce). This publication lists the SIC numbers issued to major areas of business: for example, the SIC number for piano tuning is #7699. This unique number is used in locating statistical data.

State Business Directories (American Business Information). Reference books, which include businesses by city, businesses by yellow page category, major employers, and manufacturers by city and product.

Standard and Poor’s Industry Review. Provides updated information on all industries including current trends, merges and acquisitions, and industry projections.

Statistical Abstract of the U.S. (U.S. Dept. of Commerce). Updated annually, provides demographic, economic, and social information.

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 12, U.S. and International Business Research Resources 173

Publications and Periodicals Business Week, McGraw-Hill, Inc., 1221 Avenue of the Americas, New York, NY 10020. Entrepreneur Magazine, 2392 Morse Avenue, Irvine, CA 92714. Fast Company, P.O. Box 52760, Boulder, CO 80328. Home Office Computing, P.O. Box 53538, Boulder, CO 80321. Inc., 38 Commercial Wharf, Boston, MA 02110. Nation's Business, 1615 H. Street N.W., Washington, DC 20062-2000. Small Business Forum: Journal of the Association of Small Business Development Centers, University of Wisconsin SBDC, 432 North Wake Street, Madison, WI 53706. Small Business Reporter, Bank of America, Department 3120, P.O. Box 37000, San Francisco, CA 94137. Small Business Success, Pacific Bell Directory, 101 Spear Street, Rm. 429, San Francisco, CA 94105 (800) 237-4769 in CA - or - (800) 848-8000.

Indexes to Periodicals and Magazine Articles Also found at the library, periodicals and magazine articles can be researched by subject. Use the index below to find and familiarize yourself with periodicals and articles, which contain information specific to your type of business. Business Periodicals Index (H.W. Wilson Company). An index to articles published in 300 business-oriented periodicals. Gale Directory of Publications (Gale Research). Lists periodicals and newsletters. Magazines for Libraries (R.R. Bowker Company). Directory of publications. New York Times Index (NY Times Company). A guide to articles published in the New York Times. Reader's Guide to Periodical Literature (H.W. Wilson Company). An index to articles published in 200 popular magazines. Ulrich's International Periodicals Directory (R.R. Bowker Company). Lists over 100,000 magazines, newsletters, newspapers, journals, and other periodicals in 554 subject areas.

Books Avdvani, Asheesh. Investors in Your Backyard: How to Raise Business Capital from the People You Know. Berkeley, CA: Nolo Press, 2006 Bangs, David. Non Profits Made Easy. Irvine, CA: Entrepreneur Media, Inc., 2006. Clifford, Denis and Ralph Warner. Form a Partnership. Berkeley, CA: Nolo Press, 2006. Coveney, Patrick. Business Angels: Securing Start-Up Finances. New York: John Wiley and Sons, 1998. Elias, Stephen R. Trademark: Legal Care for Your Business & Product Name. Berkeley, CA: Nolo Press 2005 Godin, Seth. Bootstrapper's Bible. Chicago: Dearborn, 1998.

174 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 12, U.S. and International Business Research Resources

Gompers, Paul and Lerner, Josh. The Venture Capital Cycle. 2006. Hupalo, Peter I. Thinking Like An Entrepreneur. W. St. Paul, MN: HCM Publishing, 1999. Levinson, Jay Conrad. Guerrilla Marketing With Technology. Addison Wesley. 1997. Metrick, Andres, Venture Capital and the Finance of Innovation. 2006. Norman, Jan. What No One Ever Tells You About Marketing Your Own Business. 2004. Norman, Jan. What No One Ever Tells You About Financing Your Own Business. 2005. Ogilvy, David. Ogilvy on Advertising. New York, NY: Random House. Pakroo, Peri H., Starting & Building a Nonprofit: A Practical Guide. Nolo Press, 2007. Pinson, Linda. Keeping the Books. Chicago: Kaplan Publishing, 2007. Pinson, Linda and Jerry Jinnett. Steps to Small Business Start-up. New York: Kaplan, 2006. Scott, David Meerman. The New Rules of Marketing and PR: How to Use News Releases, Blogs, Podcasting, Viral Marketing and Online Media to Reach Buyers Directly. 2007. Steingold, Fred. The Complete Guide to Buying a Business. Berkeley, CA: Nolo, 2005. Steingold, Fred. Negotiate the Best Lease for Your Business. Berkeley, CA: Nolo, 2005. Tiernan, Bernadette. E-Tailing. Chicago: Dearborn Trade, 1999. Tiernan, Bernadette. The Hybrid Company. Chicago: Dearborn Trade, 2001. Wheeler, Alina. Designing Brand Identity. 2006.

U.S. Government Departments Federal agencies are an excellent resource for researching your industry. In addition to the federal agencies provided below, it is recommended that you also gather information from governmental agencies on your state and local level. Please be aware that the phone numbers given for some agencies are for a central office. Upon calling, you can be directed to the department, which can meet your specific needs. To receive appropriate materials and a catalog, be sure to ask to be put on a mailing list.

Bureau of Consumer Protection Division of Special Statutes 6th and Pennsylvania Avenue NW Washington, DC 20580

Consumer Products Safety Commission Bureau of Compliance 5401 Westbard Avenue Bethesda, MD 20207

Department of Agriculture 14th Street and Independence Avenue SW Washington, DC 20250

Department of Commerce Office of Business Liaison 14th Street and Constitution Avenue NW Washington, DC 20230

Department of Commerce International Trade Administration 14th Street and Constitution Avenue NW Washington, DC 20230

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 12, U.S. and International Business Research Resources 175

Department of Education 400 Maryland Avenue SW Washington, DC 20202

Department of Energy Forrestal Building 1000 Independence Avenue SW Washington, DC 20585

Department of Health and Human Services 200 Independence Avenue SW Washington, DC 20201

Department of Housing and Urban Development 451 7th Street SW Washington, DC 20410

Department of Labor 200 Constitution Avenue NW Washington, DC 20210

Department of State 2201 C Street NW Washington, DC 20520

Department of Transportation 400 7th Street SW Washington, DC 20590

Department of the Treasury 15th Street and Pennsylvania Avenue NW Washington, DC 20220

Environmental Protection Agency 401 M Street SW Washington, DC 20460

Federal Communications Commission (FCC) 1919 M Street NW Washington, DC 20554

Federal Trade Commission Public Reference Branch Pennsylvania Avenue and 6th Street NW Washington, DC 20580

Food and Drug Administration FDA Center for Food Safety and Applied Nutrition 200 Charles Street, SW Washington, DC 20402

Internal Revenue Service 1 (800) 829-3676 for tax forms and information.

Library of Congress Copyright Office 101 Independence Ave. SE Washington, DC 20540 Public Information Office (202) 707-2100

176 Anatomy of a Business Plan, Chapter 12, U.S. and International Business Research Resources

Patent and Trademark Office U.S. Department of Commerce P.O. Box 9 Washington, DC 20231 Public Information Office (703) 557-4357

Superintendent of Documents – Mail Drop: SD U.S. Government Printing Office Washington, DC 20402

U.S. International Trade Commission 500 E Street SW Washington, DC 20436

U.S. Small Business Administration The Small Business Administration is a federal agency, but it is singled out because of its importance to small businesses in America. The SBA offers an extensive selection of information on most business management topics from how to start a business to exporting your products. The SBA has offices throughout the country. Consult the U.S. Government section in your telephone directory for the office nearest you. The SBA offers a number of programs and services, including training and educational programs, counseling services, financial programs and contact assistance. These organizations are available to you through the SBA:

Service Corp of Retired Executives (SCORE). A national organization sponsored by SBA of volunteer business executives who provide free counseling, workshops and seminars to prospective and existing small business people.

Small Business Development Centers (SBDCs). Sponsored by the SBA in partnership with state and local governments, the educational community and the private sector. They provide assistance, counseling and training to prospective and existing business people.

Small Business Institutes (SBIs). Organized through SBA on more than 500 college campuses around the nation. The institutes provide counseling by students and faculty to small business clients.

For more information about SBA business development programs and services:

1. Call the SBA Small Business Answer Desk at 1 (800) 827-5722.

2. SBA has a home page on the Internet's World Wide Web, which provides an interactive guide to SBA programs. (http://www.sba.gov)

3. The SBA address is as follows:

U.S. Small Business Administration 1441 L Street NW Washington, DC 20005

177

Appendix

I

Marine Art of California Business Plan

The business plan presented in Appendix I is an actual business plan developed by Mr. Robert Garcia for his business, Marine Art of California. Mr. Garcia has generously allowed it to be used in Anatomy of a Business Plan and AUTOMATE YOUR BUSINESS PLAN to serve as an illustration that will help you with the writing of your own plan. Mr. Garcia wrote this plan when he was in the process of organizing his business for startup and looking for investors in the form of limited partnerships. His business has changed direction and he has now been in a related business for a few years and updates his plan regularly to reflect what is actually happening in the operation of his venture. The plan was written prior to start-up of the original business. For that reason, it included projections only and the financial section ended with a break-even analysis. After one year in business, Mr. Garcia’s business plan would also include historical profit & loss statements, a current balance sheet, and financial statement analysis, all of which would be based on the actual transactions of his business.

Additions and Changes to the original plan In order to give you a complete example of an up-to-date business plan, including historical information as well as projections (especially in the financial area), I decided to create a what-if scenario for the business that would reflect the financial numbers for the first year of operation in order to show how projections can be measured against performance.

178 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Because it would be inappropriate to disclose the financial information of a current business, I created a financial scenario to show what might have happened in the year 2008. The historical financial statements and financial statement analysis documents on pages 26 through 32 of this plan are for educational purposes only and do not reflect the actual financial history or industry ratio standards of Marine Art of California. The remainder of the plan is presented as originally written. If it, too, had been updated, it would have included any changes in position and planning that occurred during that year of business (i.e., new partners, changes in marketing plans, etc.). This plan can help you As you proceed with the writing of your own plan, it may help you to look at Mr. Garcia’s business plan to see how he handled each of the corresponding sections. Some of the research material has been condensed and all of his supporting documents are not included. I have also chosen to omit his personal financial history for privacy reasons. Regarding the Marketing Plan In the opening page of Chapter 5, The Marketing Plan, it was stated that smaller start-ups may choose not to address all of the components of a full blown marketing strategy, but should still cover the basic marketing elements. As you examine the marketing plan section for Marine Art of California, you will see that Mr. Garcia has chosen that path. He does a great job assessing his target market, evaluating his competition, researching his market, and planning his advertising. This is an excellent example of the development of a basic marketing plan. You should especially note how meticulous he has been in the documentation of his resources.

Warning! The plan is to be examined for Mr. Garcia’s handling of content only. It has been used as an example in the book and software because I feel that it is a fine example of a basic business plan. There is no judgement inferred as to appropriateness or financial potential for lenders or investors. Do not use it as a source of research for your own company. Important. This plan is for illustrative purposes only! I have changed dates, names, contact numbers, and addresses .I have also added to, changed, and/or reorganized some of the information in order to keep the plan up- to-date. Do not try to contact Mr. Garcia or any of the other people mentioned in this business plan. It would not be appropriate.

I am very pleased that I have the opportunity to include this material in Anatomy of a Business Plan and Automate Your Business Plan and hope that it will be of benefit to you. I thank Bob Garcia for being so generous and for allowing me to share his interpretation of business planning with so many small business owners.

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 179

MARINE ART OF CALIFORNIA P.O. Box 10059-251 Newport Beach, CA 92658

BUSINESS PLAN Robert A. Garcia, President

P.O. Box 10059-251 Newport Beach, CA 92658

(714) 997-9100

Plan prepared * by

Robert A. Garcia (Private and Confidential)

Copy 1 of 2

* Financial history updated through December 31, 2008, by the developers of Automate Your Business Plan Historical financial statements in this plan show what could have happened in 2008. The 2008 year-end financial statements and financial statement analysis were prepared by Automate Your Business Plan developers and are intended to be used for educational purposes only. They were not meant to and do not reflect the actual financial history of Marine Art of California.

180 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

TABLE OF CONTENTS

EXECUTIVE SUMMARY……………………………………………………………... 1 I. ORGANIZATIONAL PLAN …………………………………………………...… 2-8

Summary Description of Business ............................................................…….... 2 Products and Services ............................................................................................. 3 Legal Structure .………........................................................................................... 3 Management ............................................................................................................ 4 Personnel ................................................................................................................. 5 Legal and Accounting .......................…….............................................................. 7 Insurance ................................................................................................................. 7 Security ................................................................................................................... 8 II. MARKETING PLAN ………………………………….………………………….. 9-17

Target Market …….................................................................................................. 9 Competition ............................................................................................................. 10 Market/Industry Trends .......................................................................................... 10 Market Research Resources .................................................................................... 11 Methods of Sales and Distribution ……………………………………………….. 12 Advertising ……………………………………………………………………….. 13 Pricing .................................................................................................................... 15 Location ......................................................................................................……… 15 Gallery Design .......…………...................................................….......................... 16 Timing of Market Entry ..........................................................…............................ 17 III. FINANCIAL DOCUMENTS……………………………………………….……... 18-32

Summary of Financial Needs ............................................................................... 19 Loan Fund Dispersal Statement ........................................................................... 19 Financial Projections for 2008 .…………………………………………………. 20-25 Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement .................................….…..................... 20-21 Quarterly Budget Analysis ............................................…........................ 22 Three-Year Income Projection (2008, 2009, 2010) ...........…...…............ 23 Projected Balance Sheet (for Dec. 31, 2008) ....................….................... 24 Break-Even Analysis ........................................................…..................... 25 Historical Financial Statements for 2008 ……………………………………….. 26-28 Profit and Loss (Income) Statement) ........…..…….........……………....... 26-27 Balance Sheet (Dec. 31, 2008) …......................………....…..................... 28 Financial Statement Analysis ........................................................….................... 29-32 Summary .............................................................................……................ 29 Ratio Table .....................................................………................................. 30 IV. SUPPORTING DOCUMENTS……………………………………………………. 31-36

Catalog Cost Analysis ..................................................................…..........…........ 32 Competition Comparison Analysis ..........................................................….......... 33 Proposal for Limited Partnership ............................................................…........... 34 Terms & Conditions for Participants ..................................................…............... 35 Letter of Reference ..............................……………………...........…................... 36

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 181

MARINE ART OF CALIFORNIA

Executive Summary

Marine Art of California is a Limited Partnership to be established in 2004. The direct mail order and showroom company will be located in Newport Beach, CA. The company is seeking working capital in the amount of $130,000 for the purpose of start-up operations and to cover estimated operating expenses for a six-month period.

Twenty limited partnerships (2.25% each) are being offered in return investments of $6,500 to be treated as loan funds to be repaid over a 15-year period at the rate of 11%. Limited partnerships will have a duration of four years, at which time the partners’ shares will be bought back at the rate of $3,250 for each 2.25% share. At the end of the 15-year loan period, it is projected that the Return on Investment (ROI) for each $6,500 share will amount to $34,084. The $130,000 in loan funds will enable the company to effectively market its products and services while maintaining proper cash flow. Funding is needed in time for the first catalog issue to be distributed in November 2004 and for a showroom to be operational in the same month for the Christmas buying season. There is a two to three week period between order placement and delivery date.

It is projected that the company will reach its break-even point in the latter part of the second year of operation. Repayment of the loan and interest can begin promptly within 30 days of receipt of funds and can be secured by the percentage of the business to be held as collateral.

1

182 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

I. ORGANIZATIONAL PLAN Marine Art of California

Summary Description of Business

Marine Art of California is a start-up company in Newport Beach, marketing the works of California artists through a direct mail-order catalog. The product line is a unique combination of art, gift items and jewelry, all tied together by a marine or nautical theme. This marketing concept is a first! There is no known retailer or catalog company exclusively featuring the works of California artists in either a retail store or by mail-order catalog. I'm targeting a specific genre of the art market that, in terms of marketability, is on the cutting edge. Having managed Sea Fantasies Art Gallery at Fashion Island Mall in Newport Beach, I was able to discuss my idea personally and collect more than 700 names and addresses of highly interested customers who are marine art lovers. Of these, 90% live in the surrounding communities and the rest are from across the U.S. and other nations. Currently, I have begun mailings, taking orders and making sales. I have a large number of artists and vendors throughout California with marketing agreements already in place. I have assets of about $10,000 of miscellaneous items. These include framed and unframed originals, lithographs, posters, bronzes, acrylic boats, jewelry, videos, cassettes, CDs, T-shirts, glass figurines, greeting cards, shells and coral. Sales will be processed by a four-step marketing plan. First is a direct mail-order catalog published bi- monthly (six times a year). This allows for complete marketing freedom targeting high-income households, interior designers and other businesses located in coastal areas. The second is to generate sales through a retail showroom where merchandise can be purchased on-site and large high-end pieces (exhibited on consignment) can be ordered by catalog and drop shipped from artist/vendor directly to the customer. Third, a comprehensive advertising campaign targeting the surrounding high- income communities shall be conducted (e.g., yellow pages, high-profile magazines, monthly guest artist shows, grand opening mailings and fliers with discount coupons). Fourth is to conduct an ongoing telemarketing program aimed at customers on our mail lists in our local area at minimal cost. Industry trends have stabilized with the bottoming of the current recession. My plan to counter this situation is to obtain exclusive marketing rights on unique designs and the widest selection in the market of quality items priced affordably under $100.00. My plan is to secure my ranking as the number two marine art dealer in Southern California, second only to the Wyland Galleries by the end of 2009 and by 2010, through steadily increasing catalog distribution to more than 150,000 copies per mailing, to rank as the #1 dealer in California in gross sales! From 2007 through 2009, projected catalog distribution will increase at a rate of at least 100,000 catalogs per year.

2

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 183

Products and Services The product line of MARINE ART OF CALIFORNIA consists of hand-signed limited editions of bronzes, acrylics, lithographs and posters with certificates. Included are exclusive designs (covered by signed contracts) of (1) originals and prints, (2) glass figurines, and (3) fine jewelry. Rounding out the line are ceramic figures, videos, cassettes, CDs, marine life books, nautical clocks, marine jewelry (14k gold, sterling silver, genuine gemstones) and many more gift items, as well as a specific line for children. The marketing areas covered are both Northern California and Southern California. The suppliers are artists and vendors from throughout California. They number over 260! I chose them because they best express, artistically, the growing interest in the marine environment. However, due to catalog space, only 30 to 50 artists/vendors can be represented. The retail showroom will be able to accommodate more. My framing source for art images is a wholesale operation in Fullerton that services many large accounts including Disney Studios. With an extremely large artist/vendor pool to draw from, I virtually eliminate any supply shortage that cannot be replaced quickly. Also, my shipping policy specifies a maximum of 3 weeks delivery time for custom-made pieces such as limited edition bronzes that need to be poured at foundries. Almost all of my suppliers have been in business for years and understand the yearly marketing trends.

Administrative Plan Legal Structure

The structure of the company will consist of one (1) General Partner and up to twenty (20) Limited Partners. The amount of funds needed from the Limited Partners is $130,000, which will equal 45% ownership of the business. Each Limited Partner's investment of $6,500 shall equal 2.25% of the business. The investment will be treated as a loan and will be paid back over 15 years at 11% interest. The loan repayment amount for each 2.25% share will be $79.03 per month. No Limited Partner shall have any right to be active in the conduct of the Partnership's business or have the power to bind the Partnership with any contract, agreement, promise, or undertaking. Provisions for Exit and Dissolution of the Company The duration of the Partnership* is 4 years. The General Partner will have the option of buying out the Limited Partners at the end of 4 years for $3,250 for each 2.25% interest. The buyout will not affect the outstanding loan, but the General Partner will provide collateral equal to the loan balance. The value of the business will be used as that collateral. The distribution of profits shall be made within 75 days of the end of the year. Each Limited Partner will receive 2.25% per share of investment on any profits over and above the following two months' operating expenses (January and February). This amount will be required to maintain operations and generate revenues necessary to keep the company solvent. In the event of a loss, each Limited Partner will assume a 2.25% liability for tax purposes and no profits will be paid. The General Partner will assume 55% of the loss for tax purposes. A Key Man Insurance Policy in the amount of $250,000 shall be taken out on the General Partner to be paid to the Limited Partners in the event of the General Partner's death. The policy will be divided among the Limited Partners according to their percentage of interest in the company. * See copy of Proposal for Limited Partnership in Supporting Documents for remainder of details.

3

184 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Management

At present, I, Robert A. Garcia, am sole proprietor. I possess a wealth of business environment experience as indicated on my resume. My first long-term job was in the grocery industry with Stater Brothers Markets. I worked from high school through college, rising to the position of second assistant manager. The most valuable experience I came away with was the ability to work cohesively with a variety of personalities in demanding customer situations. It was at this point that I learned the importance and value of the customer in American business. The customers' needs are placed first! They are the most important link in the chain. With the opportunity for better pay and regular weekday hours, I left Stater Bros. for employment with General Dynamics Pomona Division. For the next eleven years I was employed in Production Control and earned the title of Manufacturing Coordinator, supervising a small number of key individuals. I was responsible for all printed circuit board assemblies fabricated in off-site facilities located in Arizona and Arkansas. My duties included traveling between these facilities as needed. On a daily basis, I interfaced with supporting departments of Engineering, Quality Assurance, Procurement, Shipping and Receiving, Inspection, Stockroom and Inventory Control, Data Control Center, Electronic Fabrication, Machine Shop and Final Assembly areas. The programs involved were the Standard Missile (Surface to Air Weapon System), Phalanx Close I Weapons System, Stinger System and Sparrow Missile. My group was responsible for all analysis reports for upper management, Naval personnel, and corporate headquarters in St. Louis, Missouri. Duties included: solving material shortages, scheduling work to be released to maintain starts and completions, and driving all support departments to meet final assembly needs for contract delivery. Problem solving was the name of the game. The importance of follow-up was critical. Three key concepts that we used as business guidelines were: (1) production of a quality product; (2) at a competitive price; and (3) delivered on schedule. I'm currently in contact on a regular basis with eight advisors with backgrounds in marketing, advertising, corporate law, small business start-up, finance, direct mail-order business and catalog production. Two individuals are college professors with active businesses, one is a publisher of my business plan reference book, and two are retired executives with backgrounds in marketing and corporate law involved in the SCORE program through the Small Business Administration (SBA). I meet with these two executives every week.

Pertinent Courses and Seminars Completed

College Course Supervisory Training Mt. San Antonio College College Course Successful Business Writing Mt. San Antonio College Seminar Producing a Direct Mail Catalog Coastline Community College Seminar Business Taxes and Recordkeeping SCORE Workshop Seminar Business Plan Road Map SCORE Workshop

Note: See résumé in Supporting Documents. Manager Salary Plan: Upon the signing of Limited Partnership agreements, I will maintain the status as managing partner and decision maker. For the duration of the Partnership (planned for four years), as the manager, I will draw a monthly salary of $2,000, as per the agreement. In addition, I will retain 55% ownership of the company.

4

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 185

Personnel The total number of employees to be hired initially will be four. Interviews have been conducted for each position, and all are tentatively filled. I will be on the premises during all business hours for both retail and catalog ordering operations during the first month of business. It will be the owner's duty to hire the following employees:

1. Store Manager - part time - $11.00 per hour 2. 1st Asst. Manager - part time - $9.00 per hour 3. 2nd Asst. Manager - part time - $8.00 per hour 4. Sales Consultant - part time - $7.00 per hour 5. Administrative Asst. - part time - $10.00 per hour

TRAINING:

1. All employees will be cross trained in the following areas:

a. Knowledge of product line and familiarity with key suppliers b. Daily Sales Reconciliation Report (DSR) c. Catalog order processing d. Company policy regarding customer relations e. Charges – VISA / MasterCard

PERSONNEL DUTIES:

1. Manager - Reports directly to Owner a. Open store (key) - dust and vacuum b. Write work schedule c. Verify previous day's sales figures d. Follow up on any problems of previous day e. Head biweekly wall-to-wall inventory f. Reconcile any business discrepancies g. Responsible for store and catalog operations h. Order inventory and process catalog orders i. Have access to safe j. Conduct telemarketing in spare time k. Authorize employee purchase program (EPP)

2. Administrative Assistant - Reports to Manager

a. Open store (key) and have access to safe b. Write work schedule c. Perform office functions

(1) Daily Sales Reconciliation Report (DSR) (2) Accounts Receivable and Payable (A/R) (A/P) (3) Accounts Payable (A/P) (4) Payroll (P/R) (5) General Ledger (G/L) (6) Typing - 60 wpm (7) Computer - WP / Lotus / D-Base (8) 10-Key Adding Machine

d. Process catalog orders e. Authorize employee purchase program (EPP)

5

186 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Personnel – cont. 3. 1st Assistant Manager - Reports to Manager

a. Close store (Key) b. Order inventory c. Complete Daily Sales Reconciliation Report (DSR) d. Follow up on day's problems not yet solved e. Have access to safe f. Process catalog orders g. Conduct telemarketing in spare time

4. 2nd Assistant Manager - Reports to 1st Assistant Manager

a. Is familiar with all 1st Assistant Manager tasks b. Process catalog orders c. Assist in customer relations follow-up d. Dust and vacuum showroom e. Conduct telemarketing in spare time

5. Sales Consultant - Reports to 2nd Assistant Manager

a. Cover showroom floor b. Process catalog orders c. Assist in customer relations follow-up d. Dust and vacuum showroom e. Conduct telemarketing in spare time

EMPLOYEE PROFILE:

1. Personable, outgoing, reliable, in good health

2. College background

3. High integrity and dedication

4. Neat in appearance

5. Able to take on responsibilities

6. Able to follow directives

7. Demonstrates leadership qualities

8. Previous retail experience

9. Basic office skills

10. Sincere interest in marine art and environment

11. Likes water sports

12. Team worker

6

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 187

Legal and Accounting Legal: Lester Smith of Taylor, Smith, Varges & Whelen, a law corporation will be retained for all legal matters. The firm is located in Orange County, California and specializes in business and copyright law. Mr. Smith is one of the firm’s original partners. Accounting: All bookkeeping activities shall be done by the administrative assistant. John Horist, CPA has been hired to take care of financial reporting and tax accounting. John brings more than 40 years experience in his field. His hourly fee is very reasonable. Business Software: I would like to point out the key areas of recordkeeping required in the business and explain the software to be used and why. The areas are as follows:

Mail Lists - List & Mail Plus Software from Avery. It stores, sorts and prints up to 64,000 addresses with no programming required. It contains pre-defined label formats, or I can create my own. Searching and extracting subsets of the mailing list are possible. It also checks for duplicate entries.

Labels - MacLabel Pro Software from Avery. The features include preset layouts for

Avery laser labels and dot matrix labels, drawing tools and graphic sizing, built-in clip art and easy mail merge.

Accounting - Sybiz Windows Accounting Software. This program automatically updates

all accounts, customers, payroll, suppliers, inventory and ledgers in one step. Windows graphics, fonts and integration make it easy to use.

Business Planning - Automate Your Business Plan software will be used to analyze and

update the company’s strategy and financial plan. The simplicity and power of these reasonably-priced programs make them very attractive.

Insurance

Prospective Carrier: State Farm Insurance 2610 Avon, Suite C Newport Beach, CA 92660 (714) 645-6000 Agent: Kim Hiller Type of Insurance: Business/Personal: $ 150,000.00 Deductible: $ 1,000.00 Liability: $1,000,000.00

Premium: Annual Premium: $ 3,100.00 Monthly Premium: $ 258.00 Workers' Comp: 1.43 per/1K of Gross Payroll

7

188 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Security

PROBLEM SITUATIONS TO BE CONSIDERED AND PROTECTIVE MEASURES TO BE USED:

1. Internal Theft - Employee Dishonesty

a. Shoplifting of store merchandise - two closed-circuit monitoring cameras recording showroom activity each business day.

b. Cash theft - $400 limit of cash on hand. Timely safe drops and daily maintenance of Daily Sales Reconciliation Report will balance cash with receipts.

c. Falsifying receipts - DSR will detect discrepancies.

d. Employee Purchase Plan - will reduce inclination to steal. Employee discount is 35% off retail price. Can purchase layaway (20% down - balance over 60 days) or by payroll deduction (deducted from each check over four pay periods). Processed by authorized personnel other than oneself (two signatures required).

e. Employee Orientation Program - will stress security procedures and employee integrity.

f. Biweekly wall-to-wall inventory - will reveal any losses.

2. External Theft - Customer Shoplifting or Robbery

a. Walk-in theft - two closed-circuit monitoring cameras recording showroom

activity each business day.

b. Break-in theft or robbery - alarm system plus closed circuit monitoring cameras. All fine jewelry is displayed in locked cases. It is removed and stored in the safe each night.

c. Wall-to-wall biweekly inventory - will reveal any merchandise loss.

8

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 189

II. MARKETING PLAN Marine Art of California

Target Market

Who are my customers? 1. Profile: Economic level - middle to upper class.

Psychological makeup - art lover, jewelry lover, fashion conscious, ocean lover, eclectic taste, college educated, discriminating buyer, upwardly mobile life-style.

Age - 35 to 55.

Sex - Male/Female.

Income level - $75,000 and above.

Habits - high-expense entertainment, travel, marine-oriented hobbies (shell/dolphin collectors, scuba diver, boat/yacht owner, etc.), patrons of performing arts, concerts and museums.

Work - professional, business owners, business executives, middle management, interior designers.

Shop - middle to high-profile retail establishments.

2. Location: Orange County - coastal areas - home value of $500,000 and above.

San Francisco County, San Diego County, San Bernardino County

3. Market size: Mail list purchased through wholesale mail list companies. The consumer base will

range from 20,000 to 100,000 in the first year of operations.

4. Competition: Minimal due to unique 2-pronged marketing concept of marketing exclusively

California marine art, custom-designed jewelry and giftware by way of (1) direct mail- order catalog and (2) retail showroom. No known operation in either category.

5. Other factors: As acting distributor for several artists I am able to retain exclusive marketing rights

and, in most cases, have contracted to purchase at 10-15% below published wholesale price lists.

9

190 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Competition

The two areas of competition to consider will be (1) competitors to the retail showroom and (2) competitors to the direct mail-order operation.

(1) Competition to Retail Showroom

In the Supporting Documents, you will find a Competition Evaluation Worksheet with information on competitors who operate within a radius of 3 miles of proposed store site. Retail Stores to be evaluated have at least 1 of the 4 categories of my product line: *

A. Marine Art - Framed (custom) and framed B. Marine Sculpting - Cast in bronze and acrylic C. Marine and Nautical Gift Items D. Marine and Contemporary Jewelry Designs - Fine and fashion

(2) Competition to Direct Mail-Order Catalog

After investigating scores of catalog companies across the nation for the past year and speaking to artists and vendors across the state of California, we are aware of only one mail- order company with a similar theme but with a very different line and profile than Marine Art of California.

_______________________________________________ * Supporting documents are not attached to this sample Marketing Plan.

Market/Industry Trends

Information extracted from: ABI/INFORM DATABASE at UCI Library for Business Research.

Title: Sharper Image Revamps Product Line. Sells Items Consumers Can Actually Buy.

Journal: Marketing News Vol.: 26 Issue: 10, Pg.: 2 Summary: Although shoppers will still find upscale items at Sharper Image, the company has doubled the amount of goods that are more affordable. The addition of low-priced items is part of a continuing shift that will last, even if the economy improves. Title: What's Selling, and Why

Journal: Catalog Age Vol.: 9 Issue: 5, Pg.: 5 Summary: Market researcher Judith Langer believes today's mailers must create a value package that combines quality and price. Merchandise is reflecting consumer sentiment about the economy and the desire to buy U.S. goods and services. Title: Tripping the Gift Market Fantastic

Journal: Catalog Age Vol.: 9 Issue: 6, Pg.: 30 Summary: Christmas Fantastic and Celebration Fantastic catalogs feature gifts and decorative accessories and target upscale females age 25 and over. Response has been strong. Average orders of $95 for Christmas Fantastic and $85 for Celebration Fantastic have surpassed company expectations.

10

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 191

Market/Industry Trends – cont. Title: Spring Sales Blossom

Journal: Catalog Age Vol.: 9 Issue: 6, Pg.: 36 Summary: Spring sales appear to be much stronger than in 2003. Many mailers believe the latest upturn in sales will be long-lasting. Title: Your Catalog's List Is Its Greatest Asset

Journal: Target Marketing Vol.: 15 Issue: 2, Pg.: 44-45 Summary: There are a number of reasons why greater attention should be paid to the customer mail list rather than prospecting for new customers: 1. It is the primary source of profit for the company. 2. It is the cataloger's most valuable asset. 3. It will outperform a rented list by as much as 10 times in response rate and average order. Note: The above articles have been condensed for brevity.

Market Research Resources Art Business News (Monthly) Monthly trade magazine for art dealers and framers. Foremost business journal in the art industry. It

provides readers with a wide range of art industry news, features, sales and marketing trends, and new product information. Reports on trade shows nationally and internationally.

National Jeweler (Monthly) Dealer magazine. Provides jewelry industry news, features, sales and marketing trends, fashions, and

styles. Lists major manufacturers and wholesalers. Catalog Age (Monthly) Monthly journal featuring articles on mail-order companies. Provides inside information on statistics for

mail-order business. Highly informative. Target Marketing (Monthly) - Monthly trade journal. Orange County Business Journal (Weekly)

U.S. Small Business Administration Free Publications: Selling by Mail Order Tax & Regulatory Requirements in Orange County Partnership Agreements - Planning Checklist Understanding Cash Flow How to Write a Business Plan Insurance Checklist for Small Business Anatomy of a Business Plan - Pinson (Dearborn) Automate Your Business Plan 2007: Pinson (Out of Your Mind...and Into the Marketplace)

11

192 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Market Research Resources – cont. Direct Marketing Handbook - Edward L. Nash (McGraw-Hill) The Catalog Handbook - James Holland Direct Marketing Association - Membership organization for catalogers. Orange County Demographic Overview: Demographic reports, charts and maps provided by the market

research department of the Orange County Register. ABI/INFORM Data Base - University of California, Irvine (see Industry Trends section) On-line database located in the library. Contained in this database are abstracts and indexes to business

articles that are published in more than 800 different journals. ABI/INFORM is an excellent source of information on:

Companies Trends Marketing & Advertising Products Corporate Strategies Business Conditions Management Strategies

Methods of Sales and Distribution

Two-Way Distribution Program

A. Direct Mail-Order Catalog

1. Catalog mailings are distributed through target marketing.

2. Orders are processed via telephone (1-800 #) or by return mail-order forms, accepting checks, VISA/MC, or American Express.

3. Shipping in most cases is done by the artist or vendor directly to the customer per my instructions. All other shipping is done by Marine Art of California.

4. Shipping costs are indicated in the catalog for each item. The customer is charged for shipping costs to reimburse the vendor.

5. UPS shipping is available throughout the United States.

B. Retail Showroom 1. All items shown in the catalog will be available for purchase in the retail store.

2. High-ticket items will be carried on consignment with previous agreements already made with individual artists.

3. General Catalogs will be displayed on an order counter for all products not stocked in the store and that can be shipped on request.

4. All large items will be delivered anywhere in Orange County at no charge.

12

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 193

Methods of Sales and Distribution – cont.

Since I am dealing with more than 260 artists and vendors across the state there should be no problem with the availability of merchandise. I am only able to carry about 55 artists and vendors in the catalog. Most items can be ordered for the store and be in stock within a 2-3 day turnaround. For more detailed information on shipping arrangements, please see copy of Terms and Conditions for Participants in Supporting Documents section.

Advertising

Pacific Bell: Yellow/white pages - 1 line No charge Bold - $5.00 extra each Pac Bell/Sammy Sales order # N74717625 (8/21) 740-5211 Business line installation $70.45 Monthly rate $11.85

DEADLINE - August 19th - Cannot change without $18.00 per month rate increase Display - 1/4 column listing (per month) $49.00 (Yearly cost $588.00) Disconnect w/message (new #) 1 year No charge Donnelly: White pages - 1 line No charge 1-800-834-8425 Yellow pages - 2 lines No charge 3 or more $10.00 1/2 add (per month) $27.00 DEADLINE - August 21 (30 days to cancel) Change deadline - September 10 Deposit due September 11 $183.00 Monthly rate $91.50 (Yearly cost $1098.00) Metropolitan Circulation 40,000 Magazine: Monthly rate $129.00 757-1404 Kim Moore 4940 Campus Drive Newport Beach, CA 92660

California Riveria: 1/6 page (per month) $300.00 494-2659 Art charge - one time $50.00 Leslie 40% discount - new subscriber Box 536 Can hold rate for 6 months (Reg. $575.00) Laguna Beach, Color (per month) $600.00 CA 92652 Articles No charge

Print month end Circulation: 50,000 29K High Traffic 21K Direct Mail (92660 - 92625)

13

194 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Advertising – cont. Grand Opening: 4 x 6 Postcard - color $400.00 Catering $200.00 Artist show Discount coupons Fliers Newspaper ads OC Register - one time cost - $100)

Orange County News: Will get advertising estimates after 6 months in business.

(714) 565-3881

Orange County Register: Monthly rate $100.00

DONNELLY LISTINGS:

5 Categories:

1. Art Dealer, Galleries

2. Interior Designers and Decorators

3. Framers

4. Jewelers

5. Gift Shops

1. ART DEALERS, GALLERIES: Original Art, Lithos, Posters, Custom Framing, Bronze & Acrylic Sculptings Int. Designer Prices, Ask for Catalog

2. INTERIOR DECORATORS & DESIGNERS: Original Art, Lithos, Posters, Custom Framing, Bronze & Acrylic Sculptings Dealer Prices, Ask for Catalog

3. FRAMERS: Large Selection of California Marine Art, Coastal Scenes, Custom Framing

Matting, Ask for Mail-Order Catalog

4. JEWELERS: Specialty, Marine/Nautical Custom Designs by California Artists, 14K Gold,

Sterling, Gemstones, Ask for Catalog

5. GIFT SHOPS: Unique Line of Marine/Nautical Gifts, Glass Figurines, Acrylic Boats, Clocks, Art, Jewelry, Bronzes, Ask for Catalog

14

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 195

Pricing A. Purchasing

As stipulated in my Terms and Conditions, I request a 10 - 15% discount off published wholesale prices from artists and vendors in lieu of a participation fee. In about 95% of all agreements made, I am receiving this important discount!

B. Catalog Pricing

• Non-Jewelry Items - To recover publication costs, I have "keystoned" (100% markup) all items plus an additional 10-50%. Keystoning is typical in the retail industry. The added margin will cover any additional shipping charges that may not be covered by the indicated shipping fee paid by the customer.

• Jewelry Items - Typical pricing in the industry is "Key" plus 50% (150% markup) to triple "Key" (200% markup). My markup is "Key" plus 10-30% to stay competitive.

B. Store Pricing

All items "Keystone" plus 10 - 20% to allow a good margin for sales on selected items. C. Wholesale

Mailings and advertising will target Interior Decorators and Designers. To purchase wholesale, one must present a copy of an ASID or ISID license number and order a minimum purchase of $500.00 or more. The discount will be 20% off retail price.

Below is a sample of the computer data base with 16 fields of information on each item in inventory and how the retail price is computed. File: Price List - Record 1 of 449

Item: Fisherman's Wharf Image Pr: $5.00 Disc: 50% IM Make: Poster Type: Poster Adj. Whsl: $36.50 Vendor: Chrasta Frame: PT4XW Key+: 10% Exclusive: So. California Frame Price: $31.50 Retail Price: $79.50 Size: 21.5 26 Sq. Whsl. Price: $36.50 Group: 1 Vendor #: NAC102WM

Location

The prime business location targeted for Marine Art of California retail showroom is 1000 square feet at 106 Bayview Circle, Newport Beach, CA 92660. This site was chosen because of large front display windows, excellent visibility and access for the showroom, as well as adequate floor space to house inventory for catalog shipping. Both operations require certain square footage to operate successfully. Demographics and surrounding stores are extremely favorable.

Proposed site: Newport Beach, California Features: * Retail Shop space of 1000 sq. ft. * Located in the primary retail and business sector of Newport Beach, Orange County's most affluent and growing community * Excellent visibility and access * Median household income in 1 mile radius is $90,000.00

15

196 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Location – cont. Demographics 3 1 Mile 3 Miles 5 Miles Population: 1,043 111,983 308,906 Income: $90,000 $61,990 $59,600 Private Sector Employment (Daytime population) 1 Mile 3 Miles 5 miles 43,921 113,061 306,313 Socio-Economic Status Indicator (SESI) 1 Mile 3 Miles 5 Miles 73 79 79 Population by Age 1 Mile 3 Miles 5 Miles 25 - 29 9.2% 8.4% 30 - 34 9.4% 9.9% 35 - 44 16.1% 18.6% 45 - 54 12.3% 12.1% 25 - 54 TOTAL 47.0% 49.0% Leasing Agent: Chuck Sullivan, CB Commercial, 4040 MacArthur Blvd., Newport Beach, CA 92660 ________________________________ 3 Donnelly Marketing Information Service

Gallery Design

After managing Sea Fantasies Gallery at Fashion Island Mall in Newport Beach, I have decided to recreate its basic layout. My goal is to create the most stunning and unique showroom design in Orange County with a product line that appeals to the high-profile customer's taste. The design theme is to give the customer a feeling of being underwater when they enter. This would be accomplished by the use of glass display stands and live potted tropical plants to simulate lush, green underwater vegetation. Overhead curtains 18 inches wide would cleverly hide the track lighting while reflecting the light on the curtain sides, creating the illusion of an underwater scene with sunlight reflecting on the ocean surface. A large-screen TV would continuously play videos of colorful underwater scenes with mood music playing on the store's sound system. A loveseat for shoppers to relax in would face the screen. Along with creating a soothing and relaxing atmosphere, the videos, CDs, and cassettes would be available for sale. All fine art pieces (bronzes and framed art) would be accented with overhead track lighting, creating a strong visual effect. Large coral pieces would be used for display purposes, such as for jewelry. Others would be strewn around the showroom floor area for a natural ocean floor effect. Certain end displays would be constructed of glass with ocean floor scenes set inside consisting of an arrangement of coral, shells, and brightly painted wooden tropical fish on a two-inch bed of sand! All display stands would be available for sale. This design concept was generally considered to be the most outstanding original store plan in Fashion Island as expressed by Mall customers and the Management Office. By incorporating these tried and proven concepts with my own creative designs, this gallery will have the most outstanding and unique appearance of any gallery from Long Beach to San Clemente. The showroom area will be approximately 800 sq./ft. The rear and stock area is about 200 sq./ft.

16

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 197

Timing of Market Entry

Considering the fact that most of my product line could be viewed as gift items, the upcoming Holiday Season is of CRITICAL IMPORTANCE! This is typically the peak sales period in the retail industry. Catalogs from large retailers and mail-order houses are already appearing in the mail for the holidays. These are the dates to consider:

1. OCTOBER 8: Camera-ready artwork goes to film separator.

Turnaround time - 3 days! 2. OCTOBER 11: All slides and artwork must be ready to be delivered to the printer, Bertco Graphics, in Los Angeles.

Turnaround time - 11 working days!

3. OCTOBER 22: Printed catalogs must be delivered to Towne House Marketing in Santa Ana.

Turnaround time - 3 days! 4. OCTOBER 29: Catalogs shipped to Santa Ana Main Post Office.

Turnaround time - 2 working days! 5. NOVEMBER 1: CUSTOMER RECEIVES CATALOG - Ordering begins. 6. DECEMBER 4: Last ordering date to ensure Christmas delivery! Can send via Federal Express all stocked items and all stocked items at vendors.

Problem Items: a) High-end cast bronzes b) Hand-made glass figurines c) Original paintings

Turnaround time - 3 weeks!

17

198 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

III. FINANCIAL DOCUMENTS Marine Art of California

Sources and Uses of Loan Funds A. Statement of Financial Needs.............................….…....... 19 B. Dispersal of Loan Funds....................................…..…..…. 19

2008 Financial Projections A. Cash Flow Statement….………….…………………....…. 20-21

B. Quarterly Budget Analysis …………………….….……… 22 C. Three-Year Income Projection (2008, 2009, 2010)….…… 23 D. Projected Balance Sheet for December 31, 2007 ….…….. 24 E. Break-Even Analysis ………………………….…….……. 25

2008 Historical Statements A. 12-Month Profit & Loss (Income Statement) 2008 ……… 26-27 B. Balance Sheet as of December 31, 2008 …………………. 28

Financial Statement Analysis A. Company Financial Statement Analysis Summary …….…. 29 B. Ratio Table for Marine Art of California …………………. 30 C. 2008 Vertical Income Statement Analysis ………………… 31 D. December 31, 2008 Vertical Balance Sheet Analysis …….. 32

.

18

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 199

Summary of Financial Needs

I. Marine Art of California, a limited partnership, is seeking equity capital for start-up purposes.

A. Direct Mail-Order Catalog

B. Retail/Wholesale Showroom

II. Funds needed to accomplish above goal will be $130,000. See “Loan Fund Dispersal Statement” below for distribution of funds and backup statement.

Loan Fund Dispersal Statement

I. Dispersal of Loan Funds

Marine Art of California will utilize funds in the amount of $130,000 for startup of two retail functions: (1) a direct mail-order catalog and (2) a retail showroom to conduct related functions.

II. Backup Statement

Direct mail-order catalog: a) 24 pages b) 2 editions c) Quantities: 20K $20,000 30K 23,300 Startup expense of warehouse – One Time Cost: 25,175 3 Months Operating Expense: 58,364 3 Month Total Loan Repayment Cost @ $1,560: 3,161

TOTAL $130,000

19

200 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement Page 1 (Pre-Start-Up & January thru May)

Marine Art of California

For the Year 2008 Start-Up

Nov-Dec Jan Feb Mar Apr May BEGINNING CASH BALANCE 0 75,575 65,312 50,837 49,397 37,807

CASH RECEIPTS A. Sales/Revenues 41,620 22,065 16,040 42,350 30,300 67,744 B. Receivables (Credit Accts.) 0 0 0 0 0 0 C. Interest Income 0 0 0 0 0 0 D. Sale of Long-Term Assets 0 0 0 0 0 0 TOTAL CASH AVAILABLE 41,620 97,640 81,352 93,187 79,697 105,551 CASH PAYMENTS

A. Cost of goods to be sold Inventory Purchases 29,900 12,213 9,200 22,375 16,375 35,122 B. Variable Expenses 1. Advertising/Marketing 1,042 221 221 221 521 521 2. Car Delivery/Travel 200 100 100 100 100 100 3. Catalog Expense 27,600 9,600 10,800 10,800 14,600 14,600 4. Gross Wages 5,120 2,560 2,560 2,560 2,560 3,520 5. Payroll Expense 384 192 192 192 192 269 6. Shipping 800 400 400 400 400 400 7. Misc. Var. Exp. 3,000 500 500 500 500 500 Total Variable Expenses 38,146 13,573 14,773 14,773 18,873 19,910 1. Accounting & Legal 820 160 160 160 160 160 2. Insurance + Workers' Comp 904 302 302 302 302 320 3. Rent 3,900 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 4. Repairs & Maintenance 60 30 30 30 30 30 5. Guaranteed Payment (Mgr. Partner) 4,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 6. Supplies 600 300 300 300 300 300 7. Telephone 1,050 600 600 700 700 1,000 8. Utilities 630 290 290 290 290 290 9. Misc. (inc. Licenses/Permits) 175 0 0 0 0 0 Total Fixed Expenses 12,139 4,982 4,982 5,082 5,082 5,400 D. Interest Expense 1,192 1,192 1,192 1,192 1,192 1,192 E. Federal/State Income Tax 0 0 0 0 0 0 F. Capital Purchases (Office) 9,000 0 0 0 0 0 G. Capital Purchases (Showroom) 5,300 0 0 0 0 0 H. Loan payments 368 368 368 368 368 368 I. Equity Withdrawals 0 0 0 0 0 0 TOTAL CASH PAID OUT 96,045 32,328 30,515 43,790 41,890 61,992 CASH BALANCE/DEFICIENCY (54,425) 65,312 50,837 49,397 37,807 43,559 LOANS TO BE RECEIVED 130,000 0 0 0 0 0 EQUITY DEPOSITS 0 0 0 0 0 0

ENDING CASH BALANCE 75,575 65,312 50,837 49,397 37,807 43,559 1. $130,000 15-year loan. 20 limited partners @ $6,500 in exchange for 2.5% equity (each) in company (see proposal in Supporting Docs) 2. Cash business: Prepaid orders and paid on-site purchases only; no open accounts or receivables.

20

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 201

Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement Page 2 (May thru December 2008 + 6 and 12-month Totals)

Marine Art of California

6-MONTH 12-MONTH Jun TOTALS Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec TOTALS 43,559 75,575 37,462 48,996 46,287 47,992 37,772 80,527 75,575

47,696 226,195 83,508 58,672 67,950 47,700 154,200 105,700 743,925 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

91,255 301,770 120,970 107,668 114,237 95,692 191,972 186,227 819,500

25,123 120,408 43,054 30,661 35,275 25,150 78,375 54,125 387,048

521 2,226 521 521 521 521 521 521 5,352 100 600 100 100 100 100 100 100 1,200

16,400 76,800 16,400 18,200 18,200 20,000 20,000 20,000 189,600 3,520 17,280 3,520 3,520 3,520 3,520 3,520 3,520 38,400

269 1,306 269 269 269 269 269 269 2,920 400 2,400 400 400 400 400 400 400 4,800 500 3,000 500 500 500 500 500 500 6,000

21,710 103,612 21,710 23,510 23,510 25,310 25,310 25,310 248,272

160 960 160 160 160 160 160 160 1,920 320 1,848 320 320 320 320 320 320 3,768

1,300 7,800 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 15,600 30 180 30 30 30 30 30 30 360

2,000 12,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 24,000 300 1,800 300 300 300 300 300 300 3,600

1,000 4,600 1,250 1,250 1,500 1,500 1,800 1,800 13,700 290 1,740 290 290 290 290 290 290 3,480

0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 5,400 30,928 5,650 5,650 5,900 5,900 6,200 6,200 66,428 1,192 7,152 1,192 1,192 1,192 1,192 1,190 1,190 14,300

0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

368 2,208 368 368 368 368 370 370 4,420 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

53,793 264,308 71,974 61,381 66,245 57,920 111,445 87,195 720,468

37,462 37,462 48,996 46,287 47,992 37,772 80,527 99,032 99,032 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

37,462 37,462 48,996 46,287 47,992 37,772 80,527 99,032 99,032

21

202 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Quarterly Budget Analysis Marine Art of California

For the Quarter Ending: December 31, 2008

BUDGET ITEM THIS QUARTER YEAR-TO-DATE Budget Actual Var. Budget Actual Var.

SALES/REVENUES 307,600 300,196 (7,404) 743,925 730,379 (13,546) a. Catalog Sales 285,500 275,238 (10,262) 672,920 647,380 (25,540) b. Showroom Sales 15,300 16,382 1,082 46,325 53,805 7,480 c. Wholesale Sales 6,800 8,576 1,776 24,680 29,194 4,514 Less Cost of Goods 159,650 146,315 13,335 375,048 369,502 5,546 a. Purchases 167,650 154,172 13,478 387,048 380,914 6,134 Catalog Products 152,750 137,619 15,131 336,460 323,690 12,770 Showroom Products 10,650 11,191 (541) 35,163 38,903 (3,740) Wholesale Products 4,250 5,362 (1,112) 15,425 18,321 (2,896) b. Less Change in Ending Inventory 8,000 7,857 143 12,000 11,412 588 GROSS PROFITS 147,950 153,881 5,931 368,877 360,877 (8,000)

VARIABLE EXPENSES 1. Advertising/Marketing 1,563 4,641 (3,078) 5,352 16,431 (11,079) 2. Car Delivery/Travel 300 268 32 1,200 1,193 7 3. Catalog Expense 60,000 54,852 5,148 189,600 172,263 17,337 4. Gross Wages 10,560 10,560 0 38,400 38,400 0 5. Payroll Expense 807 807 0 2,920 2,920 0 6. Shipping 1,200 1,732 (532) 4,800 5,591 (791) 7. Miscellaneous Selling Expense 1,500 1,328 172 6,000 4,460 1,540 8. Depreciation (Showroom assets) 265 265 0 1,060 1,060 0

FIXED EXPENSES 1. Accounting & Legal 480 450 30 1,920 2,035 (115) 2. Insurance + Workers' Comp 960 960 0 3,768 3,768 0 3. Rent 3,900 3,900 0 15,600 15,600 0 4. Repairs & Maintenance 90 46 44 360 299 61 5. Guaranteed Pay't (Mgr. Partner) 6,000 6,000 0 24,000 24,000 0 6. Supplies 900 500 400 3,600 2,770 830 7. Telephone 5,100 5,134 (34) 13,700 13,024 676 8. Utilities 870 673 197 3,480 2,447 1,033 9. Miscellaneous Admin. Expense 0 197 (197) 0 372 (372) 10. Depreciation (Office equip) 450 450 0 1,800 1,800 0

NET INCOME FROM OPERATIONS 53,005 61,118 8,113 51,317 52,444 1,127 INTEREST INCOME 0 0 0 0 0 0 INTEREST EXPENSE 3,858 3,858 0 14,300 14,300 0

NET PROFIT (LOSS) BEFORE TAXES 49,147 57,260 8,113 37,017 38,144 1,127 TAXES (Partnership*) 0 0 0 0 0 0 (Partners taxed individually according to distributive shares of profit/loss PARTNERSHIP: NET PROFIT (LOSS) 49,147 57,260 8,113 37,017 38,144 1,127

NON-INCOME STATEMENT ITEMS

1. Long-term Asset Repayments 0 0 0 0 0 0 2. Loan Repayments 1,104 1,104 0 4,420 4,420 0 3. Equity Withdrawals 0 0 0 0 0 0 4. Inventory Assets 8,000 7,857 143 12,000 11,412 588

BUDGET DEVIATIONS This Quarter Year-To-Date 1. Income Statement Items: $ 8,113 $ 1,127 2. Non-Income Statement Items: $ 143 $ 588 3. Total Deviation $ 8,256 $ 1,715 Cash Position Year-To-Date: Projected = $99,032 Actual = $100,747

22

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 203

Three Year Income Projection Marine Art of California

Updated: September 26, 2007 Nov-Dec 2007 YEAR 1 YEAR 2 YEAR 3 TOTAL Pre-Start-Up 2008 2009 2010 3 YEARS

INCOME 1. SALES/REVENUES 41,620 743,930 2,651,856 4,515,406 7,952,812 Catalog Sales 33,820 672,925 2,570,200 4,421,500 7,698,445 Showroom Sales 4,600 46,325 53,274 61,266 165,465 Wholesale Sales 3,200 24,680 28,382 32,640 88,902 2. Cost of Goods Sold (c-d) 23,900 375,048 1,329,476 2,261,783 3,990,207 a. Beginning Inventory 6,000 6,000 18,000 25,000 6,000 b. Purchases 23,900 387,048 1,336,476 2,268,783 4,016,207 Catalog 19,600 336,460 1,285,100 2,210,750 3,851,910 Showroom (Walk-in) 2,300 35,163 33,637 37,633 108,733 Wholesale 2,000 15,425 17,739 20,400 55,564 c. C.O.G. Avail. Sale (a+b) 29,900 393,048 1,354,476 2,293,783 4,022,207 d. Less Ending Inventory (12/31) 6,000 18,000 25,000 32,000 32,000

3. GROSS PROFIT ON SALES (1-2) 17,720 368,882 1,322,380 2,253,623 3,962,605 EXPENSES 1. VARIABLE (Selling) (a thru h) 38,146 249,332 734,263 1,316,291 2,338,032 a. Advertising/Marketing 1,042 5,352 5,727 6,127 18,248 b. Car Delivery/Travel 200 1,200 1,284 1,374 4,058 c. Catalog Expense 27,600 189,600 670,400 1,248,000 2,135,600 d. Gross Wages 5,120 38,400 41,088 43,964 128,572 e. Payroll Expenses 384 2,920 3,124 3,343 9,771 f. Shipping 800 4,800 5,280 5,808 16,688 g. Miscellaneous Selling Expenses 3,000 6,000 6,300 6,615 21,915 h. Depreciation (Showroom Assets) 0 1,060 1,060 1,060 3,180

2. FIXED (Administrative) (a thru h) 12,139 68,228 71,609 75,268 227,244 a. Accounting & Legal 820 1,920 2,054 2,198 6,992 b. Insurance + Workers' Comp 904 3,768 4,032 4,314 13,018 c. Rent 3,900 15,600 16,692 17,860 54,052 d. Repairs & Maintenance 60 360 385 412 1,217 e. Guaranteed Pay't (Mgr. Partner) 4,000 24,000 24,000 24,000 76,000 f. Supplies 600 3,600 3,852 4,123 12,175 g. Telephone 1,050 13,700 15,070 16,577 46,397 h. Utilities 630 3,480 3,724 3,984 11,818 i. Miscellaneous Fixed Expense 175 0 0 0 175 j. Depreciation (Office Assets) 0 1,800 1,800 1,800 5,400

TOTAL OPERATING EXPENSES (1+2) 50,285 317,560 805,872 1,391,559 2,565,276 NET INCOME OPERATIONS (GPr - Exp) (32,565) 51,322 516,508 862,064 1,397,329 OTHER INCOME (Interest Income) 0 0 0 0 0 OTHER EXPENSE (Interest Expense) 1,192 14,300 13,814 13,274 42,580 NET PROFIT (LOSS) FOR PARTNERSHIP (33,757) 37,022 502,694 848,790 1,354,749 TAXES: (Partnership)* 0 0 0 0 0 * (partners taxed individually according to 0 0 0 0 0 distributive shares of profit or loss) 0 0 0 0 0

PARTNERSHIP: NET PROFIT (LOSS) (33,757) 37,022 502,694 848,790 1,354,749

23

204 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Projected Balance Sheet

Business Name: Date of Projection: September 30, 2007 Marine Art of California Date Projected for: December 31, 2008

ASSETS % of LIABILITIES % of

Assets Liabilities Current Assets Current Liabilities Cash $ 98,032 73.96% Accounts Payable $ 0 0.00% Petty Cash $ 1,000 0.75% Notes Payable $ 4,906 3.79% Sales Tax Holding Account $ 4,067 3.07% Interest Payable $ 0 0.00% Accounts Receivable $ 0 0.00% Inventory $ 18,000 13.58% Taxes Payable (Partnership) Short-Term Investments $ 0 0.00% Federal Income Tax $ 0 0.00%

Self-Employment Tax $ 0 0.00% $ 0 0.00% State Income Tax $ 0 0.00%

Sales Tax Accrual $ 4,067 3.15% Fixed Assets Property Tax $ 0 0.00% Land (valued at cost) $ 0 0.00%

Payroll Accrual $ 0 0.00% Buildings $ 0 0.00% 1. Cost 0 Long-Term Liabilities 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0 Notes Payable to Investors $ 120,306 93.06%

Notes Payable Others $ 0 0.00% Showroom Improvements $ 4,240 3.20% 1. Cost 5,300 2. Less Acc. Depr. 1,060 TOTAL LIABILITIES $ 129,279 100.00%

Office Improvements $ 4,160 3.14% 1. Cost 5,200 2. Less Acc. Depr. 1,040 % of

NET WORTH (EQUITY) N. Worth Office Equipment $ 3,040 2.29% 1. Cost 3,800 Proprietorship $ 0 0.00% 2. Less Acc. Depr. 760 or

Partnership Autos/Vehicles $ 0 0.00% 1. Bob Garcia, 55% Equity $ 1,793 55.00% 1. Cost 0 2. Ltd. Partners., 45% Equity $ 1,467 45.00% 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0 or

Corporation Capital Stock $ 0 0.00%

Other Assets Surplus Paid In $ 0 0.00% 1. $ 0 0.00% Retained Earnings $ 0 0.00% 2. $ 0 0.00%

TOTAL NET WORTH $ 3,260 100.00%

Assets - Liabilities = Net Worth TOTAL ASSETS $ 132,539 100.00% and

Liabilities + Equity = Total Assets 1. See Financial Statement Analysis for ratios and notations.

24

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 205

Break-Even Analysis Marine Art of California

Date of Analysis: September 29, 2007

40

E X 36 P E 32 N S 28 E T 24 O & T 20 A R Variable L E 16 Costs V E E 12 X N P U 8 E E N 4 S $ E $ 0 Fixed Costs S 0 4 8 12 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 DOLLARS SALES VOLUME

NOTE: Figures shown in hundreds of thousands of dollars (Ex: 4 = $ 400,000)

Marine Art of California Break-Even Point Calculation

B-E POINT (SALES) = Fixed costs + [(Variable Costs/Est. Revenues) X Sales] B-E Point (Sales) = $ 181,282.00 + [ ( $ 2,750,165.00 / $ 3,437,406.00 ) X Sales ]

B-E Point (Sales) = $ 181,282.00 + [ .8001 X Sales ]

S - .8001S = $181,282.00 S - .8001S = $181,282.00 .19992S = $181,282.00

S = $181,282.00/.1999 Break-Even Point S = $906,800 *rounded figure

FC (Fixed Costs) = (Administrative Expenses + Interest) $ 181,282 VC ( Variable Costs ) = (Cost of Goods + Selling Expenses) $ 2,750,165 R ( Est. Revenues ) = (Income from sale of products and services) $ 3,437,406

Break-Even Point = $ 906,727

25

206 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

The financial figures below in no way represent an actual Profit & Loss Statement for Mr. Garcia's business. This statement is for

illustrative purposes only and is an example of what "might have happened" during Marine Art of California's first year of business.

Profit & Loss (Income) Statement Marine Art of California

Page 1 (January thru June + 6-Month Totals)

For the Year: 2008 6-MONTH % of Total Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun TOTALS Revenues

INCOME AM0UNT PERCENT 1. Sales/Revenues 21,073 17,916 40,640 31,408 66,858 50,034 227,929 100.00% a. Catalog Sales (60%-40%) 16,700 13,700 34,786 24,600 61,540 42,846 194,172 85.19% b. Showroom Sales (Walk-in) 1,825 2,356 3,900 4,670 3,170 4,648 20,569 9.02% c. Wholesale Sales 2,548 1,860 1,954 2,138 2,148 2,540 13,188 5.79% 2. Cost of Goods Sold 10,622 9,960 22,799 16,417 35,137 25,580 120,515 52.87% a. Beginning Inventory 6,000 7,234 7,465 6,230 6,784 6,345 6,000 2.63% b. Purchases 11,856 10,191 21,564 16,971 34,698 26,335 121,615 53.36% (1) Catalog Goods (50%) 8,350 6,850 17,393 12,300 30,770 21,423 97,086 42.59% (2) Showroom (50%+$1Kp/m) 1,913 2,178 2,950 3,335 2,585 3,324 16,285 7.14% (3) Wholesales (x.625) 1,593 1,163 1,221 1,336 1,343 1,588 8,244 3.62% c. C.O.G. Available for Sale 17,856 17,425 29,029 23,201 41,482 32,680 127,615 55.99% d. Less Ending Inventory 7,234 7,465 6,230 6,784 6,345 7,100 7,100 3.12% 3. GROSS PROFIT 10,451 7,956 17,841 14,991 31,721 24,454 107,414 47.13%

EXPENSES

1. Variable (Selling) Expenses a. Advertising/Marketing 836 836 836 1,547 1,547 1,547 7,149 3.14% b. Car Delivery/Travel 94 126 78 83 112 97 590 0.26% c. Catalog Expense 9,600 10,770 10,770 11,960 11,960 11,960 67,020 29.40% d. Gross Wages 2,560 2,560 2,560 2,560 3,520 3,520 17,280 7.58% e. Payroll Expense 192 192 192 192 269 269 1,306 0.57% f. Shipping 385 432 391 406 389 391 2,394 1.05% g. Misc. Variable Expenses 538 147 268 621 382 211 2,167 0.95% h. Depreciation (Showroom) 88 88 89 88 88 89 530 0.23% Total Variable Expenses 14,293 15,151 15,184 17,457 18,267 18,084 98,436 43.19%

1. Fixed (Admin) Expenses a. Accounting & Legal 150 150 150 385 150 150 1,135 0.50% b. Insurance + Workers' Comp 302 302 302 302 320 320 1,848 0.81% c. Rent 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 7,800 3.42% d. Repairs & Maintenance 0 12 56 0 0 72 140 0.06% e. Guar. Payment (Mgr. Partner) 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 12,000 5.26% f. Supplies 287 246 301 223 259 172 1,488 0.65% g. Telephone 542 634 556 621 836 872 4,061 1.78% h. Utilities 287 263 246 164 168 172 1,300 0.57% i. Misc. Fixed Expenses 23 17 0 46 39 0 125 0.05% j. Depreciation (Office equip) 150 150 150 150 150 150 900 0.39% Total Fixed Expenses 5,041 5,074 5,061 5,191 5,222 5,208 30,797 13.51%

Total Operating Expense 19,334 20,225 20,245 22,648 23,489 23,292 129,233 56.70%

Net Income From Operations (8,883) (12,269) (2,404) (7,657) 8,232 1,162 (21,819) -9.57% Other Income (Interest) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0.00% Other Expense (Interest) 1,192 1,192 1,192 1,192 1,192 1,192 7,152 3.14% Net Profit (Loss) Before Taxes (10,075) (13,461) (3,596) (8,849) 7,040 (30) (28,971) -12.71% Taxes: Partnership* 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0.00% *(partners taxed individually on 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0.00% distributive shares of profits) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0.00%

PARTNERSHIP: NET PROFIT (LOSS) (10,075) (13,461) (3,596) (8,849) 7,040 (30) (28,971) -12.71%

26

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 207

The financial figures below in no way represent an actual Profit & Loss Statement for Mr. Garcia's business. This statement is for

illustrative purposes only and is an example of what "might have happened" during Marine Art of California's first year of business.

Profit & Loss (Income) Statement Marine Art of California

Page 2 (July thru December + 12-Month Totals)

For the Year: 2008 12-MONTH of Total Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec TOTALS Revenues

INCOME AM0UNT PERCENT 1. Sales/Revenues 81,092 57,014 64,148 67,684 127,390 105,122 730,379 100.00% a. Catalog Sales (60%-40%) 72,740 47,890 57,340 57,468 120,550 97,220 647,380 88.64% b. Showroom Sales (Walk-in) 5,490 6,734 4,630 6,340 4,280 5,762 53,805 7.37% c. Wholesale Sales 2,862 2,390 2,178 3,876 2,560 2,140 29,194 4.00% 2. Cost of Goods Sold 41,819 28,641 32,212 33,942 63,689 48,684 369,502 50.59% a. Beginning Inventory 7,100 7,256 8,421 9,555 10,940 12,267 6,000 0.82% b. Purchases 41,975 29,806 33,346 35,327 65,016 53,829 380,914 52.15% (1) Catalog Goods (50%) 36,370 23,945 28,670 28,734 60,275 48,610 323,690 44.32% (2) Showroom (50%+$1Kp/m) 3,745 4,367 3,315 4,170 3,140 3,881 38,903 5.33% (3) Wholesales (x.625) 1,860 1,494 1,361 2,423 1,601 1,338 18,321 2.51% c. C.O.G. Available for Sale 49,075 37,062 41,767 44,882 75,956 66,096 386,914 52.97% d. Less Ending Inventory 7,256 8,421 9,555 10,940 12,267 17,412 17,412 2.38% 3. GROSS PROFIT 39,273 28,373 31,936 33,742 63,701 56,438 360,877 49.41%

EXPENSES

1. Variable (Selling) Expenses a. Advertising/Marketing 1,547 1,547 1,547 1,547 1,547 1,547 16,431 2.25% b. Car Delivery/Travel 136 107 92 96 84 88 1,193 0.16% c. Catalog Expense 15,125 17,633 17,633 18,284 18,284 18,284 172,263 23.59% d. Gross Wages 3,520 3,520 3,520 3,520 3,520 3,520 38,400 5.26% e. Payroll Expense 269 269 269 269 269 269 2,920 0.40% f. Shipping 516 467 482 534 617 581 5,591 0.77% g. Misc. Variable Expenses 459 184 322 721 265 342 4,460 0.61% h. Depreciation (Showroom) 88 88 89 88 88 89 1,060 0.15% Total Variable Expenses 21,660 23,815 23,954 25,059 24,674 24,720 242,318 33.18%

1. Fixed (Admin) Expenses a. Accounting & Legal 150 150 150 150 150 150 2,035 0.28% b. Insurance + Workers' Comp 320 320 320 320 320 320 3,768 0.52% c. Rent 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 15,600 2.14% d. Repairs & Maintenance 0 0 113 46 0 0 299 0.04% e. Guar. Payment (Mgr. Partner) 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 24,000 3.29% f. Supplies 164 231 387 143 164 193 2,770 0.38% g. Telephone 1,164 1,287 1,378 1,422 1,943 1,769 13,024 1.78% h. Utilities 159 148 167 193 217 263 2,447 0.34% i. Misc. Fixed Expenses 41 9 0 22 0 175 372 0.05% j. Depreciation 150 150 150 150 150 150 1,800 0.25% Total Fixed Expenses 5,448 5,595 5,965 5,746 6,244 6,320 66,115 9.05%

Total Operating Expense 27,108 29,410 29,919 30,805 30,918 31,040 308,433 42.23%

Net Income From Operations 12,165 (1,037) 2,017 2,937 32,783 25,398 52,444 7.18% Other Income (Interest) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0.00% Other Expense (Interest) 1,192 1,192 1,192 1,192 1,190 1,190 14,300 1.96% Net Profit (Loss) Before Taxes 10,973 (2,229) 825 1,745 31,593 24,208 38,144 5.22% Taxes: Partnership* 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0.00% *(partners taxed individually on 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0.00% distributive shares of profits) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0.00%

PARTNERSHIP: NET PROFIT (LOSS) 10,973 (2,229) 825 1,745 31,593 24,208 38,144 5.22%

27

208 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Balance Sheet

Business Name:

Marine Art of California Date: December 31, 2008

ASSETS % of LIABILITIES % of Assets Liabilities

Current Assets Current Liabilities Cash $ 100,102 75.43% Accounts Payable $ 0 0.00% Petty Cash $ 645 0.49% Notes Payable $ 4,906 3.82% Sales Tax Holding Account $ 3,107 2.34% Interest Payable $ 0 0.00% Accounts Receivable $ 0 0.00% Inventory $ 17,412 13.12% Taxes Payable Short Term Investments $ 0 0.00% Federal Income Tax $ 0 0.00%

Self-Employment Tax $ 0 0.00% Long Term Investments $ 0 0.00% State Income Tax $ 0 0.00%

Sales Tax Accrual $ 3,107 2.42% Fixed Assets Property Tax $ 0 0.00% Land (valued at cost) $ 0 0.00%

Payroll Accrual $ 0 0.00% Buildings $ 0 0.00% 1. Cost 0 Long Term Liabilities 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0 Notes Payable to Investors $ 120,306 93.76%

Notes Payable Others $ 0 0.00% Showroom Improvements $ 4,240 3.20% 1. Cost 5,300 2. Less Acc. Depr. 1,060 TOTAL LIABILITIES $ 128,319 100.00%

Office Improvements $ 4,160 3.13% 1. Cost 5,200 2. Less Acc. Depr. 1,040 % of

NET WORTH (EQUITY) Net Worth Office Equipment $ 3,040 2.29% 1. Cost 3,800 Proprietorship $ 0 0.00% 2. Less Acc. Depr. 760 or

Partnership Autos/Vehicles $ 0 0.00% 1. Bob Garcia, 55% Equity $ 2,413 55.00% 1. Cost 0 2. Ltd. Prtnrs., 45% Equity $ 1,974 45.00% 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0 or

Corporation Capital Stock $ 0 0.00%

Other Assets Surplus Paid In $ 0 0.00% 1. $ 0 0.00% Retained Earnings $ 0 0.00% 2. $ 0 0.00%

TOTAL NET WORTH $ 4,387 100.00% Assets - Liabilities = Net Worth

TOTAL ASSETS $ 132,706 100.00% and Liabilities + Equity = Total Assets

28

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 209

Financial Statement Analysis Summary

The following is a summary of 2008 financial statement analysis information developed from the Ratio table on the next page.

*Writer must research industry for standards. 2008 2008 INDUSTRY* PROJECTED ACTUAL STANDARD

1. Net Working Capital $112,126 $113,253 $100,000 + 2. Current Ratio 13.5 15.1 2.0 + 3. Quick Ratio 11.5 13.0 1.0 + 4. Gross Profit Margin 49.60% 49.4% 45.0% 5. Operating Profit Margin 6.9% 7.2% 6.8% 6. Net Profit Margin 5.0% 5.2% 12.4% 7. Debt to Assets 97.5% 96.7% 33.0% 8. Debt to Equity 39.7:1 29.3:1 1.0:1 + 9. ROI (Return on Investment 28.0% 28.7% 11% +

10. Vertical Income Statement Analysis **

Sales/Revenues 100.0% 100.0% Cost of Goods 50.4% 50.6% 50.0% - Gross Profit 49.6% 49.4% 40.0% + Operating Expense 42.7% 42.2% 35.0% + Net Income Operations 6.9% 7.2% 15.0% + Interest Income 0/0% 0.0% N/A Interest Expense 1.9% 2.0% Variable Net Profit (Pre-Tax) 5.0% 5.2% 10.0% + ** All items stated as % of Total Revenues

11. Vertical Balance Sheet Analysis *** Current Assets 91.2% 91.4% 85.0% Inventory 13.6% 13.1% 28.0% Total Assets 3.7% 96.7% Current Liabilities 3.7% 3.7% 20.0% - Total Liabilities 97.5% 96.7% Net Worth 2.5% 3.3% 50.0% + Total Liabilities + Net Worth 100.0% 100.0% *** All Asset items stated as % of Total Assets; Liability & Net Worth items stated as % of Total Liabilities + Net Worth

Notes: Marine Art of California has an excessively high debt ratio (96.7%). However, the company has survived the first year of business, maintained its cash flow ($100,000+), and returned a higher amount than origin- ally promised to its investors. Sales for the first year were less than projected (-2%), but the net profit was still in excess of projections by 0.2%. Good management of the company by Mr. Garcia + a timely product with a solid niche would seem to be a good indicator that this company's profits will continue to increase rapidly and that the company will be more than able to fulfill its obligations to its limited partners/investors.

29

210 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Financial Statement Analysis Ratio Table Marine Art of California

For the Year: 2008 Type of Analysis Formula Projected: Year 1 Historical: Year 1

1. Liquidity Analysis Balance Sheet Current Assets 121,099 Current Assets 121,266 Current Assets Current Liabilities 8,973 Current Liabilities 8,013

a. Net Working Capital Current Liabilities Net Working Capital $112,126 Net Working Capital $113,253 Balance Sheet Current Assets 121,099 Current Assets 121,266

b. Current Ratio Current Assets Current Liabilities 8,973 Current Liabilities 8,013 Current Liabilities Current Ratio 13.50 Current Ratio 15.13 Balance Sheet Current Assets 121,099 Current Assets 121,266

c. Quick Ratio Current Assets minus Inventory Inventory 18,000 Inventory 17,412 Current Liabilities Current Liabilities 8,973 Current Liabilities 8,013 Quick Ratio 11.49 Quick Ratio 12.96

2. Profitability Analysis Income Statement Gross Profits 368,882 Gross Profits 360,877

a. Gross Profit Margin _Gross Profits_ Sales 743,930 Sales 730,379 Sales Gross Profit Margin 49.59% Gross Profit Margin 49.41%

b. Operating _Income From Operations_ Income From Ops. 51,322 Income From Ops. 52,444 D. Profit Margin Sales Sales 743,930 Sales 730,379

Op. Profit Margin 6.90% Op. Profit Margin 7.18%

c. Net Profit Margin __Net Profits__ Net Profits 37,022 Net Profits 38,144 Sales Sales 743,930 Sales 730,379 Net Profit 4.98% Net Profit 5.22%

4. Debt Ratios Balance Sheet Total Liabilities 129,279 Total Liabilities 128,319 Total Liabilities_ Total Assets 132,539 Total Assets 132,706

a. Debt to Assets Total Assets Debt to Assets Ratio 97.54% Debt to Assets Ratio 96.69% ___Total Liabilities___ Total Liabilities 129,279 Total Liabilities 128,319

b. Debt to Equity Total Owners' Equity Total Owners' Equity 3,260 Total Owners' Equity 4,387 Debt to Equity Ratio 3965.61 Debt to Equity Ratio 2924.98%

4. Investment Measures Balance Sheet Net Profits 37,022 Net Profits 38,144

a. ROI Net Profits__ Total Assets 132,539 Total Assets 132,706 (Return on Investment) Total Assets ROI (Ret. on Invest.) 27.93% ROI (Ret. on Invest.) 28.74%

Balance Sheet NOTE: NOTE: 1. Each asset % of Total Assets

5. Vertical Financial 2. Liability & Equity % Total L&E See FSA Summary See FSA Summary Statement Analysis Income Statement Balance Sheet and Balance Sheet and

3. All items % of Total Revenues Income Statement Income Statement

Balance Sheet 1. Assets, Liab & Equity measured NOTE: NOTE: against 2nd year. Increases and

6. Horizontal Financial decreases stated as amount & % Horizontal Analysis Horizontal Analysis Statement Analysis Income Statement Not Applicable Not Applicable

2. Revenues & Expenses measured against 2nd year. Increases and Only one year in business Only one year in business decreases stated as amount & %

30

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 211

IV. SUPPORTING DOCUMENTS Marine Art of California

Catalog Cost Analysis Competition Comparison Analysis Proposal for Limited Partnership Terms and Conditions for Participants Letter of Reference

31

212 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Catalog Cost Analysis

PRINTING QUANTITY 20,000 30,000 40,000 50,000 60,000

CATALOG ITEMS 24-Page: Price per 1000 521.37 413.92 360.07 336.11 306.49 WEIGHT - 2.208 OZ. Extended Cost 10,427.40 12,417.60 14,402.80 16,305.50 18,389.40 Prep & Delivery 756.00 970.00 1,235.00 1,500.00 1,765.00 Mail List Costs - $50.00 per/1000 1,000.00 1,500.00 2,000.00 2,500.00 3,000.00 Postage - $170 per/1000 3,200.00 4,800.00 6,400.00 8,000.00 9,600.00 Film Separations - $64 per/page 3,600.00 2,500.00 2,500.00 2,500.00 2,500.00 Art Work 1,000.00 1,000.00 1,000.00 1,000.00 1,000.00 TOTAL COSTS 19,983.40 23,187.60 27,537.80 31,805.50 36,254.40 Rounded Numbers 20,000.00 23,200.00 27,600.00 32,000.00 36,500.00 UNIT COSTS 1.00 0.77 0.69 0.64 0.61 COSTS PER PAGE 0.04 0.03 0.03 0.03 0.03 COSTS PER/1000 999.17 772.92 688.44 636.11 604.24

PRINTING QUANTITY 70,000 80,000 90,000 100,000

CATALOG ITEMS 24-Page: Price per 1000 291.72 280.29 268.85 261.00 WEIGHT - 2.208 OZ. Extended Cost 20,420.40 22,423.20 24,196.50 26,100.00 Prep & Delivery 2,030.00 2,295.00 2,560.00 2,825.00 Mail List Costs - $50.00 per/1000 3,500.00 4,000.00 4,500.00 5,000.00 Postage - $170 per/1000 11,900.00 13,600.00 15,300.00 17,000.00 Film Separations - $64 per/page 2,500.00 2,500.00 2,500.00 2,500.00 Art Work 1,000.00 1,000.00 1,000.00 1,000.00 TOTAL COSTS 41,350.40 45,818.20 50,056.50 54,425.00 Rounded Numbers 41,500.00 46,000.00 50,500.00 55,000.00 UNIT COSTS 0.59 0.57 0.56 0.54 COSTS PER PAGE 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.02 COSTS PER/1000 590.72 572.73 556.18 544.25

FOREIGN PRINTING QUANTITY 40,000 50,000 60,000 70,000 NOTE: 20% will be deducted for foreign printing. Prices are reflected in Profit 27,600.00 32,000.00 36,500.00 41,500.00 0.80 0.80 0.80 0.80 FOREIGN PRINTING COSTS 22,080.00 25,600.00 29,200.00 33,200.00

FOREIGN PRINTING QUANTITY 80,000 90,000 100,000 46,000.00 50,500.00 55,000.00 0.80 0.80 0.80 FOREIGN PRINTING COSTS 36,800.00 40,400.00 44,000.00

32

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 213

Competition Comparison Analysis

Price Total Retail % of Total # of Item

Range Prices Prices Items RNG %

COMPANY NAME Wild Wings -50.00 2,092.35 3% 68 19% Spring -100.00 5,269.50 7% 68 19% -100.00 38% 32 Pages -200.00 11,302.00 15% 78 22% -500.00 39,905.00 54% 124 35% -999.00 11,045.00 15% 19 5% $1,000.00 4,745.00 6% 2 1% $74,358.85 100% 359 100% Avg Item Price $207.13 (Based on keystone pricing) Avg Item Profit $103.56

Sharper Image -50.00 1,580.65 9% 47 39% Jul/Aug -100.00 2,418.45 14% 31 26% -100.00 64% 24 of 60 Pages -200.00 3,898.75 23% 25 21% -500.00 4,879.45 29% 13 11% -999.00 2,797.85 17% 4 3% $1,000.00 1,195.00 7% 1 1% $16,770.15 100% 121 100% Avg Item Price $138.60 (Based on keystone pricing) Avg Item Profit $69.30

Sharper Image -50.00 2,223.60 10% 73 42% Jul/Aug -100.00 3,227.95 15% 41 24% -100.00 66% 32 of 60 Pages -200.00 5,088.35 23% 33 19% -500.00 7,129.10 33% 20 12% -999.00 4,047.75 19% 6 3%

$1,000.00 0.00 0% 0 0% $21,716.75 100% 173 100% Avg Item Price $125.53 (Based on keystone pricing) Avg Item Profit $62.77

Marine Art of California -50.00 2,826.95 13% 108 54% Nov/Dec -100.00 3,587.65 17% 46 23% -100.00 77% 40 Pages -200.00 3,461.85 16% 23 12% -500.00 4,528.25 21% 15 8% -999.00 4,281.00 20% 6 3%

$1,000.00 2,600.00 12% 1 1% $21,285.70 100% 199 100% Avg Item Price $106.96 (Based on keystone pricing) Avg Item Profit $53.48

33

214 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Proposal for Limited Partnership

Borrow $130,000.00 from private investors as limited partners as outlined:

$130,000.00 = 45% of Marine Art of California $130,000.00 = 20 shares @ $6,500 each 1 share = 2.25% of Marine Art of California Limited Partners will own 2.25% of the business for each $6,500 invested. The investment will be treated as a loan and paid back at 11% interest over 15 years at approximately $78 per month per shareholder.

1 share = $78 per month for 15 years 20 shares = $1,560 per month The General Partner, Robert A. Garcia, will own 55% of the business. The Limited Partners will own 45% of the business for the duration of the partnership. The duration of the partnership is 4 years. The General Partner will have the option of buying out the Limited Partners at the end of 4 years for $3,250 for each 2.25% interest. The buyout will not affect the outstanding loan, but the General Partner will provide collateral equal to the loan balance. The value of inventory will be used as that collateral.

Return On Investment (ROI) for each $6,500 share:

A. Principal (15 years) Interest (15 years) Buy-out (4 years) Total (15 years) $6,500 + $7,540 + $3,250 = $17,290 B. PROJECTED Annual Profits (Loss) for 1 share (2.25%):

2007 2008 2009 2010 4 Year Total ($759.53) $833.00 $11,310.62 $19,097.78 = $30,481.87

♦ Principal and Interest (15 years) $14,040.00 ♦ Buy-Out (4 years) $ 3,250.00 ♦ Projected Profits/loss (4 years) $30,481.87

Total Projected Return on Investment $47,771.87 or Net Profits = $41,271 = 635% Assets $ 6,500 Contract Highlights: 1. First Right of Refusal: Limited Partners agree to extend the First Right of Refusal to the General Partner, Robert A. Garcia, in the event the Limited Partner desires to sell, grant, or trade his/her share of the business.

2. Key Man Insurance: A life insurance policy valued at $250,000.00 shall be taken out on General Partner, Robert A. Garcia, which is approximately double the amount of the $130,000.00 loan needed. In the event of the death of Robert A Garcia, the payments of the full policy amount will be divided among the Limited Partners equal to the amount invested (e.g., 2.25% investment would equal a 1/20th layout of $12,500.00).

3. Limited Partner Purchase Program: General Partner, Robert A. Garcia, agrees to grant at cost buying privileges on all product line items for the purchase of 3 or more shares. For 1-2 shares, a 45% discount shall be extended. These shall be in effect for the life of the Limited Partnership contract (minimum 4 years before exercising buy-out option). For remainder of the loan contract, (2 years) a discount of 35% off retail price will be extended. At the completion of the loan repayment, a Lifetime Discount of 20% off retail will be extended to Limited Partners. These privileges are non-transferable.

34

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan 215

MARINE ART OF CALIFORNIA Robert A. Garcia P.O. Box 10059-251 Newport Beach, CA 92658 714-722-6478

TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR PARTICIPANTS

1. Artist/Vendor agrees to drop ship stocked items within 48 hours of notification to indicated customer with Instructions for Shipping provided by Marine Art of California. A time schedule is needed for custom made pieces such as bronzes acrylics or original art works requiring longer delivery. Customer will pay shipping.

2. Artist/Vendor agrees to provide 48 hour Federal Express Delivery with added shipping charges for all stocked items.

3. Artist/Vendor agrees to use only shipping labels provided by Marine Art of California.

4. Artist/Vendor guarantees that all items shipped will be free of any business names, logos, addresses, phone numbers or any other printed material referencing said Artist/Vendor (engravings or signatures of Artist on pieces not included).

5. Each Artist shall include a pre-approved autobiographical sheet with each shipment.

6. Artist/Vendor shall include required Certificates of Authenticity on all Limited Edition pieces shipped.

7. Exclusive marketing rights for a selected art item made for Marine Art of California shall be covered in a separate contract.

8. Artist/Vendor agrees to fax a copy of the shipping manifest or phone in shipping information and date of pickup on same day of transaction.

9. Artist/Vendor guarantees insurance coverage for the full retail value.

10. Artist/Vendor shall agree to 10 day full refund period beginning from the date customer receives shipped merchandise.

11. Artist/Vendor agrees to extend 30 days net payment plan to Marine Art of California.

12. Artist/Vendor shall not record names nor addresses of buyers for purposes of any sales or marketing contact within 24 months of shipment of the order.

13. In lieu of any participation fee, Artist/Vendor agrees to extend a 15% discount on published wholesale prices to Marine Art of California. This is justifiable due to advertising, printing, mailing and target marketing costs and projected volume sales.

14. Each Artist/Vendor shall be notified 2 weeks prior to the mailing of the first catalog issue.

15. Artist/Vendor agrees to provide goods and services as stated above for a minimum duration of 60 days after publication date.

I hereby acknowledge and accept these terms and conditions set forth by Marine Art of California. _________________________________________ ______________________________________________ (Company) (Signature and Title of Authorized Representative) _________________________________________ Date:_________________________________________ (Print Name and Title)

35

216 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix I: Marine Art of California Business Plan

Powell and Associates Marketing Consultants

1215 West Imperial Highway - Suite 103 - Brea, CA 92621 Keith Powell - President Tel: (714) 680-8306

Dear Prospective Investor: It is indeed a pleasure to write a reference letter for Bob A. Garcia. I have known Bob over the past five years and have found him to be an extremely creative and enthusiastic individual. I have been associated with Bob through several community and civic organizations for which he is an active participant. He has also held office in several of these organizations and has always fulfilled his duties with aplomb. Bob approached me well over a year ago to meet with him on a regular basis to become a "mentor" of a then dream, now a reality, his company MARINE ART OF CALIFORNIA. Along with several other mentors that he has been seeking advice from, I have had the privilege of reviewing, commenting and assisting in the development of his plan. He has evidenced great discipline, follow through, creativity, and a willingness to do his homework on this business venture. I would most highly recommend he be given the consideration he seeks. Bob has evidenced the qualities needed to succeed in any business venture; those of commitment, dedication, optimism and follow through. If you have any further questions, please do not hesitate to contact me. My direct line is 714-680-8306. Cordially,

Keith P. Powell Keith P. Powell President

36

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

217

Appendix

II

Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

The Dayne Landscaping, Inc. business plan presented on the following pages is based on research for a landscaping and snow removal business in New Hampshire. It was developed by international marketing specialist, Robin Dayne, President of rtd Marketing International, Inc. in Nashua, New Hampshire. Robin wrote this plan specifically for you (the readers of, Anatomy of a Business Plan and the users of our AUTOMATE YOUR BUSINESS PLAN software). It will show you how you can follow our format and write a winning business plan for your own company. Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Scenario Dayne Landscaping, Inc. is a fictitious one-year old business that provides landscaping and snow removal services in Nashua, New Hampshire. The business had a successful first year (2007) and is planning to expand its customer base and purchase its present site (currently leased) for $375,000. In order to purchase the location, Dayne Landscaping, Inc. will use $100,000 of its own funds and seek a loan for the remaining $275,000 . How is this business plan organized? The Organizational and Marketing Plans for Dayne Landscaping, Inc. reflect the company’s current status and its plans for its future expansion. It is important that the marketing plan provide convincing evidence supporting the feasibility of the loan. The lender needs to know that the company has the ability to increase its market share (and revenues) enough to insure that it can repay the loan and interest and still maintain its profitability.

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

218

Financial Documents need to reflect the company’s history and project its future. This company has been in business for one year (2007) and is seeking a loan. Therefore, the financial documents need to begin with a summary of financial needs and dispersal of loan funds statement. The next section includes projections and historical financial statements for the 2007 business year (first year in business). They will show how well the company met its original projections and what its current financial status is. The third area to be covered in financial documents will address the company’s projections for the future (2007-2009)—projected cash flow, three-year income projection, and projected balance sheet. The closing pages of the financial section contain a financial statement analysis of the company’s history and future projections. Utilizing the financial information developed previously, ratios are computed and matched against industry standards. Of Special Note I found two things of particular interest is Robin’s Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Plan. The Organizational Plan, very effectively addressed Personnel in terms of who they are, training, duties, profile, and salaries/benefits. In the Marketing Plan, Robin did not address the full gamut of marketing considerations. However, I liked her treatment of the target market and her example of the marketing promotion of target market #1. As you proceed with the writing of your own plan, it may help you to look at Dayne Landscaping, Inc.’s business plan to see how Robin handled each of the corresponding sections. Some of the research material has been condensed and we have not included all of the necessary supporting documents. We have also chosen to omit any business or personal financial history that the writer or lender may wish to include in copies of the business plan.

Warning! This plan is to be examined for Ms. Dayne’s handling of content only. It has been used as an example in our book and software because we feel it is a fine example of business plan organization. There is no judgment inferred as to appropriateness or financial potential for lenders or investors. Do not use it as a source of research for your own company.

We are very pleased that Robin Dayne has provided us with this excellent example of a business plan for inclusion in Anatomy of a Business Plan and AUTOMATE YOUR BUSINESS PLAN. We hope that Dayne Landscaping, Inc.’s plan will be of benefit to you. We thank Robin for being so generous and for allowing us to share her interpretation of business planning with our readers. Robin Dayne is an international marketing consultant who specializes in creating increased revenues through Customer Base Management™. Her email is [email protected]

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

219

Dayne Landscaping, Inc.

22 San Carlos Dr. Nashua, New Hampshire 03060

603-335-8200

Robin T. Dayne, President

22 San Carlos Dr. Nashua, NH 03060

(603)-335-8200

Joe Sanborn, Vice-President 56 Gingham St.

Nashua, NH 03990 (603) 446-9870

Fred Ryan, Treasurer

98 Canon St. Nashua, NH 06223

(603) 883-0938

Trudy St. George, Secretary 31 Mill St.

Nashua, NH 08876 (603) 595-3982

Business Plan Prepared January 2008 by the Corporate Officers

(Private and Confidential)

Copy 1 of 5

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

220

TABLE OF CONTENTS

I. EXECUTIVE SUMMARY ……............................................................ 1 II. PART I - THE ORGANIZATIONAL PLAN.......................................… 2 – 7 Summary Description of the Business ...................…............................………….. 2 Products and/or Services …………………………………………………………… 3 Administrative Plan ………………………………………………………………… 4

Legal Structure ………………………………………………………………. 4 Corporate Officers …………………………………………………………… 4

Management …………………………………………………………………. 4 Personnel …………………………………………………………………….. 5 Training ……………………………………………………………………… 5 Personnel Duties ……………………………………………………………... 5 Employee Profile …………………………………………………………….. 6 Accounting & Legal …………………………………………………………. 6 Insurance …………………………………………………………………….. 7 Security ………………………………………………………………………. 7

III. PART II - MARKETING ..................................................................... 8 - 15 Target Markets ....................................................….........................................….… 8-9 Competition ………………………………………………………………………… 10 Methods of Distribution ...........................…......................................................…... 10 Advertising Strategy .…................…….......……................................................ …. 10-12 Paid Advertising ……………………………………………………………… 10-11 Direct Mail ....................…....................................................................…....... 12 Community Involvement …………………………………………………….. 12 Individual Marketing Promotion .....................................................................…….. 13-15 IV. PART III - FINANCIAL DOCUMENTS ........…................................ 16 - 33 Sources & Uses of Loan Funds .............................................................................… 17 2007 Historical Financial Documents .................................................................…. 18-23 Cash Projected and Historical for 2007 ……………………………………… 18 Profit & Loss Stement for 2007 ……………………………………………… 19 Balance Sheet, December 31, 2007…………………………………………… 20 Break-Even Analysis ………………………………………………………… 21 2008 Financial Projections ………………………………………………………… 22-25 Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement for 2008 (by month) ………………………. 22-23 Three Year Income Projection 2008, 2009, 2010 …………………………… 24 Projected Balance Sheet for December 31, 2008 ……………………………. 25 Financial Statement Analysis ………………………………………………………. 26-29 Financial Assumptions for Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan ……………… 30 V. SUPPORTING DOCUMENTS * ...................................................... 31 - 34 Competition Comparison ………………………………………………………….. 31 Owner's Resume …………………………………………………………………… 32 Letter of Recommendation ………………………………………………………… 34

* Note. We have included only part of the supporting documents in this sample business plan.

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

221

Dayne Landscaping, Inc.

Executive Summary

Dayne Landscaping, Inc. is a one-year-old landscaping and snow-removal company, established in January of 2007. The company is located at 22 San Carlos Ave., Nashua, New Hampshire. The currently leased location is available for sale at $375,000. Dayne Landscaping, Inc. has $100,000 to invest and is seeking a $275,000 loan to complete the purchase. By owning the facility, the company can increase its equity for an amount equivalent to the current rental expense.

Dayne Landscaping has established its niche in the landscaping and snow removal business during 2006. Projections for 2007 show that it is reasonable to expect expansion of its customer base to new markets and territories. Cash Flow projections support the assumption that the company will have sufficient funds to purchase equipment and hire additional employees to support implementation of the marketing programs.

Management: Dayne Landscaping is managed by Robin Dayne. She has five prior years of experience in the landscaping business, working for a local competitor. Previously she worked in a variety of service industries selling and marketing products and services. Robin has established a strong team of very dedicated people who love to work with nature. As manager her role is to identify new business, develop and implement marketing activities, and to negotiate and close new contracts.

Current Market: Today the business services 100 residential accounts, 15 small business accounts, and currently no large corporate accounts. The services include: landscaping and design, lawn care and maintenance, snow plowing and removal, and tree maintenance and removal. The success of the company has been a direct result of our ability to provide personal service at a competitive rate, thus creating a dedicated customer base. Currently, the average cost for lawn maintenance of a residential home is $25-30 per hour, small business accounts $50-100 per hour, and large corporate accounts are negotiated on a per contract basis. Due to the seasonal changes in New Hampshire, snow removal becomes an important part of the business to maintain the company’s revenues during the slower winter months of December, January, February, and March.

Projected Market: The projected growth rate for the landscaping industry, based the previous years is 28%. We will be expanding our business with new equipment, marketing, and additional employees to meet and exceed that demand. We are expecting to grow our customer base by 50% based on our first year’s track record, our unique offering, and planned marketing activities.

Loan Repayment: The $275,000 in loan funds will be required for April 2008 closing. Repayment of the 15- year loan, plus interest, can begin promptly in May. Early retirement of the loan is anticipated, possibly by the end of tax year 2013. In addition to the property and facility, itself, the loan can further be secured by the owner’s home equity which is currently $167,000.

1

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

222

Dayne Landscaping, Inc.

I. The Organizational Plan

Summary Description of the Business Dayne Landscaping, Inc., established in January 2007 as a corporation, handles landscaping, lawn maintenance and snow removal, of residential homes, and small businesses in New Hampshire. It began with 20 residential accounts and 2 small business accounts. As of January 2008, the company has grown to 100 residential accounts and 15 small business accounts, totaling $750,000 in revenue, a growth of 520%.

Mission Dayne Landscaping’s mission is to be perceived as the most valued provider of landscaping and snow removal services. The company has been very successful due to the high standard of service and care provided to the customer and because of its reputation for quick response times during snowstorms. Business Model The company also offers a unique service of oriental garden design landscaping, the only one in the tri-state area. Today that service is offered in New Hampshire only. Twenty-five of the 115 accounts have contracted for these unique gardens. Our plan is to open markets in Connecticut and Massachusetts over the next 3 years. It is important to note that these gardens are a not only a unique service; they are also our premium high ticket service and provide a larger profit margin, directly impacting the company’s bottom line. Strategy The company’s growth strategy is to buy out smaller landscaping companies as we expand the business in to Massachusetts and Connecticut and increase our Large Corporate accounts for snow removal. Currently, with local corporations “downsizing”, “out-sourcing” these services to local businesses has become prevalent. Facility The company currently leases a 20,000 sq. ft. area, which includes a 4,000 sq. ft. building for the main office, a large attached garage for trucks, maintenance equipment and supplies, two large lots, one fenced in for parking equipment, plows, flatbeds, and storage of trees, shrubs, and plants.

2

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

223

Products and Services Dayne Landscaping offers three categories of landscaping services to three varieties of customers. The customers consist of residential homes, small businesses, and large corporations. Each group has the option of purchasing the same types of services. Lawn care includes, mowing, weeding, planting, re- sod, pest control, and tree and shrub maintenance. Customized landscape design can be purchased on a contract basis, including specialties in oriental gardens, tree sculpture, and complete landscape design. The third service offered is snow plowing and removal.

All the plantings are high quality and are purchased from a local nursery that has been in the business for over 35 years. We also have an arrangement to use the nursery as a consultant when there is a need for it. Customer Profiles The following are descriptions of the three types of customer and the services that are typically purchased by each.

1. Residential homes in mid- to high-income areas, typically purchase lawn care that consists of mowing, weeding, pest control, and tree/scrub maintenance. There are two people assigned per job: two part-time college students, over-seen by a supervisor. This job can take an average of two hours to complete. Each home receives a contract for two visits per month unless there is a special need, which is an additional cost to the basic contract. These lawn contacts run from March thru November. Additionally, 50% of the residential customers also purchase winter snow removal for their driveways, and these customers are charged a minimal flat fee and a per call fee, with an up-front deposit to insure they get priority service.

2. Small business account or office park is the second type of customer. They

typically consist of banks, or small office buildings and require shrub and landscaping care, weed and pest control and minimal lawn mowing. The average time required to service this type of account is three to four hours with one supervisor and two or three part-time employees. All the small business accounts have a contract for snow removal. A pre-determined amount for the contract is negotiated in Oct. for the four months November thru February, with a per call fee for the month of March, which can have unpredictable snow storms. These customers require quick response times and are charged for that level of service, as they need to accommodate their own customers during business hours.

3. Large corporate account or condo complex are the third type of customer. They

require the same services as the small corporate account, but require many more hours, employees, and equipment. Additionally, included in their lawn maintenance is routine watering. The accounts that are being targeted will require an average of one week of maintenance per month. This is the area to be expanded over the next three years. To support the watering needed every other day during the summer months, one part-time worker is hired and dedicated to watering for every two companies. Corporate account contracts are negotiated individually, and range from 60K to 350K per year depending on the amount of square footage and specific landscaping requirements. These customers also require immediate response times, especially in winter during the snow season.

3

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

224

Administrative Plan

Legal Structure Dayne Landscaping, Inc. is a corporation filed under the same name. The legal and financial advisors recommended a corporation as the most efficient structure based on the plan to purchase pre-existing small landscaping companies in the tri-state area over the next two years. There have been 300 shares of stock applied for, and 100 issued to the sole shareholder (President) at the time of incorporation. This will leave the flexibility of having additional shares on hand should we need to use them in negotiations of larger landscaping company buy-outs. Corporate Officers: Robin Dayne, President Bob Sanborn, Vice President and Accountant (see resumes in Fred Ryan, Treasurer Supporting Documents) Trudy St. George, Secretary and Legal Counsel The officers of the company determine the direction of the corporation through its board meetings. Additionally, there is an incentive plan for board members to acquire company stock based on set profit goals. It should be noted that the President is the only officer working in the day-to-day business. All other officers interact at the monthly board meetings as well as on an “as needed” basis. This allows the company to have access to expertise and advice at large cost savings, which has a direct impact on the bottom line and growth of the company.

Management & Personnel Management At present, Robin Dayne, is the President and sole shareholder in Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Robin has five prior years of experience in the landscaping business, working for a local competitor. Previously she worked in a variety of service industries selling and marketing products and services.

Dayne Landscaping, Inc. has been incorporated for almost one year, realizing a 520% growth rate between January to November. The growth rate is attributed to high standards set for customer service. Many customers shifted from the prior company because of their loyalty to Robin Dayne. She has set up an incentive plan for her employees that rewards them for outstanding customer service based on year-end survey results, or when contracts are renewed or new business is closed.

Under Ms. Dayne’s management, a strong team of very dedicated people who love to work with nature has been formed. As manager her role is to identify new business, develop and implement marketing activities, and to negotiate and close new contracts.

The four supervisors manage the accounts and part-time workers. They also determine staffing and equipment needed to maintain the account. There are also two design specialists, one of which is specifically trained in oriental garden design and tree topiaries.

4

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

225

Personnel There are three full-time office employees - one office manager and two administrative assistants. Four supervisors and two design specialists work in the field. The remainder are part- time workers, numbering from four to twenty-five or more, depending on the time of the year and work load.

1. Owner-President: 2007 Guaranteed Salary $65,000 with yearly increases justified by profitability.

2. Design Specialists: 2 in 2008; Salaries @ $25,000 + 5% commission on new business contracts. 3. Four Supervisors: Salaries @ $15,000 + 3% bonus per contract for excellent year-end

customer surveys. 4. Office Manager: Salary @ $22,000 per year 5. Administrative Assistants (1 in 2007, 2 in 2008): Salaries @ $15,000 per year. 6. Part-time workers: 5-25 @ $7 per hour; (more added as volume increases).

Training All employees receive training from the President and the Supervisor in the following areas:

Given by the President

a. Company policies and procedures regarding the customers and company standards b. Landscaping orientation at the time they are hired c. Liability and safety procedures d. Equipment care and theft policies

Given by the Supervisors a. Overview of each account assignment b. Equipment assignment and training - operation of mowers, tools, and supplies c. Chemicals precautions

Personnel Duties

1. President/Owner a. Sets company policies and trains all new employees b. Solicits, interviews and hires new employees c. Assigns accounts to Supervisors d. Negotiates new and large contracts e. Approves the purchases of equipment and supplies f. Handles customer service issues that can not be satisfied by Supervisor g. Reviews and signs all checks h. Follows up on Supervisor sales leads

2. Four Supervisors - report to President a. Manages on average 25 residential accounts and 4 small business accounts b. Will be managing 1-2 Large Corporate accounts c. Responsible for training part-time help on account profiles and equipment d. Forecasts supplies needed for each account e. Forecasts and manages work schedules f. Conducts second round of interviews of part-timers and approves g. Handles account problems related to service and quality issues h. Solicits new business leads to President. i. Responsibility for inventory and equipment assigned to their team

5

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

226

3. Office Manager - reports to president a. Manages account scheduling b. Supports Supervisors - back-up supplies misc. c. Takes account calls and passes to supervisors d. Performs yearly customer survey e. Answers phone f. Dispatches and is in “beeper” contact with supervisors g. Assigns and maintains equipment for supervisors

4. Administrative Assistant - reports to president

a. Responsible for Bookkeeping functions of: Daily sales reconciliation Accounts receivable and accounts payable Payroll General Ledger

b. Computer Typing - 60 WPM, with software knowledge - WP/Excel/D-Base c. 10- key adding machine d. Access to safe e. Tracks orders placed for equipment and supplies

5. Part-time Employees - report to supervisor

a. Assigned to work specific accounts b. Mows, weeds, does manual labor c. Identifies any problems d. Follows instructions from supervisor e. Manages inventory of supplies

Employee Profile All employees must be:

a. Hard working and neat in appearance b. Like working outdoors c. Good communicators d. Team workers e. Educated for full-time work with a minimum HS degree, or in College f. Able to follow directives and be a quick learner g. Dedicated to doing an outstanding job h. Responsible, regarding safety

Accounting and Legal Accounting All bookkeeping is kept on computer, on a regular basis, by the Administrative Assistant on the software “QuickBooks Pro” from Intuit. At the end of the year the files are printed and passed to the accountant Bob Sanborn, CPA who has been a personal friend for many years and has 35 years experience as a CPA. His fees are reasonable and there is a high level of trust in his input to the business as he is the Vice President for the corporation as well.

6

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

227

The customer base and prospect database is kept on the software “ACT” from Contact Software International that allows us to keep precise timelines of our scheduling and mange our accounts accurately. “Office Professional” from Microsoft allows us to perform WP, develop customized Spreadsheets, and develop proposals and presentations to larger accounts. All the above programs are “off-the-shelf” and are easy to get support for at very reasonable prices. Legal All contracts and other legal matters are handled by Trudy St. George, corporate officer and board member. Trudy is the senior partner of a 20-year old law firm specializing in business contracting.

Insurance

Carrier: Primercia Agent: Sam Bickford 111 Shoe St, Manchester, New Hampshire Type of Insurance: Business/personal 600,000 Deductible 4,000 Liability 1,000,000 Equipment 40,000 Deductible 500 Liability 2,000,000 Vehicles 150,000 Deductible 1,000 Liability 1,000,000 Annual Premium $8,000 Monthly Premium 670 Workers Comp. 1.43 per/1k gross Payroll

Security

Problems situations to be considered and protective measures to be taken:

1. Internal theft - Employee Dishonesty a. Shoplifting - of supplies - (4) closed circuit cameras in garage recording 24 hours b. Cash Theft - petty cash limit of $600. Daily receipt drop-off to bank of all receivable c. Falsifying signatures - all checks signed by President at the end of the day d. Employee orientation - to reduce theft and stress security procedures e. Monthly Inventory - responsibility of the Supervisors

2. External Theft

d. Walk-in theft Cameras at each doorway exits (2) e. Cameras in garage and on parking area, and fenced in plant lot f. Break-in theft/robbery - Alarms set nightly and connected directly to local Police station

7

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

228

Dayne Landscaping, Inc.

II. Marketing Plan

Author Note: The Marketing Plan for Dayne Landscaping, Inc. focuses on three of the basic elements presented in our marketing chapter for a smaller business— Market Analysis (Target Markets and Competition), Sales Strategy, and Advertising. This marketing plan has a special strength in the target marketing area in that the company planned its strategy for each of its market segments by evaluating the target in terms of who they are, what the company will do to approach the target, when the campaign will take place, and where the campaign will be positioned. Also, the Target Market Worksheet for Target #1 at the end of this section is a great tool for analyzing and planning your own target marketing. It is my suggestion that the marketing plan for your company should address the components in a way that more closely follows the marketing plan outline in Chapter 5. However, I think this marketing plan may provide you with an organized means for developing your strategy for individual market segments.

Target Markets with Sales Strategies

Target #1 Large Corporate Facilities and Condominiums Who: Corporations that are “outsourcing” the landscaping maintenance of their facilities to

outside vendors, and condominium complexes. There are approximately 75 accounts that are potential customers within a 50 mile radius. Our goal is to secure 5 in 2008.

What: Tele-market for background information, and send a direct mail with telemarketing follow-up. Describe landscaping, lawn maintenance, pest control and all other landscaping services, such as tree removal and replacement, landscaping design and care, and snow plowing and removal from their parking lots and driveways. Provide a guarantee for the services and show competitive comparison pricing from local companies.

8

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

229

When: Begin January to determine the bidding process and RFP schedule to determine the timing of proposals. Call each account to determine the timing and arrange for an on-site inspection, to determine the amount of work needed and special needs to develop an estimate. If possible inquire what the previous years costs were and if the customer was satisfied with the work of their current landscaper.

Where: Position joint services with local garden stores for promotions and advertising.

Target #2 Small Businesses or Office Parks Who: All small businesses and office parks that have outdoor grounds that want to save

money, or are unhappy with their present landscaping company. In the 50 mile radius there are approximately 125 accounts that are potential customers. Our goal is to add 15 new contracts in this category in 2008.

What: Tele-market for background information and send a direct mail with telemarketing follow-up. Describe all the same landscaping and snow plowing services, referencing existing satisfied customers. Provide a guarantee for services rendered, show the cost savings using Dayne Landscaping, Inc., and develop a plan for continued snow and landscape maintenance. Offer the company’s quality guarantee, and comparison chart of competitive pricing.

When: Begin January to determine when existing contracts expire and provide information on the company and services. Request an on-site evaluation to determine costs and uncover any problem areas needing work.

Where: Position joint services with local garden stores for promotions and advertising. Advertise in the local papers, Yellow Pages and Business to Business Directory.

Target #3 Residential Homes Who: Target all residential homes in the 50 mile radius that are in mid to high income areas

and over 3+ acres. Contact all existing customers with satisfaction survey, and solicit at the same time for:

a. Additional business - renew contracts for next year b. New customers - referrals

What: Develop and send company brochure that targets the residential homes supplying them

with information on all services offered by Dayne Landscaping, Inc. with price comparisons.

When: Develop brochure in January and mail in February prior to Spring and Summer contracts. Follow-up with existing customers and potential customers in September for the snow plowing contracts.

Where: Position joint services with local garden stores for promotions and advertising

9

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

230

Competition Dayne Landscaping currently has two competitors in the local area: The Garden Shop and Landscaping Plus. While they have been in the New Hampshire area for several years, they are family- owned businesses that have a limited number of clientele and the same number of accounts year after year. They also have no type of Landscaping specialty. Only the Garden Shop offers snow removal. Landscaping Plus has only three snow plows that are active during the winter months.

Methods of Distribution

Dayne Landscaping sells directly to the customer, is primarily a service business, with the exception of selling the landscaping plants and shrubs, which come from a local nursery wholesaler.

Advertising Strategy Paid Advertising We currently participate in several forms of advertising:

1. Newspaper ads: All ad copy is identical, and include information required by the newspaper:

a. Ad information: 1. Ad size: The ad is two column x 3 ins. 2. Timing: Monthly 3. Section: Garden section b. Ad location, Contact and fees:

Nashua Telegraph Contact: Mark Potts P.O. Box 1008 Circulation: 50,000

Nashua, NH 03061-1008 Fee: $126.00

Manchester Union Leader Contact: Ken Coose 100 William Loeb Drive Circulation: 125,000 Manchester, NH 03109 Fee: $171.99

Lowell Sun Contact: Carol McCabe 15 Kearney Square Circulation; 75,000 Lowell, MA 01852-1996 Fee: $153.00

Hartford Daily news Contact: Sue Betz 100 Main St. Circulation: 150,000 Hartford, CT 10002 Fee: 190.00

10

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

231

2. Phone books - Yellow pages and directories

a. NYNEX Phone Book - Yellow Pages

Ad Information: Coverage: So. NH area Yearly Fee: $650.00 Ad Size: 1/4 page Renewal date: February 1st Contact: Sam Moore

b. Business to Business Directory (NH only)

Ad Information Coverage: All NH Yearly Fee: $250.00 Ad Size: 1/4 page Renewal Date: January 1st Contact: Karl Hess

3. Local Cable Channels

a. Channel 13 - Local Nashua station reaching all of So. NH Ad Information: Length of ad “spot”: 60 seconds

Development costs: $250.00 (one time fee) Length of campaign: 3 mos. Runs per month: Three times per day, everyday Cost for 3 mos.: $300. Total campaign cost: $550.

b. Weather Channel “tag line” - reaching 400,000 homes Ad Information: Length of ad “spot”: 15 seconds Development costs: $100. (one time fee) Length of campaign: 3 mos. Runs per month: 20 times per day, everyday Cost for 3 mos.: $900. Total campaign cost: $1000.

11

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

232

Direct Mail Note: There was no direct mail done in the first year of business. With the development of the Marketing plan, two direct mail pieces will need to be developed to target our three potential customer bases for 2008. (see detailed plan of this activity) Direct mail #1 Designed for: Target market #1- large corporations and condominiums Target market #2 - small business and office parks. Creative Strategy: Design needs to be glossy, appropriate for corporate,

professional environment. Highlight: Customer service - testimonials Quick response time All services Guarantee Free evaluation

Direct mail #2 Designed for: Target market #3 - residential homes Creative Strategy: Design should be a tri-fold brochure “self-mailer”

(no envelope required) Direct highlights for the homeowner Highlight: Customer service - testimonials Quick response time All services Guarantee Free evaluation Community Involvement Member of the Chamber of Commerce in Nashua. Board Member of the local Garden Club, involved with teaching kids about plants and nature, as well as involved with the “Beautification of Nashua” program.

Note: In this example plan, we have included the

promotion for target market #1 only. All target markets would have their own separate plan using the same format.

12

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

233

Worksheet for Individual Marketing Promotion

Target Market #1: Large Corporate or Condo Landscaping Date: 01/08

Program Name: Corporate Promo Media: Direct Mail & Telemarketing Program Objectives: * Generate a minimum of 500k in additional revenue in 2008 * Increase corporate account base by 5 new accounts * Establish Dayne Landscaping as a landscaping provider to large corporations and condominiums Audience:

Direct Mail Who - the 70 identified accounts consisting of condominiums and large corporations. What - Send direct mail (company brochure) to Corporate and Condo contacts listing services

and benefits of Dayne Landscaping. Position money back guarantee as an added promotion.

Where - in the New Hampshire, and Massachusetts areas (50 mile radius). When - Drop mail in mid- January.

Telemarketing (Prior to mailing): Who - Call all accounts to identify landscaping contact in the large corporation or in property

management company of the condominium.

What - Find out the contract renewal dates and bid submission dates for each prospect.

When - Make phone calls first two weeks of January.

Where – NA

Telemarketing (Post Direct Mail): Who - Call all contacts and confirm bid dates What - ask if they received the direct mail and offer a free landscaping consultation. When - Calling begins 5-8 working days after the direct mail is received. Where – NA

13

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

234

List source: The list was taken from the library in the “New Hampshire Corporate Directory”, and

“Massachusetts Corporate Directory” as well as the Realty listing of Condominiums.

Creative Strategy - for Direct Mail: * Position Dayne Landscaping, Inc. as a leader in quality service * Position Guarantee * Leverage existing customer base with success stories * Position against the competition * Position “free” consulting offer * The telemarketing call back in a week

Creative Strategy - for Telemarketing: * Develop script with the same messages as the direct mail will have * If possible position - Company and Promotional offer

Components of mailing: Tri-fold brochure - components

* Self-mailer, with reply card * Address hand written on the backside

Timing:

Pre- Mailing Telemarketing

% Called Location Call dates 50% New Hampshire 1/2 - 1/9 50% Massachusetts 1/9 - 1/18 Direct Mail

% Mailed Location Mail date 50% New Hampshire Jan. 1/12 50% Massachusetts Jan. 1/19

Post- Mailing Telemarketing

% Called Location Call dates 50% New Hampshire 1/22 50% Massachusetts 1/29

Call to action: Reply card to be sent to office or and #800 number can be called

14

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

235

Lead criteria: “Hot” leads are classified as anyone getting a proposal, evaluation, or call back from the

mailing or telemarketing. They have the potential of closing in 2008.

“Warm” leads are any accounts that are interested and cannot do anything until 2003 due to their current contracts.

“Cold” leads are those accounts that are not interested at all, and have no revenue potential in the future.

Training:

Employees in the field - will be given an overview of the entire promotion to prepare them for customers asking questions, while on the job.

Office staff - will receive training and instructions on how to answer to phone and track the responses from the #800 and mailer. They will also be assisting on the pre and post telemarketing activities.

Expenses: Will not exceed $3000. for the entire promotion. Measurement: Revenue Goal 500k Expenses 3K Total # (list) 70 # or responses TBD # of leads TBD Cost/ per Response TBD Cost/ per Lead TBD Revenue/Expense ratio TBD

*TBD = To be determined at the end of the program.

Assumptions:

* Average value per contract = 100K

* Response rate = 2.0 % on the Direct mail and 15-20% on the telemarketing or 1.5 responses on the direct mail, and 10-14 on the telemarketing.

* “Hot” lead rate = 0.5% on the direct mail and 5%- 7% on the telemarketing or 3.5 leads on the direct mail and 3.5-5 leads on the telemarketing

Lead tracking Process: * All Direct mail responses will be tracked * All Phone calls will be logged when responding on the # 800.

* All regular calls will be screened “are you calling regarding our direct mail promotion?”

Program review: 30 days after last tell-marketing follow-up call.

15

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

236

Dayne Landscaping, Inc.

Part III: Financial Documents

Sources and Uses of Loan Funds

A. Statement of Financial Needs................................………........………..….. 17 B. Dispersal of Loan Funds..........................…............………….......……...... 17

2007 Financial Statements (Projected and Historical) A. Cash Flow (Projected and Historical for 2007...........................….............. 18 B. 2007 Profit & Loss (Income) Statement.........................….....…………...... 19 C. Balance Sheet as of December 31, 2007 ................................…...…....…... 20

D. Break-Even Analysis (historical)..................................….....………........... 21

2008 Financial Projections A. Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement..................................……........……........ 22-23 B. Three-Year Income Projection (2008-2009-2010).......…..........….…........ 24 C. Projected Balance Sheet for December 31, 2008...........…...…....….…...... 25

Financial Statement Analysis A. Company Financial Statement Analysis Summary ...................………..…. 26

B. Ratio Table for Dayne Landscaping, Inc. ...............................….……........ 27 C. 2007 Historical Vertical Income Statement Analysis............…………....... 28 D. December 31, 2007 Vertical Balance Sheet Analysis….………………..... 29

Business Plan Financial Assumptions Purpose & Terms of Loan & Financial Assumptions ……………………........ 30

16

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

237

Summary of Financial Needs

I. Dayne Landscaping, Inc. is seeking a loan to increase its equity capital through real estate investment:

A. By purchasing the buildings currently being leased by the company. B. By purchasing the parcel of land on which the buildings now stand. II. Dayne Landscaping, Inc. has $100,000 in cash to invest. An additional amount of $275,000 in loan funds is needed to complete the purchase.

Loan Fund Dispersal Statement 1. Dispersal of Loan Funds

Dayne Landscaping, Inc. will utilize the anticipated loan in the amount of $275,000 to purchase the facility (land and buildings) that it currently leases. The full purchase price is $375,000. The present owner of the premises is John S. Strykker. The parcel and accompanying buildings, located at 22 San Carlos Drive in Nashua, New Hampshire, are currently owned by John S. Strykker.

2. Back-Up Statement

a. The land is currently appraised at $200,000. Attached buildings appraise at $175,000. The owner, Mr. John S. Strykker is agreeable to close of escrow on or about April 15, 2008.

b. Dayne Landscaping, Inc. has appropriated $100,000 in retained earnings to be used as a capital investment in the facility. The additional $275,000 in loan funds will make up the full purchase amount of $375,000.

c. The buildings sit on a 20,000 square foot parcel of land, centrally located in Nashua, New Hampshire. The land is currently appraised at $200,000 and the buildings at $175,000. There are two large lots. One is fenced in for parking equipment and also serves as a storage area for trees, shrubs and plants. There is a 4,000 square foot building that serves as the main office and a large attached garage to house trucks, maintenance equipment and supplies.

d. The $275,000 in loan funds are needed by April 1 in order to proceed with escrow. Loan repayment can begin promptly on May 1st for a 15-year period. The company has a strong cash flow and a rapidly-growing market. Early payoff is anticipated.

e. Dayne Landscaping is currently paying $2850 in monthly rental expense. Payments on the anticipated $275,000, 15-year loan @ 9% would amount to $2,789. Purchase of the land and buildings will enable Dayne Landscaping, with no additional expense, to repay the loan + interest and to divert the current rental expense into equity growth.

17

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

238

2007 Cash Flow Statement One-Year Cash Flow Projection and Cash Flow History

Dayne Landscaping, Inc. For the Year 2007 Projected for: Historical for:

2007 2007 BEGINNING CASH BALANCE (January 1, 2007) 0 0

CASH RECEIPTS A. Sales/Revenues $573,000 $777,864 1. Landscaping - Residential 185,000 216,000 2. Landscaping - Small Business 65,000 160,700 3. Landscaping - Customized 174,000 199,374 4. Snow Removal - Residential 15,000 18,250 5. Snow Removal - Small Business 125,000 167,100

6. 5% Snow Removal contracts 5,000 8,500 7. Sale of Miscellaneous Accessories 4,000 7,940

B. Receivables 0 0 C. Interest Income 1,250 1,250 D. Sale of Long-Term Assets 0 0 TOTAL CASH AVAILABLE $574,250 $779,114 CASH PAYMENTS A. Cost of goods to be sold 1. Fertilizer 20,000 19,000 2. Pesticide 10,000 11,000 3. Plants/Shrubs 18,000 23,000 4. Salt/Sand 5,000 8,030

5. Seed 45,000 45,000 Total Cost of Goods $98,000 $106,030 B. Variable Expenses (Selling) 1. Design Specialist Salary/Payroll Taxes 20,000 20,000 2. Machinery, Tools, Equipment 11,500 11,000 3. Marketing 5,411 5,400 4. Part-time Worker Salaries/Payroll Taxes 150,000 182,000 5. Sales Bonuses 1,500 2,000 6. Sales Commissions 8,000 10,800 7. Supervisor Salaries/Payroll Taxes 60,000 60,000 8. Travel Expense 9,500 10,400 9. Miscellaneous Selling Expense 1,000 1,200 Total Variable Expenses $266,911 $302,800 C. Fixed Expenses (Administrative) 1. Administrative Fees (Legal/Accounting) 3,050 3,050 2. Insurance (Liability, Casualty, Fire, Theft) 11,600 11,600 3. Licenses and Permits 4,200 4,200 4. Office Equipment 5,700 7,700 5. Office Salaries/Payroll Taxes 42,000 42,000 6. Owner's Guaranteed Payment 57,000 65,000 7. Rent Expense + Security Deposit 39,900 39,900 8. Utilities 4,320 4,320 9. Miscellaneous Administrative Expense 200 500 Total Fixed Expenses $167,970 $178,270 D. Interest Expense 1,386 5,535 E. Federal and State Income Tax 7,196 65,220 F. Other Uses 0 0 G. Long-term Asset Payments 17,334 15,081 H. Loan Payments 0 0 I. Capital Distributions 0 0 TOTAL CASH PAID OUT $558,797 $672,936 CASH BALANCE/DEFICIENCY 15,453 106,178 LOANS TO BE RECEIVED 0 0 CAPITAL CONTRIBUTION 25,000 25,000 ENDING CASH BALANCE (December 31, 2001) $40,453 $131,178

18

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

239

2007 Profit & Loss (Income) Statement Dayne Landscaping, Inc.

For the Year: 2007 6-MONTH % of Total 12-MONTH % of Total TOTALS Revenues TOTALS Revenues

INCOME AM0UNT PERCENT AM0UNT PERCENT 1. Sales/Revenues 488,610 100.00% 777,864 100.00% Landscaping - Residential 138,000 28.24% 216,000 27.77% Landscaping - Small Business 104,000 21.28% 160,700 20.66% Landscaping - Customized 130,250 26.66% 199,374 25.63% Snow Removal - Residential 14,300 2.93% 18,250 2.35% Snow Removal - Small Business 96,800 19.81% 167,100 21.48% Miscellaneous Accessories 5,260 1.08% 8,500 1.09% 5% Snow Removal Contracts 0 0.00% 7,940 1.02% 2. Cost of Goods to be Sold 91,030 18.63% 101,030 12.99% a. Beginning Inventory 0 0.00% 0 0.00% b. Purchases 91,030 18.63% 106,030 5.79% (1) Fertilizer 13,000 2.66% 19,000 2.44% (2) Pesticide 8,000 1.64% 11,000 1.41% (3) Plants/Shrubs 22,000 4.50% 23,000 2.96% (4) Salt/Sand 3,030 0.62% 8,030 1.03% (5) Seed 45,000 9.21% 45,000 5.79% c. C.O.G. Available for Sale 91,030 18.63% 106,030 5.79% d. Less Ending Inventory 0 0.00% 5,000 0.64% 3. GROSS PROFIT 397,580 81.37% 676,834 87.01%

EXPENSES 1. Variable (Selling) Expenses a. Design Specialist Salary 10,000 2.05% 20,000 2.57% b. Machinery, Hand Tools, Equip. 9,000 1.84% 11,000 1.41% c. Marketing 3,205 0.66% 5,400 0.69% d. Part-time Worker Salaries 72,250 14.79% 182,000 23.40% e. Sales Bonuses 2,000 0.41% 2,000 0.26% f. Sales Commission 6,300 1.29% 10,800 1.39% g. Supervisor Salaries 30,000 6.14% 60,000 7.71% h. Travel Expense 6,700 1.37% 10,400 1.34% i. Miscellaneous Selling Expense 900 0.18% 1,200 0.15% j. Depreciation (Variable Assets) 7,598 1.56% 15,200 1.95% Total Variable Expenses 147,953 28.23% 318,000 40.88%

1. Fixed (Administrative) Expenses a. Admin. Fees- Legal/Acct. 2,048 0.42% 3,050 0.39% b. Insurance (Liab,Cas,Fire,Theft) 5,802 1.19% 11,600 1.49% c. Licenses and Permits 4,200 0.86% 4,200 0.54% d. Machinery, Tools, Equipment 6,700 1.37% 7,700 0.99% e. Office Salaries 21,000 4.30% 42,000 5.40% f. Owner's Guaranteed Payment 32,502 6.65% 65,000 8.36% g. Rent Expense + Security Dep. 22,800 4.67% 39,900 5.13% h. Utilities 2,160 0.44% 4,320 0.56% i. Miscellaneous Fixed Expense 400 0.08% 500 0.06% j. Depreciation (Fixed Assets) 0 0.00% 0 0.00% Total Fixed Expenses 97,612 19.98% 178,270 22.92%

Total Operating Expense 245,565 48.21% 496,270 63.80%

Net Income From Operations 152,015 33.16% 180,564 23.21% Other Income (Interest) 625 0.13% 1,250 0.16% Other Expense (Interest) 2,918 0.60% 5,535 0.71% Net Profit (Loss) Before Taxes 149,722 32.69% 176,279 22.66% Provision for Income Taxes a. Federal 41,642 8.52% 51,999 6.68% b. State 11,230 2.30% 13,221 1.70%

NET PROFIT (LOSS) AFTER TAXES 96,850 21.87% 111,059 14.28%

19

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

240

Balance Sheet

Business Name: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Date: December 31, 2007

ASSETS % of LIABILITIES % of Assets Liabilities

Current Assets Current Liabilities Cash $ 31,178 15.83% Accounts Payable $ 0 0.00% Savings (Land & Building) $ 100,000 50.77% Notes Payable $ 16,332 26.81% Petty Cash $ 0 0.00% Interest Payable $ 0 0.00% Accounts Receivable $ 0 0.00% Pre-Paid Deposits $ 0 0.00% Inventory $ 5,000 2.54%

Taxes Payable Accrued Federal Income Tax $ 0 0.00%

Long Term Investments $ 0 0.00% Accrued State Income Tax $ 0 0.00% Accrued Payroll Tax $ 0 0.00% Accrued Sales Tax $ 0 0.00%

Fixed Assets Land (valued at cost) $ 0 0.00% Payroll Accrual $ 0 0.00%

Buildings $ 0 0.00% Long Term Liabilities 1. Cost 0 Notes Payable to Investors $ 0 0.00% 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0 Notes Payable Others $ 44,587 73.19%

Improvements $ 0 0.00% 1. Cost 0 TOTAL LIABILITIES $ 60,919 100.00% 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0

Equipment $ 12,800 6.50% 1. Cost 16,000 % of 2. Less Acc. Depr. 3,200 NET WORTH (EQUITY) Net Worth

Furniture $ 0 0.00% 1. Cost 0 Corporation 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0

Capital Stock $ 20,000 14.70% Autos/Vehicles $ 48,000 24.37% 1. Cost 60,000 Surplus Paid In $ 5,000 3.67% 2. Less Acc. Depr. 12,000

Retained Earnings, Appropriated $ 100,000 73.50%

Other Assets Retained Earnings $ 11,059 8.13% 1. $ 0 0.00% Unappropriated 2. $ 0 0.00%

TOTAL NET WORTH $ 136,059 100.00% Assets - Liabilities = Net Worth

TOTAL ASSETS $ 196,978 100.00% and Liabilities + Equity = Total Assets

1. See Financial Statement Analysis for ratios and notations

20

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

241

Break-Even Analysis Based on 2007 Financial Statements – Not a Projection

Dayne Landscrping

Date of Analysis: December 31, 2007 10

E X 9 P E 8 N S 7 E T 6 O & T 5 A R Variable L E 4 Costs V E E 3 X N P U 2 E E N 1 Fixed S $ Costs E $ 0 S 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 DOLLARS SALES VOLUME NOTE: Figures shown in hundreds of thousands of dollars (Ex: 4 = $ 400,000)

Break-Even Point Calculation

B-E POINT (SALES) = Fixed costs + [(Variable Costs/Est. Revenues) X Sales]

B-E Point (Sales) = $ 183,805 + [ ( $ 419,030 / $ 777,864 ) X Sales ]

B-E Point (Sales) = $ 183,805 + [ ..5487 X Sales ]

S - .5387S = $183,805 S - .5387S = $183,805 .4613S = $183,805

S = $183,805/.4613 Break-Even Point S = $398,450 *rounded figure

FC (Fixed Costs) = (Administrative Expenses + Interest) $ 183,805 VC ( Variable Costs ) = (Cost of Goods + Selling Expenses) $ 419,030 R ( Est. Revenues ) = (Income from sale of products and services) $ 777,864

Break-Even Point = $ 398,444

21

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

242

2008 Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement Page 1 (January thru June)

Dayne Landscaping, Inc. For the Year 2008 Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun

BEGINNING CASH BALANCE 131,178 137,633 140,273 139,746 45,856 115,074 CASH RECEIPTS A. Sales/Revenues 123,850 89,100 184,400 169,200 200,600 192,900 1. Landscaping - Residential 0 0 41,000 21,000 23,000 24,000 2. Landscaping - Small Business 0 0 56,500 50,500 40,000 39,500 3. Landscaping - Large Corporations 0 0 73,500 57,200 55,100 51,000 4. Customized Landscaping 0 0 13,400 40,500 82,500 78,400 5. Snow Removal - Residential 11,050 5,700 0 0 0 0 6. Snow Removal - Small Business 66,900 53,000 0 0 0 0 7. Snow Removal - Large Corporations 45,900 30,400 0 0 0 0 8. 5% Snow Removal Contracts 0 0 0 0 0 0 B. Interest Income 108 110 109 110 109 110 C. Sale of Long-Term Assets 0 0 0 0 0 0 TOTAL CASH AVAILABLE 255,136 226,843 324,782 309,056 246,565 308,084 CASH PAYMENTS A. Cost of goods to be sold 1. Fertilizer 0 0 10,700 12,800 9,800 3,100 2. Pesticide 0 0 6,250 2,400 5,500 3,500 3. Plants/Shrub 0 0 16,100 13,000 3,500 3,200 4. Salt/Sand 5,375 0 0 0 0 0 5. Seed 0 0 21,000 41,500 24,500 5,000 Total Cost of Goods 5,375 0 54,050 69,700 43,300 14,800 B. Variable Expenses 1. Design Specialists (2 - w/taxes & benefits) 5,834 5,834 5,834 5,834 5,834 5,834 2. Machinery, Tools, Equipment 350 6,000 0 500 500 1,000 3. Marketing 3,500 6,500 6,500 3,500 3,500 5,000 4. Part-time Worker Salaries (w/ taxes) 23,500 30,000 37,600 40,000 39,000 38,033 5. Sales Bonuses 0 2,000 2,500 500 6. Sales Commissions 0 0 1,100 5,750 2,250 1,500 7. Supervisor Salaries (w/taxes & benefits) 7,500 7,500 15,000 15,000 15,000 15,000 8. Travel Expense 550 850 1,200 1,300 1,200 860 9. Miscellaneous Selling Expense 500 500 500 500 500 500 Total Variable Expenses 41,734 59,184 70,234 72,884 67,784 67,727 C. Fixed Expenses 1. Administration Fees - Legal/Accounting 509 508 508 2,250 508 508 2. Insurance (Liab, Casualty, Fire/Theft, W Comp) 704 714 735 739 737 736 3. Licenses and Permits 100 200 750 2,350 1,300 1,025 4. Office Equipment 1,750 8,650 1,100 900 825 525 5. Office Salaries (w/taxes & benefits) 5,250 5,250 5,250 5,250 5,250 5,250 6. Owner's Guaranteed Payment 6,833 6,833 6,833 6,833 6,833 6,833 7. Rent Expense 2,850 2,850 2,850 0 0 0 8. Utilities 480 463 360 376 247 378 9. Miscellaneous Administrative Expense 200 200 200 200 200 200 Total Fixed Expenses 18,676 25,668 18,586 18,898 15,900 15,455 D. Interest Expense (Vehicles, Equipment) 406 397 389 380 371 362 E. Interest Expense (Land & Buildings) 0 0 0 0 2,062 2,057 F. Federal Income Tax 0 0 33,249 0 0 33,249 G. State Tax 0 0 7,199 0 0 7,199 H. Capital Asset Purch, Cash (Land & Buildings)* 0 0 0 375,000 0 0 I. Capital Asset Purch, Cash (Vehicles, Equip)** 50,000 0 0 0 0 48,000 J. Loan Repayment (Land & Buildings) 0 0 0 0 727 732 K. Loan Repayment (Vehicles, Equipment) 1,312 1,321 1,329 1,338 1,347 1,356 TOTAL CASH PAID OUT 117,503 86,570 185,036 538,200 131,491 190,937 CASH BALANCE/DEFICIENCY 137,633 140,273 139,746 (229,144) 115,074 117,147 LOAN TO BE RECEIVED (Land & Buildings) 0 0 0 275,000 0 0 EQUITY DEPOSITS 0 0 0 0 0 0

ENDING CASH BALANCE 137,633 140,273 139,746 45,856 115,074 117,147

22

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

243

2008 Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement Page 2 (July thru December + 6 & 12-month Totals)

Dayne Landscaping, Inc. 6-MONTH 12-MONTH TOTALS Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec TOTALS

131,178 117,147 122,610 104,184 100,611 119,509 110,104 131,178

960,050 149,400 138,000 122,000 83,900 67,090 87,760 1,608,200 109,000 24,000 24,000 24,000 24,000 0 0 205,000 186,500 33,400 32,000 30,000 28,000 0 0 309,900 236,800 28,000 35,000 30,500 12,900 0 0 343,200 214,800 64,000 47,000 37,500 9,000 372,300 16,750 0 0 0 0 5,000 6,750 28,500

119,900 0 0 0 0 30,000 42,410 192,310 76,300 0 0 0 0 25,090 38,600 139,990

0 0 0 0 10,000 7,000 0 17,000 656 109 109 109 110 110 110 1,313

0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1,091,884 266,656 260,719 226,293 184,621 186,709 197,974 1,740,691

36,400 7,600 4,000 0 0 0 0 48,000 17,650 4,500 1,850 0 0 0 0 24,000 35,800 1,700 2,700 2,300 1,500 0 0 44,000 5,375 0 0 0 0 4,700 5,000 15,075

92,000 2,000 2,000 0 0 0 0 96,000 187,225 15,800 10,550 2,300 1,500 4,700 5,000 227,075

35,004 5,834 5,834 5,834 5,834 5,834 5,834 70,008 8,350 10,000 650 0 0 350 475 19,825

28,500 3,500 3,500 3,500 6,500 6,500 3,500 55,500 208,133 42,000 39,400 38,000 14,000 19,000 21,500 382,033

5,000 500 500 6,000 10,600 500 500 0 2,500 5,000 2,500 21,600 75,000 15,000 15,000 15,000 15,000 15,000 15,000 165,000 5,960 940 1,130 970 400 400 600 10,400 3,000 500 500 500 500 500 500 6,000

379,547 78,274 66,514 63,804 44,734 53,084 50,409 736,366

4,791 508 508 509 508 508 509 7,841 4,365 742 741 739 705 712 716 8,720 5,725 1,175 500 405 295 200 100 8,400

13,750 250 450 350 200 200 200 15,400 31,500 5,250 5,250 5,250 5,250 5,250 5,250 63,000 40,998 6,833 6,833 6,834 6,834 6,834 6,834 82,000 8,550 0 0 0 0 0 0 8,550 2,304 457 432 286 329 360 387 4,555 1,200 250 250 250 250 250 250 2,700

113,183 15,465 14,964 14,623 14,371 14,314 14,246 201,166 2,305 353 344 335 325 316 306 4,284 4,119 2,051 2,046 2,040 2,035 2,029 2,023 16,343

66,498 0 0 33,249 0 0 33,249 132,996 14,398 0 0 7,199 0 0 7,200 28,797

375,000 0 0 0 0 0 0 375,000 98,000 30,000 60,000 0 0 0 0 188,000 1,459 738 743 749 754 760 766 5,969 8,003 1,365 1,374 1,383 1,393 1,402 1,412 16,332

1,249,737 144,046 156,535 125,682 65,112 76,605 114,611 1,932,328 (157,853) 122,610 104,184 100,611 119,509 110,104 83,363 (191,637)

275,000 0 0 0 0 0 0 275,000 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

117,147 122,610 104,184 100,611 119,509 110,104 83,363 83,363

23

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

244

Three Year Income Projection Dayne Landscaping, Inc.

Updated: December 31, 2007 YEAR 1 YEAR 2 YEAR 3 TOTAL 2008 2009 2010 3 YEARS

INCOME 1. SALES/REVENUES 1,608,200 2,010,250 2,311,788 5,930,238 a. Landscaping - Residential 205,000 256,250 294,688 755,938 b. Landscaping - Small Business 309,900 387,375 445,481 1,142,756 c. Landscaping - Large Corporations 343,200 429,000 493,350 1,265,550 d. Customized Landscaping 372,300 465,375 535,181 1,372,856 e. Snow Removal - Residential 28,500 35,625 40,969 105,094 f. Snow Removal - Small Business 192,310 240,388 276,446 709,143 g. Snow Removal - Large Corporations 139,990 174,988 201,236 516,213 h. 5% Snow Removal Contracts 17,000 21,250 24,438 62,688 2. Cost of Goods Sold (c-d) 222,075 273,844 323,420 819,339 Cost of Goods (as a Percentage of Sales) 13.81% 13.62% 13.99% 13.82% a. Beginning Inventory 5,000 10,000 20,000 5,000 b. Purchases 227,075 283,844 326,420 837,339 (1) Fertilizer 48,000 60,000 69,000 177,000 (2) Pesticide 24,000 30,000 34,500 88,500 (3) Plants/Shrubs 44,000 55,000 63,250 162,250 (4) Salt/Sand 15,075 18,844 21,670 55,589 (5) Seed 96,000 120,000 138,000 354,000 c. C.O.G. Avail. Sale (a+b) 232,075 293,844 346,420 842,339 d. Less Ending Iventory (12/31) 10,000 20,000 23,000 23,000 3. GROSS PROFIT ON SALES (1-2) 1,386,125 1,736,406 1,988,367 5,110,898 Gross Profit ( as a Percentage of Sales) 86.19% 86.38% 86.01% 86.18% EXPENSES 1. VARIABLE (Selling) (a thru j) 772,933 916,341 1,027,822 2,717,097 Selling Expenses (as a Percentage of Sales) 48.06% 45.58% 44.46% 45.82% a. Design Specialist Salaries/PayrollTaxes 70,008 77,000 84,700 231,708 b. Machinery, Tools, Equipment 19,825 15,000 17,000 51,825 c. Marketing 55,500 55,000 55,000 165,500 d. Part-time Worker Salaries/PayrollTaxes 382,033 477,541 549,172 1,408,747 e. Sales Bonuses 6,000 13,500 18,500 38,000 f . Sales Commission 21,600 24,000 27,000 72,600 g. Supervisor Salaries/Payroll Taxes 165,000 181,500 199,650 546,150 h. Travel expense 10,400 12,000 14,000 36,400 i . Miscellaneous Selling Expense 6,000 8,000 10,000 24,000 j . Depreciation (Product/Service Assets) 36,567 52,800 52,800 142,167 2. FIXED (Administrative) (a thru j) 209,916 246,967 290,467 747,350 Admin. Expenses (as a Percentage of Sales) 13.05% 12.29% 12.56% 12.60% a. Administration Fees- Legal/Acct. 7,841 7,800 7,800 23,441 b. Insurance - Liability, Casualty, Fire/Theft, 8,720 10,500 12,000 31,220 c. Licenses and Permits 8,400 10,300 12,200 30,900 d. Office Equipment 15,400 30,800 45,200 91,400 e. Office Salaries/Payroll Taxes 63,000 77,000 91,000 231,000 f . Owner's Guaranteed Payment 82,000 90,000 100,000 272,000 g. Rent Expense 8,550 0 0 8,550 h. Utilities 4,555 5,500 6,500 16,555 i . Miscellaneous Administrative Expense 2,700 3,400 4,100 10,200 j . Depreciation (Facility, Admin. Assets) 8,750 11,667 11,667 32,084 TOTAL OPERATING EXPENSES (1+2) 982,849 1,163,308 1,318,289 3,464,447 NET INCOME OPERATIONS (G.Profit - Expenses) 403,276 573,098 670,078 1,646,452 Net Income Operations (as a Percentage of Sales) 25.08% 28.51% 28.99% 27.76% OTHER INCOME (Interest Income) 1,313 1,378 1,447 4,138 OTHER EXPENSE (Interest Expense) 20,627 28,105 25,844 74,576 NET PROFIT (LOSS) BEFORE TAXES 383,962 546,371 645,681 1,576,014 TAXES 1. Federal, S-Employment 132,996 196,335 235,066 564,397 2. State 28,797 40,978 48,426 118,201 3. Local 0 0 0 0

NET PROFIT (LOSS) AFTER TAXES 222,169 309,058 362,189 893,416

Net Profit (Loss) (as a Percentage of Sales) 13.81% 15.37% 15.67% 15.07%

24

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

245

Projected Balance Sheet

Business Name: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Projected for: December 31, 2008

ASSETS % of LIABILITIES % of

Assets Liabilities Current Assets Current Liabilities Cash $ 83,363 12.41% Accounts Payable $ 0 0.00% Petty Cash $ 0 0.00% Notes Payable $ 27,337 8.72% Accounts Receivable $ 0 0.00% Interest Payable $ 0 0.00% Inventory $ 10,000 1.49% Pre-Paid Deposits $ 0 0.00% Short Term Investments $ 0 0.00%

Taxes Payable Accrued Federal Income Tax $ 0 0.00%

Long Term Investments $ 0 0.00% Accrued State Income Tax $ 0 0.00% Accrued Payroll Tax $ 0 0.00% Accrued Sales Tax $ 0 0.00%

Fixed Assets Land (valued at cost) $ 200,000 29.77% Payroll Accrual $ 0 0.00%

Buildings $ 163,050 24.27% Long Term Liabilities 1. Cost 175,000 Notes Payable to Investors $ 0 0.00% 2. Less Acc. Depr. 11,950 Notes Payable Others $ 286,281 91.28%

Improvements $ 0 0.00% 1. Cost 0 TOTAL LIABILITIES $ 313,618 100.00% 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0

Equipment $ 92,833 13.82% 1. Cost 104,000 % of 2. Less Acc. Depr. 11,167 NET WORTH (EQUITY) Net Worth

Furniture $ 0 0.00% 1. Cost 0 Corporation 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0

Capital Stock $ 20,000 5.58% Autos/Vehicles $ 122,600 18.25% 1. Cost 160,000 Surplus Paid In $ 5,000 1.40% 2. Less Acc. Depr. 37,400

Retained Earnings, Appropriated $ 333,228 93.02%

Other Assets Retained Earnings $ 0 0.00% 1. $ 0 0.00% Unappropriated 2. $ 0 0.00%

TOTAL NET WORTH $ 358,228 100.00% Assets - Liabilities = Net Worth

TOTAL ASSETS $ 671,846 100.00% and Liabilities + Equity = Total Assets

1. See Financial Statement Analysis for ratios and notations

25

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

246

FINANCIAL STATEMENT ANALYSIS SUMMARY The following is a summary of Dayne Landscaping, Inc. 2007 and 2008 financial statement analysis information, as developed on the next 3 pages of spreadsheets (pages 29-31) :

*Author notation: Writer must research industry standards. 2007 2008 INDUSTRY HISTORICAL PROJECTED STANDARD

1. Net Working Capital $119,846 $66,026 $80,000 + or - 2. Current Ratio 8.34 3.42 2.0 + 3. Quick Ratio 8.03 3.05 1.0 + or - 4. Gross Profit Margin 87.01% 86.19% 85.0% 5. Operating Profit Margin 23.21% 25.08% 25.0% 6. Net Profit Margin 14.28% 13.81% 14% 7. Debt to Assets 30.93% 46.68% 33.0% - 8. Debt to Equity 44.77% 87.55% 100% - 9. ROI (Return on Investment 56.38% 33.07% 24% +

10. Vertical Income Statement Analysis * Sales/Revenues 100.00% 100.0% Cost of Goods 12.99% 13.81% 15.0% + or - Gross Profit 87.01% 86.19% 85.0% Operating Expense 63.80% 61.11% 62.0% + or - Net Income Operations 23.21% 25.08% 23.0% + or - Interest Income 0.16% 0.08% N/A Variable Interest Expense 0.71% 1.28% 4.0% Variable Net Profit (Pre-Tax) 22.66% 23.88% 19.0% + or - * All items stated as % of Total Revenues

11. Vertical Balance Sheet Analysis Current Assets 69.14% 13.90% 18.0% + Inventory 2.54% 1.49% 2.0% Total Assets 100.0% 100.00% Current Liabilities 8.29% 4.07% 15.0% - Total Liabilities 30.93% 46.68% 50.0% - Net Worth 69.07% 53.32% 50.0% + Total Liabilities + Net 100.0% 100.00% * All Asset items stated as % of Total Assets; Liability & Net Worth items stated as % of Total Liabilities + Net Worth

Notes: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. has taken advantage of a rapidly-increasing marketplace, and has also neatly incorporated snow removal services to increase revenues significantly during winter months. The company earned an unusually high 2007 net profit for a start-up service business ($111,059). Debt Ratios (Debt:Assets, 30.93% and Debt:Equity, 44.77%) are better than industry average. A 2008 beginning cash balance of $131,178, with no current liabilities other than $16,332 of notes payable on a previous loan, give the company sufficient marketing funds to expand services into the corporate landscaping and design areas. The purchase of their present facility, currently under a lease agreement (using $100,000 cash + $275,000 loan funds) will not raise the Debt to Equity Ratio (projected at 87.55%) beyond a safe limit. Projections indicate high sales growth with the acquisition of new personnel, vehicles, and equipment to service the increased customer base. The company is experiencing rapid, but controlled growth. Financial projections indicate that the company will be more than able to fulfill its obligations to repay the $275,000 loan with interest and still maintain good cash flow and increased profitability.

26

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

247

Financial Statement Analysis

Ratio Table Dayne Landscaping, Inc.

Type of Analysis Formula Historical: 2007 Projected: 2008

1. Liquidity Analysis Balance Sheet Current Assets 136,178 Current Assets 93,363 Current Assets Current Liabilities 16,332 Current Liabilities 27,337

a. Net Working Capital Current Liabilities Net Working Capital $119,846 $66,026 Balance Sheet Current Assets 136,178 Current Assets 93,363

b. Current Ratio Current Assets Current Liabilities 16,332 Current Liabilities 27,337 Current Liabilities Current Ratio 8.34 Current Ratio 3.42 Balance Sheet Current Assets 136,178 Current Assets 93,363

c. Quick Ratio Current Assets minus Inventory Inventory 5,000 Inventory 10,000 Current Liabilities Current Liabilities 16,332 Current Liabilities 27,337 Quick Ratio 8.03 Quick Ratio 3.05

2. Profitability Analysis Income Statement Gross Profits 676,834 Gross Profits 1,386,125

a. Gross Profit Margin _Gross Profits_ Sales 777,864 Sales 1,608,200 Sales Gross Profit Margin 87.01% Gross Profit Margin 86.19%

b. Operating _Income From Operations_ Income From Ops. 180,564 Income From Ops. 403,276 Profit Margin Sales Sales 777,864 Sales 1,608,200

23.21% Op. Profit Margin 25.08%

c. Net Profit Margin __Net Profits__ Net Profits 111,059 Net Profits 222,169 Sales Sales 777,864 Sales 1,608,200 14.28% 13.81%

4. Debt Ratios Balance Sheet Total Liabilities 60,919 Total Liabilities 313,618 Total Liabilities_ Total Assets 196,978 Total Assets 671,846

a. Debt to Assets Total Assets Debt to Assets Ratio 30.93% Debt to Assets Ratio 46.68% ___Total Liabilities___ Total Liabilities 60,919 Total Liabilities 313,618

b. Debt to Equity Total Owners' Equity Total Owners' Equity 136,059 Total Owners' Equity 358,228 Debt to Equity Ratio 44.77% Debt to Equity Ratio 33.07%

4. Investment Measures Balance Sheet Net Profits 111,059 Net Profits 222,169

a. ROI Net Profits__ Total Assets 196,978 Total Assets 671,846 (Return on Investment) Total Assets ROI (Ret. on Invest.) 56.38% ROI (Ret. on Invest.) 33.07%

Balance Sheet NOTE: NOTE: 1. Each asset % of Total Assets

5. Vertical Financial 2. Liability & Equity % Total L&E See Attached See Statement Analysis Income Statement Balance Analysis - page 31 Projected Balance Sheet - 27

3. All items % of Total Revenues Income Analysis – page 30 3-Year Income Statement - 26

Balance Sheet 1. Assets, Liab & Equity measured NOTE: NOTE: against 2nd year. Increases and

6. Horizontal Financial decreases stated as amount & % Horizontal Analysis Horizontal Analysis Statement Analysis Income Statement Not Applicable Not Applicable

2. Revenues & Expenses measured against 2nd year. Increases and Only one year in business Only one year in business decreases stated as amount & %

27

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

248

2007 Historical Vertical Income Statement Analysis

Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Begin - January 1, 2007 End - December 31, 2007

A M O U N T % Total INCOME Revenues 1. Sales/Revenues $ 777,864 100.00% a. Landscaping - Residential 216,000 27.77% b. Landscaping - Small Business 160,700 20.66% c. Customized Landscaping 199,374 25.63% d. Snow Removal - Residential 18,250 2.35% e. Snow Removal - Small Business 167,100 21.48% f . 5% Snow Removal Contracts 8,500 1.09% g. Miscellaneous Accessories 7,940 1.02% 2. Cost of Goods Sold (c-d) 101,030 12.99% a. Beginning Inventory 0 0.00% b. Purchases 106,030 13.63% (1) Fertilizer 19,000 2.44% (2) Pesticide 11,000 1.41% (3) Plants/Shrubs 23,000 2.96% (4) Salt/Sand 8,030 1.03% (1) Seed 45,000 5.79% c. C.O.G. Avail. Sale (a+b) 106,030 13.63% d. Less Ending Inventory (12/31) 5,000 0.64% 3. Gross Profit on Sales (1-2) $ 676,834 87.01%

EXPENSES 1. Variable (Selling) (a thru j) 318,000 40.88% a. Design Specialist Salary/Payroll Taxes 20,000 2.57% b. Machinery, Hand Tools, Equipment 11,000 1.41% c. Marketing 5,400 0.69% d. Part-time Worker Salaries 182,000 23.40% e. Sales Bonuses 2,000 0.26% f. Sales Commission 10,800 1.39% g. Supervisor Salaries/Payroll Taxes 60,000 7.71% h. Travel Expense 10,400 1.34% i. Miscellaneous Variable Expense 1,200 0.15% j. Depreciation (Product/Services Assets) 15,200 1.95% 2. Fixed (Administrative) (a thru j) 178,270 22.92% a. Administration Fees - Legal/Accounting 3,050 0.39% b. Insurance (Liab, Casualty, Fire/Theft) 11,600 1.49% c. Licenses & Permits 4,200 0.54% d. Office Equipment 7,700 0.99% e. Office Salaries/Payroll Taxes 42,000 5.40% f. Owner's Guaranteed Payment 65,000 8.36% g. Rent Expense 39,900 5.13% h. Utilities 4,320 0.56% i. Miscellaneous Fixed Expense 500 0.06% j. Depreciation (Administrative Assets) 0 0.00% Total Operating Expenses (1+2) 496,270 63.80% Net Income from Operations (GP-Exp) $ 180,564 23.21% Other Income (Interest Income) 1,250 0.16% Other Expense (Interest Expense) 5,535 0.71% Net Profit (Loss) Before Taxes $ 176,279 22.66% TAXES: a. Federal 51,999 6.68% b. State 13,221 65,220 1.70% c. Local 0 0.00% NET PROFIT (LOSS) AFTER TAXES $ 111,059 14.28%

28

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

249

2007 Historical Vertical Balance Sheet Analysis

(All Asset percentages = % of Total Assets; All Liability or Equity percentages = % of Total Liabilities + Total Equity)

Analysis of Historical Balance Sheet Date of Balance Sheet: December 31, 2007

Dayne Landscaping, Inc.

% of % of ASSETS Total LIABILITIES Total

Assets L + NW Current Assets Current Liabilities Cash $ 131,178 66.60% Accounts Payable $ 0 0.00% Petty Cash $ 0 0.00% Notes Payable $ 16,332 8.29% Sales Tax Holding Account $ 0 0.00% Interest Payable $ 0 0.00% Accounts Receivable $ 0 0.00% Pre-Paid Deposits $ 0 0.00% Inventory $ 5,000 2.54% Short-Term Investments $ 0 0.00% Taxes Payable

Accrued Federal Income Tax $ 0 0.00% Long Term Investments $ 0 0.00% Accrued State Income Tax $ 0 0.00%

Accrued Payroll Tax $ 0 0.00% Fixed Assets Accrued Sales Tax $ 0 0.00% Land (valued at $ 0 0.00%

Payroll Accrual $ 0 0.00% Buildings $ 0 0.00% 1. Cost 0 Long Term Liabilities 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0 Notes Payable to Investors $ 0 0.00%

Notes Payable to Others $ 44,587 22.64% Improvements $ 0 0.00% 1. Cost 0 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0 TOTAL LIABILITIES $ 60,919 30.93%

Equipment $ 12,800 6.50% 1. Cost 16,000 2. Less Acc. Depr. 3,200 NET WORTH (EQUITY)

Furniture $ 0 0.00% Corporation 1. Cost 0 2. Less Acc. Depr. 0 Capital Stock $ 20,000 10.15%

Autos/Vehicles $ 48,000 24.37% Surplus Paid In $ 5,000 2.54% 1. Cost 60,000 2. Less Acc. Depr. 12,000 Retained Earnings, $ 100,000 50.77%

Appropriated

Other Assets Retained Earnings, $ 11,059 5.61% 1. $ 0 0.00% Unappropriated 2. $ 0 0.00%

TOTAL NET WORTH $ 136,059 69.07%

TOTAL ASSETS $ 196,978 100.00% LIABILITIES + NET WORTH $ 196,978 100.00% Assets - Liabilities = Net Worth -or- Liabilities + Equity = Assets

29

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

250

Financial Assumptions Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

Seeking Bank Loan

• Purpose: To purchase land and facilities currently leased by Dayne Landscaping, Inc. • Projected Terms: $275,000 for 15 Years @ 9%; need funding by April 1, 2008,

repayments can begin on May 1, 2008 (see amortization schedule C)

Financial Assumptions

• $25,000 initial capital contribution by owner in corporation (not a loan).

• 5% required up front fees for all snow contracts.

• 5% Sales Commission to be paid to sales representatives..

• Bonuses of $500 each to be paid for landing new corporate accounts.

• Salaries for (4) Supervisors @ $15,000, totaling $60,000. (+ benefits and payroll taxes)

• Salary for the President to be guaranteed @ $65,000 for 2001; projected raise to $82,000 for 2002.

• Salary for the Office Manager @ $22,000 (+ benefits and payroll taxes).

• Salary for Administration Assistants (1 in 2001, 2 in 2002) @ $15000 (+ payroll taxes and benefits).

• Salary for part time people at $7.00 per hour. Hired as needed to meet volume

• Licensing permit fees with City and State during the year.

• Rent deposit at $5,700 for first and last month.

• Heat and Electricity at $60 per sq. ft, totaling $360 per month, and $4.320 per year.

• Fire and Liability Insurance at $50 per sq. ft, totaling $300 per month, and $3,600 per year.

• All insurance at $8,000 per year. The total cost of insurance at $11,600.

• 2 Trucks purchased with 2001 loan: $60,000 @ 8%; interest 5-year period = $12,995.05 (see amortizing schedule A)

• 4 Large Mowers purchased with 2001 loan: $16,000 @ 8%; interest 3-year period = $2049.79 (see amortizing schedule B)

• State Income Taxes charges at 7.5% of net profits.

• Federal Income Taxes based on Federal Corporation Tax Schedule (15%-25%-34%-39% of net profits)

• Estimated Taxes paid on schedule quarterly, based on actual and projected net profits for 2007 and 2008.

• Ending inventory: 2007 = $5,000; 2008 projected at $10,000

30

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

251

Dayne Landscaping, Inc.

Part IV – Supporting Documents *

Competition Comparison Owner’s Resume Letter of Reference Quarterly Budget Analysis

* Note: For purposes of brevity, we have chosen to include only a portion of the supporting documents that would be found in Dayne Landscaping, Inc’s business plan.

Competition Comparison Vendor Garden Shop Landscaping Plus Dayne Landscaping

Landscaping Design Yes Yes Yes Oriental design No No Yes Maintenance Yes Yes Yes Pest control No No Yes Snow Services Plowing Yes Yes Yes Removal No No No Response time Whenever Whenever Designated Guarantee No No Yes

Servicing NH only NH, MA NH, MA, CT Price per hour $25-30 $30-35 $20- 30

31

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

252

Robin T. Dayne 181 Thoreaus Landing

Nashua, NH 03060 603-888-2020 (W) 603-889-2293 (H)

Summary Five years’ experience in the Landscaping Industry. Skilled in sales, support and operations of new accounts for an established landscaping company. Managed office of 10 employees related to customer service. Proficient in management and workings of the landscaping service industry. Knowledgeable in landscaping design, and planning.

Experience

Landscaping Plus, Nashua, NH 1998 – 2006

Office Manager, Jan. 2005-December 2006 Managed 10 employees that sold and serviced customer accounts. Responsible for planning scheduling, and managing inventory (equipment and tools) for the ten employees. Implemented the first “customer satisfaction survey” over the phone, to the entire base of customer’s.

• Developed a tool “check-in” process saving the company $10,000 a year in lost inventory.

• Organized the telemarketing necessary for the customer survey resulting in additional sales revenue of $25,000

• Implemented and managed service issue “hot line” for dissatisfied customers.

• Responsible for all major accounts and employees that worked at the sites

Account Supervisor, Dec. 2003 – Dec. 2004 Managed 20 assigned accounts for landscaping and snow maintenance.

Responsible for reporting to the President all account updates and potential revenue opportunities.

• Maintained the 20 accounts by scheduling all part-time workers • Trained part-time employees in proper lawn care maintenance • Managed the inventory, equipment and supplies of each worker • Managed all customer service issues and received excellence award

for all accounts at the end of the year. • Scheduled all snow removal and coordinated snow emergencies

32

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

253

Account Landscaping Specialist, June 2001 – Nov. 2003

• Worked the landscaping contract of a large corporate account • Recommended landscaping design changes and secured additional contract

with company • Provide snow removal during storm and emergencies • Learned the operation of all landscaping equipment, tools and vehicles

Equipment Rental, Inc., Nashua, NH Jan. 1996 – May 2001

Service Desk Manager

• Responsible for handling any service issues related to the renting of the company’s equipment or machinery

• Managed all bill disputes to resolution • Interfaced with office manager on large account problems • Recommended improvements in the problem solving process that

resulted in speedy results for the customers

Personal Strengths

Excellent organizational and communication skills Dedicated to customer service excellence Strong management training and experience Strong knowledge of landscaping industry

Education Completed Bachelors Degree in Horticulture at the University of New Hampshire. Independent studies at the Institute for Higher Learning majoring in Environmental Protection.

Affiliations and Interests

Board member of the Nashua Chamber of Commerce Committee member of the City’s “Beautification Program” Volunteer at Community Services of Nashua

33

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix II: Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan

254

rtd Marketing International, Inc. 81 Walden Pond Ave., Nashua, NH 03060

November 22, 2007 Dear Prospective Investor, I am delighted to have the opportunity to write this letter of recommendation for Robin T. Dayne. We have had a contract with Dayne Landscaping, Inc. since February. We came to them initially for snow removal because the company we were using could not guarantee our facility would be plowed by 7:00 am, which we needed in order for our employees to park for work. Dayne Landscaping was able to provide us that guarantee and did an excellent job of fulfilling their commitment, during some very tough storms. We have since contacted with them for landscaping maintenance and have found the same quality of service. They recommended changes that would save us money and our property hasn’t looked this good in years. Recently we secured their services to install an Oriental garden, which is unique and attractive. Our international clientele has even commented on our unique landscaping and in our business, first impressions can mean everything. I would recommend them highly, based on their level of service, quality of work and commitment as well they should be considered for the funding they seek. If you have further questions, feel free to contact me. I can be reached on my private number 603-882-2221, during business hours. Cordially,

Heather Pope Heather Pope President

34

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

255

Appendix

III

Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

The business plan presented in Appendix III is an actual business plan developed for Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. using Anatomy of a Business Plan and its software companion, AUTOMATE YOUR BUSINESS PLAN. Mr. Paul Jarolimek II, President and CEO of the company (www.whinc.com) has generously allowed us to publish the plan in the new edition of our book and the new revision of our software. Wmhinc.com is modeled as an Internet Portal with primary focus on the housing industry. Their web site provides consumers the opportunity to design and purchase a home online. Wmhinc.com’s vision as an innovative, dynamic start up company is to provide services that will establish the Company as the premiere online provider of manufactured housing, industry information, and associated services. The Company was in the process of development and the business plan was written for the purpose of raising venture capital. The Company expected to raise the needed capital by the end of 2001 and begin operations in January 2002. They have since, renamed their company and expanded their focus.

Working with a business plan consultant Wmhinc.com’s business plan was developed by the owners of the business with professional assistance from a very reputable business plan consultant, Mr. Ndaba Mdhlongwa of Dallas, Texas (businessplanprofessionals.com -or- 972-241-1144). I also owe Mr. Mdhlongwa a debt of gratitude because he has put in many extra hours of volunteer time to work with me in preparing the business plan for presentation to my readers and software users. Many times, the owners of the business either feel too pressed for time to write their plans—or sometime they just feel that they would have more confidence in the result—if they could engage the services of a business plan professional. In this case, they found the right person to work with. Before you hire someone yourself, be sure that you know what you are getting into. Hiring the wrong person can be very costly both in terms of money and the quality of your business plan. Hiring the right person can be very beneficial.

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

256

This plan is for a more aggressive business Wmhinc.com is seeking venture capital in the amount of $10 million. As you learned in Chapter 1, investors become equity partners in your company. Because of the risks involved in venturing with a company, they are looking for rapid growth/profitability projections backed by reason. Therefore, you will notice that they have written their business plan with a heavy focus on the Summary Description of the Business, Marketing Plan, Sources and Uses of Financing, and Executive Summary.

• The Wmhinc.com marketing plan In Chapter 5, Part II, The Marketing Plan, you were presented with a very comprehensive list of marketing plan components, representing a full spectrum of marketing possibilities. Mr. Jarolimek, with the assistance of Mr. Mdhlongwa has addressed all of these components in the Wmhinc.com marketing plan. It is a good example of a very fine market planning effort.

• Financial documents

This is a plan for a start up company. For this reason, you will note that all of the financial documents are pro forma, or projected, spreadsheets. Only after the company has been in business for one accounting period will it have historical financial statements.

• Note the Executive Summary

Venture capitalists like to see an exciting Executive Summary. The one in this plan is an example of a more comprehensive one, addressing important highlights of the company and an Income Statement Summary for their Four-Phases of Development.

Thank you again to Mr. Paul Jarolimek and to Mr. Ndaba Mdhlongwa for allowing me to share this interpretation of business planning with our readers and software users. I know that it will be a great help to them as they write their plans.

Warning! The plan is to be examined for Wmhinc.com’s handling of content only. There is no judgement inferred as to appropriateness or financial potential for lenders or investors. Do not use this plan as a source of research for your own company. Please do not contact the company. Mr. Jarolimek has been generous in sharing his plan and I would not want to be responsible for taking up more of his valuable time. Also, remember that his name and other things have changed with his company. Names, links, addresses, or phone numbers in this document may no longer be valid.

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

257

Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc.

5300 W Sahara suite 101 PO Box 27740

Las Vegas, NV 89146 Telephone: 509-663-3876 URL: www.Wmhinc.com

Paul Jarolimek II: President and CEO

Mary Lou Jarolimek: CFO

Suzanne Jarolimek: Director of Customer Relations

Mike Gage: CTO

Kerry Lease: Executive VP of Marketing

Plan prepared November 2001 by the Corporate Officers

This confidential summary has been prepared for those wishing to establish a business relationship with Wmhinc.com, Inc. By accepting a copy of this document, the recipient agrees not to reproduce it in whole or in part, not to use it for any other purpose, and not to disclose any of its contents to third parties without written permission of Wmhinc.com, Inc. This document is a summary and not a prospectus for the purposes of a securities offering. It is furnished for information purposes only. No representation or warranty is made by Wmhinc.com, Inc. or any other entity as to the accuracy or completeness of such information, and nothing contained in the summary is, or shall be, relied on as a promise or representation to the future.

Copy 1 of 3

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

258

TABLE OF CONTENTS Executive Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1- 2

I. Organizational Plan................................... 3-10

Summary Description of Business (Mission, Model, Strategy, Risks) . . . . . . . . . . 3 Products and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Intellectual Property . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Legal Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Management and Personnel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9

Accounting & Legal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Insurance and Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 II. Marketing Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-23

Marketing Strategy Over view and Goals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Market Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-18 Target Markets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-13 Competition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-15 Market Trends .................................................................................…........ 15-17 Market Research: Additional Factors ...............................................…....... 17 Marketing Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-23 General Description and Methods of Sale and Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-18 Pricing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Sales Strategies and Incentives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-19 Advertising Strategies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-22 Traditional Advertising . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Web Advertising/New Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Long-term Sponsorships . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22 Public Relations and Networking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Customer Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Implementation of Marketing Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Assessment of Marketing Effectiveness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 III. Financial Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-35

Summary of Financial Needs and Dispersal of Investment Funds . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-26 Financial Assumptions for Wmhinc.com projections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-28 Three-Year Income Projections for 2002, 2003, 2004 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-31 Projected Balance Sheet for December 31, 2002 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Break-Even Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Financial Statement Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34-37 Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Ratio Analysis Table w/Ratio Calculations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 IV. Supporting Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36

Insurance Update Form . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36

Note. For brevity, only one of Wmhinc.com’s Supporting Documents has been included in this plan.

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

259

EXECUTIVE SUMMARY

Wmhinc.com is an innovative, dynamic start-up company providing services that will establish the Company as the premiere online provider of manufactured housing, industry information, and associated services. The web site provides consumers the opportunity to design and purchase a home online. Additionally, it provides comprehensive industry information, nationwide Associated Services Yellow Pages, and industry and government links.

The Company plans to establish itself as the "next generation provider" of manufactured homes, products, and related services and capture a sizable portion of this market in the next decade. Furthermore, Wmhinc.com is modeled as an Internet Portal, constructed and designed after well- known portals such as C/Net (information technology), CNNfn (finance), Showbiz (entertainment), WebMD (health and fitness), and Thrive Online (health and fitness) with primary focus on the housing industry.

HIGHLIGHTS of Wmhinc.com

• Management Experience. The Management team is highly qualified and capable in the areas of eCommerce, marketing, manufactured home, and housing related services.

• Industry knowledge. Wmhinc.com will leverage its knowledge of the industry to establish a dominating presence in its delivery of homes and related services to consumers.

• Web site. With its three-click ease of navigation, the consumer will be smoothly transported from the front page to a ‘state specific’ choice page. This second page will have multiple directions in which the customer may travel.

• Diverse Sources of Revenues. Unlike a number of other transaction-based businesses operating on the Internet, Wmhinc.com’s business model is not based on ‘click through’ advertising revenue nor is it based on subscription, membership dues, or user fees.

• Aggressive Marketing. Management is positioning Wmhinc.com to grow aggressively through strategic alliances, innovative marketing and branding programs, and first mover initiatives.

• Growing Market Segment. Today manufactured homes make up over 25% of new homes in the United States. Sales of new manufactured homes exceeded $16 billion in 1999, an increase of 400% in the last ten years. With new design elements and customizable options, manufactured homes have begun to cross over into the mainstream.

1

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

260

Management has developed a clear and defined path that will help establish the Company as the leading provider of manufactured housing, industry information, and associated services on the Internet. At the forefront of its model, is the establishment of departments that will handle various aspects of operations including the sale and distribution of new, factory over-run, and bank-owned homes. While the Company fully expects competition to materialize in some form, management also believes its business model will mitigate competitive threats and capitalize on the identified opportunity gaps such as geographic specialization/expertise, superior customer service and usability. Customers will be the focal point of the Wmhinc.com business model and overall strategy. All customers will be treated with respect, their housing choices made simple, and their decision making process made positive. Wmhinc.com will continually develop its customer network, continually striving to receive referrals from existing customers and visitors. Wmhinc.com has established strategic relationships with several leading industry specialists in the areas of financing, decoration, and manufacturing. By the first fiscal year, the Company expects to have set up additional partnerships with major manufacturers, state and national manufactured housing associations, relevant Internet partner suppliers, and other services providers thereby making Wmhinc.com a hub for manufactured homes and related services. In addition, these alliances will enable the Company to draw and retain a strong customer base. Wmhinc.com intends to derive its revenue from various business activities including:

• E-commerce revenues from the sale of new customer built homes • E-commerce revenues from the sale of factory over-run homes through partner suppliers • Fees and commissions paid by partner suppliers of Bank-Owned Homes • Sales of advertising space to service providers (exclusive, proprietary Yellow Pages) • Fees paid by regional and international Internet partner suppliers of Wmhinc.com for certain

exclusive rights • Fees paid by state and municipality commerce and tourism departments for placement referrals • E-commerce revenues and fees paid by land and community developers • Fees for design, positioning and management of ”Auction Sites“ for maximum speed in

disposing of large inventory blocks • Resale/income stream from company owned land and community developments

The company is seeking venture capital in the amount of $10 million for its Four-Phase Development. The company’s revenue projections for 2002, 2003, and 2004 are $17 million, $77 million, and $136 million, respectively.

Income Statement Summary 2002 2003 2004

Income $ 17,216,075 $ 77,631,985 $ 136,623,886 Variable Expenses 5,081,104 18,072,884 34,871,019 Fixed Expenses 1,427,176 6,449,120 11,107,191 Income Taxes 5,196,029 23,262,736 40,652,953 Net Income $ 5,511,766 $ 35,428,528 $ 51,675,986

2

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

261

Part I: ORGANIZATIONAL PLAN Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc

Summary Description of the Business Wmhinc.com is an innovative, dynamic start-up company providing services that will establish the Company as the premiere online provider of manufactured housing, industry information, and associated services. Mission At Wmhinc.com, our mission is to provide the most innovative and practical web based housing solutions. Wmhinc.com plans are to become a dominant player in the online marketplace, providing new, factory over-run, and bank-owned homes direct to the consumer. Business Model Wmhinc.com has developed a clear and defined path that will help establish the Company as the leading provider of manufactured housing, industry information, and associated services on the Internet. At the forefront of its model, is the establishment of a department that will sell and distribute new, factory over-run, and bank-owned homes, a department the Company believes will be the core of the business. Wmhinc.com will leverage its knowledge of the industry to establish a dominating presence in its delivery of homes and related services to consumers. The web site, with its ‘three click’ ease of navigation will smoothly transport the consumer from the front page to a ‘state specific’ choice page. This second page will have multiple directions in which the customer may travel. At Wmhinc.com, consumers are just one ‘click’ away from building a house online. The Wmhinc.com business model is based on strategic alliances with various manufacturing industry leaders. Through these alliances, the Company will showcase floor plans, option books, and color choice catalogs. The web site will also feature ‘Factory Special’ pages of pre-built homes which will allow consumers to find a new, factory over-run home that suits their needs within a specific state. Through the Associate Services Yellow Pages consumers will find help in installing their home, which may be accessed from the second page or from within the information areas. Also fully integrated with partner suppliers, will be the whole experience of buying, decorating, furnishing, moving in, and setting up a home in a simple, rich, and comfortable environment for consumers.

One of the most innovative and attractive aspects of the Wmhinc.com model is the lack of ‘floor planning’. Traditional retail outlets rely on loans in order to provide the funds to procure their display models and special order models have long been a risk to manufacturers. This is primarily due to the Manufacturer guarantee of a buy-back in the event that a retailer default is required by the finance companies to secure the loans for a retailer’s inventory. By eliminating this, Wmhinc.com will virtually eliminate any risk to the manufacturers in our partnership circle.

3

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

262

Upon finalization of the home order, customers will be required to instruct their financing source (or make a cash deposit themselves) to deposit the agreed upon amount for the home into an escrow account that will be controlled by Wmhinc.com. The Escrow Company will be given instructions to fund the Factory for the home upon the verification of the building of the home and the presentation of the invoice. Wmhinc.com will retain the balance of the funds after the payoff to the Factory, to be paid when delivery is completed, thus completing the contractual obligations.

Strategy The Company plans to establish itself as the "next generation provider" of manufactured homes, products, and related services and capture a sizable portion of this market in the next decade. Furthermore, Wmhinc.com is modeled as an Internet Portal, constructed and designed after well-known portals such as C/Net (information technology), CNNfn (finance), Showbiz (entertainment), and Thrive Online (health and fitness) with primary focus on the housing industry. The dual strategy of the selling and distribution of homes and associated products and services as well as developing Wmhinc.com as a portal, takes into account that the home buying and installation process takes between 3-6 months. During this time frame, visitors will make repeated, almost daily, visits in order to gain additional information, services, and a sense of community with others in like situations. This strategy will increase page views, repeat traffic, and value to our advertisers. Furthermore, this portal presence will allow Wmhinc.com to cultivate additional advertisers from non- related industries in order to take advantage of the relationship with our customers. To enhance this, the Company plans to install message boards and forums for discussions concerning the purchase and installation of manufactured housing, as well as non-specific games and varied interest content. The Company’s long-term objective is to dominate the Manufactured Housing Internet sector as well as create a Brick and Mortar presence in the manufacturing and retailing of homes and associated products. The Company will leverage this new service in the housing industry to dominate the growing manufactured home market. As a Company, we feel that there are a number of opportunities we can capitalize on and they include:

• B2B Technology. Resale of exclusive technology to brick and mortar business to facilitate their infrastructure. Customers include the manufactured housing, auto, and RV industries, and others.

• B2B Government. Sale of homes and coordination of delivery for FEMA and State disaster relief efforts (These number in the thousands of homes annually).

• B2B Garages. Exclusive patentable product in development allowing a fully built two-car garage to be delivered and erected on site within hours. These will be sold wholesale to Brick and Mortar companies.

• B2B Motorsports. Ability to remarket advertising space within our NASCAR sponsorship program for a substantial amount more than expenses, allowing a co-branding opportunity for affiliates.

• B2B Service. Ability through existing service structure to offer Brick and Mortar companies a service department for the Warranty work of the units sold at a substantial reduction of costs. Also a service for manufacturers in providing Warranty work for customers sold by other retailers by an existing recognized centralized team.

• B2B Online Auctions. Fees and profits generated by resale of large block of homes within an online auction setting. Primarily for manufacturers and banks who unload a large number of houses at once.

• B2B Manufacturing of Wmhinc.com branded homes. Ability to retire idle manufacturing plants of partner manufacturers with a split of proceeds of retail sales. Long-term intent of purchase of idle plants to allow for greater profit.

• B2C New Home sales. Unique national online sales of manufactured housing to retail customers.

• B2C Bank-Owned home sales. Realization of fees and commission for resale of bank-owned homes.

4

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

263

• B2C Garages. Unique national online sales of exclusive, patentable deliverable garages.

• B2C Parts/Service. Ability through our online partnerships to provide parts and service to individual homeowners to facilitate the maintenance and remodel of existing homes.

• B2C Listing for sale of customer homes “Net Listings”. Allows customers to list their homes for sale taking advantage of the traffic on our web site. A fee will be charged based on the sale price.

Wmhinc.com will become a “one-stop” destination for consumers seeking manufactured housing, presenting long-term opportunities for its partner suppliers by enabling them to increase their product deliveries and market share. Furthermore, as a result of ongoing investments in search engine placement, Internet advertising, and traditional advertising, will consist primarily of the NASCAR Winston Cup Series, print and television. Management is projecting first year traffic will place Wmhinc.com firmly in the Media Metrix top 100 web sites.

Strategic Relationships The Company has strategic alliances with several leading housing related companies. These alliances are valuable because they provide Wmhinc.com with established companies and distribution channels. Cavalier Homes have agreed to partner with Wmhinc.com for their work with developers, the sale of the computer programs, and the promotion of a yet publicly undisclosed financing company that they are developing. The agreement with Cavalier Homes is expected to be finalized by the end of January. Additionally, an agreement is expected to be reached with Fleetwood Homes by the end of January too. Currently, Wmhinc.com has working agreements for 4,000 homes with several developers for an average of $2,000 to $5,000 per house. Below is the current status of other key relationships:

Manufacturers Established Relationships Contacted – Pending Commitment Kit Homes – Homes (HUD) and RVs Wick Building Systems – Homes (Modular) Ritz-Craft Homes – Homes (Modular & HUD) Cavco (Cendex corp) – Homes (HUD) Chariot Eagle Homes – Homes (Park Model, American Homestar – Homes (HUD) Patriot Homes – Homes (HUD) Fairmont/Friendship Homes – Homes (HUD) Oakwood Homes – Homes (overstock new Nobility – Homes (HUD) Turtle Homes – Homes (HUD) Handicapped Kent Homes – Homes (Modular) Maple Homes of Canada – Homes (Modular) Excel Homes – Homes (Modular)

Banks (For Sales of Bank-Owned Homes) Established Relationships Contacted – Pending Commitment

Associates Housing Finance Conseco Bombardier Green Point Content Providers and Associates (Internet) Established Relationships Contacted – Pending Commitment MonsterDaata.com – Neighborhood information GetConnected.com – Services disconnect/reconnection Moving.com – Moving resources iSyndicate.com – Miscellaneous content provider

Reprint and Copyright Permission Established Relationships Contacted – Pending Commitment North Dakota Manufactured Housing Association – Website content

South Carolina Manufactured Housing Association – Web site content

Ray Sterner – Johns Hopkins University Pennsylvania Manufactured Housing association – Web site content

5

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

264

Establishing dominance in the Internet market for manufactured housing and further increasing and expanding market share, Wmhinc.com will add value to the products and services offered by its partner companies. High overhead, accelerated collapse of retailing outlets, zero market penetration in some areas (primarily due to extremely high start-up costs for new retail centers) all have combined together to provide the overwhelming need for Wmhinc.com’s services.

SWOT Analysis Wmhinc.com conducted a SWOT Analysis to examine key factors that are internal (strengths and weaknesses) and external (opportunities and threats). Following are the results:

STRENGTHS

• Strategic alliances with several leading companies that have established distribution channels • Internet Portal with primary focus on the housing industry • Extensive experience in eCommerce, marketing, manufactured homes, and housing related services • Innovative web site with ease of navigation and complete “state specific” web pages • Centralized point for FEMA to procure homes in the event of a natural disaster for replacement of

destroyed property WEAKNESSES

• Wmhinc.com has a relatively short operating history • Security of sensitive customer information • Brand recognition • Limited sales force

OPPORTUNITIES

• Manufactured homes make up over 25% of new homes in the United States • Sales of new manufactured homes exceeded $16 billion in 1999, an increase of 400% in the last ten

years • Housing and support for land and community developers • Company owned and independent manufacturers are having extreme difficulty moving their

products • Overproduction of ‘stock’ homes in an already over-saturated market • Development of personnel housing on military bases

THREATS

• Established competitors in the marketplace • Changes in customer requirements and preferences • Frequent new product and service introductions which embody new processes and technologies • Evolving industry standards and practices • Acceptance of customers to use the Internet and other online services as a medium for buying

manufactured homes • Failure of subcontractors/partners to perform services to customer’s satisfaction

Risks As with all companies, the opportunity is tempered with certain risks. Important risks to consider are described below according to internal and external risk categories.

6

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

265

Wmhinc.com Associated Risks • Early Stage Business – Wmhinc.com was incorporated in August 2000 and has a relatively

short operating history. The Management Team has experience in the areas of business management, manufactured housing, e-commerce, and various types of expertise that contribute to managing startups. Moreover, the Management Team has considerable expertise in product/service launches as well as marketing and sales. In addition, Wmhinc.com and its prospects must be considered in light of the risks, expenses, and difficulties frequently encountered by companies in an early stage of development. This is an especially important consideration to weigh in view of the fact that Wmhinc.com is engaged in a new and rapidly evolving market for Internet services.

• Establishing, Building, Maintaining, and Strengthening Brand – Wmhinc.com’s senior

management believes building, strengthening, and maintaining the Wmhinc.com brand is important in is ability to attract and retain customers. Moreover, the importance of brand recognition will escalate in proportion to the expected increasing numbers of Internet competitors. Positioning and strengthening Wmhinc.com’s brand name is dependent upon the success of the Company’s marketing and promotional efforts and Wmhinc.com’s ability to provide high-quality, cost-effective content. In addition, Wmhinc.com plans to undertake certain Public Relations activities and tasks. These efforts contribute to building a brand name.

Internet Associated Risks • Technology – The market for manufactured homes is constantly undergoing change. Important

factors to consider include: (1) Changes in customer requirements and preferences; (2) Frequent new product and service introductions that embody new processes and technologies; (3) Evolving industry standards and practices that could render Wmhinc.com’s existing practices and methodologies obsolete.

• eCommerce – Wmhinc.com’s future revenues and profits are substantially dependent upon broad acceptance of customers to use the Internet and other online services as a medium for buying manufactured homes. Interest and use of the Web is a recent phenomenon, and it goes along with the rise of Internet and related online services. There can be no assurance that such acceptance and use will continue in the future. Moreover, there is no assurance that a broad base of consumers will adopt or continue to use the Internet as a medium of commerce.

• System failure – Wmhinc.com’s success and its ability to facilitate electronic commerce successfully depends on the efficient and uninterrupted operation of its Internet connectivity systems. Wmhinc.com obtains its high-speed Internet access through third party Internet Service Providers (ISP). ISPs maintain physical and electronic systems that are vulnerable to failure, damage, or interruption resulting from any number of possibilities, ranging from earthquakes, floods, fire, loss of power, telecommunication failure, break-in, sabotage, vandalism, and similar events.

• Database Security – Through its Web site, Wmhinc.com will maintain sensitive customer data in its database. To protect customer records, a sophisticated security system has been incorporated into the Web site that relies on a combination of security devices and methods that make the data virtually scrambled to the point that the likelihood of a hacker has an extremely low probability of accessing customer records. Despite this, maintaining customer records on a Web-based system bears certain risks and liability.

Business and Financial Risks • Competition – Wmhinc.com operates in highly competitive markets and may not be able to

compete effectively. Many of Wmhinc.com’s current and potential competitors have longer operating histories and substantially greater financial, technical, marketing, distribution and other resources than Wmhinc.com does and therefore may be able to respond more quickly than Wmhinc.com can to new or changing opportunities, technologies, standards or customer requirements.

7

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

266

• Dependency on Effective Marketing and Sales – Wmhinc.com expects that its future financial performance will depend in part on sales of its services. Wmhinc.com recently published its Web site. Market acceptance of Wmhinc (as a company) depends on the market demand for the specific functionality of such services. If Wmhinc’s services fail to meet customer needs or expectations, for whatever reason, Wmhinc.com’s reputation could be damaged, or it could be required to upgrade or enhance services, which could be costly and time consuming.

• Dependency on Sales Force and Distribution – Wmhinc.com’s failure to expand its sales force and distribution channels would adversely affect its revenue growth and financial condition. To increase its revenue, Wmhinc.com must increase the size of its sales force and the number of its indirect channel partners, including original equipment manufacturers, value-added resellers and systems integrators. A failure to do so could have a material adverse effect on Wmhinc.com’s business, operating results, and financial condition. There is intense competition for sales personnel in Wmhinc.com’s business, and there can be no assurance that Wmhinc.com will be successful in attracting, integrating, motivating, and retaining new sales personnel. Wmhinc.com’s existing or future channel partners may choose to devote greater resources to marketing and supporting the services of competitors. In addition, Wmhinc.com will need to resolve potential conflicts among its sales force and channel partners.

• Poor results by service providers may damage Wmhinc’s reputation – Wmhinc’s business could be adversely affected if its subcontractors/partners fail to perform services to its customer’s satisfaction. The occurrence of various situations could result in loss of or delay in revenue, loss of market share, failure to achieve market acceptance, diversion of development resources, injury to Wmhinc.com’s reputation, or damage to its efforts to build brand awareness, any of which could have adverse effects on its business, operating results and financial condition.

Products and Services The Company plans to establish itself as the "next generation provider" of manufactured homes, products, and related services. The Company’s web site not only provides the opportunity for the consumer to design and purchase a home online, but also includes comprehensive information, a nationwide Associated Services Yellow Pages, and industry and government links. Designed to be user friendly with a simple 'three click' system and 'state specific' listings of products and services, the web site enables the consumer to find the home or information needed with ease.

Intellectual Property Patents, copyrights, and/or trademarks Wmhinc.com regards its copyrights, trademarks, trade secrets (including methodologies, practices, and tools) and other intellectual property rights as critical to success. To protect its rights, Wmhinc.com relies on a combination of trademark and copyright laws, trade secret protection, nondisclosure agreements, and other contractual agreements with its employees, affiliates, clients, strategic partners, acquisition targets, and others. Location The Company’s principal offices are located at 5300 W Sahara, Suite 101, Las Vegas, NV 89146. Currently, the Company is paying a monthly rental fee of $1,500. The Company plans to develop a gated compound on 10–20 acres of land consisting of 2 converted Manufactured homes (total area 5000 square feet) which will serve as the office area. Also on the compound will be a housing development featuring 6 manufactured homes. In January 2002, the Company will begin its search for potential sites. Site selection is expected to be completed by the middle of February with construction beginning in March.

8

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

267

Legal Structure Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. (Wmhinc.com) is a privately-held Nevada C Corporation. The Company was formed on August 1st, 2000 and incorporated on August 23rd, 2000. Provided below is a list of the Company’s corporate officers and their compensation.

Compensation Paul S Jarolimek II President/CEO $ 52,500 Michael Gage CTO $ 52,500 MaryLou Jarolimek CFO $ 52,500 Stephen Massie EVP Warranty/Service $ 52,500 Jim Stephens EVP Sales $ 52,500 Suzanne Jarolimek EVP Customer Service $ 52,500 Kerry Lease EVP Marketing STOCK ONLY Larry Queen VP Technology - Graphics $ 52,500 Leon Jarolimek VP Customer Service/Warranty $ 52,500 William Smith Corporate Counsel STOCK ONLY

Management The Company’s management philosophy is based on responsibility and mutual respect. At Wmhinc.com, we have an environment that encourages creativity and achievement. Wmhinc.com management is highly experienced and qualified. Wmhinc.com.’s management team provides strong leadership ability, sales and marketing expertise, and extensive knowledge in both Manufactured Housing and the Internet. See resume in Supporting Documents. Descriptions of the management team and responsibilities are as follows.

• Paul Jarolimek II, Founder, Chairman, President and CEO – Paul Jarolimek II, Founder, Chairman, President and CEO is a veteran in the manufactured housing industry who has proven his leadership in both independent retail enterprises and from within the corporate structure. A top salesperson for one of the leading manufactured housing companies in the nation prior to taking on management roles, he has the management experience, customer service, and people skills to facilitate his role in this company.

• MaryLou Jarolimek, Board Member and CFO – Mary Lou Jarolimek has nearly 30 years of business acumen. Having successfully run a number of businesses and trained in financial services, her role as CFO is most suited.

• Suzanne Jarolimek, Board Member and Director of Customer Relations – Suzanne Jarolimek, brings with her a pragmatic and laser focused vision of the needs of our customers.

• Mike Gage, Board Member and CTO – Mike Gage brings value to the Company with his many years of Internet commerce experience and deep understanding of hardware and software applications.

• Kerry Lease, Board Member and Executive VP of Marketing – Kerry Lease, delivers twenty-five years of highly successful business ownership in the highly competitive field of advertising and marketing.

9

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

268

Personnel Management realizes that the strength of the Company’s personnel is key to its success. As such, plans include filling staff positions with professionals who have proven success and records in the dot.com world and have an understanding of the housing industry. The Company plans to hire 5 department managers at an average salary of $40,000 per year each and 10 hourly employees at an average wage rate that totals $16,800 per year per employee. Accounting and Legal

Accounting Wmhinc.com will follow Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP). The Company will use the Accrual Basis for recognition of revenues and handle accounting and bookkeeping internally. The CFO is responsible for the overall financial condition of the Company and managing all financial functions in keeping Wmhinc.com a profitable corporation. All bookkeeping activities will be handled internally by the Administrative Assistant using Peachtree Accounting. Peachtree Accounting has been selected over other accounting packages because of its powerful business management and Internet tools. An outside CPA firm will provide auditing services and develop financial reports for Wmhinc.com. The Company will keep its customer database on ACT contact management software by Symantec. ACT allows users to create a database, fax, run reports, and do mail merge. A new feature also allows users to send and receive e-mail messages from within Act's interface.

Legal For all legal aspects of the business, the Company has retained the services of the Maryland based Law Office of Kerwin A. Miller, LLC. Provided below is the company’s contact information.

Law Office of Kerwin A. Miller, LLC Principal – Kerwin Miller 6905 Rockledge Drive, Suite 600, Bethesda, MD 20817 Off: (301) 896-9421 Fax: (301) 941-9009

Insurance Management has assessed insurance requirements and has concluded that the Company will need business liability coverage, industry specific liability insurance coverage, workers’ compensation coverage, medical coverage, and key-man coverage. (Note: see Insurance Update Form in supporting documents.) Security The Company will maintain sensitive customer data in its database and from transactions on the Internet. To protect customer records, a sophisticated security system will incorporate into the Web site that relies on a combination of security devices and methods that encrypt the data leaving an extremely low probability of accessing customer records.

10

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

269

Part II: MARKETING PLAN Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc.

I. Overview and Goals A. Overview of Marketing Strategy

The Marketing Plan is developed in order to support Wmhinc.com’s goals and strategies. It is based on strategic goals as well as from knowledge gained during analysis of the industry, competitive intelligence, and what Wmhinc.com knows (or assumes) about its customers and partners. Initial marketing tactics will focus on the development of the Wmhinc.com promotional material, an efficient public relations campaign, including a strong Internet search engine presence, cold calling, and visits to trade shows and a corporate sales force.

B. Goals of Marketing Strategy

• Creating a Well Known Brand • Building an Strong Customer Base • Increasing Product/Service Sales

II. Market Analysis A. Target Market(s)

Customers will be the focal point of the Wmhinc.com business model and overall strategy. All customers will be treated with respect, their housing choices made simple, and their decision-making process made positive. Wmhinc.com will continually develop its customer network, striving to receive referrals from existing customers and visitors. Wmhinc.com caters to the following customer groups/target markets:

• Individuals (Wmhinc.com’s NASCAR advertising campaign that is explained below, will primarily target this market segment)

• Government • Developers • Manufacturers • Retail Sale Centers • Advertisers

Value Propositions Wmhinc.com offers the following value propositions for each customer group/target market.

11

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

270

Individuals Ease of Use – Easy navigation through the web site utilizing a ‘three click’ process to find the right section, build and purchase homes, and find information.

Buy Homes Online – Prices posted, options and features from many different manufacturers allow a greater choice than can be found on a local level. No pricing games normally played by local retailers, where your neighbor paid $5000 less for the same home because he negotiates better…Ability to self direct the design of the home, and ability to see how the inclusion of certain options effect the home and prices before having to commit to a loan. Ability to compare different manufacturers, options, and colors.

No Pressure – No high-pressure sales tactics so often encountered in retail sales. No issues with untrained sales staff or managers. No push by retailers into a home which may not suit their needs in order for the company to remove the home from their inventory.

Unparalleled Information sources – Wmhinc.com has access to tens of thousands of pages of information and is developing a joint information venture with FEMA for the prevention of disasters. This program will be exclusive and proprietary and will be protected by intellectual property rights. Additionally, Wmhinc.com is in the process of securing the rights to reprint two industry related publications (one of which is used by major universities as a textbook) online for our customers to reference. These publications will be published under an exclusive arrangement. Furthermore, directed information such as checklists, instructions and explanations of the installation and moving processes will give the customer the ability to oversee their own project instead of relying on a third party to do this for them. Customers will also have the ability to verify that the work being done is in a workmanship fashion and in a timely manner. This is a huge problem facing brick & mortar retailers as evidenced by web sites such as http://members.boardhost.com/oakwoodhomes/.

Sense of Community – With the installation of Manufactured housing taking three to six months from start to finish Wmhinc.com will offer a sense of community to those who visit the web site. Regardless of whether the Company sells them a home, visitors will benefit from the message boards and information that will provide them with a starting point for their projects and discussion points with people in similar situations.

Less cost – While the Company intends to be competitive, it also realizes the customer will save a great deal of money working directly with contractors and other companies in order to facilitate their home installation and moving services. There is commonly a mark-up of these type services by Brick & Mortar retailers, which is not generally seen in Internet based sales.

Government Disaster Relief Services – Centralized point for FEMA to procure homes in the event of a natural disaster for replacement of destroyed property. Also a joint venture with FEMA for disaster awareness and preventative measures that can be undertaken before or after the home is installed.

Military Housing – Ability to provide a wide range of options at a low bid price for the development of personnel housing on military bases.

VA Preferred Provider of Manufactured Housing – Provide the VA department a definitive provider of housing for post-military personnel. This will be done in such a way that the VA recommends us for those in need of manufactured homes.

Developers Provide large blocks of housing and support for land and community developers – This program provides a tremendous resource for the developer in availability of many choices of homes with one contact, standardized pricing, reference materials, as well as follow-up marketing opportunities.

12

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

271

Manufacturers Marketing their Homes – Through their traditional retail outlets, both company owned and independent, manufacturers are having extreme difficulty moving their products. This is primarily due to high overhead, accelerated collapse of retailing outlets, and zero market penetration in some areas (due to extremely high startup costs for new retail centers).

Reduction of Overstock Homes – Many press releases by the major Manufactured Housing companies such as Oakwood Homes, American Homestar, Champion, Fleetwood, and the like have pointed to overproduction of ‘stock’ homes in an already over-saturated market, combined with higher than normal repossession rates further returning homes to the marketplace.

Immediate Payment on Sold homes – One of the most innovative and attractive aspects of the Wmhinc.com model is the lack of ‘floor planning’. This has long been a risk to manufacturers due to the guarantees required by the finance companies to secure the loans for a retailer’s inventory. By eliminating this, Wmhinc.com will virtually eliminate any risk to the manufacturers in our partnership circle. Upon finalization of the home order by the customer, they will be required to instruct their financing source (or deposit themselves if paying cash) to deposit the agreed upon amount for the home into an escrow account controlled by Wmhinc.com. The Escrow Company will be given instructions to fund the Factory for the home upon the verification of the building of the home and the presentation of the invoice.

Retail Sale Centers and Parent Companies Technology – The technology of the Company’s tracking program, which will be installed on the web site will give Wmhinc.com the ability to track virtually every aspect of the customer’s buying process. Additionally, this will enable the Company to constantly communicate with potential customers. Studies have shown that the decision making process can take six months or more and the installed program will provide the ability to automatically track and keep in contact with the customer during this decision making process. Furthermore, this will also track the after sale service allowing Wmhinc.com to remain in contact and to smoothly facilitate warranty service of the homes. This will enable the Company to continue its follow- up with the customer long after the home purchase and mining referrals of new customers through existing clientele. This technology will be offered in a slightly modified version to others in the industry as well as to any industry that deals in large ticket items, such as automobiles, RVs, motorcycles, boats, etc.

Pre-built Garages – Patentable product in development, which can be sold to industry brick & mortars on a wholesale level for eventual resale. Wmhinc.com has procured engineering and design, as well as manufacturing space to facilitate the production of these units.

Advertisers Copyrighted, exclusive, industry specific Yellow Pages – This is designed to provide companies, both on and off the Internet, in related industries the ability to put their products directly in front of the people who need them the most. High volume specific traffic, needing the services listed, provides huge benefits to this program. Furthermore, the Company’s involvement in the NASCAR Winston Cup Series, with their viewers 73% certified brand loyalty, will translate in a loyalty to the Company’s advertisers. Management believes that due to the eschewing of the “banner ad” and instead providing a fixed position advertising format familiar and comfortable to our customers, as well as the community aspect of the web site, the information resources, and the depth of companies partnering in advertising, Wmhinc.com will be the one-stop destination for consumers of manufactured Housing thus bringing greater returns to advertising dollars spent.

13

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

272

B. Competition

1. Description of Major Competitors Chandler, Inc. – Chandler's is committed to being number one in the South by offering customers "direct from the builder pricing". Chandler drop ships custom ordered homes directly from the manufacturer to the customer’s lot. This amounts to thousands of dollars in savings to the customer. Chandler offers the above propositions that make it one of the best sites to purchase mobile homes:

2254 U.S. 84 West Valdosta, Georgia 31601 Phone (912) 242-5900 Fax (912) 242-8833 http://www.chandlersmfg.com/

Homestore.com, Inc. – Homestore.com with its family of sites is one of the leading destinations for home and real estate-related information on the Internet. RealSelect, Inc., is the official Internet site of the National Association of Realtors® and has pioneered the use of the Internet as a channel for buying and selling homes. Each site in the Homestore.com™ family provides definitive resources for both professionals and consumers, including advanced search functions, rich editorial content, marketplaces for related products and services, and tools such as checklists and calculators.

225 West Hillcrest Drive, Suite 100 Thousand Oaks, CA 91360 Phone: (805) 557-2300 http://www.factorybuilthousing.com/ MHShopper – MHShopper was founded in 2000 to create a network of market leading manufactured home dealers across the country. Through this united network, MHShopper and the Manufactured Home Shopper Network is able to ensure value pricing and a variety of low- cost financing options - savings that are passed to both dealers and consumers. MHShopper completed it's first round of financing in July, 2000 through a private placement with Roth Capital Partners of Newport Beach, California.

15282 Newsboy Circle, Huntington Beach CA 92649 Phone : (714) 373-5001 (6:30am to 5pm PST) Fax : (714) 373-5006 http://MHShopper.com Michael Holigan.com – MH2Technologies makes building easier, more productive, and more profitable. Its service offerings, including MH2Build and MH2Marketing, were developed by builders for builders. MH2Build allows homebuilders and light commercial contractors to save time, reduce overhead, simplify ordering, and schedule efficiently. From any location, builders can use MH2Build for job management, scheduling, and materials ordering. MH2Technologies also provides homebuilders exceptional branding power through MH2Marketing. MH2Technologies' licensees gain the ability to differentiate themselves in the very fragmented national homebuilding industry. MHConnection.com – MHConnection.com is a privately-held web-based marketplace for the mobile and manufactured home industry. The company is based in Cedaredge, Colorado. Its principals and advisors have vast industry experience as well as technical expertise.

MHConnection.com, Inc. 1825 2550 Rd. Cedaredge, CO 81413 Phone: (800) 304-2835 http://www.MHConnection.com

14

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

273

Mobile Homes Coast 2 Coast – Mobile Homes Coast 2 Coast is the ultimate online resource for consumers to showcase their mobile home or manufactured home to prospective buyers and for people wanting to buy a mobile home in their area. Mobile Homes Coast 2 Coast facilitates the process for buyers and sellers through advertisements on their web site. When a seller places an ad, prospective buyers can instantly view it and the seller has immediate access to make any changes they want to make to their ads.

Mobile Homes Coast 2 Coast also provides all of the necessary information (and resources to information) that buyers and sellers of mobile homes and manufactured homes will ever need. The company provides services for sellers, dealers, financial institutions, mobile home communities, and all businesses related to this industry a low-cost and effective means of advertising.

http://mobilehomescoast2coast.com/

2. Assessment of Their Strengths/Weaknesses Competition exists within the industry but not at the level at which Wmhinc.com is participating. Individual retailers, information-only sites, and manufacturer sites all have a common denominator and that is none of them actually offer the home to the customer. The closest service competitors are offering is allowing the visitor to request more information which is then sent, sans prices.

While Wmhinc.com fully expects additional competition to materialize in some form, management also believes its business model will mitigate competitive threats and capitalize on the identified opportunity gaps such as geographic specialization and expertise, superior customer service, and usability.

C. Market Trends 1. Target Market Trends

Wmhinc.com believes that it provides a natural evolution in the Manufactured Housing market. While the Company’s services have never been directly sold on the Internet, recent studies have shown dramatic increases of Internet usage by consumers for home purchases. A unique marketing channel has been developed as clearly shown in the Internet retailing of vehicles, heavy equipment, boats, and big ticket items. Consumers are becoming increasingly more comfortable with making major purchases online. Internet vehicle sales alone exceeded $670 million for the year ending 1999 says analyst James McQuivey of Forrester Research, and by 2003, it is projected that eight million cars will be purchased with some help from the Internet. That market, and a nationwide figure of over 370,000 manufactured homes delivered in 1998, and over 320,000 delivered in 1999, has given Wmhinc.com a clearly defined and workable model.

Demographically Wmhinc.com is positioned on the cusp of a major resurgence in manufactured housing. While traditional buyers of manufactured housing have been, and continue to be, first-time homebuyers which is where Wmhinc.com’s primary marketing thrust will center early on, the aging ‘baby boomer’ section of the population will account for a dramatic increase in manufactured housing sales.

15

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

274

The year ending 1999 saw a downturn in the nationwide delivery in Manufactured housing, and while there are many reasons for the downturn, facts show that as the baby boomers enter the pre-retirement stages they will become a burgeoning market for manufactured housing. Empty nests, upscale 55 and older communities, the high quality and relative low expense not only in the purchase, but maintenance of Manufactured Housing, as well as other factors, will play a pivotal role in the purchase of Manufactured Housing by ‘baby boomers’. This, coupled with the demographics of Internet usage showing adults 55 and older represent the fastest growing group of U.S. Internet users according to International Data Corp., which found the number of seniors online will more than triple from 11.1 million in 1999 to 34.1 million in 2004, and will account for 20% of all new users, will provide Wmhinc.com a long-term source of customers.

2. Industry Trends According to Statistical Surveys, the industries leading information source, there has been a precipitous drop in manufactured housing shipments over the last two plus years. In 1998 there were over 370,000 total shipments nationwide. In 1999 that figure dropped to over 320,000. Currently the shipments stand at approximately 120,000 through the month of May 2000.

While there has been much speculation concerning this, the industry is cyclical. Press releases by the major manufactured housing companies such as Oakwood Homes, American Homestar, Champion, and Fleetwood have repeatedly pointed to overproduction of ‘stock’ homes in an already over-saturated market, combined with higher than normal repossession rates further returning homes to the marketplace. The shutting down of business by major ‘traditional’ independent retailers because of the obligations extended by the Manufacturers, resulted in the buying back of millions of dollars of inventory aided in flooding an already overwhelmed retail structure. These and other factors, while perceived as a negative by many, provide Wmhinc.com with a world of opportunity.

Through their traditional retail outlets, both company owned and independent manufacturers are having extreme difficulty moving products. High overhead, accelerated collapse of retailing outlets, zero market penetration in some areas (primarily due to extremely high startup costs for new retail centers) all have combined together to provide the overwhelming need for the services offered by Wmhinc.com

The Manufactured Home Market The Federal Manufactured Home Construction and Safety Standards Act, is administered by the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development (HUD). This building code, which is also known as the HUD code, federally regulates the design and construction of manufactured homes. It also sets the standards for home durability and safety.

The implementation of the HUD code was a pivotal point in the manufactured home industry. No longer referred to as mobile homes or trailers, manufactured homes began a revolution in housing. Home construction became consistent industry wide, and manufacturers, lenders, and consumers began to recognize manufactured homes as a viable alternative to site-built homes.

16

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

275

Today, manufactured homes make up over 25% of new homes in the United States. Sales of new manufactured homes exceeded $16 billion in 1999, an increase of 400% in the last ten years. With new design elements and customizable options, manufactured homes have begun to cross over into the mainstream. The improvement of construction standards and incredible sales growth in the industry has caused many national lenders to reconsider their views of manufactured homes. Manufactured home buyers now have more financing options than those buyers who are considering purchasing site-built homes.

D. Market Research - Additional Factors

Additional highlights of the manufactured home market include: • Over 19 million people (about 8 % of the U.S. population) live full time in over

8 million manufactured homes.

• In 1999, the industry shipped 348,671 homes from 323 manufacturing facilities. • 88% of manufactured home owners report satisfaction with the manufactured

housing lifestyle.

• A majority of manufactured homes are never moved after they have been installed.

• Manufactured housing retail sales were estimated at $16.3 billion in 1998. In 1999, 20.7% of all new single-family housing starts were manufactured homes.

• According to the Census Bureau, 1999 figures show that 68 percent of new manufactured homes were located on private property, and 32 percent of new manufactured homes were located in communities.

• The average sales price of a manufactured home was $43,600 in 1999. Single- section homes average $31,800, while multi-section homes average $50,200.

• In 1999, the estimated economic impact from manufactured housing was $34.5 billion. The economic impact reflects the economic activity generated by the production and sale of a home - this includes salaries, goods purchased and auxiliary services.

III. Marketing Strategy A. General Description

The overall marketing plan for Wmhinc.com’s service is based on the following fundamentals:

• The segment of the market(s) planned to reach. • Distribution channels planned to be used to reach market segments:

NASCAR, television, print, sales associates, and telemarketing. • Share of the market expected to capture over a fixed period of time.

17

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

276

Market Responsibilities Wmhinc.com is committed to an extensive promotional campaign. This will be done aggressively and on a broad scale. To accomplish initial sales goals, the Company will require an extremely effective promotional campaign to accomplish two primary objectives:

• Attract quality sales personnel that have a desire to be successful. • Attract customers that will constantly look to Wmhinc.com for their

housing needs.

In addition, Wmhinc.com plans to advertise in NASCAR, television, newspapers, and joint direct mail efforts with FEMA

B. Method of Sales and Distribution Wmhinc.com’s sales plan is to seek business that will advance the Company’s quest to vertically integrate and become a stronger force in the housing industry. The Company will continue to strive towards procuring sales of its services in the nation. To accomplish Wmhinc.com ’s endeavors, the Company will utilize internal and external sales tactics. By aggressively seeking new accounts and taking full advantage of the existing relationships the Company has with current customers and broadening its customer base, the Company will expand and compete with the leading companies in its markets.

C. Pricing Wmhinc.com sets pricing based on market and competitive rates. Through its alliances with various manufacturers, Wmhinc.com is able to order the homes at discounted prices. With its business model, the Company is then able to pass on the direct cost savings to the customer while generating significant profit margins.

D. Sales Strategies

Wmhinc.com plans to use a combination of the following strategies to reach its markets.

• Direct sales • Direct mail • E-mail marketing • Affiliate marketing • Viral marketing

These channels are most appropriate because of the time to market, reduced capital requirements, and fast access to established distribution channels. The sales department will be headed by one general sales manager and one national sales manager that will be initially charged with developing the sales force to consist of several sales teams led by local sales managers.

18

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

277

E. Sales Incentives As an extra incentive for customers and potential customers to remember Wmhinc.com’s name, the Company, through its NASCAR involvement, plans to enable the marketing of die-cast renderings of the sponsored racecar, T-shirts and other clothing, miscellaneous novelties, and other advertising specialties with the Company logo. This multi-billion dollar NASCAR sports merchandising program will produce dramatic branding of the Wmhinc.com name as these items will appear in virtually every K-Mart and Wal-Mart in the United States and abroad. Retail sales of NASCAR related merchandise has grown over 1400% in the last decade. This will be an ongoing program for the Company, when appropriate and where it is identified as beneficial.

F. Advertising Strategies

1. Traditional Advertising Advertising will focus on building awareness of Wmhinc.com’s brand and on marketing (online) services as a better and cost effective way for purchasing manufactured homes. Advertising will be directed at bringing interested prospects to Wmhinc.com’s web site for additional information. Advertising programs will include the following channels:

• Television (network/cable) • Radio • Print

2. Web Advertising/New Media

Wmhinc.com plans to contract one or more third parties to handle its Web advertising requirements. Wmhinc.com will conduct Internet advertising in the form of Internet banner ads, newsletters, co-branding efforts, search engines, portals, and press releases on Web sites that have high traffic-visitors that match Wmhinc.com’s target demographics. Through the Web site, prospective customers can obtain detailed information on the services, request additional information, and opt-in or opt-out to future product/service announcements.

Cost of Advertising Nascar Winston Cup $6,000,000 Internet (Primarily search engine placement) $ 500,000 Print Advertising $ 200,000

3. Long-term Sponsorships Wmhinc.com will initiate a national advertising campaign in conjunction with the Company’s sponsorship of a Winston cup Series team. The Company’s national advertising accounts will receive a full-page advertisement (which could be their home page displayed within the Wmhinc.com web site, see: http://Wmhinc.com/yp or Moving.com within the moving section and FEMA in the 'FEMA' section of our site). Additionally, they will receive the following value-added propositions.

19

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

278

♦ Three associate sponsor placements on a NASCAR Winston Cup racecar, this could be in one race or over three races. Races are first come first serve, and include the Daytona 500 and the Brickyard 400 at the Indy Motor Speedway. The Company has selected Derrike Cope as its driver for the upcoming NASCAR season. Advertising will include mention on television (Fox and/or NBC) and radio. NASCAR boasts a viewership of over 4,500,000 people not including the individual race attendance. Location would be:

• Leading edge of hood • Lower quarter panel front of rear wheel • Lower quarter panel rear of rear wheel • Trunk lid • Rear panel in area between rear lights (TV Panel)

♦ Permanent placement on the car/equipment hauler (rolling billboard from February to November)

♦ Invitation for two to the exclusive hospitality tent prior to race. Wine and dine with the crew and officials and meet Kenny Wallace and the crew chief, Barry Dobson. (per race)

♦ Two VIP garage passes (per race) ♦ Opportunity to be a uniformed crewmember during the race ♦ News and other TV placement as sponsor ♦ Prominently displayed and mentioned as a FEMA "Project Impact" associate

during joint press conferences ♦ Prominently displayed within the "Project Impact" joint Wmhinc.com and FEMA

web site ♦ Opportunity for advertiser’s name to be in retail outlets including K-Mart and

Wal-Mart. (Die-cast cars and t-shirts) Wmhinc.com believes this joint marketing venture will help to increase its customer base as well as produce income from the sale of the advertising well over the amount required for its own marketing efforts. Effectively, this will result in an immediate return on the Company’s marketing investment as well as the excellent exposure of the NASCAR association.

NASCAR Statistics: 1998-1999 Total US TV rating (Regular season – households)

Per event average: • In-Focus time: 9min 04sec • Sponsor mentions: 5.4 • Value based on cost per :30 ad: $626,330

20

1.4 2.9

4.2 5.5

11.3

0

2

4

6

8

10

12

NHL MLB NBA NASCAR NFL

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

279

Other coverage opportunities (No additional cost added): Television NASCAR 2 Day (ESPN) NASCAR 2 Day (ESPN) Inside NASCAR (TNN) Inside W.C. (Speedvision) NASCAR Garage (TNN) Week in NASCAR (Prime) RPM2Night (ESPN2) Radio Live coverage MRN&PRN NASCAR Garage NASCAR Live NASCAR Now NASCAR Today NASCAR USA Fast Talk with Benny Parsons Publications Inside NASCAR NASCAR Magazine NASCAR W.C. Scene NASCAR W.C. Illustrated NASCAR Racing for Teens NASCAR Preview NASCAR Garage Speedway Scene National Speed Sport News

Percentage of fans that say sponsorships have an impact on their purchases:

• Somewhat: 48% • Extreme: 32% • Very little: 12% • None: 8%

Audience brand loyalty

Audience income: Audience age: >$20,000 15.9% 12 – 17 12.0% $20 - $30,000 16.7% 18 – 24 12.8% $30 - $50,000 30.2% 25 – 34 18.7% $50 - $75,000 20.4% 35 – 44 22.6% $75,000 + 16.8% 35 – 44 22.6%

55 + 18.2% Comparable Value Throughout the 1999 season, there were 108 broadcasts of Winston Cup Series events, airing on ABC, CBS, ESPN, ESPN2, NBC, TBS, and TNN.

21

28% 36% 38% 38%

47% 52%

72%

0% 10% 20% 30% 40% 50% 60% 70% 80%

Olympics NFL MLB NBA Golf Tennis NASCAR

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

280

The broadcast season resulted in the collection of 344 hours, 17 minutes, and 53 seconds of exposure time, 20,507 verbal mentions and $1,438,015,450 of comparable value for 831 sponsors. The average sponsor received $1,732,550 value from their sponsorship involvement in the Winston Cup Series, which was an average of $50,960 per event. The top 25 sponsors received an even greater return averaging $21,285,245 worth of comparable value for the season or $626,330 per event. Due to Wmhinc.com’s NASCAR involvement and FEMA partnership management clearly expects to drive over one million unique visitors through the web site every month within the first year. NASCAR’s online site generates over 43 million page views by over 4.6 million unique users per month, each averaging 9 minutes per visit. FEMA has over 150,000,000 unique visitors per year on its web site.

G. Public Relations As Wmhinc.com launches its services, it is extremely important to develop and implement a public relations campaign that creates rapid recognition by the target markets and others who can help the Company build its markets. Wmhinc.com plans to establish and promote a favorable relationship with the public by developing communications with non-customers, including labor, public interest groups, government agencies, and press releases. Wmhinc.com will also monitor and improve public opinion as well as developing publicity where possible. Wmhinc’s public relations campaign will include the following:

• Building an Online Presence • Communities, Chats, and Message Boards • Events (online and offline) • Networking (organization membership, leadership positions) • Press releases (print, radio, television, online) • Interviews (print, radio, television, chat rooms, online events)

H. Networking

Wmhinc.com plans to become a member of state and national manufactured housing associations, the Manufactured Housing Institute (www.manufacturedhousing.org), the National Manufactured Housing Congress (www.nmhcogress.org) and several industry publications.

IV. Customer Service

The customer service strategy is based on providing high quality service which means having sufficient staffers available to take calls without keeping a customer waiting. Wmhinc.com will emphasize through advertising and PR channels that clients will receive personalized service and customer service as needed. Wmhinc.com will use automation technology such as FAQ pages on the Web site, message and discussion boards, bulletin boards, an online help desk, and self-service help wherever possible.

22

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

281

One major problem that can arise is that if the service is poorly delivered, the Company would require a large customer service department. If such a company is overloaded with customer service calls, eventually, we would see an exodus to alternative manufactured housing companies. On the other hand, excellent customer service will enhance the Company’s image, boost sales, lead to repeat business, and a high number of sales resulting from referrals.

V. Implementation of Marketing Strategy

A. In-House Responsibilities Wmhinc.com will develop and execute its marketing strategy in-house. In addition to developing the marketing plan, the Company will set goals, objectives, and propositions.

B. Out-Sourced Functions

Wmhinc.com plans to contract one or more third parties to handle its Web advertising requirements. Additionally, the Company will outsource PR responsibilities to an established public relations company.

VI. Assessment of Marketing Effectiveness Wmhinc.com, Inc. will evaluate the results of its marketing efforts on a monthly basis. At that time, based on the evaluation, decisions will be made and necessary changes will be implemented to increase marketing effectiveness. Participation in the evaluation process will be required for management and for key personnel in the marketing department.

23

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

282

Part III: FINANCIAL DOCUMENTS Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc.

Sources and Uses of Loan Funds A. Statement of Financial Needs …………………………………… 25 B. Dispersal of Loan Funds ………………………………………… 25-26

2002 Financial Projections A. Assumptions for Financial Projections …………………………. 27-28 B. Three-Year Income Projection (2002, 2003, 2004) …………….. 29 C. Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement for 2002 ……………………… 30-31 D. Projected Balance Sheet for December 31, 2002 ……………….. 32 E. Break-Even Analysis …………………………………………….. 33

Financial Statement Analysis A. Company Financial Statement Analysis Summary ……………….. 34 B. Ratio Table for Whinc.com. ..........................……………………… 35

24

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

283

Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc.

Summary of Financial Needs &

Dispersal of Investment Funds

Source of Funds

I. Wmhinc.com is seeking funding in the amount of $10 million for its Four-Phase Development.

II. Provided below is a breakdown of the use of funds.

Use of Funds

USE OF FUNDS BASED ON $10 MILLION INVESTMENT

Phase I First Quarter of Operations Projected Expense % of Gross Proceeds

1) Commissions Paid $ 700,000.00 7.00% 2) Website Development $ 168,750.00 1.69% 3) Rent, Lease, & Utilities $ 81,420.00 0.81% 4) Connectivity & Installation $ 5,000.00 0.05% 5) Executive & Administrative $ 372,920.00 3.73% 6) Professional, Legal, Advisory $ 5,000.00 0.05% 7) Advertising $ 1,433,660.00 14.34% 8) Equipment & Furniture $ 79,000.00 0.79% 9) Tech Support $ 5,000.00 0.05%

10) Networking Equipment $ 350,000.00 3.50% 11) Marketing $ - 0.00% 12) Working Capital $ 175,000.00 1.75%

Total $ 3,375,750.00 33.76%

25

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

284

Phase II Third Quarter of Operations Projected Expense % of Gross Proceeds

1) Commissions Paid $ - 0.00% 2) Website Development $ 168,750.00 1.69% 3) Rent, Lease, & Utilities $ 81,420.00 0.81% 4) Connectivity $ 10,000.00 0.10% 5) Executive & Administrative $ 272,920.00 2.73% 6) Professional, Legal Advisory $ 20,000.00 0.20% 7) Advertising $ 1,433,660.00 14.34% 8) Equipment and Furniture $ - 0.00% 9) Tech Support $ 5,000.00 0.05%

10) Networking Equipment $ - 0.00% 11) Marketing $ 3,000.00 0.03% 12) Working Capital $ 175,000.00 1.75%

Total $ 2,169,750.00 21.70%

Phase III Third Quarter of Operations Projected Expense % of Gross Proceeds

1) Commissions Paid $ - 0.00% 2) Website Development $ 168,750.00 1.69% 3) Rent, Lease & Utilities $ 81,420.00 0.81% 4) Connectivity $ 15,000.00 0.15% 5) Executive & Administrative $ 272,920.00 2.73% 6) Professional, Legal, Advisory $ 20,000.00 0.20% 7) Advertising $ 1,433,660.00 14.34% 8) Equipment & Furniture $ - 0.00% 9) Tech Support $ 5,000.00 0.05%

10) Networking Equipment $ 150,000.00 1.50% 11) Marketing $ 3,000.00 0.03% 12) Working Capital $ 125,000.00 1.25%

Total $ 2,274,750.00 22.75%

Phase IV Fourth Quarter of Operations Projected Expense % of Gross Proceeds

1) Commissions Paid $ - 0.00% 2) Website Development $ 168,750.00 1.69% 3) Rent Lease, & Utilities $ 81,420.00 0.81% 4) Connectivity $ 20,000.00 0.20% 5) Executive & Administrative $ 272,920.00 2.73% 6) Professional, Legal, Advisory $ 20,000.00 0.20% 7) Advertising $ 1,433,660.00 14.34% 8) Equipment & Furniture $ - 0.00% 9) Tech Support $ 5,000.00 0.05%

10) Network Equipment $ - 0.00% 11) Marketing $ 3,000.00 0.03% 12) Working Capital $ 175,000.00 1.75%

Total $ 2,179,750.00 21.80% Gross Maximum Proceeds $ 10,000,000.00 100.00%

26

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

285

ASSUMPTIONS FOR FINANCIAL PROJECTIONS

A summary of the significant accounting policies applied in the preparation of the accompanying projected financial statements. Enclosed, are four-year financial projections of Wmhinc.com. Operations, derived from stated projections beginning January 2001. INITIAL FUNDING The Company is seeking funding in the amount of $10,000,000 from venture capital sources. PRE-OPERATIONAL EXPENSES / USE OF FUNDS

• Principal Office Development $ 602,480 (Tech Hardware/Software, Communication, Support, Office Furniture, Supplies…)

• Initial Promotional Budget $6,700,000 (NASCAR, Internet Promo, Print & Outdoor)

• Working Capital $ 725,840 (Licensing, Vehicle & Equip Lease, Product Development, R&D, Insurance)

• Cost of Offering $ 200,000

• Offering Commission $1,400,000

INCOME / SALES

72% to 75% of the total revenue is generated by business-to-business monthly fee transactions (B2B technology, government, developers, advertising, garages, service, motorsports, online auctions, Wmhinc.com branded homes). 25% to 28% of total revenues are generated by business-to-consumer monthly transactions (new home sales, bank-owned home sales, garages, parts/services, net listings of customer home sales). The Company currently has working agreements for approximately 4,000 homes with several developers for an average of $2,000 to $5,000 per house. Today manufactured homes make up over 25% of new homes in the United States. Sales of new manufactured homes exceeded $16 billion in 1999, an increase of 400% in the last ten years. With new design elements and customizable options, manufactured homes have begun to cross over into the mainstream.

• In 1999, the industry shipped 348,671 homes from 323 manufacturing facilities.

• The average sales price of a manufactured home was $43,600 in 1999. Single-section homes average $31,800, while multi-section homes average $50,200.

• Over 19 million people (about 8% of the U.S. population live full-time in over 8 million manufactured homes.

27

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

286

Wmhinc.com Financial Assumptions – page 2

Due to Wmhinc.com’s NASCAR involvement and FEMA partnership management clearly expects to drive over one million unique visitors through the web site every month within the first year. NASCAR’s online site generates over 43 million page views by over 4.6 million unique users per month, each averaging 9 minutes per visit. FEMA has over 150,000,000 unique visitors per year on its web site.

NOTES

Four-Year Cash Flow Projections

• Venture Capital – The Company’s principals are injecting $50,000 into business. In order to fund pre-operational expenses, the Company is seeking venture capital in the amount of $10,000,000.

• Cash Disbursements – Expenditures of cash will be determined by the current financial position of the Company. Marketing and Product Development will include focus groups, product & campaign development. Research & Development will consist of market analysis of viable market opportunities through its hub of web-based products and services. The company will also commit monthly investments in its corporate community programs in markets that we serve and have a strong presence.

Four-Year Income Projections

• The annual growth rate is justified by the Company’s discipline and ability to establish a web-based hub of manufactured home resources, long-term strategic alliances, and brand equity in viable markets.

• Expenses – Expenses are expected to increase as the Company intensifies its marketing and advertising campaigns. Furthermore, expenses are expected to increase as the Company hires additional staff. The Company plans to hire 5 department managers at an average salary of $40,000 per year each and 10 hourly employees at an average wage rate that totals $16,800 per year. Executive salaries will be as follows:

Paul S Jarolimek II President/CEO $ 52,500 Michael Gage CTO $ 52,500 MaryLou Jarolimek CFO $ 52,500 Stephen Massie EVP Warranty/Service $ 52,500 Jim Stephens EVP Sales $ 52,500 Suzanne Jarolimek EVP Customer Service $ 52,500 Larry Queen VP Technology - Graphics $ 52,500 Leon Jarolimek VP Customer Service/Warranty $ 52,500

• Income Tax Rate – 19% estimated federal tax; 9% estimated state tax, and 3% estimated local tax.

28

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

287

Three-Year Income Projection Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc.

Percentages = % of Sales/Revenues Updated: Nov, 2001 Year 1: 2002 Year 2: 2003 Year 3: 2004 Total: 3 Years

AMOUNT % AMOUNT % AMOUNT % AMOUNT % INCOME 1. SALES/REVENUES (Total) 17,216,075 100.00% 77,631,985 100.00% 136,623,886 100.00% 231,471,946 100.00% a. B2B Technology 1,705,258 9.91% 7,842,148 10.10% 13,673,847 10.01% 23,221,253 10.03% b. B2B Government 1,381,258 8.02% 6,330,184 8.15% 11,070,952 8.10% 18,782,394 8.11% c. B2B Developers 3,752,185 21.79% 17,143,833 22.08% 28,695,395 21.00% 49,591,413 21.42% d. B2B Advertisers 3,410,510 19.81% 15,551,942 20.03% 27,325,714 20.00% 46,288,166 20.00% e. B2B Garages 511,577 2.97% 2,330,164 3.00% 4,098,726 3.00% 6,940,467 3.00% f. B2B Service 136,420 0.79% 621,149 0.80% 1,092,991 0.80% 1,850,560 0.80% g. B2B Motorsports 204,632 1.19% 931,623 1.20% 1,639,487 1.20% 2,775,742 1.20% h. B2B Online Auctions 341,121 1.98% 1,552,657 2.00% 2,732,478 2.00% 4,626,256 2.00% i. B2B Man. Wmhinc.com Homes 1,347,152 7.82% 5,532,123 7.13% 9,725,243 7.12% 16,604,518 7.17% Total B2B Sales 12,790,113 74.29% 57,835,823 74.50% 100,054,833 73.23% 170,680,769 73.74% j. B2C New Home 1,534,732 8.91% 7,375,043 9.50% 13,088,218 9.58% 21,997,993 9.50% k. B2C Bank Owned Home Sale 1,875,782 10.90% 8,539,519 11.00% 15,805,450 11.57% 26,220,751 11.33% l. B2C Garages 511,577 2.97% 2,328,960 3.00% 4,800,686 3.51% 7,641,223 3.30% m. B2C Parts/Service 153,473 0.89% 698,688 0.90% 1,301,162 0.95% 2,153,323 0.93% n. B2C "Net Listings" 350,398 2.04% 853,952 1.10% 1,573,537 1.15% 2,777,887 1.20% Total B2C Sales 4,425,962 25.71% 19,796,162 25.50% 36,569,053 26.77% 60,791,177 26.26% 2. COST OF GOODS SOLD 0 0.00% 0 0.00% 0 0.00% 0 0.00% 3. GROSS PROFIT ON SALES (1-2) 17,216,075 100.00% 77,631,985 100.00% 136,623,886 100.00% 231,471,946 100.00%

EXPENSES 1. VARIABLE (Selling) (a thru g) 5,081,104 29.51% 18,072,884 23.28% 34,871,019 25.52% 58,025,007 25.07% a. Marketing and Advertising 2,046,308 11.89% 12,456,948 16.05% 23,845,694 17.45% 38,348,950 16.57% b. Communications Support 53,296 0.31% 264,894 0.34% 275,946 0.20% 594,136 0.26% c. Community Reinvestments 886,733 5.15% 1,250,000 1.61% 2,000,000 1.46% 4,136,733 1.79% d. Research and Development 1,559,054 9.06% 2,398,512 3.09% 5,200,000 3.81% 9,157,566 3.96% e. Technical Support 169,762 0.99% 473,955 0.61% 521,658 0.38% 1,165,375 0.50% f. Travel and Entertainment 341,051 1.98% 492,753 0.63% 1,732,856 1.27% 2,566,660 1.11% g. Vehicle/Equipment Leases 24,900 0.14% 735,822 0.95% 1,294,865 0.95% 2,055,587 0.89%

2. FIXED (Administrative) (a thru m) 1,427,176 8.29% 6,449,120 8.31% 11,107,191 8.13% 18,983,487 8.20% a. Company Benefits/Insurance 110,400 0.64% 834,426 1.07% 1,859,465 1.36% 2,804,291 1.21% b. Executive Salaries 864,996 5.02% 1,648,651 2.12% 2,354,986 1.72% 4,868,633 2.10% c. Facility Expense 43,680 0.25% 1,469,512 1.89% 3,654,895 2.68% 5,168,087 2.23% d. General Office Expenses 25,939 0.15% 192,645 0.25% 272,698 0.20% 491,282 0.21% e. Insurance and Licensing 24,000 0.14% 359,485 0.46% 426,595 0.31% 810,080 0.35% f. Labor/Wages 168,672 0.98% 495,365 0.64% 921,589 0.67% 1,585,626 0.69% g. Legal 4,256 0.02% 50,000 0.06% 70,000 0.05% 124,256 0.05% h. Maintenance/Repairs 6,902 0.04% 64,974 0.08% 75,913 0.06% 147,789 0.06% i. Memberships & Subscriptions 2,779 0.02% 5,139 0.01% 7,968 0.01% 15,886 0.01% j. Non-Income Taxes 134,376 0.78% 578,624 0.75% 716,945 0.52% 1,429,945 0.62% k. Utilities 12,071 0.07% 122,698 0.16% 254,658 0.19% 389,427 0.17% l. Depreciation 14,023 0.08% 42,978 0.06% 64,895 0.05% 121,896 0.05% m. Misc. Fixed Expense 15,082 0.09% 584,623 0.75% 426,584 0.31% 1,026,289 0.44%

TOTAL OPERATING EXPENSE (1+2) 6,508,280 37.80% 19,500,060 25.12% 45,978,210 33.65% 77,008,494 33.27% NET INCOME OPERATIONS (GP-Exp) 10,707,795 62.20% 58,131,925 74.88% 90,645,676 66.35% 154,463,452 66.73% OTHER INCOME (Interest Income) 0 0.00% 0 0.00% 0 0.00% 0 0.00% OTHER EXPENSE (Interest Expense) 0 0.00% 0 0.00% 0 0.00% 0 0.00% NET PROFIT (LOSS) BEFORE TAXES 10,707,795 62.20% 58,131,925 74.88% 90,645,676 66.35% 154,463,452 66.73% TAXES 1. Federal, S-Employment 3,268,916 18.99% 16,895,236 21.76% 28,694,855 21.00% 48,859,007 21.11% 2. State 1,456,855 8.46% 4,956,265 6.38% 8,956,212 6.56% 15,369,332 6.64% 3. Local 470,258 2.73% 851,896 1.10% 1,318,623 0.97% 2,640,777 1.14%

NET PROFIT (LOSS) AFTER TAXES 5,511,766 32.02% 35,428,528 45.64% 51,675,986 37.82% 87,594,336 37.84%

29

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

288

Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement Page 1 (January thru June)

Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. For the Year 2002

Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun BEGINNING CASH BALANCE 422,040 386,590 584,289 777,245 1,898,144 2,373,465

CASH RECEIPTS A. Sales/Revenues B2B 604,681 662,229 691,834 740,481 772,063 875,799 1. B2B Technology 80,624 88,297 92,245 98,731 102,942 116,773 2. B2B Government 65,306 71,521 74,718 79,972 83,383 94,586 3. B2B Developers 177,373 194,254 202,938 217,208 226,472 256,901 4. B2B Advertisers 161,248 176,594 184,489 197,462 205,883 233,546 5. B2B Garages 24,187 26,489 27,673 29,619 30,883 35,032 6. B2B Service 6,450 7,064 7,380 7,898 8,235 9,342 7. B2B Motorsports 9,675 10,596 11,069 11,848 12,353 14,013 8. B2B Online Auctions 16,125 17,659 18,449 19,746 20,588 23,355 9. B2B Man. Wmhinc.com 63,693 69,755 72,873 77,997 81,324 92,251 B. Sales/Revenues B2C 201,561 220,743 230,611 246,827 257,356 291,933 1. B2C New Home 72,562 79,467 83,020 88,858 92,648 105,096 2. B2C Bank Owned Home Sale 88,687 97,127 101,469 108,604 113,236 128,450 3. B2C Garages 24,187 26,489 27,673 29,619 30,883 35,032 4. B2C Parts/Service 7,256 7,947 8,302 8,886 9,265 10,510 5. B2C "Net Listings" 8,869 9,713 10,147 10,860 11,324 12,845 TOTAL CASH AVAILABLE 1,228,282 1,490,305 1,737,345 2,011,380 3,184,919 3,833,130 CASH PAYMENTS A. Cost of goods to be sold 1. (Currently no COG) 0 0 0 0 0 0 Total Cost of Goods 0 0 0 0 0 0 B. Variable (Selling) Expenses 1. Marketing and Advertising 102,847 113,594 119,143 128,359 134,118 143,482 2. Communications Support 4,200 4,500 4,500 4,750 4,750 4,500 3. Community Reinvestments 41,925 45,914 47,967 51,340 53,530 60,722 4. Research and Development 11,265 16,093 22,990 32,843 46,918 67,026 5. Technical Support 14,000 14,200 14,250 14,250 14,562 14,500 6. Travel and Entertainment 28,000 28,000 29,500 30,000 30,000 30,000 7. Vehicle/Equipment Leases 2,000 2,250 1,875 2,100 1,975 2,000 Total Variable Expenses 204,237 224,551 240,225 263,642 285,853 322,230 C. Fixed (Administrative) Expenses 1. Company Benefits/Insurance 8,500 8,500 9,000 9,000 9,000 10,500 2. Executive Salaries 72,083 72,083 72,083 72,083 72,083 72,083 3. Facility Expense 3,640 3,640 3,640 3,640 3,640 3,640 4. General Office Expenses 2,000 2,050 2,350 2,010 1,989 2,100 5. Insurance and Licensing 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 6. Labor/Wages 14,056 14,056 14,056 14,056 14,056 14,056 7. Legal 1,000 0 0 0 0 256 8. Maintenance/Repairs 500 500 530 600 520 550 9. Memberships & Subscriptions 200 200 200 200 200 200 10. Non-Income Taxes 9,768 10,012 10,364 10,779 11,085 11,201 11. Utilities 900 900 900 900 1,200 1,200 12. Misc. Fixed Expense 1,250 1,250 1,250 1,250 1,250 1,250 Total Fixed Expenses 115,897 115,191 116,373 116,518 117,023 119,036 D. Interest Expense 0 0 0 0 0 0 E. Federal Income Tax 188,648 197,553 210,945 225,379 237,658 249,985 F. State and Other Taxes 82,975 95,000 106,599 119,251 137,654 158,954 G. Long-term asset payments 0 0 0 0 0 0 H. Marketable Investments 161,248 176,594 184,489 197,462 205,883 233,546 I. Notes Payable to Investors 88,687 97,127 101,469 108,604 113,236 128,450 TOTAL CASH PAID OUT 841,692 906,016 960,100 1,030,856 811,454 1,212,201 CASH BALANCE/DEFICIENCY 386,590 584,289 777,245 1,898,144 2,373,465 2,620,929 LOANS TO BE RECEIVED 0 0 0 0 0 0 EQUITY DEPOSITS 0 0 0 0 0 0

ENDING CASH BALANCE 386,590 584,289 777,245 1,898,144 2,373,465 2,620,929

Note: Beginning Cash Balance 50,000 Pre-operational Expenses Venture Capital 10,000,000 Principal Office Development 602,480 Total Cash Available $10,050,000 Initial Promotional Budget 6,700,000

Working Capital 725,480 Less Pre-operational Expenses (right) 9,627,960 Cost of Offering 200,000

Offering Commission 1,400,000 Gross Cash Balance $422,040 Total Pre-operational Expenses $9,627,96

30

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

289

Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement Page 2 (July thru December + 6 & 12-month Totals)

Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc.

6-MONTH 12-MONTH TOTALS Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec TOTALS

422,040 2,620,929 2,937,063 3,335,980 3,755,714 4,406,160 5,825,008 422,040

4,347,087 976,577 1,133,671 1,239,890 1,598,372 1,688,166 1,806,350 12,790,113 579,612 130,128 151,147 165,319 213,116 225,089 240,847 1,705,258 469,486 105,403 122,429 133,908 172,624 182,322 195,086 1,381,258

1,275,146 286,901 332,523 363,701 468,856 495,195 529,863 3,752,185 1,159,222 260,255 302,293 330,637 426,233 450,177 481,693 3,410,510

173,883 39,038 45,344 49,596 63,935 67,527 72,254 511,577 46,369 10,410 12,092 13,225 17,049 18,007 19,268 136,420 69,554 15,615 18,138 19,838 25,574 27,011 28,902 204,632

115,922 26,026 30,299 33,064 42,623 45,018 48,169 341,121 457,893 102,801 119,406 130,602 168,362 177,820 190,268 1,347,152

1,449,031 325,318 377,866 413,298 532,791 564,456 763,202 4,425,962 521,651 117,115 136,032 148,787 191,805 202,580 216,762 1,534,732 637,573 143,140 166,261 181,851 234,428 247,598 264,931 1,875,782 173,883 39,038 45,344 49,596 63,935 67,527 72,254 511,577

52,166 11,711 13,603 14,879 19,180 20,258 21,676 153,473 63,758 14,314 16,626 18,185 23,443 26,493 187,579 350,398

6,218,158 4,248,142 4,826,466 5,402,466 6,419,668 7,223,238 9,157,762 17,638,115

0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

741,543 142,178 159,605 167,446 252,396 285,949 297,191 2,046,308

27,200 4,396 4,350 4,350 4,200 4,300 4,500 53,296 301,398 67,666 78,596 85,966 110,821 117,046 125,240 886,733 197,135 95,751 136,787 195,410 279,157 310,175 344,639 1,559,054

85,762 14,000 13,500 13,500 13,500 15,000 14,500 169,762 175,500 24,551 25,000 25,000 25,000 26,000 40,000 341,051

12,200 2,400 2,500 1,500 1,700 2,100 2,500 24,900 1,540,738 350,942 420,338 493,172 686,774 760,570 828,570 5,081,104

54,500 10,500 10,000 9,400 8,000 9,000 9,000 110,400

432,498 72,083 72,083 72,083 72,083 72,083 72,083 864,996 21,840 3,640 3,640 3,640 3,640 3,640 3,640 43,680 12,499 2,700 2,500 1,830 2,310 2,000 2,100 25,939 12,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 24,000 84,336 14,056 14,056 14,056 14,056 14,056 14,056 168,672

1,256 1,000 0 0 0 0 2,000 4,256 3,200 600 600 627 675 600 600 6,902 1,200 264 263 263 263 263 263 2,779

63,209 11,329 11,435 11,754 12,066 12,261 12,322 134,376 6,000 1,200 1,200 971 900 900 900 12,071 7,500 1,257 1,257 1,267 1,267 1,267 1,267 15,082

700,038 120,629 119,034 117,891 117,260 118,070 120,231 1,413,153 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

1,310,168 265,481 296,862 324,644 341,552 357,708 272,501 3,168,916 700,433 170,632 185,698 198,557 207,261 224,677 239,855 1,927,113

0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1,159,222 260,255 302,293 330,637 426,233 450,177 481,693 3,410,510

637,573 143,140 166,261 181,851 234,428 247,598 264,931 1,875,782 6,048,172 1,311,079 1,490,486 1,646,752 2,013,508 1,398,230 2,207,781 16,876,578

169,986 2,937,063 3,335,980 3,755,714 4,406,160 5,825,008 6,949,981 761,537 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

169,986 2,937,063 3,335,980 3,755,714 4,406,160 5,825,008 6,949,981 761,537

31

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

290

Projected Balance Sheet

Business Name: Date of Projection: November 2001 Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Date Projected For: December 31, 2002

ASSETS % of LIABILITIES % of Assets Liabilities

Current Assets Current Liabilities Cash $ 6,949,981 35.40% Accounts Payable $ 1,166,475 14.16% Petty Cash $ 0 0.00% Notes Payable $ 0 0.00% Accounts Receivable $ 7,054,432 35.93% Interest Payable $ 0 0.00% Inventory $ 0 0.00% Marketable Investments $ 1,875,578 9.55% Tax Accruals

Federal Income Tax $ 3,268,916 39.68% State Income Tax $ 1,456,855 17.68%

Long Term Investments $ 0 0.00% Local Income Tax $ 470,258 5.71% Sales Tax Accrual $ 0 0.00%

Fixed Assets Property Tax $ 0 0.00% Land (valued at cost) $ 0 0.00%

Payroll Accrual $ 0 0.00% Buildings $ 0 0.00% 1. Cost 0 Long Term Liabilities 2. Less Acc. 0 Notes Payable to Investors $ 1,875,782 22.77%

Notes Payable, Others $ 0 0.00% Improvements $ 0 0.00% 1. Cost 0 2. Less Acc. 0 TOTAL LIABILITIES $ 8,238,286 100.00%

Equipment $ 485,977 2.48% 1. Cost 500,000 2. Less Acc. 14,023

NET WORTH % of Furniture $ 0 0.00% Net Worth 1. Cost 0 2. Less Acc. 0 Corporation

Autos/Vehicles $ 0 0.00% Capital Stock $ 10,500,000 92.16% 1. Cost 0 2. Less Acc. 0 Surplus Paid In $ 0 0.00%

Retained Earnings $ 893,556 7.84%

Other Assets 1. Non-Depreciable Assets $ 3,265,874 16.64% 2. $ 0 0.00%

TOTAL NET WORTH $ 11,393,556 100.00% Assets + Liabilities = Net Worth

TOTAL ASSETS $ 19,631,842 100.00% and Liabilities + Equity = Total Assets

32

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

291

Break-Even Analysis Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc.

Date of Analysis: November, 2001 20

E X 18 P E 16 N T S 14 O E T 12 A & L 10 R E E 8 X V P E 6 E N Variable N U 4 Costs S E E 2 Fixed $ Costs $ $ 0 $ 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 DOLLARS SALES VOLUME

NOTE: Figures shown in one (1) millions of dollars (Ex: 2 = $ 2,000,000)

B-E POINT (SALES) = Fixed costs + [(Variable Costs/Est. Revenues) X Sales] B-E Point (Sales) = $ 3,872,963 + [ ( $ 2,635,317 / $ 17,052,654 ) X Sales ]

Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc.

Break-Even Point Calculation

FC (Fixed Costs) = (Administrative Expenses + Interest) $ 3,872,963 VC ( Variable Costs ) = (Cost of Goods + Selling Expenses) $ 2,635,317 R ( Est. Revenues ) = (Income from sale of products and services) $ 17,052,564

Break-Even Point = $ 4,580,899

33

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

292

Financial Statement Analysis Summary The following is a summary of the 2002 (projected) financial statement analysis information developed on the ratio table on the next page.

2002 INDUSTRY PROJECTED STANDARD

1. Net Working Capital $9,517,487 $0 + or - 2. Current Ratio 2.50 1.60 + or - 3. Quick Ratio 2.5 0.4 + or - 4. Gross Profit Margin* 100.00% 22.70% 5. Operating Profit Margin* 62.20% 2.60% * See explanation below (Notes) 6. Net Profit Margin 32.00% 0.0% 7. Debt to Assets 41.96% 0.0% 8. Debt to Equity 72.31% 12.5:1 + 9. ROI (Return on Investment) 28.08% 0.0% +

10. Vertical Income Statement Analysis * Sales/Revenues 100.00% Cost of Goods 0.0% 0.0% + or - Gross Profit 100.00% 22.70% + or - Operating Expense 37.80% 20.30% + or - Net Income Operations 62.20% 2.40% + or - Interest Income 0.0% N/A Interest Expense 0.00% Variable Net Profit (Pre-Tax) 62.20% 2.60% + or - * All items stated as % of Total Revenues

11. Vertical Balance Sheet Analysis * Current Assets 80.90% 77.40% Inventory 0.0% 61.50% Total Assets 100.00% 100.00% Current Liabilities 32.40% 62.30% + or - Total Liabilities 42.00% Net Worth 58.00% 26.50% + or - Total Liabilities + Net Worth 100.0%

* All Asset items stated as % of Total Assets;

Liability & Net Worth items stated as % of Total Liabilities + Net Worth

Notes: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. is entering a rapidly growing marketplace and has developed a business model that will keep operating expenses at a minimum. By outsourcing activities related to the development of mobile homes, the Company will initially have zero cost of goods sold. Due to the nature of business activities, Management does not anticipate carrying inventory. The operating expenses are higher than industry standards in year 1 because of the high costs associated with entry into the marketplace. With zero cost of goods sold, Wmhinc.com has higher profit margins than RMA figures. Financial projections show that, based on an investment of $10 million, Wmhinc.com will maintain good cash flow, increase profitability, and provide a timely and healthy return for investors.

34

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

293

Financial Statement Analysis Ratio Table

Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Type of Analysis Formula Projected: 2002

1. Liquidity Analysis Balance Sheet Current Assets 15,879,991 Current Assets Current Liabilities 6,362,504

a. Net Working Capital Current Liabilities Net Working Capital $9,517,487 Balance Sheet Current Assets 15,879,991

b. Current Ratio Current Assets Current Liabilities 6,362,504 Current Liabilities Current Ratio 2.50 Balance Sheet Current Assets 15,879,991

c. Quick Ratio Current Assets minus Inventory Inventory 0 Current Liabilities Current Liabilities 6,362,504

Quick Ratio 2.50

2. Profitability Analysis Income Statement Gross Profits 17,216,075

a. Gross Profit Margin _Gross Profits_ Sales 17,216,075 Sales Gross Profit Margin 100.00%

b. Operating Profit _Income From Operations_ Income From Operations 10,707,795 Margin Sales Sales 17,216,075

Operating Profit Margin 62.20%

c. Net Profit Margin __Net Profits__ Net Profits 5,511,766 Sales Sales 17,216,075 Net Profit Margin 32.02%

3. Debt Ratios Balance Sheet Total Liabilities 8,238,286

Total Liabilities_ Total Assets 19,631,842 a. Debt to Assets Total Assets Debt to Assets Ratio 41.96%

___Total Liabilities___ Total Liabilities 8,238,286

b. Debt to Equity Total Owners' Equity Total Owners' Equity 11,393,556 Debt to Equity Ratio 72.31%

4. Investment Measures Balance Sheet Net Profits 5,511,766

a. ROI Net Profits__ Total Assets 19,631,842 (Return on Investment) Total Assets ROI (Ret. on Investment) 28.08%

Balance Sheet NOTE: 1. Each asset % of Total Assets

5. Vertical Financial 2. Liability & Equity % Total L&E See Attached Statement Analysis Income Statement Projected Balance Sheet Analysis - page 37

3. All items % of Total Revenues Projected Income Statement Analysis - page 36

Balance Sheet 1. Assets, Liab & Equity measured NOTE: against 2nd year. Increases and

6. Horizontal Financial decreases stated as amount & % Horizontal Analysis Statement Analysis Income Statement Not Applicable

2. Revenues & Expenses measured against 2nd year. Increases and New Business decreases stated as amount & %

35

Anatomy of a Business Plan – Appendix III: Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan

294

SUPPORTING DOCUMENTS

Insurance Update Form

* Note: For purposes of brevity, we have chosen to include only one of the supporting documents from Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc.’s business plan.

Insurance Update Form Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc.

Updated as of November, 2001

Company Contact Person Coverage Cost Per Year

1. HealthWest Insurance James Boyd Medical and Other Benefits $ 110,400 2526 St. John's Street (509) 523-9568 Las Vegas, NV 89247

2. The Insurance Agency Michael Smith Business Liability $ 4,800 16432 Midway Street (509) 795-7556 Las Vegas, NV 89147

3. The Insurance Agency Michael Smith Industry Specific Liability $ 8,100 (Address: see above) (509) 795-7556

4. The Insurance Agency Michael Smith Workers Compensation $ 6,100 (Address: see above) (509) 795-7556

5. The Insurance Agency Michael Smith Key-man Coverage $ 3,000 (Address: see above) (509) 795-7556

6. Auto Insurance Brokers Gene Hastings Auto - Vehicle 1 $ 1,000 4589 Marsh Lane (509) 465-1235 Las Vegas, NV 89146

7. Auto Insurance Brokers Gene Hastings Auto - Vehicle 2 $ 1,000 (Address: see above) (509) 465-1235

1. Total Annual Insurance Cost $ 134,400

2. Average Monthly Insurance Cost $ 11,200

36

295 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Appendix

I IV

KARMA JAZZ CAFÉ Business Plan

The business plan presented in Appendix IV is an actual business plan developed for Karma Jazz Café using Anatomy of a Business Plan and its software companion, AUTOMATE YOUR BUSINESS PLAN. KARMA JAZZ CAFÉ Scenario This business was established by DeShea Cook, a veteran of the restaurant industry with over 12 years experience. She developed the concept for Karma Jazz Café in 2006 in response to emerging trends and the need for unique dining concepts with an ethnic flavor. In 2007, DeShea moved forward by opening a location in Atlanta, GA. Based on the success of that location, she then set out on a mission to open up a second location in Fort Worth, TX. This business plan was developed for the setup of the new location. Finally, a Business Plan for a Restaurant I have been asked many times whether or not we have a business plan for a restaurant. Because of DeShea, we now have this fine example. Although restaurant businesses vary greatly regarding their business visions, the types of food and beverages they specialize in, the services they offer, the customers they cater to, and the business procedures they follow, this plan should help to give you a jump start when it comes to planning for your own business. A special thank you to DeShea Cook for her generosity and willingness to share her business plan with my readers and software users. Business plans take lots of time to develop and they are considered to be extremely personal and proprietary. It is not often that I find business owners who are willing to put their companies’ business plans in print for the benefit of other people who are looking for information and guidance during the writing process. DeShea’s sharing of her Karma Jazz Café business plan with my readers is a great example of entrepreneurs helping each other.

296 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

I would also like to note that Ndaba Mdhlongwa, the same business plan specialist that wrote the Wholesale Mobile Home, Inc. business plan (Appendix III), was instrumental in working with DeShea Cook on the development of the plan for the Atlanta location and on the translation of that plan into a new plan for the Fort Worth location. It is most important that business owners actively participate in the writing of their business plans. However, it is not uncommon to hire the services of a professional to work with them at various stages in the process to look for strengths and weaknesses and to help them through portions of the plans in which they need to work out problems. The combined effort can prove to be very effective. Of Special Note in This Plan Although this is a business plan for a second Karma Jazz Café based on the same concept as the first one in Atlanta, this plan is treated as one for a start-up business. Many things would be the same. However, since the two locations are different, it was especially important to conduct adequate research on the demographics and psychographics for the Fort Worth, Texas target market. It also follows that a current competitive analysis was needed for the new area. Although the two restaurants are branded the same and have the same owner, each has its own identifying factors. I would also like to note, that the financial projections in the current plan have been scaled down to reflect a more conservative scenario. One of the most common errors in making financial projections is the overstating of revenues and the understating of expenses. In this case, historical financial statement analysis from the initial location has helped the owner to make more realistic projections for the new location. When you develop and write your own plan, it will help you to see how each of the corresponding sections was handled in the Karma Jazz Café business plan. However, remember that your own company will be unique. The business planning process is the same, but your plan will have to match your vision and your financial and marketing plans will have to be based on your own area and target market.

Warning! This plan is to be examined for the handling of content only. It has been included in Anatomy of a Business Plan because it is a sound business plan for a restaurant that was launched and is successfully operating in Atlanta, Georgia. There is no judgment inferred as to appropriateness or financial potential for lenders or investors. Do not use it as a source of research for your own company. Important. Do not try to contact DeShea Cook or any of the other people mentioned in this business plan. It would not be appropriate. However, I’m sure that DeShea would be most happy if you would like to thank her for sharing her business plan by patronizing the Karma Jazz Café in Atlanta, GA or Fort Worth, TX.

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 297

KARMA JAZZ CAFÉ “Jazz is Alive and Well”

224 Goldeneye Lane

Fort Worth, TX76120

817-939-9152

Website: www.karmajazzcafe.com

Email: [email protected]

Contact: DeShea Cook

KJC

Prepared January 2008 ______________________________________________________________________________

This confidential summary has been prepared for those wishing to establish a business relationship with Karma Jazz Café. By accepting a copy of this document, the recipient agrees not to reproduce it in whole or in part, not to use it for any other purpose, and not to disclose any of its contents to third parties without written permission of Karma Jazz Café. This document is a summary. It is furnished for information purposes only. No representation or warranty is made by Karma Jazz Café or any other entity as to the accuracy or completeness of such information, and nothing contained in the summary is, or shall be, relied on as a promise or representation to the future.

______________________________________________________________________________

298 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Table of Contents

I. Executive Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 01 - 04 II. Part I: Organizational Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 05 - 10

Summary of the Business . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 05 Products and/or Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . 07 Administrative Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 07

Location, Legal Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 07 Management and Personnel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 08 Accounting and Legal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 09 Insurance, Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10

III. Part Ii: Marketing Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 - 18

Overview and Goals of Marketing Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Market Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11

Target Market(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Competition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Market Trends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14

Marketing Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 General Description, Methods of Sales and Distribution . . . . . . 15 Packaging, Pricing, Branding, Sales Strategies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Sales Incentives/Promotions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Advertising Strategies, Public Relations, Networking . . . . . . . . 17

Customer Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Implementation of Marketing Strategy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18

IV. Part III: Financial Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 - 31 2007 Historical Financial Statements (Atlanta Location) . . . . . . . . 20 - 21

Profit & Loss Statement (Oct. 2007 thru Dec. 2007) . . . . . . . . . 20 Balance Sheet (December 31, 2007) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21

Sources and Uses of Loan Funds (Ft. Worth Location) . . . . . . . . . 22 Financial Projections (Fort Worth Location) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 - 30

Financial Assumptions for Projections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Three-Year Income Projection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Projected Balance Sheet. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Break-Even Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Charts & Graphs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28

Financial Statement Ratio Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 - 30 Financial Statement Analysis Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Financial Statement Analysis Ratio Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30

V. Supporting Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31

299 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Executive Summary Karma Jazz Café was established by DeShea Cook, a veteran of the restaurant industry with over 12 years experience. She has also assembled a highly capable management team along with an advisory board consisting of individuals with over 25 years experience in restaurant and nightclub ownership. DeShea Cook established the concept for Karma Jazz Café in 2006, this in response to emerging trends and the need for unique dining concepts with an ethnic flavor. In 2007, she moved forward by opening a location in Atlanta, GA. Based on the success of that location, DeShea Cook is on a mission to open up a second location in Fort Worth, TX. This business plan has been developed for the setup of the new location. Located in Sundance Square, in the heart of downtown Fort Worth, TX, Karma Jazz Café will be an enchanting full-service restaurant offering the finest Creole style cuisine. Karma Jazz Café will also provide customers with a unique dining experience, featuring live smooth jazz on Thursday, Friday, Saturday, and Sunday. Karma Jazz Café will be the only live jazz venue in the very lucrative tourist district of Fort Worth. The 200 capacity Karma Jazz Café will have cozy lounge areas and intimate table settings with direct view of the stage area. Patio dining will allow guests to dine with enjoying the elements. The menu will be a collaborative effort between the company owner and the Head Chef. This approach will be necessary in order to combine the owners’ many years of experience in Creole cuisine with new and creative culinary techniques. The result will be a selection of dishes that will appeal to the sophisticated consumer while maintaining exceptional dining value. Market Opportunity According to the National Restaurant Association, the U.S. restaurant industry with 945,000 restaurant locations is expected to generate $558 billion in 2008. In Texas, the National Restaurant Association estimates that the restaurant industry hit sales of $32 billion in 2007. Restaurant operators are increasingly optimistic about the direction of the restaurant industry and the overall economy, according to the latest results of the National Restaurant Association's Restaurant Performance Index. During the next several months, restaurant operators are expecting positive trends in terms of sales, staffing levels, capital expenditures, as well as the overall economy1. Karma Jazz Café will develop a captivating, friendly atmosphere, provide outstanding service and offer an extensive selection of quality Creole food. These key elements will add up to a highly successful venture that will yield high returns.

1 National Restaurant Association

KJC

1

300 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Restaurant operators remain solidly optimistic about sales growth in their establishments. Sixty- one percent of restaurant operators expect to have higher sales in six months (compared to the same period in the previous year), while only 6 percent of operators expect their sales volume in six months to be lower than it was during the same period in the previous year. Restaurant operators are also more confident in the direction of the overall economy. Fifty-five percent of restaurant operators expect economic conditions in six months to be better than they are now – up from 52 percent last month and the strongest outlook in eight months2. Karma Jazz Café will take advantage of the positive outlook being portrayed by existing restaurant operators to develop a dynamic restaurant that will grow to become the establishment of choice for fine dining and live jazz experiences. To accomplish this goal, the company will leverage the experience of its highly experienced management team and the support of its advisory board. Management

DeShea Cook brings several years of experience in various entertainment avenues and over five years of finance management along with over a decade of exceptional customer service training. She is no stranger to business ownership. For the past three years, she has owned and operated a successful entertainment company that promotes local events with entertainers. DeShea Cook worked in various positions in restaurants and nightclubs that her stepfather has owned and/or managed. These positions included, but are not limited to; waitstaff, hostess, inventory control, booking acts for events, etc. DeShea Cook currently serves as Consumer Finance Manager for New Beginnings, a company that takes care of mentally challenged adults and children. DeShea Cook attended Collin County Community College where she studied Telecommunication Management and Fine Art. After a move to Atlanta, she studied real estate and worked for Harry Norman Realtors and Coldwell Banker Residential under their top Sales Representative. While at Harry Norman Realtors, she worked on several major condominium projects and grossed over $2 million in sales. During that time, she continued to work in the entertainment industry under her stepfather’s guidance and assisted with celebrity parties and events.

Raymond Jones is an expert in restaurant and bar industry management. With over 20 years of experience in the restaurant and bar industry, as an owner and professional consultant, Mr. Jones has handled all areas of operations including proper food handling and preparation, safety procedures, cleanliness, temperature control, equipment controls and maintenance. He has consulted for major hotel and restaurant chains on management, health, and safety issues. Raymond Jones has also prepared training manuals and instructed staff on comprehensive restaurant policies and procedures. In his public entity consulting work, Raymond Jones was contracted to train restaurant personnel on behalf of the City of Dallas, regarding food preparation, safety procedures, hygiene, equipment use, and maintenance issues. In private entity work, he has provided consulting services and had direct employment in restaurant management positions for various corporations at numerous facilities nationwide.

2 National Restaurant Association

2

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 301

Advisor

Steve Cook, Jr. Steve Cook is a highly respected business professional. In 2005, he retired from TXU Energy after 36 years of service. By the time he retired, he had risen to the rank of Regional Manager. In his position as Regional Manager, he was responsible for planning, executing and directing the daily functions and operations of the Waco, Texas facility. Upon his retirement, he became President of CO-GILL Financial Services, LLC dba Home Purchase Center. The Home Purchase Center is committed to helping its clients find the right home mortgage product for their needs. Steve Cook is a former Board Member for CareLinc in Waco, TX. He is affiliated with several business organizations including the Irving Black Arts Council (Irving, TX), H.O.T. Minority Business Alliance (Waco, TX), Greater Waco Chamber of Commerce, Waco Hispanic Chamber of Commerce, and Waco Cultural Arts Fest.

Competitors The Sundance Square is home to a host of restaurants. It has been noted that one can dine there every day of the week and never eat at the same restaurant twice. While other restaurant establishments exist, their focus is not on Creole cuisine. The only establishment that offers Creole food, Razzoo’s, is more of a low end restaurant. They also offer a mix of American food. None of the restaurants in the Sundance Square currently offers live jazz music. Karma Jazz Café's Competitive Advantages Karma Jazz Café will provide the perfect mix of premium quality food and exciting jazz entertainment. It will be the only restaurant offering live jazz music. Only one other restaurant in Sundance Square, Razzoo’s, offers Creole style dishes. However, Karma Jazz Café will include many more modern dining elements than Razzoo’s and the other restaurants in the area as well as superior customer service. Management experience is a key competitive advantage for Karma Jazz Café. The owner, DeShea Cook, has been working in the restaurant industry for over 12 years in various positions. Three of the Company’s principal investors have successfully started and operated their own businesses for over 30 years. A member of the advisory team have established and operated several successful restaurants and night clubs for over 25 years. A key competitive advantage will be location. Karma Jazz Café will be located in the Tower Building in the Sundance Square. While this tourist district receives heavy traffic during the day, traffic is especially heavier on weekends. Evenings and weekends, Sundance Square takes on a whole new flavor. The area has a very large concentration of daytime workers that will not travel very far for lunch. Karma Jazz Café also has a strong opportunity to capture these guests for happy hour activities after work. Capital Requirements Karma Jazz Café has secured owner and investor funding in the amount of $200,000 for the development of its Fort Worth restaurant location.

3

302 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Sources of Funds

• Owners $100,000 • Investors $100,000

Total Funding $200,000

Breakdown of Use of Funds

Pre-Operational Expenditures • Improvements/Renovations $50,000 • Equipment $30,000 • Furniture & Fixtures $40,000 • Restaurant/Business Supplies $10,000 • Inventory $15,000 • Marketing & Advertising $20,000

Total (Pre-Operational Use of Funds) $165,000

Operational Funds • Working capital $35,000 Note. The working capital will be the beginning cash balance when

the restaurant begins operations.

Total Funding Use $200,000 Financial Projections

Projected Three-Year Income Statement Summary

Year 1: 2008 Year 1: 2009 Year 1: 2010

Revenues 1,312,395 1,447,959 1,631,096

Operating Expenses 1,224,158 1,354,411 1,469,574

Net Income Operations 60,439 61,319 105,169

4

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 303

Part I: Organizational Plan KARMA JAZZ CAFÉ

Summary of the Business The Karma Jazz Café concept was established by DeShea Cook in 2006. In 2007, she moved forward by opening a location in Atlanta, GA. Based on the success of that location, DeShea Cook is on a mission to open up a second location in Fort Worth, TX. This business plan has been developed for the setup of the new location. Karma Jazz Café is a full-service restaurant with particular focus on Creole cuisine. The Company’s proprietary recipes will be combined with modern culinary techniques and a more sophisticated atmosphere that will position the Karma Jazz Café brand in the marketplace and allow for future growth. The menu will have something for everyone and focus on flavors that consumers readily identify and associate with Creole cuisine. Showcase dishes include: Seafood Gumbo, Jumbo Grilled Shrimp, Crawfish Etouffee, Mahi Mahi, and Snapper. The menu is rounded out by a selection on salads, po-boys, and a premium line of specialty Creole toppings. Karma Jazz Café will be the premier, cozy, live jazz venue in the Dallas Fort Worth Metroplex. The Company’s goal is to remain a step ahead of its competition through an exemplary service provision. Karma Jazz Café expects its guests to have a relaxed and refreshing experience. Live jazz music, which is currently not being offered anywhere within Sundance Square, will be provided four days a week (Thursday, Friday, Saturday, and Sunday) at Karma Jazz Café. On other days and during lunch hours jazz music will be played in the background. Located on the main level of a new hi-rise development that is 98% occupied, Karma Jazz Café will have a simple, yet unique menu and atmosphere that will create a sense of romance and “belonging” for locals and tourists alike. Karma Jazz Café will also target local business professionals during lunch and happy hour. The hours of operation for Karma Jazz Café will be as follows:

Hours of Operation

Day Hours Wednesday through Thursday 4:00 pm to 11:00 pm Friday 4:00 pm to 2:00 am Saturday 6:00 pm to 2:00 am

Note. Karma Jazz Café will be closed on Thanksgiving Day, Christmas Day, and New Year’s Day.

Mission The mission of Karma Jazz Café is to develop an elegant establishment and offer a variety of unique Creole foods along with an exquisite mix of live jazz entertainment.

5

304 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Goals and Objectives The following goals and objectives have been established for Karma Jazz Café:

• Create awareness of the Company’s existence • Capitalize on the excellent location opportunity within Sundance Square • Become the venue of choice for fine dining • Launch operations at the Sundance Square venue with a highly publicized

grand opening event on or around May 1, 2008 • Closely monitor and maintain tight control of financial matters • Exceed $1,200,000 in annual sales by the third year of plan implementation

Strategy Karma Jazz Café will accomplish its goals and objectives by developing and implementing marketing campaigns that reach out and appeal to a broad consumer base. The restaurant will also benefit significantly from a major marketing campaign that is being done for the Sundance Square District. The live jazz entertainment will be the attraction that draws people to the restaurant for their dining needs. Adding to the appeal will be the restaurant’s combination of modern kitchen procedures and an extensive product mix with consistent quality. All this will be combined with exceptional customer service. On the operations side, Karma Jazz Café will install detailed operating procedures, standards, controls, and cooking methods and processes. To meet its goal of maintaining tight control on financials, Karma Jazz Café will use a point-of-sale (POS) cash register system that will provide management with hourly, daily, and weekly information regarding sales, inventory, food and beverage costs, labor costs, and other critical data that will assist in controlling operating expenses. Karma Jazz Café will capitalize on its location at the Sundance Square by developing strategies aimed at attracting the general population, workers in the area, as well as people attending various festivals such as Mayfest. For the holiday season, Karma Jazz Café plans to aggressively market a corporate catering program so businesses that wish to host holiday gatherings for customers or employees can select from a special menu designed for larger parties.

SWOT Analysis

Strengths Weaknesses

Management team and advisory board with extensive restaurant industry experience Sophisticated and inviting atmosphere with outdoor seating Authentic Cajun food Extensive food selection Live jazz music Marketing campaign that is being done to promote Sundance Square District

Start up restaurant

No brand recognition

6

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 305

Opportunities Threats

Location (Sundance Square District) allows Karma to reach workers, tourists, and residents Location will allow Karma to host corporate events and gatherings Expanding the brand to other major metropolitan areas Numerous festivals are held in the area attracting large crowds

Strong competition from established restaurants in the area

Emergence of restaurants that claim to offer Creole cuisine

Health and safety standards are always a potential liability in the restaurant industry

Products and Services Karma Jazz Café will be a classy full-service restaurant serving Cajun cuisine. The restaurant will feature a simple menu offering a variety of food that meets different tastes. Traditional “bar” appetizers will be on hand as well for people craving quesadillas, wings, calamari and an array of seafood while they drink and enjoy themselves. Karma Jazz Café will be characterized by cozy lounge areas and intimate table settings situated in a spectator setting with views of the stage area. The restaurant will comfortably accommodate 200 guests. The area will also offer patio dining. Karma Jazz Café will feature live jazz music from local jazz artists with strong listener base and following. A satellite feed with provide smooth jazz music during breaks and off-times. In the future, Karma Jazz Café plans to establish a catering division. The Company also has an opportunity for additional sales with the introduction of corporate and family catering programs. This revenue potential has not been considered in the projected sales as these programs are still in development. Administrative Plan A. Location

Karma Jazz Café will be located at 500 Throckmorton in the Sundance Square District of downtown Fort Worth, Texas. The restaurant will be situated on the street level of the Tower, an upscale hi-rise building. This positions Karma Jazz Café in an area that gets a heavy traffic flow of residents, tourists, and professionals. Karma Jazz Café plans to sign a long-term lease for approximately 6,000 square feet of space. Karma Jazz Café will as well as the availability of parking. There are several parking lots and parking garages on all four sides of the building. These parking areas are all free to the public after 5:00 pm Monday through Friday and all day Saturday and Sunday. Karma Jazz Café will also validate parking for my restaurant patrons.

B. Legal Structure Karma Jazz Café is registered as a Limited Liability Company (LLC) under the laws of the State of Texas.

7

306 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

C. Management, Personnel, and Advisor Karma Jazz Café has a capable management team with direct knowledge of the industry and the expertise to successfully manage a restaurant business. The management team currently includes DeShea Cook and Raymond Jones.

Management

DeShea Cook is pursuing a life-long ambition of restaurant ownership. She brings several years of experience in various entertainment avenues and over five years of finance management along with over a decade of exceptional customer service training. This experience will enable DeShea Cook to make the customer feel important while maintaining the bottom line for the Karma Jazz Café. DeShea Cook is no stranger to business ownership. She also owns and operates a successful entertainment company that promotes local events with entertainers. She has had this company for over three years. DeShea Cook worked in various positions in restaurants and nightclubs that her stepfather has owned and/or managed. These positions included, but are not limited to; waitstaff, hostess, inventory control, booking acts for events, etc. DeShea Cook has also been an apprentice under her mentor and fellow manager who has been in the business for over 25 years. DeShea Cook currently serves as Consumer Finance Manager for New Beginnings, a company that takes care of mentally challenged adults and children. She is responsible for all accounts payable and receivable and well as the liaison between the company and the Social Security Administration. She has held this position for three years and is regularly monitored and surveyed by the State of Texas. DeShea Cook attended Collin County Community College where she studied Telecommunication Management and Fine Art. After a move to Atlanta, she studied real estate and worked for Harry Norman Realtors and Coldwell Banker Residential under their top Sales Representative. While at Harry Norman Realtors, she worked on several major condominium projects and grossed over $2 million in sales. During that time, she continued to work in the entertainment industry under her stepfather’s guidance and assisted with celebrity parties and events.

Raymond Jones is an expert in restaurant and bar industry management. With over 20 years of experience in the restaurant and bar industry, as an owner and professional consultant, Raymond Jones has handled all areas of operations including proper food handling and preparation, safety procedures, cleanliness, temperature control, equipment controls and maintenance. He has consulted for major hotel and restaurant chains on management, health, and safety issues. What’s more, he has interfaced with health inspectors nationally on behalf of various clients. Raymond Jones has also prepared training manuals and instructed staff on comprehensive restaurant policies and procedures. In his public entity consulting work, Raymond Jones was contracted to train restaurant personnel on behalf of the City of Dallas, regarding food preparation, safety procedures, hygiene, equipment use, and maintenance issues. In private entity work, he has provided consulting services and had direct employment in restaurant management positions for various corporations at numerous facilities nationwide.

8

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 307

Personnel Karma Jazz Café places an extremely high value on the importance of its workforce (human capital). All employees will be treated with respect, compensated sufficiently, and provided with a professional work environment. The Company will implement various bonus programs aimed at retaining its workforce and minimizing turnover. These incentive programs will ensure that employees remain at the Karma Jazz Café. The Company will also benefit from repeat business as customers establish relationships with Karma Jazz Café employees. Karma Jazz Café will create an exceptional work environment, designed to attract and keep the best employees in the industry. This will ensure consistency in the Company’s operations and provide Karma Jazz Café with a cost effective and less expensive way of operating. The Company will also organize various group events for employees aimed at promoting morale and employee relations. Karma Jazz Café plans to retain highly qualified individuals for the following key positions:

Advisor

Steve Cook, Jr. is a highly respected business professional. In 2005, he retired from TXU Energy after 36 years of service. By the time he retired, he had risen to the rank of Regional Manager. In his position as Regional Manager, he was responsible for planning, executing and directing the daily functions and operations of the Waco, Texas facility. Upon his retirement, he became President of CO-GILL Financial Services, LLC dba Home Purchase Center. The Home Purchase Center is committed to helping its clients find the right home mortgage product for their needs. Steve Cook is a former Board Member for CareLinc in Waco, TX. He is affiliated with several business organizations including the Irving Black Arts Council (Irving, TX), H.O.T. Minority Business Alliance (Waco, TX), Greater Waco Chamber of Commerce, Waco Hispanic Chamber of Commerce, and Waco Cultural Arts Fest.

D. Accounting and Legal

Accounting

Day-to-day bookkeeping will be done in-house. For added accounting and financial functions, Karma Jazz Café has retained the services of Accounting Systems, Inc., 1220 N. Freeway Drive, Fort Worth, TX 76210.

Personnel Breakdown Individual/Position Salary Busboys (3) $6.00 per hour Waitstaff (6) $2.75 per hour Bartenders (6) $3.00 hour Head Bartender (2) $3.75 hour Hostess $10.00 hour Security (4) $12.00 hour Janitorial service $500 per week

9

308 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Legal For all legal aspects relating the business, Karma Jazz Café has retained the services of Parker & Parker, LLP, 6589 Williams Avenue, Fort Worth, TX 76210.

E. Insurance

The following insurance policies will be obtained for Karma Jazz Café:

• Property • General liability • Umbrella/Excess Liability • Workers compensation

For all its insurance needs, Karma Jazz Café has retained the services of Texas Insurance Group, 3000 West Jordan Street, Fort Worth, TX 76210.

F. Security

Karma Jazz Café plans to procure a sophisticated point of sale system that will be the foundation of accounting controls for the restaurant. The Micros 3700 POS system will provide staff members with the means to enter all customer orders, time & attendance, and payments. This will provide the management team with detailed reports on food, beverage, and liquor usage. This information will then be utilized to conduct weekly inventory accounting for all items in the restaurant and then compared to purchases. Any variances will be analyzed and resolved weekly. The Company’s inventory accounting system is the heart of operational processes; this will determine in near real time the state of the restaurant at any given time so the management team can make effective decisions. Credit card payments will also run through the POS system and processed via an encrypted broadband connection to the company’s credit card processor. This will not only help for the timeliness of each transaction, but will also eliminate the need for employees to manually record customer information as it’s all done electronically. Additionally, any customer information that is retained for marketing purposes will be housed on the Company’s servers with only the Restaurant Manager and owner having access. Physical security will be controlled via an in-house closed circuit camera system. The Company will have cameras mounted at key points throughout the restaurant including; front & back entrances, bar area, kitchen line, and stock room. A monitor will be housed in the manager’s office for viewing. Additionally, access to the restaurant’s cameras will available to the Company owner via an encrypted connection to the Internet. A password protected VPN client on the owner’s workstation off premises will provide the ability to monitor activities whenever necessary. Cash will be housed in the office safe that only the Restaurant Manager and owner have access to. Karma Jazz Café will have a no tolerance policy that the office be locked at all times. Bank deposits will also be conducted twice daily (after lunch and store closing) so as to reduce the cash that is left on premises. All transactions will be tracked for constant auditing.

10

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 309

Part II: Marketing Plan KARMA JAZZ CAFÉ

Marketing Strategy Overview and Goals (Marketing Plan: Section I)

Overview Karma Jazz Café will compete on the basis of taste, quality, dining value, live jazz music, and customer service to name a few. Management believes that the Karma Jazz Café concept will differentiate it from competitors. It is the only restaurant that offers high-end Creole cuisine as well as live jazz music. The Karma Jazz Café marketing strategy is bring awareness of its existence in order to attract and acquire customers that will look to it for ongoing dining needs. This will be accomplished by using various forms of media including radio, television, and print advertising.

Goals • Goal #1 – Establish Karma Jazz Café as an authentic Creole

restaurant.

• Goal #2 – Promote Karma Jazz Café as the only restaurant that provides live jazz music.

• Goal #3 – Build strong brand recognition leading to the opening of additional restaurants in other metropolitan areas.

• Goal #4 – Establish Karma Jazz Café as the location of choice for corporate events.

• Goal #5 – Attract a clientele for all occasions including lunch, dinner, and happy hour.

Market Analysis (Marketing Plan: Section II)

A. Target Market(s) Karma Jazz Café is targeting tenants of the Tower building, professionals that work in the Sundance Square District, residents of the Dallas Fort Worth Metroplex as well as tourists. Located in the heart of one of the hottest areas in the Dallas Fort Worth Metroplex, Karma Jazz Café will benefit from an embedded clientele.

11

310 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Daytime Statistics - Sundance Square District

Radius Daytime Population Median Age 0.5 mile of Karma Jazz Café 36,165 32.3 1 mile of Karma Jazz Café 47,816 33.3 2 miles of Karma Jazz Café 92,698 32.8

Note. Based on 2007 day time estimates

There are several major corporations with offices in downtown Fort Worth to attract a steady lunch and happy hour crowd. The Company will benefit from easy access to the restaurant. In addition to the easy access for drivers coming from all areas of the Dallas Fort Worth Metroplex, there is a public transportation system that runs through downtown and right by the restaurant.

Target Markets Demographics Psychographics Niche Market

Workers Age 24 - 40 Average income

starting at $40,000 and up

Enjoy fine dining Hold professional or managerial positions Dine out frequently

Attend happy hour events frequently

Enjoy music experience along with dining

Corporate clients that reserve space for happy

hour or company gatherings

Tourists/

Visitors Age 18 - 60 Out of town travelers

Looking specifically for Creole cuisine

Motivated to try different food types

Residents of Louisiana

Residents Age 18 - 60 Couples looking for elegant restaurant to dine

out Individuals with a taste

for ethnic foods Jazz music lovers

Individuals and families that moved to the area from Louisiana due to the hurricanes (Katrina

and Rita)

B. Competition

Major Competitors The Sundance Square is home to a host of restaurants. It has been noted that one can dine there every day of the week and never eat at the same restaurant twice. While other restaurant establishments exist, their focus is not on Creole cuisine. The only establishment that offers Creole food, Razzoos, is more of a low end restaurant. They also offer a mix of American food. None of the restaurants in the Sundance Square currently offers live jazz music.

12

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 311

Karma Jazz Café’s Competitive Advantages Karma Jazz Café will be successful because there is a need for the type of restaurant the Company is bringing to the Sundance Square District. Only one other restaurant, Razzoo’s, offers Creole style dishes. Karma Jazz Café will include many more modern dining elements than Razzoo’s and the other restaurants in the area. Additionally, The Company’s customer service approach will be superior. Karma Jazz Café will provide the perfect mix of premium quality food and exciting jazz entertainment. Karma Jazz Café will be the only restaurant offering live jazz music. There is an abundance of talented jazz artists in the area with the closest venue to play being over 40 miles away in Dallas, Texas. Karma Jazz Café will attract the most talented jazz artists in the area. To date, the Company has secured commitments from several leading jazz artists with large followings. Management experience is a key competitive advantage for the Karma Jazz Café. The owner, DeShea Cook, has been working in the restaurant industry for over 12 years in various positions. What’s more, jazz music has always played an important role in her life and the idea of Karma Jazz Café has been a life long dream. Karma Jazz Café will also be successful because of the team of advisors that are backing the venture. Three of the Company’s principal investors have successfully started and operated their own businesses for over 30 years. Some members of the management/advisory team have established and operated several successful restaurants

Restaurants at the Sundance Square

Restaurant Cuisine Type

Razzoo's American/Creole Taverna Pizzeria and Risotteria Authentic Italian 8.0 Restaurant And Bar Diverse selection including: Southwestern

cuisine, steaks, seafood and pastas Bella Vista Authentic Italian Pizza, pasta, hot & cold subs,

lasagna & daily specials Billy Miner's Saloon Burgers, Hotdogs, chicken & seafood options Cabo Grande Tex Mex Chili's Burgers, salads, fajitas and southwest favorites Chop House Steaks, Poultry & Seafood Specialties City Club of Fort Worth Fine dining and athletic club Daddy Jack's Seafood New England Seafood Ferre Ristorante e Bar Italian/Tuscan La Madeleine Bakery And Cafe French Country Mi Cocina Tex Mex P.F. Chang's China Bistro Chinese Cuisine Piranha Killer Sushi Japanese/Sushi Reata at Sundance Square Legendary Western Cuisine Riscky's Barbecue BBQ Ribs, Steaks, Catfish & Chicken Uno Chicago Grill Pizza, pasta, specialty dishes, sandwiches,

salads, desserts and full bar

13

312 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

and night clubs for over 25 years. This experience makes them very knowledgeable of the pitfalls and avenues for success in restaurant operations. A key competitive advantage will be location. Karma Jazz Café will be located in the Tower Building in the Sundance Square. This location is in a vibrant downtown marketplace. Sundance Square is 20 fabulous blocks of downtown Ft. Worth where people work, live, shop, and dine. By day, tourists, office workers and residents stroll brick-paved, flower-lined sidewalks, sightsee charming, historical buildings, shop in unique stores, and visit art galleries and museums. While this tourist district receives heavy traffic during the day, traffic is especially heavier on weekends. Evenings and weekends, Sundance Square takes on a whole new flavor. Exciting night life includes dancing to the hottest music, socializing in sleek bistros, lively outdoor concerts, laugh-out-loud comedy clubs, innovative theatre productions and 20 screens of box- office hits. The Karma Jazz Café’s dining value will also separate it from the others. Karma Jazz Café is known for generous portions at moderate prices. Karma Jazz Café will have a lunch menu specially developed for the large audience of the Sundance Square and downtown Fort Worth. The lunch menu will feature items that are similar to the dinner menu but with smaller portions and can be produced at a much faster pace meeting the limited time available for lunch. The area has a very large concentration of daytime workers that will not travel very far for lunch. Karma Jazz Café also has a strong opportunity to capture these guests for happy hour after work.

C. Market Trends

Industry Trends Restaurants are the cornerstones of the economy, career-and-employment opportunities for millions of Americans, and local communities. Nationally, with 945,000 restaurant locations, the restaurant industry is expected to generate $558 billion in 2008. Restaurant- industry sales on a typical day in 2007 were $1.5 billion. Including the impact restaurants have on sales in related industries, the industry’s overall impact on the U.S. economy is $1.3 trillion a year—about 10 percent of the U.S. gross domestic product. The restaurant industry is the nation’s largest private sector employer. Restaurants employ 12.5 million people today, and are expected to add 1.9 million new jobs between 2006 and 20163.

$42.80

$185.10

$308.20

$511.10 $558.30

$0.00

$100.00

$200.00

$300.00

$400.00

$500.00

$600.00

1970 1986 1996 2006 2007

Restaurant Industry Sales

Note. Figures are in billions of current dollars. 2007 figures are projections.

3 National Restaurant Association

14

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 313

Target Market Trends Texas’s restaurants provide appetizing, healthful and nourishing food, convenience, value, entertainment, and social occasions where people can enjoy friends and family away from the stresses of daily life. Restaurants in Texas also are an engine of economic growth, generating tremendous sales and tax revenues for the state. They provide career-and-employment opportunities for individuals of every age, background, and skill and experience level. Restaurants are an important part of their communities and neighborhoods, enthusiastically and generously giving their time and resources to support a variety of causes4.

Restaurant Statistics - Texas

Category Number

Number of eating and drinking places in Texas 53,631*

2006 restaurant sales in Texas $32 billion**

2006 estimated restaurant and foodservice employment in Texas

905,000

2016 projected restaurant and foodservice employment in Texas

1,110,700

* 2006 estimates **2007 projection

Marketing Strategy (Marketing Plan: Section III)

A. General Description Allocation of Marketing Efforts: In order to fund the marketing efforts, the Company has allocated 5% and 3% of restaurant sales for the first and second year respectively. Management understands that a greater effort will be necessary to promote the restaurant in the first years of business until the Company reached its level run rate. Management anticipates reducing the advertising budget to 2% of restaurant sales once the Company is more established in the area. Community involvement will continue post restaurant opening and will serve as a free form of advertising in local newspapers and bulletins. Karma Jazz Café will also continue to find new and creative ways to communicate its brand to the community and adjust its advertising budget based on its effectiveness and tangible results.

B. Method of Sales and Distribution

• Stores, offices, kiosks. Karma Jazz Café will operate from a facility of approximately 6,000 square feet of space.

• Catalogs, direct mail. Karma Jazz Café plans to plans to use direct mail to reach

out to businesses in the Sundance Square area. Mailers will be sending promoting the restaurant and offering coupons and specials. Mailers will also be sent to local area residents.

4 National Restaurant Association

15

314 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

• Web Site. The Karma Jazz Café will be used to promote the restaurant.

Additionally, patrons will be able to view the menu and information about the restaurant, artists performing, and specials.

C. Packaging Company Image. Karma Jazz Café will establish itself as a cozy venue that features live jazz music.

D. Pricing • Price strategy. The Karma Jazz Café pricing strategy was based on competitor

pricing. After an analysis of the fine dining restaurants in the Sundance Square, Karma Jazz Café set its prices at an even level.

• Competitive position. The only direct competitor is Razzoo’s. Karma Jazz

Café’s prices are higher than those of Razzoo’s. They are higher because Karma Jazz Café is a fine dining restaurant while Razzoo’s is a casual restaurant.

E. Branding Karma Jazz Café will be an authentic Creole restaurant, featuring fine dining and live jazz music. The restaurant will blend the taste, sights, and sounds of Louisiana to create the dining destination of choice in Dallas Fort Worth.

F. Sales Strategies

• Direct Mail - Direct mail will be sent to all local area businesses and residents. These will be aimed, initially, at generating awareness of the existence of Karma Jazz Café. In the future, the mailings will offer coupons and promote various artists performing at the restaurant.

• Email Marketing - Patrons will have the option to complete a guest card. On the

guest card, they will have the option to provide an email address. Karma Jazz Café will use the email addresses to send out notices of events taking place at the restaurant as well as specials and new product offerings. On their birthday, each patron will receive a “Happy Birthday” message and a coupon for a free meal during the month of their birthday.

• Reciprocal Marketing - Karma Jazz Café will make special arrangements with

local area businesses to leave coupon at their location. Guests that bring the coupon will receive the designated discount.

• Viral Marketing - Word-of-mouth will be a major marketing channel for Karma

Jazz Café as satisfied patrons spread the word about the great food, excellent service, and fine dining with a jazzy musical experience.

16

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 315

G. Sales Incentives/Promotions • Free Samples - Karma Jazz Café will give away free samples at various events

including Summer Fest.

• Coupons - Karma Jazz Café will include coupons in its direct mail packages.

• Other - From time to time, Karma Jazz Café will run promotions aimed at generating continued awareness and increasing sales.

H. Advertising Strategies • Traditional Advertising - Word of mouth will be the primary method of

attracting and retaining restaurant guests. Karma Jazz Café will also undertake aggressive advertising campaigns in the form of local newspaper and magazine advertisements, radio, and direct mail to surrounding homes and businesses.

• Web Advertising/New Media - Karma Jazz Café will use search engine optimization to get its web site at the top of search engines when someone conducts a search for restaurants in the Dallas Fort Worth area.

• Long-term Sponsorships - The marketing techniques that will employed for the restaurant’s opening will include a charitable fund raising event with invitations to local business leaders and media personalities. Additionally, the Company will donate a portion of the day’s food sales to local worthwhile charities.

I. Public Relations • Events - Karma Jazz Café also plans to host concierge gatherings for hotels in the

surrounding area so that hotel managers and key employees become acclimated with Karma Jazz Café facility and offerings. These gatherings will be conducted on an annual basis or when new programs are introduced. Karma Jazz Café will utilize a variety of printed material including restaurant brochures, hotel concierge cards, take-out menus, and electronic mailings as another form of advertising.

• Press releases - Karma Jazz Café will use press releases to announce special events taking place at its restaurant. This will begin with the “Grand Opening” announcement press release that will run in newspapers in Dallas and Fort Worth as well as local radio stations.

J. Networking Business Community - The Company’s efforts to become more integrated into

the Sundance Square community will be evidenced by participation in the many events that are hosted in and around the downtown district. This will include either donating products to the hosting organization or becoming a sponsor for various events. Karma Jazz Café will also benefit significantly from a major marketing campaign that is being done for the Sundance Square District by City officials.

World at-Large - Karma Jazz Café plans to participate in various local events including the annual Summer Fest in Fort Worth. During the festival, the restaurant will create a special menu and run various promotions.

17

316 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Customer Service (Marketing Plan: Section IV)

Description of Customer Service Activities Karma Jazz Café will implement the following in order to improve the dining experience for its patrons:

• Interaction between owner and patrons

• Interaction between head chef and patrons

• Offer complimentary samples during longer than normal waits

• Happy birthday tune played by live band

• Jazz recordings during time band is not playing

Expected Outcomes of Achieving Excellence

• Repeat business • Businesses looking at Karma Jazz Café to host their corporate

events • Individuals and families coming to Karma Jazz Café for birthday

and other family events • Establishing and growing catering division

Implementation of Marketing Strategy (Marketing Plan: Section V)

In-House Responsibilities

• Networking

• Concierge events

Out-Sourced Functions

• Advertising

• Public relations

• Search engine optimization

• Web site updates

• Direct mailing

18

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 317

Part III: Financial Documents

2007 Financial Statements (Atlanta, GA Location) Profit & Loss Statement (4th Qtr 2007) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Balance Sheet (Dec. 31, 2007) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21

Sources and Uses of Loan Funds (Ft. Worth Location)

Statement of Financial Needs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Sources and Uses of Funds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22

2008-2010 Financial Projections (Ft. Worth Location)

Assumptions for Financial Projections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement for 2008 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Three-Year Income Projection (2008, 2008, 2010) . . . . . . . 25 Projected Balance Sheet for December 31, 2008 . . . . . . . . . 26 Break-Even Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Charts & Graphs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28

Financial Statement Analysis

Company Financial Statement Analysis Summary . . . . . . . 29 Ratio Table for Karma Jazz Café . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30

19

KJC

318 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

20

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 319

21

320 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Sources and Uses of Funds

KARMA JAZZ CAFÉ Fort Worth, Texas Location

1. Statement of Financial Needs

Karma Jazz Café is seeking funding in the amount of $200,000 for the development of its Fort Worth restaurant location.

2. Sources of Funds

• Owners $100,000 • Investors $100,000

Total $200,000

3. Dispersal of Loan Funds

• Improvements/Renovations $50,000 • Equipment $30,000 • Furniture & Fixtures $40,000 • Restaurant/Business Supplies $10,000 • Inventory $15,000 • Marketing & Advertising $20,000 • Working capital $35,000

Total $200,000

22

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 321

Assumptions for Financial Projections Karma Jazz Café will have a capacity of 200 patrons. The financial projections are based on the actual results derived from the Atlanta operation. Provided below are the key assumptions used to develop the Company’s financial projections.

Average Sale by Customer Type

Average Sale by Category

Customer Purchase Average Spent

Meals (Including soft drinks) $15

Beer and Liquor $8

Corporate Events $500

Meals - Income from meals is expected to be steady throughout the year with heavy growth in the summer months when the City of Fort Worth is hosting various events. The Company expects to average approximately $21,000 per week. These numbers are based on the performances of other restaurants in the area, Billy Miner’s and The Pour House. Billy Miner’s is averaging approximately $28,412 per week. The Pour House is averaging approximately $32,000 per week. Karma Jazz Café was very conservative in its projections. Beer and Liquor - As with meals, beer and liquor sales will be heaviest in the summer months due to a heavy influx of visitors to the Fort Worth area. Happy hour events will help to maintain steady revenue growth for Karma Jazz Café. Liquor sales are based on the actual 2007 liquor sales for five establishments in Downtown Fort Worth. Average annual sales were as follows: Pourhouse - $1,468,648, The Reata – 1,635,218, Razzoos - $862,356. Karma Jazz Café was very conservative in its projections. Corporate Events - Karma Jazz Café will highly publicize its facility as the establishment of choice for hosting corporate events. By the end of the year, the number of event hosted at Karma Jazz Café will increase due to year end corporate parties.

Other Notes

Cost of Goods Sold - Food and beverage purchases have been based on industry averages. The rate of 40% has been applied to the gross food sales figure to derive the cost of goods sold amount. Liquor purchases are calculated based upon industry averages for similar full service restaurants. The rate of 40% has been applied to the total gross liquor sales. Payroll - Salaries are only for support staff. Members of the management team will not draw a salary. They will rely on their savings for living expenses and take owner draws as cash flow allows. Loan Payments - Loan payments will be made over a five year period at an interest rate of 8%. No payments will be due during the first six months.

23

322 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

24

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 323

25

324 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

26

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 325

27

326 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Financial Projection Charts and Graphs

28

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 327

29

328 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

30

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan 329

Part IV: Supporting Documents

Note. For purposes of brevity, we have chosen to include only two of the supporting documents that would be found in the Karma Jazz Café business plan – a timeline chart for launch goals and a location analysis.

Timeline (Milestones)

Timeline (Milestones) - Karma Jazz Café Launch

Activity Start Date End Date Responsible Individual

Research potential locations June 2007 July 2007 DeShea Cook

Conduct competitive analysis June 2007 July 2007 DeShea Cook

Research insurance options August 2007 DeShea Cook

Research security systems August 2007 Raymond Jones

Research legal structure August 2007 Raymond Jones

Retain accountant and attorney September 2007 DeShea Cook

Determine funding needs September 2007 Raymond Jones

Develop business plan September 2007 October 2007 DeShea Cook

Acquire funding October 2007 November 2007 Raymond Jones

Building Upgrades November 2007 December 2007 Steve Cook

Equipment Upgrades November 2007 December 2007 Steve Cook

Menu Development November 2007 December 2007 DeShea Cook

Hire staff November 2007 December 2007 Raymond Jones

Train staff December 2007 Raymond Jones

Initial marketing activities December 2007 DeShea Cook

Order initial inventory December 2007 Steve Cook

Begin operations January 2008

31

KJC

330 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix IV: Karma Jazz Café Business Plan

Location Analysis Note. This location analysis is not complete. It has been abbreviated to highlight a few of the most important component that were considered.

1. Location Address: Sundance Square 201 Main Street Fort Worth, TX 76102

2. Name, address, phone number of realtor/contact person:

Sundance Square Management 201 Main Street, Ste. 700 Fort Worth, TX 76102-3134 Phone: 817-255-5700 Email: [email protected]

3. Neighboring shops and local business climate:

Sundance Square is known as a place that has something for everyone. The district has a host of restaurants, banks, major retail outlets, bookstores, specialty boutiques, concert & performance halls, entertainment, and residential properties. It is also in close proximity to the Fort Worth Convention Center and the Intermodal Transportation Center. Sundance Square also plays host to festivals, concerts, holiday parades, charity walks and more.

4. Location in relation to your target market:

Sundance Square is home to a diverse customer base with plenty of discretionary income. Each year, more than 10 million people pass through Sundance Square including young families and retirees on vacation. It also plays host to convention attendees on a break, business professionals who work nearby, apartment dwellers who live downtown, and Fort Worth citizens on their way to a theatre or music performance.

5. Availability of parking:

For visitors coming to eat or to shop, Sundance Square has great options for validated weekly parking. All the visitor has to do is have their parking ticket validated at any restaurant or retailer. The validation is good for two hours of shopping and dining or four hours when seeing a movie during the weekdays. After 5 PM and all day on Saturday and Sunday the parking is free to all customers.

32

331

Appendix

V

Blank Forms and Worksheets

The forms on the following pages have been provided for you to copy and use in the writing of your business plan. Financial Worksheets The financial worksheet forms that contain "Variable Expenses" and "Fixed Expenses" have spaces for you to fill in your own categories. They should be customized to your particular business. This will require you to decide on category headings when you begin the financial section of your business plan and follow through with the same headings throughout all financial statements. The categories you use on your financial statements are those that you determine to be the major types of expenses your business will have. Those that are frequent and sizable will have a heading of their own (i.e., advertising, rent, salaries, etc.). Those expenses that are very small and infrequent will be included under the heading "miscellaneous" in either the variable or fixed expenses sections of each of your financial statements. If you have a difficult time developing a chart of accounts (categories) for your business, you can seek the help of a tax accounting professional.

332 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix V: Blank Forms and Worksheets

Cash to Be Paid Out Worksheet Business Name: ____________________ Time Period:____________ to ___________

1. Start-Up Costs: $ Business License Corporation Filing Legal Fees

Other start-up costs: a.

b. c. d.

2. Inventory Purchases

Cash out for goods intended for resale

3. Variable Expenses (Selling) a. b. c. d. e. Miscellaneous Variable Expense

Total Selling Expenses

4. Fixed Expenses (Administrative a. b. c. d. e. f. Miscellaneous Fixed Expense

Total Operating Expenses

5. Assets (Long-Term Purchases) Cash to be paid out in current period

6. Liabilities Cash outlay for retiring debts, loans, and/or accounts payable

7. Owner Equity Cash to be withdrawn by owner

Total Cash to Be Paid Out $

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix V: Blank Forms and Worksheets 333

Sources of Cash Worksheet

Business Name: __________________________ Time Period Covered: ___________ to _____________

1. Cash On Hand $ 2. Sales (Revenues)

Sales Service Income

Deposits on Sales or Services

Collections on Accounts Receivable

3. Miscellaneous Income

Interest Income Payments to be Received on Loans

4. Sale of Long-Term Assets 5. Liabilities

Loan Funds (Banks, Lending Inst., SBA, etc.)

6. Equity Owner Investments (Sole Prop. or Partnership) Contributed Capital (Corporation)

Venture Capital

A. Without sales = $ Total Cash Available

B. With sales = $

334 A

natom y of a B

usiness P lan – A

ppendix V : B

lank F orm

s and W orksheets

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix V: Blank Forms and Worksheets 335

336 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix V: Blank Forms and Worksheets

1.

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix V: Blank Forms and Worksheets 337

338 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix V: Blank Forms and Worksheets

A natom

y of a B usiness P

lan – A ppendix V

: B lank F

orm s and W

orksheets 339

340 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix V: Blank Forms and Worksheets

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix V: Blank Forms and Worksheets 341

342 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix V: Blank Forms and Worksheets

Insurance Update Form

Company Contact Person Coverage Cost Per Year

$ $ $ $ $ $

1. TOTAL ANNUAL INSURANCE COST $

2. AVERAGE MONTHLY INSURANCE COST $

Notes: 1. 2.

Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix V: Blank Forms and Worksheets 343

Location Analysis Worksheet

Address:

Name, address, phone number of realtor/contact person:

Square footage/cost:

History of location:

Location in relation to your target market:

Traffic patterns for customers:

Traffic patterns for suppliers:

Availability of parking (include diagram):

Crime rate for the area:

Quality of public services (e.g., police, fire protection):

Notes on walking tour of the area:

Neighboring shops and local business climate:

Zoning regulations:

Adequacy of utilities (information from utility company representatives):

Availability of raw materials/supplies:

Availability of labor force:

Labor rate of pay for the area:

Housing availability for employees:

Tax rates (state, county, income, payroll, special assessments:

Evaluation of site in relation to competition:

344 Anatomy of a Business Plan - Appendix V: Blank Forms and Worksheets

Competition Evaluation Worksheet

1. COMPETITOR:

2. LOCATION:

3. PRODUCTS OR SERVICES OFFERED:

4. METHODS OF DISTRIBUTION:

5. IMAGE: a. Packaging:

b. Promotional materials:

c. Methods of advertising:

d. Quality of product or service:

6. PRICING STRUCTURE:

7. BUSINESS HISTORY & CURRENT PERFORMANCE:

8. MARKET SHARE (number, types, and location of customers):

9. STRENGTHS:

10. WEAKNESSES:

Note. A competition evaluation worksheet should be made for each competitor. You should keep these records and update them throughout the life of your business.

345

Glossary Business and Financial Terms

The following glossary will define business and financial terms with which you may not be familiar. Use of these terms will help you to speak and write in a language that will be understood by potential lenders and investors as well as business associates with whom you may be dealing.

Account A separate record showing the increases and decreases in each asset, liability, owner's equity, revenue and expense item.

Accounting The process by which financial information about a business is recorded, classified, summarized and interpreted by a business.

Accounting professional One who is skilled at keeping business records. Generally, a highly trained professional rather than one who keeps books. An accountant can set up the books needed for a business to operate and help the owner understand them.

Accounts payable A record of what you owe to your creditors for goods or services received.

Accounts receivable A record of what is owed to your business as a result of extending credit to a customer who purchases your products or services. All of the credit accounts taken together are your "accounts receivable."

Affiliate marketing Engages the services of a virtually limitless sales force through some type of commission structure for sales, leads, or website visits. Affiliates are only paid for the actual sales, and their commission is a small percentage of the total sale.

Amortization To liquidate on an installment basis: the process of gradually paying off a liability over a period of time.

Analysis Breaking an idea or problem down into its parts: a thorough examination of the parts of anything.

Asset Anything of worth (having cash value) that is owned by your business (i.e. cash on hand, inventory, land, buildings, vehicles and equipment). Accounts receivable, notes receivable and prepaid purchases are also assets.

Articles of Incorporation A legal document filed with the state which sets forth the purposes and regulations for a corporation. Each state has different regulations.

Bad debts Money owed to you that you cannot collect.

Balance The amount of money remaining in an account.

Balance sheet An itemized statement which lists the total assets and the total liabilities of a given business to portray its net worth at a given moment in time.

Blog Short for Weblog. A Web site that contains an online personal journal with reflections, comments, and often hyperlinks provided by the writer. Used by businesses to gain visibility for their products and/or services.

346 Glossary of Business and Financial Terms

Bookkeeping The process of recording business transactions into the accounting records.

Break-even analysis A method used to determine the point at which the business will neither make a profit nor incur a loss. That point is expressed in either the total dollars of revenue exactly offset by total expenses or in total units of production, the cost of which exactly equals the income derived by their sale.

Bottom line A business's net profit or loss after taxes for a specific accounting period.

Budget A plan expressed in financial terms. A business is then evaluated by measuring its performance in terms of these goals. The budget contains projections for cash inflow and outflow and other balance sheet items.

Business venture Taking financial risks in a commercial enterprise.

Capital Money available to invest or the total of accumulated assets available for production. See "Owner's Equity."

Capital equipment Equipment which you use to manufacture a product, provide a service, or use to sell, store, and deliver merchandise. Such equipment will not be sold in the normal course of business, but will be used and worn out or consumed in the course of business.

Capital expenditures An expenditure for a purchase of an item of property, plant or equipment that has a useful life of more than one year. (Fixed assets)

Cash Money in hand or readily available.

Cash discount A deduction that is given for prompt payment of a bill.

Cash flow The actual movement of cash within a business; cash inflow and cash outflow.

Cash receipts The money received by a business from customers.

Collateral Something of value given or held as a pledge that a debt or obligation will be fulfilled.

Contract An agreement regarding mutual responsibilities between two or more parties.

Controllable expenses Those expenses which can be controlled or restrained by the business person. Variable expenses.

Corporation A voluntary organization of persons, either actual individuals or legal entities, legally bound together to form a business enterprise; an artificial legal entity created by government grant and treated by law as an individual.

Co-signers Joint signers of a loan agreement, pledging to meet the obligations in case of default.

Cost of goods sold The cost of inventory sold during an accounting period. It is equal to the beginning inventory for the period plus the cost of purchases made during the period minus the ending inventory for the period.

Creditor A company or individual to whom a business owes money.

Current assets Cash plus any assets that will be converted into cash within one year plus any assets that you plan to use up within one year.

Current liabilities Debts that must be paid within one year.

Current ratio A dependable indication of liquidity computed by dividing current assets by current liabilities. A ratio of 2.0 is acceptable for most businesses.

Depreciable base of an asset The cost of an asset used in the computation of yearly depreciation expense.

Glossary of Business and Financial Terms 347

Direct expenses Those expenses that relate directly to your product or service.

Debt Capital The part of the investment capital which must be borrowed.

Debt That which is owed.

Debt measures The indication of the amount of other people's money that is being used to generate profits for a business. The more indebtedness, the greater the risk of failure.

Debt ratio The key financial ratio used by creditors in determining how indebted a business is and how able it is to service the debts. The debt ratio is calculated by dividing total liabilities by total assets. The higher the ratio, the more risk of failure. The acceptable ratio is dependent upon the policies of your creditors and bankers.

Default Failure to pay a debt or meet an obligation.

Depreciation A decrease in value through age, wear or deterioration. Depreciation is a normal expense of doing business which must be taken into account. There are laws and regulations governing the manner and time periods that can be used for depreciation.

Expenses The costs of producing revenue through the sale of goods or services.

Entrepreneur An innovator of business enterprise who recognizes opportunities to introduce a new product, a new process, or an improved organization, and who raises the necessary money, assembles the factors for production, and organizes an operation to exploit the opportunity.

Equity The monetary value of a property or business which exceeds claims and/or liens against it by others.

Financial statements The periodic reports that summarize the financial affairs of a business.

Fixed assets Items purchased for use in a business which are depreciable over a fixed period of time determined by the expected useful life of the purchase. Usually includes land, buildings, vehicles and equipment not intended for resale. Land is not depreciable, but is a fixed asset.

Fixed expenses Those costs which don't vary from one period to the next. Generally, these expenses are not affected by the volume of business.

Gross Overall total revenues before deductions.

Gross profit on sales The difference between net sales and the cost of goods sold.

Gross profit margin An indicator of the percentage of each sales dollar remaining after a business has paid for its goods. It is computed by dividing the gross profit by the sales.

Horizontal analysis A percentage analysis of the increases and decreases on the items on comparative financial statements. A horizontal financial statement analysis involves comparison of data for the current period with the same data of a company for previous periods. The percentage of increase or decrease is listed.

Income statement A financial document that shows how much money (revenue) came in and how much money (expense) was paid out. This is also known as a profit and loss statement.

Interest The cost of borrowing money. The price charged or paid for the use of money or credit.

Inventory The stock of goods that a business has on hand for sale to its customers.

Invest To lay out money for any purpose from which a profit is expected.

Invest measures Ratios used to measure an owner's earnings for his or her investment in the company. See "Return on investment (ROI)."

348 Glossary of Business and Financial Terms

Invoice A bill for the sale of goods or services sent by the seller to the purchaser.

Lease A long term rental agreement.

Liabilities Amounts owed by a business to its creditors. The debts of a business.

Liability insurance Risk protection for actions for which a business is liable.

Limited partnership A legal partnership where some owners are allowed to assume responsibility only up to the amount invested.

Liquidate To settle a debt or to convert to cash.

Liquidity The ability of a company to meet its financial obligations. A liquidity analysis focuses on the balance sheet relationships for current assets and current liabilities.

Loan Money or other assets let out temporarily, usually for a specified amount of interest.

Long-term liabilities Liabilities that will not be due for more than a year in the future.

Management The art of conducting and supervising a business.

Marketing All the promotional activities involved in the buying and selling of a product or service.

Merchandise Goods bought and sold in a business. "Merchandise" or stock is a part of inventory.

Net income The amount by which revenue is greater than expenses. On an income statement this is usually expressed as both a pre-tax and after-tax figure.

Net loss The amount by which expenses are greater than revenue. On an income statement this figure is usually listed as both a pre-tax and after-tax figure.

Net profit margin The measure of a business's success with respect to earnings on sales. It is derived by dividing the net profit by sales. A higher margin means the firm is more profitable.

Net worth The owner's equity in a given business represented by the excess of the total assets over the total amounts owing to outside creditors (total liabilities) at a given moment in time. The net worth of an individual is determined by deducting the amount of all personal liabilities from the total of all personal assets.

Nonrecurring One time, not repeating. "Nonrecurring" expenses are those involved in starting a business which only have to be paid once and will not occur again.

Note A written promise with terms for payment of a debt.

Operating expenses Normal expenses incurred in the running of a business.

Operating profit margin The ratio representing the pure operations profits, ignoring interest and taxes. It is derived by dividing the income from operations by the sales. The higher the percentage of operating profit margin the better.

Other expenses Expenses that are not directly connected with the operation of a business. The most common is interest income.

Other income Income that is earned from non-operating sources. The most common is interest income.

Owners' equity The financial interest of the owner of a business. The total of all owner equity is equal to the business's assets minus its liabilities. The owners' equity represents total investments in the business plus or minus profits or losses the business has accrued to date.

Glossary of Business and Financial Terms 349

Partnership A legal business relationship of two or more people who share responsibilities, resources, profits, and liabilities.

Payable Ready to be paid. One of the standard accounts kept by a bookkeeper is "accounts payable." This is a list of those bills which are current and due to be paid.

Personal financial history A summary of personal financial information about the owner of a business. The personal financial history is often required by a potential lender or investor.

Portal A site serving as a guide or point of entry to the World Wide Web and usually including a search engine or a collection of links to other sites arranged especially by topic. Portals can be of the consumer type or enterprise type. A Portal attracts a broad (horizontal) range of users. Advertising on a portal guarantees a tremendous number of viewers at an extremely high cost.

Prepaid expenses Expense items that are paid for prior to their use. Some examples are insurance, rent, prepaid inventory purchases, etc.

Principal The amount shown on the face of a note or a bond. Unpaid principal is the amount remaining at any given time.

Pro Forma A projection or estimate of what may result in the future from actions in the present. A pro forma financial statement is one that shows how the actual operations of the business will turn out if certain assumptions are achieved.

Profit Financial gain; returns over expenditures. The sum remaining after deducting costs.

Profit margin The difference between your selling price and all of your costs.

Profit and loss statement A list of the total amount of sales (revenues) and total costs (expenses). The difference between revenues and expenses is your profit or loss. This is also known as an income statement.

Publicity Information with news value issued as a means of gaining public attention or support.

Quarterly budget analysis A method used to measure actual income and expenditures against projections for the current quarter of the financial year and for the total quarters completed. The difference is expressed as the amount and percentage over or under budget.

Quick ratio A test of liquidity subtracting inventory from current assets and dividing the result by current liabilities. A quick ratio of 1.0 or greater is usually recommended.

Ratio analysis An analysis involving the comparison of two individual items on financial statements. One item is divided by the other and the relationship is expressed as a ratio.

Receivable Ready for payment. When you sell on credit, you keep an "accounts receivable" as a record of what is owed to you and who owes it. In accounting, a "receivable" is an asset.

Reciprocal marketing Arrangements in which one company offers customers incentives to buy another company’s goods.

Retail business A business that sells goods and services directly to individual consumers.

Retained earnings Earnings of a corporation that are kept in the business and not paid out in dividends. This amount represents the accumulated, undistributed profits of the corporation.

Return on investment (ROI) The rate of profit an investment will earn. The ROI is equal to the annual net income divided by total assets. The higher the ROI, the better. Business owners should set a target for the ROI and decide what they want their investments to earn.

Revenue The income that results from the sale of products or services or from the use of investments or property.

Service business A business that provides services rather than products to its customers.

350 Glossary of Business and Financial Terms

Share One of the equal parts into which the ownership of a corporation is divided. A "share" represents a part ownership in a corporation.

Sole proprietorship A legal structure of a business having one person as the owner.

Stock Accumulated merchandise.

Stockholders' equity The stockholders' shares of stock in a corporation plus any retained earnings.

SWOT analysis "SWOT" stands for Strengths, Weaknesses, Opportunities, and Threats. A SWOT analysis is an in-depth examination of key factors that are internal (strengths and weaknesses) and external (opportunities and threats) to a business.

Takeover The acquisition of one company by another.

Tangible personal property Machinery, equipment, furniture and fixtures not attached to the land.

Target market The specific individuals, distinguished by socio-economic, demographic, and interest characteristics, who are the most likely potential customers for the goods and services of a business.

Terms of sale The conditions concerning payment for a purchase.

Three-year projection A pro forma (projected) income statement showing anticipated revenues and expenses for a business.

Trade credit Permission to buy from suppliers on open account.

Unearned income Revenue received, but not yet earned.

Variable costs Expenses that vary in relationship to the volume of activity of a business

Vertical analysis A percentage analysis used to show the relationship of the components in a single financial statement. In vertical analysis of an income statement each item on the statement is expressed as a percentage of net sales.

Viral marketing Occurs when a company offers something that people find so intriguing that they spread the word on their own.

Volume An amount or quantity of business; the "volume" of a business is the total it sells over a period of time.

Vortal They are sometimes called 'online communities' or ' vertical portals.' Vortals focus on a group of people with a specific passion or interest. Vortals appeal to a more narrowed (vertical) audience, offering access to niche markets on a larger scale.

Web site a group of World Wide Web pages usually containing hyperlinks to each other and made available online by an individual, company, educational institution, government, or organization.

Wholesale Selling for resale.

Wholesale business A business that sells its products to other wholesalers, retailers or volume customers at a discount.

Working capital Current assets minus current liabilities. This is a basic measure of a company's ability to pay its current obligations.

351

Index A Accounting and taxes, 127-36 planning for, 40 187, 226-27, 268, 307 Actual performance strategies, 79, 100-111 Administrative Plan, 37 Advertising strategies, 55-57, 193-94, 230-32, 277-80, 315 Analysis financial statement, 112-18 product-market, 64-77 quarterly budget, 94-95, 202 Anatomy of a Business Plan software (AYBP) companion to book, ix, 153 Area studies, 122 Assets, 3, 108 willingness to risk own, 3 Assumptions, financial, 12-13, 250, 285-86, 321 Automate Your Business Plan information—order form, ix

B Balance sheet, 101-103 example of, 103, 208, 240, 290, 324 explanation of categories, 102 horizontal analysis, 117 nonprofit, for a, 144 projected, 204, 245, 290, 324 vertical analysis, 117, 248-49, 327 Banner ads, 56 Branding, 45, 52 Break-even analysis, 98-99, 205, 241, 291, 325 graphically, 99 mathematically calculating, 98 Budget analysis quarterly, 94-95, 202

Budget deviation analysis for nonprofits, 149 Business, description of, 32-34, 182, 222, 261, 303 Business financial history (loan app.), 108-11 example of (form), 110-11 Business Model, 32, 261 Business plan considerations, 1-16 Dayne Landscaping, Inc., 217-254 Karma Jazz Café, 295-330 keeping it up-to-date, 151, 154-56 length of, 153 Marine Art of California, 177-216 nonprofit business planning, 137-50 packaging your, 151-56 software, ix, 152-53, Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc., 255-94

C Calendars of Federal Taxes for Which You May Be Liable, 128-133 calendars by legal structure, 130-133 Cash flow statement, proforma, 84-93 one year projection and history, 242 plan examples, 200, 242, 288, 322 Catalog, 51 cost analysis, 212 Competition comparison, 48, examples, 190, 213, 230, 251, 272, 310 Considerations, business plan, 1-16 Consultant, business plan, 261 Contingent liabilities, 108 Contracts, 119, 122, 215 Copyrights, 42 Corporation, 38 calendar of federal taxes, 133

352

Cover sheet, 17-19, 153 examples of, 19, 179, 219, 257, 297 Credit, history and reports, 3, 121 Customer base, building, 45, 62 changing needs in, 154 rules for success with, 65-67 service, 61-62, 65, 280

D Database analysis and marketing, 50, 52 Dayne Landscaping, Inc. business plan, 217-54 Debt measures, 116 Debt financing, 159 Demographics, 47, 119, 122, 154 Description (Summary) of the Business, 32 Design, Gallery 196 Direct mail, 53 Direct sales, 53 Distribution, methods of sales and, 51

examples, 192, 230, 276, 313

Distributors, 35

E E-mail marketing, 54 E-Tailers, 16, 36 E-Tailing, steps to, 16 Employee profile, 40, 186, 226, 307 Equity financing, 163-64 Event planning, 58 Executive summary, 21-30 examples of, 27, 28, 181, 221, 259, 299 Exit strategy, 4, 7-11 financing and choice of, 9-10 forms of, 8-9 legal and tax issues, 10-11 Extreme advertising, 56

F Financial Assumptions, 12-13, 250, 285, 321

Financial goals, 3 history, 108-11 needs, summary of, 80-81, 82, 283, 320 Financial documents, 2, 77-118 Dayne Landscaping, 236-50 Karma Jazz Café, 317-28 Marine Art of California, 198-210 Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, 282-93 Financial statement automated, 152 business, example of, 110-11 owner's, example of, 124-25 Financial statement analysis, 112-118 horizontal analysis, 117 ratio table, 210, 247, 293, 328 summary, 209, 246, 292, 327 vertical analysis, 248-49, 292, 327 Financing your business, 157-66 borrowing money, 157 costs of financing options, 164 debt financing, 159 equity financing, 163 sources available, 158 SBA guaranteed loans, 159 SBICs, 164 venture capitalists, 164 Focus groups, 49-50 Foreign markets, 2 legal and tax systems in, 127 networking in, 59 Forms, blank, 331-344

G Glossary of business and financial terms, 345-50 Goals marketing, 44-46 meeting lender's financial, 3 Guide, business plan as, 2

H Horizontal financial statement analysis, 117

353

I In-house marketing, 62 (See also Marketing) Incentives, 54-55 Income projection, three year, 96 examples, 203, 244, 287, 323 Income statement, 79, 96-97, 104-108, 114-18,

examples, 206-07, 239, 318 form, 106 format, 105 Industry organizations, networking through, 60 trends (See Trends) Insurance, 41, 109, 187, 227, 268, 308 Insurance update form, 41, 342 Intellectual property, 42, 266, International organizations, 61 Internet marketing strategies, 16, 43 (See also Mobile Home.com, Inc.) ordering IRS information through, 134 reaching target market through, 49 research, 48 (See also Research Resources) sales, 36 Inventory details, 108 Investment measures, 116 Investors, what they look for, 2-5 IRS information, 127-36 ordering, 134, order form, 136 publications, 129, 134-35

K Keeping the Books, 118 Karma Jazz Café business plan, 295-330

L Leases, copies of, 119, 121 Legal documents, 119, 122 representation, 41, 187, 227, 268, 308 structure, 38, 109, 183, 224, 267, 305

Lenders, what they look for, 2-5 Letters of reference, 119, 121, 216, 254 Liabilities, 108 Limited partnership, proposal for, 214 Liquidity ratios, 114 Loan fund dispersal statement, 78-81, 80-81 examples of, 82, 237, 320 Location, 37, 195-96, 266, 305 analysis worksheet, 38 in organizational plan, 37 studies, 119, 122 M Management, 39, 184, 224, 267, 306 Manufacturers, 34-35 Marine Art of California business plan, 177-216 Market analysis, 47-50, 64-76, 269-75, 309-13 entry, timing of, 197 research resources, 191 trends, assessing, 48-49, 273-75, 312 Marketing firms, hiring, 62 Marketing plan, 43-76 assessment of effectiveness, 63, 281 components of successful multimedia strategy, 68-70 contents of, 50-51 customer service, 61-62 Dayne Landscaping, Inc., 228-235 implementing, 62, 281 Karma Jazz Café, 309-16 Marine Art of California, 189-97 outline, 75-76 overview and goals of, 44-46 Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, 269-81 Marketing promotion, worksheet, 233-35 Media outlets new, 56-57 traditional, 55 Memberships, 59-61 Mission Statement, 32

example of, 222, 261, 303

354

N Net profit margin, 115 Net worth, 101 Networking, 59-61 global, 61 through civic organizations, 60-61 Niche markets, 47 Nonprofit, Business Planning for a, 137-50 Nonprofit, how to use the book, 14-15 Nonprofit organizations, understanding, 138-39

benefits of nonprofits, 138-39 obtaining legal nonprofit status, 139 qualifications to become a nonprofit, 139 types of nonprofits, 138

Nonprofits, differences in plan parts, 139-50 executive summary, 140 organizational plan, 140

marketing plan, 142-43 financial documents 143-49 supporting documents, 150 Nonprofits, statement of activities, 145 Nonprofits, statement of financial position, 144

O Offline sales, 53 Online advertising networks, 57 (See also Internet, Web site) sales, 53 Operating profit margin, 115 Organizational chart, example of, 39 Organizational Plan, 31-42 Organizational plan examples Dayne Landscaping, Inc., 222-27 Karma Jazz Café, 303-08 Marine Art of California, 182-88 Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, 261-68 Outsourcing, 62 Outline business plan, 6 marketing plan, 75-76 Owner's financial statement, 119, 121 example of, 124-25

P Packaging, 51 your business plan, 151-56 Partnership, 38 calendar of federal taxes, 131 Patents, 42 Personal Digital Assistant (PDA)

advertising, 56-57 Personnel, 40, 185-86, 225-226, 268, 307 Pitch, sales, 73 Portals, advertising on, 57 Presentation of business plan, 153 Press coverage, 58-59 Pricing, 46, 51-52, 74, 195, 276, 314 Pro forma statements, 78-79, 80, 83-93, examples, 242-43, 288-89, 322 non-profits, for, 147-48 Problems, anticipating, 155 Products, 34, 183, 223, 266, 305 description of, 34-35 increase in sales of, 45 market analysis, 64-77 Products and/or Services, 34, 183, 223, 266, 305 Professional associations, 60-61 Profit and loss (income) statement forms, 107-08 statements and balance sheets, 79, 104-108, 114-18, 206-08, 239-40, 318-19 Profitability analysis, 115 Projections, 4-5, 79, 200-05, 241-45, 287-93,

322-28 Promotions, 54-55 Proposal for limited partnership, 214 Proprietary position, 4 Psychographics, 47, 154 Public relations, 58-61, 280, 315 outsourcing, 62 Public speaking, 61 Q Quarterly budget analysis, 94-95, 202 form, 95, 335 Questionnaires, 49

355

R Ratios, 113-18 financial statement analysis, 209, 246, 292, 328 Reciprocal marketing, 54 Record keeping (and Accounting) auditing , 109 methods of accounting and, 40 and taxes, 127-36 Research, 49-50, 279 (See also Marketing) Research Resources, 167-76 Retailer, 35-36 Résumés, 119, 120-21, 123, 252-53 Revision of business plan, 154-56 S S corporation, calendar of federal taxes, 132 Sales and distribution, methods of, 51

examples, 192-94, 230, 276, 313 Sales pitch worksheet, 73 strategies, 51, 53-55, 228-29, 276, 314 worksheet for "selective," 71 SBA guaranteed loans, 159-63

Small Business Investment Companies (SBICs), 164

Security, 33-34, 188, 227, 268, 308 Services, 36, 45, 183, 223, 266, 305 Small business organization networks, 60 Smart television advertising, 57. See also Advertising Software Automate Your Business Plan, ix, 153 business plan, 151, 152-53, Sole proprietor, 38 calendar of federal taxes, 129-33 Sponsorships, long term, 57 Spreadsheets, automated, 152 Statement of Financial Position, nonprofit

balance sheet, 144 Statement of Activities, nonprofit (P&L

or income statement), 145-46

Strategy, company, 32

example of, 262, 304 Strategic relationships, 32

example of, 263 Summary of the Business, 32, 182, 222, 261, 303 Summary financial statement analysis, 112-13, 114-18, 246, 292, 327 Summary of financial needs, 78, 80-81 example of, 82, 237, 283, 320 Supporting documents, 6, 119-26 Dayne Landscaping, 251-54 Karma Jazz Café, 329-30 Marine Art of California, 211-16 Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc., 294 Supporting documents for nonprofits, 150 Surveys, 50 SWOT Analysis, 32-34

T Table of contents, vi-viii, 20, 153 examples of, 180, 220, 258, 298 Target markets, 189, 228-29, 269-71, 309 analysis of trends influencing, 49 identifying, 47 test marketing of, 4 Tax information, 127-36 calendars of federal taxes for which you may be liable, 130-34 publications, 134-36 schedule C, 128 Technological changes, 154 Television advertising, 55 Theft, 188, 227, 308 Three year income projection, 96-97, 203, 244, 287, 323

for a nonprofit, 146 form, 97 Time, effective use of in writing plan, 6 Trademarks, 42 Trading offer, example of, 126 Trends, market/industry 190-91, 273, 312

356 Index

V Venture capital financing, 164 Vertical analysis, 117, 248-49, 292, 327 Volunteering, 61 Vortals (vertical portals), advertising on, 57

W Web site advertising, 56-57 as public relations vehicle, 58 Web site, cont. competitor's, 48 description, 51 (See also Internet,

Marketing, Online) Wholesale Mobile Home.com, Inc. business

plan, 255-294 Worksheets, blank forms and, 331-44

balance sheet, 338 break-even analysis graph, 337 cash to be paid out worksheet, 332 competition evaluation worksheet, 344 financial statement analysis ratio

ratio table, 341 insurance update form, 342 location analysis worksheet, 343 profit and loss (income) statement,

12-month, 339 profit and loss (income) statement,

annual, 340 pro forma cash flow statement, 334 quarterly budget analysis, 335 sources of cash worksheet, 333 three-year income projection, 336 Writing, key to effective 5 www.wmhinc.com, 255-294

"Anatomy of a Business Plan and Automate Your Business Plan have

served as excellent business planning and financial analysis tools

for Dale Carnegie Training Centers Worldwide.” Marc K. Johnston Senior Vice President, Franchise Development

Dale Carnegie Training Centers Worldwide

Linda Pinson is an award-winning author, business planning expert, speaker, consultant, and nationally recognized business educator with specialties in financial management and small business curriculum development. The author of nine popular entrepreneurial books, she has also developed and published the best selling business plan software program,

. Linda is an executive officer on the SBFDC (California State Loan Program) Board of Directors and is a member of the TriCounty SBDC Advisory Board. Her dedication to the small business community has been recognized through awards from the U.S. Small Business Administration, the National Association of Women Business Owners, and the State of California. Linda was a delegate and tax issue chair at the White House Conference on Small Business.

Automate Your Business Plan

About the Author

The Complete Business Planning Tool!

New in the 7th Edition

Thomas J. Wacker

Centaur Holdings Corporation

Jeffrey L. Seglin

Inc. Magazine

Mark Henricks

Crain’s Chicago Business

“Anatomy of a Business Plan is one of the best books on the basics of putting together a thoughtful, thorough, and professional business plan.”

“Anatomy of a Business Plan with its companion software, Automate Your Business Plan, is the best step-by-step guide for starting, building, and raising capital for a business. We have raised more than $20 million for our clients by using it. We have an additional $15 million now pending. Use it! It works!”

“Most business plans need updating to account for new tax laws and other changes. (Anatomy of a Business Plan) is one of the newest - and best - on the topic.”

Award-winning author and consultant Linda Pinson has empowered more than a million businesses with her book, . New entrepreneurs use this book to kick- start their companies. Established businesses access it to expand their operations and move into new markets. Business units within major corporations use it for strategic planning. All business owners, managers, intrapreneurs, entrepreneurs, and executives can use these proven business planning techniques to put their businesses on the road to greater profitability.

Anatomy of a Business Plan

Anatomy of a Business Plan, Ben Franklin Award winner, “Best Business Book of the Year,” is the road-tested guide that enables owners and managers to develop polished, professional, and results- oriented plans that will enable their companies to gain that all important competitive edge and secure funding from banks, venture capitalists, angel investors, and corporations.

Write a business plan that excites lenders or investors...and puts money in your pockets.

Research and reach your customers with a winning targeted marketing strategy.

Use financial statement analysis to measure progress and make profitability decisions.

Build a credible financial plan. Learn how to make projections and plan cash flow.

Evaluate the potential of your business in the global marketplace.

Develop a plan that will guide you during the lifetime of your business.

This new edition of has been revised to reflect the latest online and printed financial and marketing resources and current business plan practices and is loaded with ready-to-use forms and worksheets and complete real-world business plans.

Anatomy of a Business Plan

Financing Your Business. You will be happy to see our new chapter on financing. Learn about debt and equity financing, types of loans, and sources of financing.

Business Planning for Nonprofits. There is a brand new chapter devoted to business planning specific to nonprofit organizations. With guidance from the chapter and reference icons at various points in the planning process, you will be neatly guided through the development of a plan that is appropriate for your nonprofit.

Karma Jazz Cafe Business Plan.

Anatomy of a Business Plan. There are now four complete business plans included in

Over the years, several of our readers have asked for a business plan for a restaurant. We now have one and hope you will like it.

Use our Business Plan Software

Automate Your Business Plan is a stand alone Windows application. With all of its advanced features, you will easily develop a winning business plan that is completely customized for your business. The software guides you step-by step through the entire business plan process with complete instructions, examples, and templates for every task. You will save 100+ hours with our Integrated (Linked) spreadsheet workbook with formatted and pre- formulated financials, ratio and budget analysis spreadsheets, and auto-generated charts and graphs.

(Order information and discount coupon inside book, pages ix-x)

Create multiple plans; export and import your projects between your office and laptop; save plans as PDFs for sharing; print your entire plan in one step; use our online web research site.

13381 White Sand Drive Tustin, CA, USA 92780-4565

Tel: 714-544-0248 Web Site: www.business-plan.com

TM

OUT OF YOUR MIND . . .

AND INTO THE MARKETPLACE

Business Books

Business Plan Software

  • Anatomy of a Business Plan - 7th edition eBook
    • Copyright & License Page
    • Book and Software Testimonials
    • About the Author
    • Dedication and Acknowledgments
    • Preface
    • Automate Your Business Plan Software
  • Table of Contents
    • Chapter 1 - Business Plan Considerations
      • Why Do You Need a Business Plan?
      • What Do Lenders and Investors Look For?
      • The Key to Effective Writing
      • Develop an Exit Strategy
        • Where is the Finish Line?
        • What are Some of the Forms of Exit?
        • Make Decisions Based on Your Exit Strategy
        • Exit Planning Just Makes Good Sense!
      • Developing Financial Assumptions
        • What are Financial Assumptions?
        • Adding Financial Assumption Explanations
        • What Is the Process for Developing Your Assumptions?
      • Nonprofit Organizations
        • Business Planning for Your Nonprofit
        • How to Use the Nonprofit Chapter
      • Summary of Steps to E-tailing
    • Chapter 2 - The Cover Sheet and Table of Contents
      • The Cover Sheet
      • Sample Cover Sheet
      • The Table of Contents
    • Chapter 3 - Executive Summary
    • Chapter 4 - Part I The Organizational Plan
      • Section I: Summary of the Business
      • Section II: Products or Services
      • Section III: Administrative Plan
        • Location
        • Legal Structure
        • Management and Personnel
        • Accounting and Legal
        • Insurance
        • Security
        • Intellectual Property
      • Summary
    • Chapter 5 - Part II The Marketing Plan
      • Section I: Overview and Goals of a Marketing Strategy
        • Definition of a Marketing Strategy
        • Goals of Your Marketing Strategy
      • Section II: Market Analysis
        • Identify Target Markets
        • Research Your Competition
        • Assess Market Trends
        • Conduct Market Research
      • Section III: Contents of Your Marketing Strategy
        • General Description
        • Method of Sales and Distribution
        • Packaging
        • Pricing Policy
        • Branding
        • Database Marketing
        • Sales Strategies
        • Sales Incentives/Promotions
        • Advertising Strategies
        • Public Relations
        • Networking
      • Section IV: Customer Service
      • Section V: Implementation of Marketing Strategy
        • In-House Responsibilities
        • Out-sourced Functions
      • Section VI: Assessment of Marketing Effectiveness
      • The Product-Market Analysis
      • Components of a Successful Multi-Media Marketing Strategy
      • Marketing Musts Worksheets
        • 1. Sell Selectively
        • 2. Know Your Niche
        • 3. Create Your Pitch
        • 4. Set Prices for Profits
      • Marketing Plan Outline
    • Chapter 6 - Part III Financial Documents
      • Purpose of Financial Documents
      • Types of Financial Documents
      • How to Proceed
      • Section I: Statements of Financial Needs & Uses of Funds from a Lender or Investor
        • Summary of Financial Needs
        • Loan Fund Dispersal Statement
        • Sample Summary of Financial Needs & Loan Fund Dispersal Statement
      • Section II: Pro Forma Statements
        • Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement (Budget)
        • Quarterly Budget Analysis
        • Three-Year Income Projection
        • Break-Even Analysis
      • Section III: Actual Performance (Historical) Financial Statements
        • Balance Sheet
        • Profit & Loss (Income) Statement
        • Business Financial History
        • Business Financial History Form
      • Section IV: Financial Statement Analysis: The Final Tool
        • Financial Statement Analysis
        • Analyzing Your P&L (Income) Statements & Balance Sheets
    • Chapter 7 - Part IV Supporting Documents
      • Personal Résumés
      • Owner’s Financial Statement
      • Credit Reports
      • Copies of Leases
      • Letters of Reference
      • Contracts
      • Legal Documents
      • Sample Résumé
      • Personal Financial Statement
    • Chapter 8 - U. S. Tax Information:
      • Comparing the U.S. Tax Systemand Business Accounting
      • Federal Taxes for Which You May be Liable
        • Tax Calendar - Sole Proprietor
        • Tax Calendar - Partnership
        • Tax Calendar - S Corporation
        • Tax Calendar - Corporation
      • Free Tax Publications Available from the IRS
      • Order Blank - IRS Forms and Publications
    • Chapter 9 - Business Planning for a Nonprofit
      • Understanding Nonprofits
      • Business Planning For Your Nonprofit Organization
        • Executive Summary
        • Part I: Organizational Plan
        • Part II: The Marketing Plan
        • Part III: Financial Documents
        • Part IV: Supporting Documents
    • Chapter 10 - Packaging Your Plan And Keeping It Up-to-Date
      • Part I: Business Plan Software
      • Part II: Packaging for Success
      • Part III: Keeping Your Plan Up-to-Date
    • Chapter 11 - Financing Your Business
      • Will You Need to Borrow Money?
      • How Much Do You Need — When Do You Need It?
      • What are the Sources Available to You?
        • Debt Financing
        • Equity Financing
      • Which Type of Financing Costs the Most?
      • Calculating the Cost
    • Chapter 12 - U.S. and International Resources for Business Plan Research
      • Internet Resources
      • Library Resources
      • Publications and Periodicals
      • Indexes to Periodicals and Magazine Articles
      • Books
      • U.S. Government Departments
      • U.S. Small Business Administration
    • Appendix I - Marine Art of California Business Plan
      • Introduction
      • Cover Sheet
      • Table of Contents
      • Executive Summary
      • I. Organizational Plan
      • II. Marketing Plan
      • III. Financial Documents
      • IV. Supporting Documents
    • Appendix II - Dayne Landscaping, Inc. Business Plan
      • Introduction
      • Cover Sheet
      • Table of Contents
      • Executive Summary
      • I. Organizational Plan
      • II. Marketing Plan
      • III. Financial Documents
      • IV. Supporting Documents
    • Appendix III - Wholesale Mobile Homes.com, Inc. Business Plan
      • Introduction
      • Cover Sheet
      • Table of Contents
      • Executive Summary
      • Part I: Organizational Plan
      • Part II: Marketing Plan
      • Part III: Financial Documents
      • Part IV: Supporting Documents
    • Appendix IV - Karma Jazz Café Business Plan
      • Introduction
      • Cover Sheet
      • Table of Contents
      • Executive Summary
      • Part I: Organizational Plan
      • Part II: Marketing Plan
      • Part III: Financial Documents
      • Part IV: Supporting Documents
    • Appendix V - Blank Forms and Worksheets
      • Cash to Be Paid Out Worksheet
      • Sources of Cash Worksheet
      • Pro Forma Cash Flow Statement
      • Quarterly Budget Analysis
      • Three-Year Income Projection
      • Break-Even Analysis Graph
      • Balance Sheet
      • Profit & Loss (Income) Statement
      • Financial Statement Analysis Ratio Table
      • Insurance Update Form
      • Location Analysis Worksheet
      • Competition Evaluation Worksheet
    • Glossary
    • Index
      • A
      • B
      • C
      • D
      • E
      • F
      • G
      • H
      • K
      • L
      • M
      • N
      • O
      • P
      • Q
      • R
      • S
      • T
      • V
      • W
  • Back Cover
  1. Button 1:
  2. Button 2:
    1. 2008-07-25T20:35:26-0400
    2. M01